Easergy Micom P139: Feeder Management and Bay Control
Easergy Micom P139: Feeder Management and Bay Control
Easergy Micom P139: Feeder Management and Bay Control
P139/EN M/R-b5-B
Technical Manual
Volume 1 of 2
General Note on the PDF Version of this Technical Manual
All entries in the Table of Contents and all cross-references to other sections,
figures etc. in green letters are hyperlinks, i.e. by a single mouse click on the
reference one can navigate directly to the referenced part of the manual.
In the Adobe Reader (or the Acrobat Pro), one can return back to the previous
view by using the menu point View / Page Navigation / Previous View (keyboard
shortcut: ALT + Left cursor key). (It might be necessary to do this several times,
if the view at the target location has also been changed (e.g. by scrolling or
changing the zoom setting).
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
NOTICE: Read these instructions carefully, and look at the equipment to become familiar
with the device before trying to install, operate, or maintain it. The following
special messages may appear throughout this documentation or on the equipment
to warn of potential hazards or to call attention to information that clarifies or
simplifies a procedure.
The addition of this symbol to a Danger or Warning safety label indicates that an
electrical hazard exists, which will result in death or serious injury if the
instructions are not followed.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to a potential personal injury
hazard. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol to avoid possible injury or
death.
DANGER
DANGER indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided,
will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided,
can result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided,
can result in minor or moderate injury with or without equipment damage.
NOTICE
NOTICE, used without safety alert symbol, indicates a potentially hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, can result in equipment damage.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Switch off the auxiliary power supply before any work in the terminal strip
area.
⚫ Switch off all the power supplies in connection to the equipment before
any work in the terminal strip area to isolate the device.
⚫ Do not touch the terminal strip area when equipment is in operation.
⚫ Do not remove or add wires in the terminal strip area when equipment is
in operation.
⚫ Short-circuit the system current transformers before disconnecting wires
to the transformer board (valid only for pin terminals, not required for ring
terminals which have a shortening block).
⚫ A protective conductor (ground/earth) of at least 1.5 mm2 must be
connected to the protective conductor terminal on the power supply board
and on the main relay case.
⚫ Do never remove the protective conductor connection to the device casing
as long as other wires are connected to it.
⚫ Where stranded conductors are used, insulated crimped wire end ferrules
must be employed.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Note: Regarding the appropriate wiring connections of the equipment refer to the
document Px3x_Grounding_Application_Guide_EN_h.pdf.
The signals MAI N: Bl ocke d/f aul ty and SFMON: War ning (LED) are
permanently assigned to the LEDs labeled OUT OF SERVICE and ALARM and can
be assigned to output relays to indicate the health of the device.
It is recommended that the signals MA IN: Blocke d/faulty and
SFMON : Wa rning ( LED) are communicated to the substation automation
system for alarm purposes, using hardwiring via output relays or the
communication interface.
WARNING
HAZARD OF UNSAFE OPERATION
⚫ Only qualified personnel, trained, authorized and familiar with the device
and all the safety instructions in the general Safety Guide (SFTY/5LM/L11
or later version) and appropriate Chapter 5, Chapter 10, Chapter 11,
Chapter 12 and Chapter 13 of this manual, shall work on installation,
connection, commissioning, maintenance or servicing of this device.
⚫ Proper and safe operation of this device depends on appropriate shipping
and handling, proper storage, installation and commissioning, and on
careful operation, maintenance and servicing. For this reason only
qualified personnel shall work on or operate this device.
⚫ Any modifications to this device must be in accordance with the manual. If
any other modification is made without the express permission of
Schneider Electric, it will invalidate the warranty, and may render the
product unsafe.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unintended
equipment operation.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
Table of Contents
3 Operation ............................................................................................................3-1
3.1 Modular Structure ....................................................................................................... 3-1
3.2 Operator-Machine Communication ............................................................................. 3-3
3.3 Cyber Security (Function Group CS) ............................................................................3-4
3.3.1 Users, Roles and Rights for Easergy MiCOM P30 ........................................................................................... 3-4
3.3.2 Cyber Security Implementation ..................................................................................................................... 3-6
3.4 Configuration of the Local Control Panel (Function Group LOC) ..................................3-7
3.4.1 Bay Panel .......................................................................................................................................................3-8
3.4.2 Signal Panel .................................................................................................................................................3-11
3.4.3 Operation Panel ...........................................................................................................................................3-12
3.4.4 Fault Panel ...................................................................................................................................................3-13
3.4.5 Ground Fault Panel ...................................................................................................................................... 3-14
3.4.6 Overload Panel ............................................................................................................................................ 3-15
3.4.7 Selection of the Control Point ...................................................................................................................... 3-16
3.4.8 Configurable Clear Key ................................................................................................................................ 3-16
3.5 Communication Interfaces ........................................................................................ 3-17
3.5.1 PC Interface (Function Group PC) ................................................................................................................ 3-18
3.5.2 Communication Interface 1 (Function Group COMM1) ................................................................................ 3-19
3.5.3 Communication Interface 2 (Function Group COMM2) ................................................................................ 3-28
3.5.4 Communication Interface 3 (Function Group COMM3) ................................................................................ 3-31
3.5.5 Communication Interface Ethernet (Function Groups IEC, GOOSE and VINP) ..............................................3-36
3.6 IRIG-B Clock Synchronization (Function Group IRIGB) ...............................................3-60
3.7 Configuration and Operating Mode of the Binary Inputs (Function Group INP) ......... 3-61
3.8 Measured Data Input (Function Group MEASI) .......................................................... 3-63
3.8.1 Direct Current Input on the Analog (I/O) Module Y ...................................................................................... 3-64
3.8.2 Connecting a Resistance Thermometer to the “PT 100 Analog Input” on the Analog (I/O) Module Y .......... 3-67
3.8.3 Connecting Temperature Sensors to the Temperature P/C Board (the RTD Module) .................................. 3-68
3.9 Configuration, Operating Mode, and Blocking of the Output Relays (Function Group
OUTP) ........................................................................................................................3-71
3.10 Measured Data Output (Function Group MEASO) ......................................................3-74
3.10.1 General Settings ..........................................................................................................................................3-74
3.10.2 BCD Measured Data Output ........................................................................................................................ 3-76
3.10.3 Analog Measured Data Output .................................................................................................................... 3-80
3.10.4 Output of “External” Measured Data ........................................................................................................... 3-86
3.11 Configuration and Operating Mode of the LED Indicators (Function Group LED) ...... 3-87
3.11.1 Configuring the LED Indicators .................................................................................................................... 3-87
3.11.2 Layout of the LED indicators ........................................................................................................................3-87
3.11.3 Operating Mode of the LED Indicators ......................................................................................................... 3-88
3.12 Main Functions of the P139 (Function Group MAIN) .................................................. 3-91
3.12.1 Conditioning of the Measured Variables ...................................................................................................... 3-91
3.12.2 Phase Reversal Function ..............................................................................................................................3-93
3.12.3 Operating Data Measurement ..................................................................................................................... 3-94
3.12.4 Configuring and Enabling the Device Functions ........................................................................................ 3-108
3.12.5 Activation of “Dynamic Parameters” ......................................................................................................... 3-111
3.12.6 Current Flow Monitoring ............................................................................................................................ 3-111
3.12.7 Inrush Stabilization (Harmonic Restraint) .................................................................................................. 3-112
3.28.12 Joint Operation of the ARC and ASC Functions .......................................................................................... 3-249
3.28.13 Test HSR ....................................................................................................................................................3-251
3.28.14 Time-Delay Reclosure (TDR) ......................................................................................................................3-252
3.28.15 ARC Counters ............................................................................................................................................ 3-254
3.28.16 Counter for Number of CB Operations ....................................................................................................... 3-254
3.29 Automatic Synchronism Check (Function Group ASC) ............................................ 3-256
3.29.1 Disabling and Enabling the ASC Function .................................................................................................. 3-259
3.29.2 ASC Readiness and Blocking ..................................................................................................................... 3-260
3.29.3 Close Request ............................................................................................................................................3-261
3.29.4 Extended Settings for the Close Enable Conditions ................................................................................... 3-264
3.29.5 Considering the CB Close Time ..................................................................................................................3-265
3.29.6 ASC Operating Modes ................................................................................................................................3-265
3.29.7 Testing the ASC Function .......................................................................................................................... 3-272
3.29.8 Integrating the ASC Function into the Control and Monitoring of Switchgear Units ...................................3-273
3.29.9 Measured Values Obtained by ASC ............................................................................................................3-274
3.29.10 ASC Counters .............................................................................................................................................3-274
3.30 Ground Fault Direction Determination Using Steady-State Values (Function Group
GFDSS) ....................................................................................................................3-276
3.30.1 Disabling and Enabling Ground Fault Direction Determination Using Steady-State Values .......................3-276
3.30.2 Ground Fault Direction Determination Using Steady-State Values Is Ready ............................................. 3-277
3.30.3 Conditioning and Selecting the Measured Values ......................................................................................3-278
3.30.4 Steady-State Power Evaluation ................................................................................................................. 3-278
3.30.5 Steady-State Current Evaluation ............................................................................................................... 3-284
3.30.6 Steady-State Admittance Evaluation ......................................................................................................... 3-285
3.30.7 Steady-State Power and Admittance Evaluation ....................................................................................... 3-289
3.30.8 Counting the Ground Faults Detected by Steady-State Power and Admittance Evaluation .......................3-290
3.31 Transient Ground Fault Detection (Function Group TGFD) ......................................3-291
3.31.1 Disabling and Enabling the Transient Ground Fault Detection Function ....................................................3-291
3.31.2 Readiness of the Transient Ground Fault Detection Function ....................................................................3-292
3.31.3 Conditioning and Selecting the Measured Values ......................................................................................3-293
3.31.4 Determining the Ground Fault Direction ....................................................................................................3-293
3.31.5 Resetting a Directional Decision ................................................................................................................3-295
3.31.6 Monitoring the Measured Values ............................................................................................................... 3-296
3.31.7 Counting the Transient Ground Faults .......................................................................................................3-296
3.32 Motor Protection (Function Group MP) .................................................................... 3-297
3.32.1 Enable/Disable the Motor Protection Function ...........................................................................................3-297
3.32.2 Starting Conditions .................................................................................................................................... 3-298
3.32.3 Overload Protection ...................................................................................................................................3-299
3.32.4 Exceptional Overload Protection Cases ..................................................................................................... 3-308
3.32.5 Low Load Protection .................................................................................................................................. 3-311
3.32.6 Protection of Increased-Safety Machines ...................................................................................................3-311
3.32.7 Running Time Meter .................................................................................................................................. 3-314
3.33 Thermal Overload Protection (Function Group THERM) .......................................... 3-315
3.33.1 Readiness of Thermal Overload Protection ................................................................................................3-315
3.33.2 Selection of Current ...................................................................................................................................3-316
3.33.3 Operating Modes ....................................................................................................................................... 3-316
3.33.4 Coolant Temperature Effect ...................................................................................................................... 3-316
3.33.5 THERM Operation without Coolant Temperature (Ambient) Acquisition .................................................... 3-318
3.33.6 Relative Replica .........................................................................................................................................3-319
3.33.7 Absolute Replica ........................................................................................................................................3-319
3.33.8 Tripping Characteristics .............................................................................................................................3-320
3.33.9 Warning Signal .......................................................................................................................................... 3-321
3.33.10 Trip ............................................................................................................................................................ 3-322
3.33.11 Cooling ...................................................................................................................................................... 3-323
3.33.12 Operation Together with the Motor Protection Function ............................................................................3-324
3.37 Underfrequency Load Shedding Protection (Function Group Pf<) .......................... 3-346
3.37.1 Disabling or Enabling Pf< Protection ......................................................................................................... 3-346
3.37.2 Pf< Readiness and Blocking ...................................................................................................................... 3-347
3.37.3 Active Power Characteristic .......................................................................................................................3-347
3.37.4 Remote and Local Choice of Active Frequency Stage ................................................................................3-349
3.38 Directional Power Protection (Function Group P<>) ............................................... 3-350
3.38.1 Disabling and Enabling P<> Protection .....................................................................................................3-350
3.38.2 Power Determination .................................................................................................................................3-350
3.38.3 Power Monitoring .......................................................................................................................................3-351
3.38.4 Active Power P> Starting ...........................................................................................................................3-352
3.38.5 Active Power P> Tripping .......................................................................................................................... 3-353
3.38.6 Reactive Power Q> Starting ...................................................................................................................... 3-354
3.38.7 Reactive Power Q> Tripping ......................................................................................................................3-355
3.38.8 Active Power P< Starting ...........................................................................................................................3-356
3.38.9 Active Power P< Tripping .......................................................................................................................... 3-357
3.38.10 Reactive Power Q< Starting ...................................................................................................................... 3-358
3.38.11 Reactive Power Q< Tripping ......................................................................................................................3-359
3.38.12 Direction Signaling .................................................................................................................................... 3-361
3.39 Voltage Controlled Directional Reactive Power Protection (Function Group QV) .....3-363
3.39.1 Disabling and Enabling QV Protection ....................................................................................................... 3-363
3.39.2 QV Readiness and Blocking ....................................................................................................................... 3-363
3.39.3 Phase-Phase Undervoltage Monitoring ...................................................................................................... 3-364
3.39.4 Directional Reactive Power Characteristic ................................................................................................. 3-364
3.39.5 Timer and Trip Logic ..................................................................................................................................3-365
3.40 Circuit Breaker Failure Protection (Function Group CBF) ........................................ 3-366
3.40.1 Disabling and Enabling Circuit Breaker Failure Protection .........................................................................3-366
3.40.2 Readiness of Circuit Breaker Protection .................................................................................................... 3-367
3.40.3 Detecting a CB Tripping .............................................................................................................................3-367
3.40.4 Current Flow Monitoring ............................................................................................................................ 3-368
3.40.5 Evaluation of CB Status Signals .................................................................................................................3-369
3.40.6 Startup Criteria ..........................................................................................................................................3-370
3.40.7 Timer Stages and Output Logic ................................................................................................................. 3-371
3.40.8 Trip Commands ......................................................................................................................................... 3-372
3.40.9 Starting Trigger ......................................................................................................................................... 3-372
3.40.10 Fault Behind CB Protection ........................................................................................................................ 3-373
4 Design .................................................................................................................4-1
4.1 Designs ....................................................................................................................... 4-2
4.2 Dimensional Drawings ................................................................................................ 4-4
4.2.1 Dimensional Drawings for the 40 TE Case .....................................................................................................4-4
4.2.2 Dimensional Drawings for the 84 TE Case .....................................................................................................4-5
4.2.3 Detachable HMI ............................................................................................................................................. 4-7
4.3 Hardware Modules ...................................................................................................... 4-8
7 Settings ...............................................................................................................7-1
7.1 Paramete rs .............................................................................................................. 7-1
7.1.1 D e v i c e I d e n t i f i c a t i o n ............................................................................................................................. 7-4
7.1.2 C o n f i g u r a t i o n P a r a m e t e r s .................................................................................................................. 7-13
7.1.3 F u n c t i o n P a r a m e t e r s .......................................................................................................................... 7-112
A3 Glossary ............................................................................................................A3-1
Modules ...................................................................................................................................... A3-1
Symbols ...................................................................................................................................... A3-1
Examples of Signal Names ......................................................................................................... A3-7
Symbols Used ............................................................................................................................. A3-8
1.1 Overview
The P139 time-overcurrent protection and control device is a one-box solution for
protection and control.
topology). The P139 has almost 300 predefined Bay Types stored for selection
and it is also possible to load user-defined bay templates.
The number of external auxiliary devices required is largely minimized by the
integration of binary signal inputs operating from any auxiliary voltage, and
versatile relay output contacts, by the direct connection option for current and
voltage transformers, and by the comprehensive interlocking capabilities. This
simplifies the handling of switch bay protection and control technology from
planning to commission.
During operation, the user-friendly interface makes it easy to set the device
parameters and allows safe operation of the substation by preventing non-
permissible switching operations.
The P139 is equipped with a large number of protection and control functions.
These can be individually configured and cancelled.
These features give the user the means to adapt the P139 to the protection and
control capacity required in a specific application.
The powerful programmable logic provided by the protection device also makes
it possible to accommodate special applications.
TIMER Timer 4
Phase currents 3 3
Residual current 1 1
Voltages – 4…5
Mmuxxx Measuring ✓
1.5 Design
The P139 is modular in design. The plug-in modules are housed in a robust
aluminum case and electrically interconnected via one analog p/c board and one
digital p/c board.
2 Technical Data
2.1 Conformity
Notice
Applicable to P139, version ‑316 ‑426/427/428 ‑661.
Declaration of Conformity
The product designated “P139 Feeder Management and Bay Control” has been
designed and manufactured in conformance with the EMC and safety standards
IEC 60255‑26 and IEC 60255‑27 and with the “EMC Directive” and the “Low
Voltage Directive” issued by the Council of the European Community.
Design
● Surface-mounted case suitable for wall installation, or
● Flush-mounted case for 19″ cabinets and for control panels.
Installation Position
● Vertical ± 30°.
Degree of Protection
Per DIN VDE 0470 and IEC 60529.
● IP 52 for the front panel.
● Flush-mounted case:
o IP 50 for the case (excluding the rear connection area)
o IP 20 for the rear connection area, pin-terminal connection
o IP 10 for the rear connection area, ring-terminal connection
● Surface-mounted case:
o IP 50 for the case
o IP 50 for the fully enclosed connection area with the supplied rubber
grommets fitted
Weight
● 40 TE case: Approx. 7 kg
● 84 TE case: Approx. 11 kg
Terminals
PC interface (X6)
● EIA RS232 (DIN 41652) connector, type D-Sub, 9-pin
2.3 Tests
Conducted Emission
Per IEC 60255-26 and CISPR 22 Class A.
● 0.15 - 0.5 MHz, 79 dBμV (quasi peak) 66 dBμV (average).
● 0.5 - 30 MHz, 73 dBμV (quasi peak) 60 dBμV (average).
Radiated Emission
Per IEC 60255-26 and CISPR 11 Class A.
● 30 - 230 MHz, 40 dBμV / m at 10 m measurement distance.
● 230 - 1 GHz, 47 dBμV / m at 10 m measurement distance.
Phase-to-phase
● RMS value 150 V.
● Coupling resistance 100 Ω.
● Coupling capacitor 0.1 μF, for 10 s.
Phase-to-ground
● RMS value 300 V.
● Coupling resistance 220 Ω.
● Coupling capacitor 0.47 μF, for 10 s.
To comply with this standard, it is suggested to set the parameter (010 220)
I NP: Filter to 6 [steps].
2.3.1.2 Insulation
Insulation Resistance
Per IEC 60255-27.
Insulation resistance > 100 MΩ at 500 Vdc.
Vibration Test
Per IEC 60255‑21-1, test severity class 1.
Seismic Test
Per IEC 60255‑21‑3, test procedure A, class 1.
Frequency range
● Horizontal axes of vibration: 1 Hz to 8 Hz with 3.5 mm peak displacement, 8
to 35 Hz with 10 m / s² peak acceleration. 2 x 1 cycle.
● Vertical axis of vibration: 1 Hz to 8 Hz with 1.5 mm peak displacement, 8 to
35 Hz with 5 m / s² peak acceleration. 1 x 1 cycle.
Temperatures
Per IEC 60255-1 & IEC 60068-2-1
Solar Radiation
Direct solar radiation on the front of the device must be avoided.
Frequency
● Nominal frequency fnom: 50 Hz and 60 Hz (adjustable).
● Operating range: 0.95 to 1.05 fnom.
● Frequency protection: 40 to 70 Hz.
Binary I/O Module X(6I 6O) Binary I/O Modules X(4H), All other modules
for switchgear control. X(6I 6H)
with high-break contacts,
applicable to DC circuits
only.
Continuous 8A 10 A 5A
current:
2.6 Interfaces
2.6.2 PC Interface
● Transmission rate: 300 to 115,200 baud (adjustable)
Wire Leads
● Per RS 485 or RS 422, 2 kV isolation
● Distance to be bridged
o Point-to-point connection: max. 1200 m
o Multipoint connection: max. 100 m
2.9 Deviations
2.9.1.1 Definitions
Reference Conditions
● Quasi-stationary sinusoidal signals at nominal frequency fnom (frequency
protection excepted), total harmonic distortion ≤ 2 %, ambient
temperature 20°C (68°F), and nominal auxiliary voltage VA,nom.
Deviation
● Deviation relative to the setting under reference conditions.
Operate value Θ
● Deviation: ± 5% of the setting or ± 1% of the nominal value
Operate values
● V<>, Vpos<>: ± 1% (in the range 0.6 to 1.4 Vnom)
● VNG>, Vneg>: ± 1% (in the range > 0.3 Vnom)
Operate values
● f<: ± 5 mHz
● Pmin: ± 20% of the setting or ± 2% of the nominal value
● Imin: ± 5% of the setting or ± 1% of the nominal value
● Angle: ± 1°
Operate values
● V<: ± 1% (in the range 0.6 to 1.4 Vnom)
● Qmin: ± 20% of the setting or ± 2% of the nominal value
● Imin: ± 5% of the setting or ± 1% of the nominal value
● Angle: ± 1°
Sector angle
● Deviation: ± 0.5°
2.9.2.1 Definitions
Reference conditions
● Sinusoidal signals at nominal frequency fnom, total harmonic distortion
≤ 2 %, ambient temperature 20°C (68°F), and nominal auxiliary voltage
VA,nom.
Deviation
● Deviation relative to the setting under reference conditions.
2.9.3.1 Definitions
Reference conditions
● Sinusoidal signals at nominal frequency fnom, total harmonic distortion ≤
2%, ambient temperature 20°C (68°F), and nominal auxiliary voltage
VA,nom.
Deviation
● Deviation relative to the nominal values under reference conditions.
Load angle
● Deviation: ± 1°
Frequency
● Deviation: ± 10 mHz
Temperature
● Deviation: ± 2°C [approx. ± 4°F]
Amplitude resolution
● at Inom = 1 A: 6.1 mArms
● at Inom = 5 A: 30.5 mArms
Amplitude resolution
● at Inom = 1 A: 1.0 mArms
● at Inom = 5 A: 4.9 mArms
Amplitude resolution
● 9.2 mVrms
Overload Memory
Number
● The 8 most recent overload events
Number
● The 8 most recent ground fault events
Fault Memory
Number
● The 8 most recent faults.
Nominal burden
● … where VA = 220 V DC and with maximum module configuration
o 40 TE case, relays de-energized/energized: approx. 15 W / 34.1 W
o 84 TE case, relays de-energized/energized): approx. 20 W / 42.3 W
● … where VA = 100 -230 V AC and with maximum module configuration
o 40 TE case, relays de-energized/energized: approx. 23 VA / 28 VA
o 84 TE case, relays de-energized/energized): approx. 40 VA / 55 VA
2.13.1 Symbols
The following symbols are used in accordance with IEC 61869 standards:
Xp
K d = K max ≈ 1 + Rp = 1 + ω · Tp
3 Operation
Communic. module
TRIP
ALARM
OUT OF SERVICE
HEALTHY
A A A
EDIT MODE
N μC P μP
Analog I/O module Processor module
Analog
Digital busbus module
module
T X Y V
Transformer module
Voltages Currents Signals Commands Signals Measured data Signals Commands Auxiliary voltage
Commands Signals Commands Commands Signals
D5Z5201C
“Parameters” Branch
All settings are contained in this branch. This branch carries all settings,
including the identification data of the P139, the configuration parameters for
adapting the P139 interfaces to the system, and the function parameters for
adapting the device functions to the process. All values in this group are stored
in non-volatile memory, which means that the values will be preserved even if
the power supply fails.
“Operation” Branch
This branch includes all information relevant for operation such as measured
operating data and binary signal states. This information is updated periodically
and consequently is not stored. In addition, various controls are grouped here,
for example those for resetting counters, memories and displays.
“Events” Branch
The third branch is reserved for the recording of events. All information in this
group is therefore stored. In particular, the start/end signals during a fault, the
measured fault data, and the sampled fault waveforms are stored here and can
be read out when required.
Cyber Security is based on the model of Role Based Access Control (RBAC) which
is a method to restrict resource access to authorized users. One role can have
one and more access rights, one user (subject) can have several roles. A user
(subject) is based on a session. This session controls for example the activity of
the user. If the user is inactive for 15 minutes (default setting) the user will be
locked out automatically.
Static separation
of duty
Subject Right
assignment assignment
1 1..n Right
Dynamic
1..n 1 separation of duty
Session
User accounts
When the user tries to access an IED, they need to login using their own
username and their own password. The username/ password combination is then
checked against the records stored on the IED. It is the role that defines their
access to the relevant parts of the system.
The default user accounts for Easergy MiCOM P30 is as below:
Schneider Electric points out that changing default users and default passwords
constitutes an important security measure for the product. Therefore Schneider
Electric recommends to change the default passwords after the first usage of the
device. Not changing the default passwords can lead to the risk of undesirable
changes by third parties.
DefaultEngineer x x x
DefaultOperator x x
DefaultViewer x
SecurityAdmin x
(for SAT only)
DefaultUser x
(for HMI only)
Tab. 3-1: Default user accounts for Easergy MiCOM P30.
Roles
Different named roles are associated with different access rights. Roles and
Rights are setup in a pre-defined arrangement, according to the IEC 62351
standard, but customized to the Easergy MiCOM P30 equipment.
The default roles for Easergy MiCOM P30 is as below:
Role Description
VIEWER Can View what objects are present within a Logical-Device by presenting the
type ID of those objects.
OPERATOR An Operator can view what objects and values are present within a Logical-
Device by presenting the type ID of those objects as well as perform control
actions.
ENGINEER An Engineer can view what objects and values are present within a Logical-
Device by presenting the type ID of those objects. Moreover, an engineer has
full access to Datasets and Files and can configure the server locally or
remotely.
Rights
In a similar way in which a set of pre-defined Roles have been created, a
predefined set of Rights have been created.
The reason why these are described as Default, is that it is possible to change the
definitions of Roles and Rights, by using the SAT software. Depending on the work
done by the system administrator, it is possible that your own situation may vary
from these initial recommendations.
To create customized bay types, the “Bay Type Configurator” (BTC), version 2.7
or higher, is needed. Older versions of the BTC can create not compatible hex files
and thus can lead to communication failures.
In addition, the P139 offers Measured Value Panels, which display the measured
values relevant at a given time.
During normal power system operation; the Bay Panel or – if activated – the
Operation Panel is displayed. If the Operation Panel is activated as an event
occurs, the display switches to the appropriate Event Panel – provided that
measured values have been selected for the Event Panels. In the event of
overload or ground fault conditions, the display will automatically switch to the
Operation Panel at the end of the event. In the event of a fault, the Fault Panel
remains active until the LED indicators or the fault memories are reset.
If the change enabling command has been issued (LOC: Param. change
enabl.) it will be cancelled after the time period, defined by setting L OC: Hold-
time for Panels has elapsed and the Bay Panel will be called up.
The P139 offers a selection from pre-defined bay types. If the required bay type
is not included in the standard selection, the user can contact the manufacturer
of the P139 to request the definition of a customized bay type to download into
the P139. By applying the bay editor from the PC Access Software Easergy Studio
the user can also define new bay types.
The activation of the Bay Panel display is described in Chapter 6, (p. 6-1).
With the graphic display fitted the Bay Panel displays the up-to-date status of the
selected bay as a single (phase) diagram. The user can choose between two
character sets to represent switch gear on the bay panel. The character sets are
described in Section 6.11.1.1, (p. 6-16).
Each external device represented in the Bay Panel is identified by an external
device designation (see Section 3.46.3, (p. 3-413)).
The user can also define the designations for busbars and busbar sections (see
descriptions of parameters LOC: Des ignation bu sbar 1 or LOC: Designat .
bus sect.1, respectively, in the “Settings” chapter).
The display of external device designations can also be disabled. The display of
the control point (local or remote control) and interlocking can also be disabled.
The switchgear unit to be controlled needs to be selected first. The selection is
cancelled if the return time for illumination (LOC: Return time illumin.) or the
return time for selection (L OC: Re tu rn ti me se l ect.) has elapsed.
LOC:
DEV01: Character set
Designat. ext. dev. [ 221 038 ]
[ 210 000 ]
LOC: LOC:
Displ. ext.dev.desig Fct.asg. num. displ.
[ 221 032 ] [ 221 041 ]
LOC: LOC:
Display L/R Fct. asg. bar displ.
[ 221 070 ] [ 221 042 ]
LOC: LOC:
Displ. interl. stat. Bar display type
[ 221 071 ] [ 221 039 ]
LOC: LOC:
Designation busbar 1 Scal. bar display I
[ 221 033 ] [ 221 044 ]
LOC: LOC:
Designation busbar 2 Scal. bar display V
[ 221 034 ] [ 221 045 ]
LOC: LOC:
Designation busbar 3 Display bar scale
[ 221 043 ] [ 221 046 ]
LOC: LOC:
Designat. bus sect.1 Return time select.
[ 221 035 ] [ 221 030 ]
LOC: LOC:
Designat. bus sect.2 Return time illumin.
[ 221 036 ] [ 003 023 ]
BB1
Q0
LOC:
Return t.select. trg
305 551
19Z5003A
LOC:
Fct. Signal Panel
[ 221 072 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
m out of n
Signal 3 LOC: LOC:
Autom. return time Autom. return time
[ 003 014 ]
Signal n
LOC: LOC:
Selected signals Hold-time for Panels Hold-time for Panels
[ 031 075 ]
LOC:
LOC: Aut.activ.Sign.Panel
Indicat.Sign.Panel [ 221 073 ]
[ 221 075 ]
LOC:
Stat.ind.Sign.Panel
[ 221 074 ]
0: Without signalling 0
Selection
1)
LOC:
Chg.Sig.Panel stat.
[ 221 076 ]
Sig. Panel
LOC:
1) Chg.Sig.Panel flash.
[ 221 077 ]
44Z5209A
LOC:
Fct. Operation Panel
[ 053 007 ]
LOC:
Selected meas. val. Hold-time for Panels LOC:
[ 031 075 ] Hold-time for Panels
FT_RC:
Record. in progress S1 1 ≥1 C
[ 035 000 ]
R1
OL_RC:
Record. in progress ≥1
[ 035 003 ] Operation Panel
GF_RC:
Record. in progress
[ 035 005 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
FT_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 003 006 ]
1: execute
FT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 243 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z01CXA
LOC:
Fct. Fault Panel
[ 053 003 ]
Measured value 3
Measured value N
LOC:
Hold-time for Panels
[ 031 075 ]
R
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1 Fault Panel
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
FT_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 003 006 ]
1: execute
FT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 243 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z01EJA
LOC:
Fct. Grd.Fault Panel
[ 053 004 ]
Measured value 3
Measured value n
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
GF_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 000 ]
1: execute
GF_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 242 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0139B
LOC:
Fct. Overload Panel
[ 053 005 ]
Measured value 3
Measured value n
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 003 ]
1: execute
OL_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 241 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0140A
LOC:
Fct. assign. L/R key
[ 225 208 ]
1: R <-> L
2: R & L <-> L
1)
& & 1
MAIN:
Inp.asg. L/R key sw.
[ 221 008 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2 m out of n
Signal 3
Signal n
Without function
Selected signal
PC:
Bay address
[ 003 068 ]
PC:
Device address
[ 003 069 ]
PC:
Baud rate
[ 003 081 ]
PC:
Parity bit
[ 003 181 ]
PC:
Spontan. sig. enable
[ 003 187 ]
PC:
Select. spontan.sig.
[ 003 189 ]
PC:
Transm.enab.cycl.dat
[ 003 084 ]
PC:
Cycl. data ILS tel.
[ 003 185 ]
PC:
Delta V
[ 003 055 ]
PC:
Delta I
[ 003 056 ]
PC:
Sig./meas.val.block. PC:
[ 003 086 ] Delta P
[ 003 059 ]
0 PC:
Delta f
1 [ 003 057 ]
0: No PC:
Delta meas.v.ILS tel
1: Yes [ 003 155 ]
PC:
Delta t
MAIN: [ 003 058 ]
Prot. ext. disabled
[ 038 046 ]
PC:
Time-out
PC: [ 003 188 ]
Command blocking
[ 003 182 ]
0: No
1: Yes
PC interface
MAIN:
Test mode
[ 037 071 ]
19Z80ECA
COMM1:
Command block. USER
[ 003 172 ]
0: No COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ]
1: Yes
COMM1:
Command block. EXT
[ 003 173 ]
COMM1:
Basic IEC870-5enable
[ 003 215 ] COMM1:
Communicat. protocol
[ 003 167 ]
0
1
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
Addit. -101 enable
[ 003 216 ]
COMM1:
0 Selected protocol Selected protocol
304 415
1
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
Addit. ILS enable
[ 003 217 ]
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
MODBUS enable
[ 003 220 ]
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
DNP3 enable
[ 003 231 ]
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
COURIER enable
[ 103 040 ]
0: No
1: Yes
64Z51FEA
COMM1: COMM1:
-103 prot. variant Select. spontan.sig.
[ 003 178 ] [ 003 179 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Line idle state Transm.enab.cycl.dat
[ 003 165 ] [ 003 074 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Baud rate Cycl. data ILS tel.
[ 003 071 ] [ 003 175 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Parity bit Delta V
[ 003 171 ] [ 003 050 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Dead time monitoring Delta I
[ 003 176 ] [ 003 051 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Mon. time polling Delta P
[ 003 202 ] [ 003 054 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet comm. address Delta f
[ 003 072 ] [ 003 052 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Test monitor on Delta meas.v.ILS tel
[ 003 166 ] [ 003 150 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Name of manufacturer Delta t
[ 003 161 ] [ 003 053 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet address ASDU Delta t (energy)
[ 003 073 ] [ 003 151 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Spontan. sig. enable Contin. general scan
[ 003 177 ] [ 003 077 ]
COMM1:
Selected protocol
304 415
COMM1:
IEC 870-5-103
[ 003 219 ]
COMM1:
General enable USER
[ 003 170 ]
1: Yes
COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ]
MAIN: COMM1:
Test mode Communic. interface Communication error
[ 037 071 ] 304 422
COMM1:
Sig./meas.block.USER
[ 003 076 ]
0: No COMM1:
Sig./meas.val.block.
1: Yes
[ 037 075 ]
COMM1:
Sig./meas. block EXT
[ 037 074 ]
MAIN:
Prot. ext. disabled
[ 038 046 ]
12Z62FFA
Fig. 3-13: Communication interface 1, settings for the IEC 60870‑5-103 interface protocol.
COMM1: COMM1:
Line idle state Delta t
[ 003 165 ] [ 003 053 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Baud rate Delta t (energy)
[ 003 071 ] [ 003 151 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Parity bit Contin. general scan
[ 003 171 ] [ 003 077 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Dead time monitoring Comm. address length
[ 003 176 ] [ 003 201 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Mon. time polling Octet 2 comm. addr.
[ 003 202 ] [ 003 200 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet comm. address Cause transm. length
[ 003 072 ] [ 003 192 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Test monitor on Address length ASDU
[ 003 166 ] [ 003 193 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Name of manufacturer Octet 2 addr. ASDU
[ 003 161 ] [ 003 194 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet address ASDU Addr.length inf.obj.
[ 003 073 ] [ 003 196 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Spontan. sig. enable Oct.3 addr. inf.obj.
[ 003 177 ] [ 003 197 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Select. spontan.sig. Inf.No.<->funct.type
[ 003 179 ] [ 003 195 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Transm.enab.cycl.dat Time tag length
[ 003 074 ] [ 003 198 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Cycl. data ILS tel. ASDU1 / ASDU20 conv.
[ 003 175 ] [ 003 190 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Delta V ASDU2 conversion
[ 003 050 ] [ 003 191 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Delta I Initializ. signal
[ 003 051 ] [ 003 199 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Delta P Balanced operation
[ 003 054 ] [ 003 226 ]
COMM1:
Selected protocol
304 415 COMM1: COMM1:
Delta f Direction bit
COMM1: [ 003 052 ] [ 003 227 ]
IEC 870-5-101
[ 003 218 ] COMM1: COMM1:
Delta meas.v.ILS tel Time-out interval
[ 003 150 ] [ 003 228 ]
COMM1:
General enable USER
[ 003 170 ]
1: Yes
COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ]
MAIN:
Test mode
[ 037 071 ] COMM1:
Sig./meas.block.USER
[ 003 076 ]
0: No
COMM1:
Sig./meas.val.block.
1: Yes [ 037 075 ]
COMM1:
Sig./meas. block EXT
[ 037 074 ]
MAIN:
Prot. ext. disabled
[ 038 046 ] 19Z51FGA
Fig. 3-14: Communication interface 1, settings for the IEC 870-5-101 interface protocol.
COMM1: COMM1:
Line idle state Transm.enab.cycl.dat
[ 003 165 ] [ 003 074 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Baud rate Cycl. data ILS tel.
[ 003 071 ] [ 003 175 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Parity bit Delta V
[ 003 171 ] [ 003 050 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Dead time monitoring Delta I
[ 003 176 ] [ 003 051 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Mon. time polling Delta P
[ 003 202 ] [ 003 054 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet comm. address Delta f
[ 003 072 ] [ 003 052 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Test monitor on Delta meas.v.ILS tel
[ 003 166 ] [ 003 150 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Name of manufacturer Delta t
[ 003 161 ] [ 003 053 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet address ASDU Delta t (energy)
[ 003 073 ] [ 003 151 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Spontan. sig. enable Contin. general scan
[ 003 177 ] [ 003 077 ]
COMM1:
Select. spontan.sig.
[ 003 179 ]
COMM1:
Selected protocol
304 415
COMM1:
IEC 870-5,ILS
[ 003 221 ]
COMM1:
General enable USER
[ 003 170 ]
1: Yes
COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ] COMM1:
Comm. interface Communication error
304 422
MAIN:
Test mode
[ 037 071 ]
COMM1:
Sig./meas.block.USER
[ 003 076 ]
0: No COMM1:
Sig./meas.val.block.
1: Yes [ 037 075 ]
COMM1:
Sig./meas. block EXT
[ 037 074 ]
MAIN:
Prot. ext. disabled
[ 038 046 ]
19Z51FHA
Fig. 3-15: Communication interface 1, settings for the ILS-C interface protocol.
COMM1: COMM1:
MODBUS prot. variant Test monitor on
[ 003 214 ] [ 003 166 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Line idle state Reg.asg. selec. cmds
[ 003 165 ] [ 003 210 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Baud rate Reg.asg. selec. sig.
[ 003 071 ] [ 003 211 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Parity bit Reg.asg. sel. m.val.
[ 003 171 ] [ 003 212 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Dead time monitoring Reg.asg. sel. param.
[ 003 176 ] [ 003 213 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Mon. time polling Delta t (MODBUS)
[ 003 202 ] [ 003 152 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet comm. address Autom.event confirm.
[ 003 072 ] [ 003 249 ]
COMM1:
Selected protocol
304 415
COMM1:
MODBUS
[ 003 223 ]
COMM1:
General enable USER
[ 003 170 ]
1: Yes
COMM1:
Commun. interface Communication error
304 422
COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ]
MAIN:
Test mode
[ 037 071 ]
19Z50FJB
COMM1: COMM1:
Line idle state Link Confirm.Timeout
[ 003 165 ] [ 003 244 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Baud rate Link Max. Retries
[ 003 071 ] [ 003 245 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Parity bit Appl.Confirm.Timeout
[ 003 171 ] [ 003 246 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Dead time monitoring Appl. Need Time Del.
[ 003 176 ] [ 003 247 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Mon. time polling Ind./cl. bin. inputs
[ 003 202 ] [ 003 232 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Octet comm. address Ind./cl. bin.outputs
[ 003 072 ] [ 003 233 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Oct.2 comm.addr.DNP3 Ind./cl. bin. count.
[ 003 240 ] [ 003 234 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Test monitor on Ind./cl. analog inp.
[ 003 166 ] [ 003 235 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Phys. Charact. Delay Ind./cl. analog outp
[ 003 241 ] [ 003 236 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
COMM1: Phys. Char. Timeout Delta meas.v. (DNP3)
Selected protocol [ 003 242 ] [ 003 250 ]
304 415
COMM1:
General enable USER
[ 003 170 ]
1: Yes
COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ]
MAIN: COMM1:
Test mode Commun. interface Communication error
[ 037 071 ] 304 422
19Z50AZA
Fig. 3-17: Communication interface 1, settings for the DNP 3.0 protocol.
COMM1: COMM1:
Line idle state Test monitor on
[ 003 165 ] [ 003 166 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
Baud rate Command selection
[ 003 071 ] [ 103 042 ]
COMM1: COMM1:
COMM1: Parity bit Signal selection
Selected protocol [ 003 171 ] [ 103 043 ]
304 415
COMM1: COMM1:
Mon. time polling Parameter selection
[ 003 202 ] [ 103 045 ]
COMM1:
General enable USER COMM1: COMM1:
[ 003 170 ] Octet comm. address Delta t (COURIER)
[ 003 072 ] [ 103 046 ]
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
Command blocking
[ 003 174 ]
MAIN: COMM1:
Test mode Commun. interface Communication error
[ 037 071 ] 304 422
19Z51BAA
COMM1:
Sel.spontan.sig.test
[ 003 180 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signals
COMM1:
Test spont.sig.start
[ 003 184 ]
COMM1:
Spontan. sig. start
0 [ --- --- ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
COMM1:
Test spont.sig. end
[ 003 186 ]
COMM1:
Spontan. sig. end
0 [ --- --- ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
48Z50FKA
COMM2:
Line idle state
[ 103 165 ]
COMM2:
Baud rate
[ 103 071 ]
COMM2:
Parity bit
[ 103 171 ]
COMM2:
Dead time monitoring
[ 103 176 ]
COMM2:
Mon. time polling
[ 103 202 ]
COMM2:
Octet comm. address
[ 103 072 ]
COMM2:
Name of manufacturer
[ 103 161]
COMM2:
Octet address ASDU
[ 103 073 ]
COMM2:
Spontan. sig. enable
[ 103 177 ]
COMM2: COMM2:
General enable USER Select. spontan.sig.
[ 103 170 ] [ 103 179 ]
COMM2:
Transm.enab.cycl.dat
0
[ 103 074 ]
1
COMM2:
0: No Cycl. data ILS tel.
[ 103 175 ]
1: Yes
COMM2:
Delta V
[ 103 050 ]
COMM2:
Delta I
[ 103 051 ]
COMM2:
Sig./meas.block.USER COMM2:
Delta P
[ 103 076 ]
[ 103 054 ]
0 COMM2:
Delta f
1 [ 103 052 ]
0: No COMM2:
Delta meas.v.ILS tel
1: Yes [ 103 150 ]
COMM2:
MAIN: Delta t
Prot. ext. disabled
[ 103 053 ]
[ 038 046 ]
COMM2:
Command block. USER
[ 103 172 ]
0: No
1: Yes
Commun. interface
MAIN:
Test mode
[ 037 071 ]
40Z5070A
COMM2:
Sel.spontan.sig.test
[ 103 180 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signals
COMM2:
Test spont.sig.start
[ 103 184 ]
COMM2:
Spontan. sig. start
0 [ --- --- ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
COMM2:
Test spont.sig. end
[ 103 186 ]
COMM2:
Spontan. sig. end
0 [ --- --- ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
48Z50FLA
3.5.4.1 Application
Communication interface 3 is designed to establish a digital communication link
between two devices from Schneider Electric's device family “Easergy MiCOM
30”.
Over this communication link can be transmitted up to 8 binary protection
signals. Whereas communication interfaces 1 and 2 are designed as information
interfaces to connect to data acquisition subsystems and for remote access,
communication interface 3 is designed as a protection signaling interface that
will transmit real time signals (InterMiCOM protection signaling interface). Its
main application is to transmit signals from protective signaling (function group
PSIG). In addition, any other internal or external binary signals may also be
transmitted.
Digital network:
● Asynchronous data interface of primary multiplexing equipment
Preference: Security.
Recommended setting: Select binary signal from groups 1 to 4 or 5 to 8 and set operating
mode Direct intertrip.
Preference: Dependability.
Recommended setting: Select binary signal from group 5 to 8 and set operating mode
Permissive.
Preference: Speed.
Recommended setting: Select binary signal from group 1 to 4 and set operating mode
Blocking.
Speed
Blocking
Permissive
slow
low
Intertrip
Security Dependability
47Z1030A
Fig. 3-22: Comparison of speed, security and dependability offered by the three operating modes.
Message
received
Blocking signals
accepted
Telegram
receive check
Permissive signals
accepted
(Re)start of the
monitoring
timer stages
COMM3:
Time-out comm.fault
[ 120 033 ]
COMM3:
1 Communications fault
[ 120 043 ]
COMM3:
Time-out link fail.
[ 120 035 ]
COMM3:
1 Comm. link failure
[ 120 044 ]
47Z1031B
From the software version -660, the Single IP Ethernet module and Redundant IP
Ethernet module are available for the devices of the Easergy MiCOM 30 Series. To
get information of the former Ethernet module, please refer to the manuals before
-660.
The P139 Feeder Management and Bay Control can be fitted with new
communication module, the Single IP Ethernet module or Redundant IP Ethernet
module. (See Chapter 15, (p. 15-1) for the exact order information and
Section 5.7, (p. 5-30) for the location and connection diagrams.)
The Ethernet modules are developed to support PRP/HSR/RSTP redundancy
protocol, conformance of IEC 61850 edition 1 and 2, Cyber Security (CS) and
Flexible Product Naming (fPN).
Parameter Description
The maximum age of the information transmitted by the Bridge when it is the
Max age
Root Bridge.
Forward delay The delay used by Bridges to transition Root and Designated Ports to Forwarding.
From the software version -661, Easergy MiCOM P30 redundant brick configuration
tool is available to configure and read the RSTP configurations.
Forwarding
The devices from the families Easergy MiCOM 30, 40, the C264 and the MiCOM H
switches support store and forward mode. The MiCOM switch forwards messages
with known addresses to the appropriate port. The messages with unknown
addresses, the broadcast messages and the multicast messages are forwarded
out to all ports except the source port. MiCOM switches do not forward error
packets, 802.3x pause frames or local packets.
Priority Tagging
802.1p priority is enabled on all ports.
information, for instance “reports”. In its function as server the P139 can supply
up to 16 clients, linked into the network, with spontaneous or cyclic information.
3.5.5.2.1.3 Transmitting Modeled Signals Not Provided by the IEC 61850 Data Model
In addition to the information included in the IEC 61850 data model an optional
number of up to 16 signals can be selected from all the signals available in the
P139 to be transmitted via reporting. A selection of state signals (shuttling to
communications) is made by setting IEC: SigGGIO1 selection. The data
object indexes defined for SigGGIO1 must follow the sequence given for the ‘m
out of n’ selection for the state signals. The indexes SigGGIO1.ST.ind1 to
SigGGIO1.ST.ind16 may then be included in the datasets just as the other data
objects.
determined by the application; merely the GOOSE capacity, i.e. the maximum
size of a dataset to be transmitted by GOOSE, is limited to 1500 bytes.
It is not possible to read the IEC configuration back from the P139 if the “Dataset”
sizes exceed the GOOSE size limit significantly. Therefore it is recommended to
limit the “Dataset” size(s) to 100% of the GOOSE capacity. Too large a dataset can
spoil IEC 61850 communication. Hence, the dataset size limit of 100% of the
GOOSE capacity should not be exceeded, neither for GOOSE nor for reports.
Data objects provided by the P139 are available for selection with a structure as
specified by IEC 61850. Within the quality descriptor for each piece of
information the invalid bit and the test bit are served according to the P139’s
state; the other attributes are not set. Any number of datasets may be created
with the IED Configurator. Saving datasets at System\LLN0 is compulsory. The
knowledge of dataset content is imperative for decoding and evaluating received
signals. Configuration files possess a listing of all datasets with a description of
all data objects included.
Next to their use with high priority transmission methods (see
Section 3.5.5.2.1.5, (p. 3-40)) datasets are used mainly for reporting. The P139
provides up to 16 unbuffered reports and 8 buffered reports independent of the
number of clients logged-on. Management is arranged into 16 Unbuffered Report
Control Blocks (urcbA to urcbP) and 8 Buffered Report Control Blocks (brcbA to
brcbH). Whereas with unbuffered reporting pieces of information may be lost
during a communications failure, the buffered report control blocks support a
buffered transmission which is required for the uninterrupted writing of events. A
pre-defined dataset may be assigned to each report which will then determine
which data object will be transmitted with the relevant report. Assigning datasets
is not limited; the same dataset may be referenced in various reports or even in
GOOSEs.
The P139 can serve up to 16 clients. Each client can log-on to any number of
available reports. One unbuffered report can be allocated to max. 8 clients, and
one buffered report can be allocated to max. 4 clients. A client is then able to
activate the wanted report for himself and to set the transmission behavior to his
requirements. The system concept with intended clients must be taken into
account when datasets are assigned to the reports.
Reports are not received by the P139.
● Status only
● Direct control with enhanced security
● SBO (Select before operate) with enhanced security
When set to the operating mode Select before operate the switchgear unit is
selected by the client before the control command is issued. Because of this
selection the switchgear unit is reserved for the client. Control requests issued by
other clients are rejected. If after a selection no control command is issued by
the client the P139 resets this selection after a settable timeout period [IC ]:
sboTimeou t (default: 2 minutes) has elapsed.
If with a system application it must be ensured that only one control command at
a time is being processed system wide ("uniqueness") then interlocking of
secondary devices among themselves is setup with GOOSE. For further details
see description of function group GOOSE.
The switchgear device’s contact positions are signaled to the clients with the
reports.
1 remote-control See note [1] The control command is sent by an operator at station level.
(at the end of
this table).
2 automatic-remote See note [1]. The control command is sent by an automatic function at
station level.
3 station-control See note [1]. The control command is sent by an operator at network
level.
4 automatic-station See note [1]. The control command is sent by an automatic function at
network level.
5 bay-control Local HMI The control command is generated at the local HMI of the
Control P139.
6 bay-control Local EXT The control command is sent via binary input (see note [2])
Control by an operator at an external local control panel, using the
setting
● (221 061) MAIN: Ele ctrical contr ol = Local
and any of the following input signals:
● DEVxx: In p.asg. el. ct rl.ope n
● DEV xx: Inp.asg.e l .ctr.clos e .
7 remote-control Remote EXT The control command is sent via binary input (see note [2])
Control by an operator at an external local control panel, using the
setting
● (221 061) MA IN: E lectri cal control = Remote
and any of the following input signals:
● DEV xx: In p.asg. el. ctrl. ope n
● DEV xx: Inp.asg.e l.ctr.clos e.
[1]: The P139 copies the Originator Identification from the command request into
the information report.
The P139 does never send the Originator Category “automatic-bay”. In all
protection devices from the Easergy MiCOM 30 family, Automatic Reclose is
implemented as part of the protection functionality, and therefore it is treated as
process, see table row No. 8 above.
UC 7
UC 1,2
Network
HMI
Trip/close by external
Gateway protection or control
UC 7
UC 3,4 UC 10 , 11
UC 9
Circuit
Station
breaker
HMI UC 6, 7 UC 5 UC 8
t
Binary signal
Communication link
Internal interface 12Z7312E
Fig. 3-25: Use cases in the network context. The “UC” numbers refer to Originator Categories in the table above.
3.5.5.2.2.1 Overview
The IEC 60870-5-104 “Network access for IEC 60870-5-101 using standard
transport profiles” is based on IEC 60870-5-101 “Transmission protocols –
Companion standard for telecontrol tasks”, and was originally intended for
SCADA applications but it is also applied in station bus communication.
The IEC 60870-5-104 implementation in Easergy MiCOM 30 relays includes server
and client functionality with multiple connections. For every connection the types
and addressing of every ASDU can be configured in data models. The data
models also include a logic module to manipulate the data and to realize logical
functions e.g. batch messages.
A Easergy MiCOM 30 bay unit can also act as a central unit. For this more
complex logical functions two additional programs may be started: the logic and
the boolean interlocking. These programs are used for functions like calculation
of busbar voltage or substation interlocking.
The configuration for IEC 60870-5-104 is done with a special configuration tool
which will be integrated in Easergy Studio like the IED Configurator.
In this manual only a short description of the IEC 60870-5-104 functions is
possible. For detailed description, please refer to IEC 60870-5-104 Application
Guide. Because the implementation of IEC 60870-5-104 is configurable, there is
also a standardized interoperability document, the IEC 60870-5-104
Interoperability Guide.
3.5.5.2.2.2 Integration
After setting I EC: Ge ne ral e nabl e U SER, the protocol IEC 60870-5-104 can be
selected in Function group IEC by switching on I EC: IEC608 70-5-104 enable
and selecting IEC 60870-5-104 in IEC : IE C prot. var iant. The other settings
visible for IEC 60870-5-104 protocol are functioning like described for IEC 61850,
see Section 3.5.5.3, (p. 3-52):
● I EC: ETH C OMM Mode
● I EC: Block Port A/B
● IEC : Bl ock Port C
The protocol IEC 60870-5-104 also uses two configuration banks, one active and
one standby bank. The configuration bank switching with IEC: Switch Config.
Bank is functioning like in IEC 61850.
All settings in the IEC function group concerning the time zone and summer time
are working like described for IEC 61850.
The setting IEC 60870-5-104 in IEC : IEC prot. var iant selects only the
communication protocol. The additional services on the Ethernet module working
like described for IEC 61850:
● Checking Spontaneous Signals, see Section 3.5.5.3.1, (p. 3-55)
● Checking Switchgear Device Positions and Signals, see Section 3.5.5.3.2,
(p. 3-56)
● Clock Synchronization, see Section 3.5.5.2.1.2, (p. 3-40)
● Virtual Local Area Network, see Section 3.5.5.2.3, (p. 3-49)
● Port Assignment, see Section 3.5.5.2.4, (p. 3-49)
● Secure Communication with the Easergy Studio via the Ethernet Interface,
see Section 3.5.5.2.6, (p. 3-51)
3.5.5.2.2.3 Engineering
The communication function in IEC 60870-5-104 are configurable by the IEC
60870-5-104 configuration tool. The maximum configuration is:
● 5 IEC 60870-5-104 server connections
● 2 IEC 60870-5-104 clients
For usage in central functions additional programs may be started to compute
more complex logical functions:
● Logic
● Boolean station interlocking
The setting of the IEC 60870-5-104 is done in the following steps:
● Configuration
The first step is to configure the module, means to choose how many
server lines are needed, how many servers need to be connected and
whether logic and Boolean interlocking is needed.
● Setting of parameters
In this step the main parameters for IEC 60870-5-104 and installed services
will be set, e.g.
o Port assignment, which service runs on which Ethernet port.
o Network configuration, VLANs, IP-addresses, subnetwork masks, …
o IEC 60870-5-104 parameters, server and client addresses, …
● Mapping data
The incoming data from the device or any IEC 60870-5-104 connection may
be mapped to any server or client connection of the module. The type and
addressing of the IEC 60870-5-104 messages is individual configurable. In
addition to the mapping data can be manipulated and linked together
through functions, for example:
o Logical functions (negation, and, or, …),
o Arithmetical functions (multiply, division, …),
o Time functions (on delay, off delay, …),
o Set functions for data and cause of transmission,
o Filter functions (deadband, average, …).
The mapping and manipulating of the data can be done individually in all
IEC 60870-5-104 servers lines and clients.
For detailed description of IEC 60870-5-104 engineering and functions, please
refer to IEC 60870-5-104 Application Guide.
From the software version -661, VLAN is available for the devices of the Easergy
MiCOM 30 Series.
A virtual LAN (VLAN) is any broadcast domain that is partitioned and isolated in a
computer network at the data link layer (OSI layer 2). VLANs work through tags
within network packets and tag handling in networking systems - recreating the
appearance and functionality of network traffic that is physically on a single
network but acts as if it is split between separate networks. It is possible to
assign traffic to different VLANs to allow the separation of the traffic while using
a single physical network.
In the table below shows the link between the Hardware modules/ ports and IED
configurator inclusive requested VLAN support capability. Only physical interface
1 is to support VLANs in fixed number (2 VLANs for physical interface 1).
Default configuration
In general the Ethernet communication module is designed that all TCP/IP
services are working on all physical / virtual interfaces. The factory delivers a
communication module without any specific port assignment. In this case –
without port assignment and without VLAN – the communication services are
available without restriction on the physical Ethernet Interfaces. Depending on
the physical module type all services are working on A/B and C for redundant
modules or A and C for the single fiber module or only C for the single copper
module.
There is one exception the Web services for the SAT tool are only available on
one interface at a time. Please find the details in Section 3.5.5.2.5, (p. 3-51).
the second network is dedicated for maintenance services. The user can
configure configuration / administration services (configuration bus) as available
on physical port C and the client application services (station bus) as available on
port A/B.
The port assignment feature is available to together with the VLAN feature since
the firmware version 661. The same scenario as above can be configured with
VLAN together. For example VLAN1 as station bus and VLAN2 as configuration
bus.
TCP/IP service
The following list of TCP/IP services can be assigned to interfaces.
Services Description
IED configuration (TLS) Services via TLS to configure the device from Easergy Studio
1) Minimum configuration: at least ONE "IEC 61850 (MMS)" and at least ONE "Basic administration
(SSH/SFTP)" should be enabled across all interfaces
2) "User management via RBAC (Webservice)" option can be fully disabled or only enabled on ONE of
the available interfaces
Tab. 3-7: TCP/IP service in port assignment.
Configured example
3.5.5.2.6 Secure Communication with the Easergy Studio via the Ethernet Interface
When P139 and Easergy Studio are connected via the Ethernet interface, they
will communicate securely using TLS (Transport Layer Security Protocol). The
benefits of secure communication are:
● Help in the prevention of unwanted eavesdropping between Easergy Studio
and the IED.
● Help in the prevention of modification of data between Easergy Studio and
the IED.
● Ensure integrity of data.
● Help to prevent replay of data at a later data.
Setting up a connection, as a quick guide you need to do the following:
When attempting to connect to the IED via Ethernet, Easergy Studio will first
attempt to communicate with the IED via secure communication.
IEC:
IEC 61850 enable
[ 104 077 ]
IEC:
IEC60870-5-104enable
[ 104 078 ]
IEC:
IEC prot. variant
[ 104 084 ]
IEC:
ETH COMM Mode
[ 104 080 ]
IEC:
Block Port A/B
[ 104 073 ]
IEC:
Block Port C
[ 104 074 ]
IEC:
Switch Config. Bank
[ 104 043 ]
IEC:
SigGGIO1 selection
[ 104 064 ]
IEC:
Diff. local time
[ 104 206]
IEC:
Diff. dayl.sav. time
[ 104 207 ]
IEC:
Switch.dayl.sav.time
[ 104 219 ]
IEC:
Dayl.sav.time start
[ 104 220 ]
IEC:
Dayl.sav.time st. d
[ 104 221 ]
IEC:
Dayl.sav.time st. m
[ 104 222 ]
IEC:
General enable USER IEC:
Dayl.sav.t.st.0:00 +
[ 104 000 ]
[ 104 223 ]
0 IEC:
Dayl.sav.time end
1 [ 104 225 ]
0: No IEC:
Dayl.sav.time end d
1: Yes [ 104 226 ]
IEC:
Dayl.sav.time end m
[ 104 227 ]
IEC:
Dayl.sav.t.end 0:00+
IEC: [ 104 228 ]
Ctrl blocked user
[ 221 125 ]
0: No
1: Yes
Commun. interface IEC:
Comm. link faulty
[ 105 180 ]
MAIN:
Test mode
[ 037 071 ] IEC:
Control blocked
[ 221 126 ]
47Z9303A
System configurator
PACiS SCE
.iid
.scd
.icd
Operating program
.mcl (Ed1)
.cid (Ed2) .x3v
TRIP
ALARM
OUT OF SERVICE
HEALTHY
EDIT MODE
P139
19Z9005A
IED
Control PC
Processor module
Operating program
Device
parameters
Parameter
switch
Parameter download
Bank 1 Bank 2
IEC:
Sel.spontan.sig.test
[ 104 245 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signals
IEC:
Test spont.sig.start
[ 104 246 ]
IEC:
Spontan. sig. start
0 [ --- --- ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
IEC:
Test spont.sig. end
[ 104 247 ]
IEC:
Spontan. sig. end
0 [ --- --- ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
49Z9002A
» Device A » Device B
IEC 61850
Mapping
Easerg Studio
IED Configurator
System/LLN0/Dataset x
19Z8203C
It is not possible to read the IEC configuration back from the P139 if the “Dataset”
sizes exceed the GOOSE size limit significantly. Therefore it is recommended to
limit the “Dataset” size(s) to 100% of the GOOSE capacity. Too large a dataset can
spoil IEC 61850 communication. Hence, the dataset size limit of 100% of the
GOOSE capacity should not be exceeded, neither for GOOSE nor for reports.
When defining the datasets for GOOSE it is advised to select the individual data
attributes and not the overlapping data objects. By this the amount of data is
kept within a limit and decoding is guaranteed on the receiving end.
When a state change occurs with a selected state signal or a measured value
changes which is greater than the dead band set for the relevant data point then
the complete GOOSE is sent. There will be multiple send repetitions at ascending
time periods. The first send repetition occurs at the given cycle time set with the
parameter [IC]: Minimum Cycle Time. The cycles for the following send
repetitions result from a conditional equation with the increment set with the
parameter [IC ] : I ncreme nt. Should no further state changes occur up to the
time when the maximum cycle time has elapsed [ IC]: Maximum Cycle Time,
then GOOSE will be sent cyclically at intervals as set for the maximum cycle
time.
In order to have unambiguous identification of a GOOSE sent, characteristics
such as [IC ]: Mult icast MAC Addres s, [ IC]: Application ID (hex),
[I C]: VLA N I dent ifie r (h ex), [IC] : V LA N P r iority and
[I C]: GOOSE I de nt if ie r must be entered in the IED Configurator settings.
Further characteristics are [ IC ]: Datase t R ef e rence and
[IC]: Config urat ion Revis ion.
Each GOOSE is given the state change index and the number of send repetitions.
» Device A » Device B
Control/LLN0.ST.OrdRun.stVal
IED Configurator
System/LLN0/Dataset
x
19Z7004C
If with a system application it must be ensured that only one control command at
a time is being processed system wide (“uniqueness”) then interlocking of
secondary devices among themselves is setup with GOOSE. The P139 sets the
status information Control/LLN0.ST.OrdRun.stVal. when it has received a control
command. This information – stored in a dataset – is distributed in the system by
GOOSE and is therefore available to all other devices as an interlocking
condition. The state information is reset and accordingly signaled after
termination of the command sequence.
The P139 is capable to monitor the command status of up to 32 further devices.
With the IED Configurator OrdRunGGIO1.ind1.stVal to OrdRunGGIO1.ind32.stVal
are configured in a similar way to the other GOOSE inputs. A shuttling to the
interlocking equations is not necessary as their consideration within command
checking is automatically enabled when the first binary signal input is configured.
During a signaling receipt phase command effecting will be rejected.
Synchronization Readiness
If the IRIG-B interface is enabled and receiving a signal, the P139 checks the
received signal for plausibility. Implausible signals are rejected by the P139. If
the P139 does not receive a correct signal in the long run, synchronization will
not be ready any longer.
IRIGB:
General enable USER
[ 023 200 ]
IRIGB:
Enabled
[ 023 201 ]
IRIGB:
Synchron. ready
[ 023 202 ]
IRIGB:
EBR Synchron. ready
[ 023 203 ]
19Z9001A
Filter Function
An additional filter function may be enabled in order to suppress transient
interference peaks at the logic signal inputs (operating modes Active "high", filt.
or Active "low", filt.). With this function enabled a status change at the binary
logic input is only signaled when the input signal remains at a steady signal level
during a set number of sampling steps (sampling step size = period / 20). The
number of sampling steps is set at parameter I NP : Filt er.
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ XXX XXX ]
Function 1 EXT
Function 2 EXT
Function 3 EXT
Function n EXT
INP:
Oper. mode U xxx
[ YYY XXX ]
0: Active "low"
1: Active "high"
2: Active "low", filt.
3: Active "high", filt.
-Uxxx
&
Input signal
&
INP: &
Filter
[ 010 220 ]
&
INP:
State U xxx
&
[ ZZZ ZZZ ]
&
12Z6213A
Fig. 3-34: Configuration and operating mode of the binary signal inputs.
MEASI:
General enable USER
[ 011 100 ]
0
MEASI:
1 Enabled
[ 035 008 ]
0: No
1: Yes
S8Z52H1A
I DC,lin / I DC,nom
1.2
1.1
I DC,lin20 1
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
I DC,lin1 0
0 0.1 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35 0.4 0.45 0.5 0.6 I DC / I DC,nom
I DC1 I DC20
19Z5266A_EN
Fig. 3-36: Example of the conversion of 4 to 10 mA input current to 0 to 20 mA monitored current, IDC,lin.
IDC,lin / IDC,nom
0.8
Interpolation points
IDC,lin20 0.7
0.6
IDC,lin4 0.5
0.4
IDC,lin3 0.3
IDC,lin2 0.2
IDC,lin1 0.1
0
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1 1.1 1.2
Fig. 3-37: Example of a characteristic with five interpolation points (characteristic with zero suppression setting of
0.1 IDC,nom is shown as a broken line).
MEASI:
Enabled
[ 035 008 ]
SFMON:
Invalid scaling IDC
[ 093 116 ]
MEASI:
Overload 20mA input
[ 040 191 ]
Input channel 1(I-1) SFMON:
Overload 20 mA input
[ 098 025 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. 20mA inp.
[ 040 192 ]
SFMON:
Open circ. 20mA inp.
[ 098 026 ]
MEASI:
Curr. IDC,lin. p.u.
[ 004 136 ]
MEASI:
Current IDC p.u.
[ 004 135 ]
MEASI:
Current IDC
[ 004 134 ]
S8Z52H2A
Beyond the linearization described above, the user has the option of scaling the
linearized values. Thereby negative values, for example, can be displayed as well
and are available for further processing by protection functions.
MEASI:
Scaled val. IDC,lin1
[ 037 192 ]
MEASI:
Scaled val.IDC,lin20
[ 037 193 ]
MEASI: MEASI:
Curr. IDC,lin. p.u. Scaled value IDC,lin
[ 004 136 ] [ 004 180 ]
Q9Z5029A
MEASI:
Enabled
[ 035 008 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. PT100
Measur. input PT100 [ 040 190 ]
SFMON:
PT100 open circuit
[ 098 024 ]
MEASI:
Temperature T
[ 004 133 ]
MEASI:
Temperature p.u. T
[ 004 221 ]
MEASI:
Temperature Tmax
[ 004 233 ]
19Z5262A
Fig. 3-40: Temperature measurement using a PT 100 resistance thermometer connected to the analog (I/O)
module.
Open-Circuit Monitoring
If one of the measuring circuits is open due to a broken wire, the signal
MEASI: O pe n ci rc. T1 (or T2, …, T9, resp.) is issued.
MEASI:
Enabled
[ 035 008 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. T1
Measur. input T1 [ 040 193 ]
SFMON:
T1 open circ.
[ 098 029 ]
MEASI:
Temperature T1
[ 004 224 ]
MEASI:
Temperature p.u. T1
[ 004 081 ]
MEASI:
Temperature T1 max.
[ 004 234 ]
19Z5263A
Fig. 3-41: Temperature measurement with temperature sensor T1 connected to the temperature p/c board. The
same applies to sensors T2 to T9.
Backup Sensors
The open circuit signals from temperature sensors, issued by function group
MEASI, are forwarded to the Thermal Overload Protection function. Should the
main temperature sensor (that has been set in the Thermal Overload Protection)
fail, it is possible to select in whether the 20 mA input or – if configured – one of
the temperature sensors T1 to T9, connected to the temperature p/c board (the
RTD module), is to be used as a backup sensor (see Section 3.33, (p. 3-315)).
In addition to this, the open circuit signals from the temperature sensors, issued
by the function group MEASI, are forwarded to the Limit Value Monitoring
function. The selection of such backup sensors for the Limit Value Monitoring
function is made in the function group MEASI.
For this purpose the temperature sensors connected to the temperature p/c
board (RTD board) are divided into three groups:
Group 1: T1, T2, T3
Group 2: T4, T5, T6
Group 3: T7, T8, T9
If ME ASI: BackupTe mpSe ns or P Sx is set to None the Limit Value Monitoring
function will operate without backup sensors.
If ME AS I: BackupTempSe nsor PSx is set to Group 1 - 2, the defective
temperature sensor from group 1 is replaced by the corresponding sensor from
group 2.
If the backup temperature sensor from group 2 also fails it will be replaced by the
corresponding sensor from group 3, under the assumption that
M EASI : Back upTempSen s or P Sx is set to Group 1 - 2/3.
The association of backup temperature sensors is listed below:
Main sensor Backup sensor from group 2, Backup sensor from group 3,
with setting: with setting:
Group 1 - 2 or Group 1 - 2/3 Group 1 - 2/3
T1 T4 T7
T2 T5 T8
T3 T6 T9
Should temperature sensor T1 fail, with the setting Group 1 - 2/3, it will be
replaced by T4. Should temperature sensor T4 also fail it will be replaced by T7.
For further details refer to section with the description of the “Limit Value
Monitoring” (Section 3.43, (p. 3-388)).
Application Example
A motor protection application is shown in the figure below with temperature
sensors T1 to T9 connected to the temperature p/c board (RTD module) and a
“PT 100” resistance thermometer connected to the analog (I/O) module Y.
RTD RTD
Phase RTD
Main Temp. Sensor
A B C Ambient temperature/
RTD Coolant temperature
Backup Temp. Sensor
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
Stator
RTD
RTD
Rotor
Bearing Bearing
Stator
19Z5236
Fig. 3-42: Temperature measurements on a motor to be used with the Limit Value Monitoring function (LIMIT) and
the Thermal Overload protection (THERM).
OUTP:
Outp.rel.block USER
[ 021 014 ]
0
OUTP:
1 Outp. relays blocked
≥1 [ 021 015 ]
0: No
OUTP: 1: Yes
Block outp.rel. EXT
[ 040 014 ] ≥1
MAIN:
Prot. ext. disabled
[ 038 046 ]
SFMON:
Hardware fault
304 950
OUTP:
Test in progress
402 107
OUTP:
Oper. mode K xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
1 ≥1
2
3 -K xxx
4
≥1
5
6
≥1 =1
1: ES updating
2: ES manual reset
≥1
3: ES reset (fault)
4: ES reset (syst.dist)
& ≥1
5: NE updating
&
6: NE manual reset &
& ≥1 OUTP:
State K 301
[ zzz zzz ]
OUTP:
Fct.assignment K xxx & S1 1
[ yyy xxx ]
R1
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3 m out of n
Signal n
≥1 & ≥1
Selected signal
&
MAIN:
General starting OUTP:
1 Latching reset
[ 040 000 ] & [ 040 088 ]
FT_RC:
System disturb. runn
[ 035 004 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OUTP:
Reset latch. USER
[ 021 009 ]
1 1
100 ms
0: don't execute
1: execute
OUTP:
Reset latch. EXT
[ 040 015 ]
19Z8741A
Fig. 3-43: Configuration, setting the operating mode, and blocking the output relays
OUTP:
Relay assign. f.test
[ 003 042 ]
OUTP:
Fct.assignment K xx1
[ AAA AAA ]
OUTP:
Fct.assignment K xx2
[ BBB BBB ]
OUTP:
Fct.assignment K xx3
[ CCC CCC ]
OUTP:
Fct.assignment K xxx
[ ZZZ ZZZ ]
MAIN: OUTP:
Device on-line
Selected relay & Test in progress
[ 003 030 ] 402 107
0: No (= off)
OUTP:
OUTP: Hold-time for test
Relay test [ 003 044 ]
[ 003 043 ]
0 &
0: don't execute
1: execute
19Z8739A
MEASI:
General enable USER
[ 011 100 ]
0
MEASI:
1 Enabled
[ 035 008 ]
0: No
1: Yes
S8Z52H1A
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
S8Z52H5A
MEASO:
Reset output USER
[ 037 116 ]
1
0: don't execute
1: execute
MEASO:
MEASO: Output reset
Reset output EXT
[ 036 087 ] [ 037 117 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ] MEASO:
Reset meas.val.outp.
1: execute 304 601
MAIN:
Reset indicat. USER
[ 021 010 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset indicat. EXT
[ 065 001 ]
47Z13H6A
3.10.1.4 Scaling
Scaling is used to map the physical measuring range to the P139 inherent setting
range.
Scaling of analog output is also suited for directional-signed output of some fault
measurands, in particular fault location in percent.
Measurands Range
Scaling is made with reference to the complete range of values for the selected
measurand (variable Mx). The complete range of values is defined by their end
values Mx,RL1 and Mx,RL2. (Mx,RL1 and Mx,RL2 are listed in the operating
program - Easergy Studio - under “minimum” and “maximum”.)
Designation of the set values in the data "Scaled min. val. BCD" ... "Scaled max. val. BCD"
model
Measurands in the range "Measurands to BCD-Out min. value ... BCD-Out max. value
be output" (Valid BCD value)
Measurands Range
053 002 ME ASO : F ct. assi gnm. BC D FT_DA: Fau lt locat. pe rcent
The following figure displays the values output as a function of the fault location.
The BCD value and the signal MEASO: Vali d BCD value = Yes are only issued
in the value range 0% to 200%.
200
FT_DA:
-320% 0% 200% 320% Fault locat. percent
[004 027]
47Z1040A
MEASO:
MEASO: Hold time output BCD
Enabled [ 010 010 ]
[ 037 102 ]
MEASO:
1-digit bit 0 (BCD)
[ 037 051 ]
MEASO:
1-digit bit 1 (BCD)
[ 037 052 ]
Setting blocked
MEASO:
1-digit bit 2 (BCD)
[ 037 053 ]
MEASO: MEASO:
Enable 1-digit bit 3 (BCD)
304 600 [ 037 054 ]
MEASO:
10-digit bit 0 (BCD)
[ 037 055 ]
MEASO:
10-digit bit 1 (BCD)
MEASO: [ 037 056 ]
Reset meas.val.outp.
304 601 MEASO:
10-digit bit 2 (BCD)
[ 037 057 ]
MEASO:
10-digit bit 3 (BCD)
[ 037 058 ]
MEASO:
100-dig. bit 0 (BCD)
[ 037 059 ]
Selected
MEASO:
meas. oper. value 100-dig. bit 1 (BCD)
[ 037 060 ]
Selected
Meas. event value
being updated
MEASO:
Selected meas. val. Valid BCD value
Value not measured [ 037 050 ]
MEASO:
Fct. assignm. BCD Meas. value ≥ 399
[ 053 002 ]
Measured value 1
Measured value 2
Measured value 3
Measured value n c1
c2
Scaling of the
BCD output
Selected meas. val. 1
++ 2
MEASO: 1...2
Output value x
[ * ]
0 . . . 100 %
x: 3 MEASO:
037 122 BCD-Out max. value 037 143
19Z5264A
Fig. 3-49: BCD measured data output. Overflow behavior is displayed in BCD example (see previous figure).
values Mx,RL1 and Mx,RL2. (Mx,RL1 and Mx,RL2 are listed in the operating
program – Easergy Studio – under “minimum” and “maximum”.)
Measurands Range
Scaled measurands with a scaled knee-point to be Mx,scal,min ... Mx,scal,knee ... Mx,scal,max
output with:
Mx,scal,min = (Mx,min - Mx,RL1) / (Mx,RL2 -
Mx,RL1
Mx,scal,knee = (Mx,knee - Mx,RL1) / (Mx,RL2 -
Mx,RL1)
Mx,scal,max = (Mx,max - Mx,RL1) / (Mx,RL2 -
Mx,RL1
Designation of the set values in the data model "Scal. min. value Ax" ...
... "Scal. knee-point Ax"
... "Scaled max. val. Ax"
Measurands Range
In this example the following P139 settings are selected in the menu branch
Parameter/Config. parameters:
037 104 MEASO : Sca le d m in . val. A-1 0.013 (corresponds with 0.02 Vnom)
037 105 MEASO : S cale d k ne e val. A -1 0.067 (corresponds with 0.10 Vnom)
037 106 ME ASO : S caled m ax . val. A -1 0.667 (corresponds with 1.00 Vnom)
By setting MEASO: A nOut m in . val. A-1, the user can specify the output
current that will be output when values are smaller than or equal to the set
minimum measured value to be transmitted. The setting at MEASO: AnO ut
max . va l. A-1 defines the output current that is output for the maximum
measured value to be transmitted. By defining the knee-point, the user can
obtain two characteristic curve sections with different slopes. When entering this
setting the user must keep in mind that only a rising/rising or falling/falling curve
sense is permitted (peaky or vee shapes not allowed). If the setting was not
properly entered, the signal SFMON: In val i d s caling A -1 will be issued.
A check of the set characteristic and its acceptance by the P139, if the setting was
properly entered, will only occur after the P139 is switched on-line again (with the
setting M A I N : D e v i c e o n - l i n e).
Ia / mA
20
Max. 18
output value
Knee point 16
output value
14
12
10
Min. 4
output value
2
0
0 0.02 0.1 1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 Vnom
0.013 0.067 0.667 1.0 Mx,scal
19Z5265A
Fig. 3-50: Example of a characteristic curve for analog measured data output . In this example the range starting
value is = 0; also possible is directional-signed output (see corresponding example in section BCD Measured Data
Output).
MEASO:
Value A-1 output
[ 037 118 ]
MEASO:
MEASO: Hold time output A-1
Enabled [ 010 114 ]
[ 037 102 ]
Setting(s) blocked c
MEASO:
Enable
304 600
An. outp. ch.1 (A-1)
[ --- --- ]
MEASO: R
Reset meas.val.outp.
304 601
Selected
meas. oper. value
OUTP: Selected
Fct.assignment K xxx Meas. event value
[ xxx xxx ] being updated
c
K x1
K x2 MEASO:
Scaled min. val. A-1
K x3 [ 037 104 ]
K xx MEASO:
Scaled knee val. A-1
[ 037 105 ]
c
MEASO:
Value A-1 output MEASO:
[ 037 118 ] Scaled max. val. A-1
[ 037 106 ]
MEASO:
AnOut min. val. A-1
[ 037 107 ]
MEASO:
Fct. assignm. A-1
MEASO:
[ 053 000 ] AnOut knee point A-1
[ 037 108 ]
Measured value 1
MEASO:
AnOut max. val. A-1
Measured value 2 [ 037 109 ]
Measured value 3
Measured value n
SFMON:
Selected meas. val. Invalid scaling A-1
[ 093 114 ]
c1
0 . . . 100 % Value < AnOut range c2
c3
S8Z52H8B
H 4 (red) TRIP With the P139 this LED indicator is customarily configured with
function MA IN: Ge n. tri p si gnal, but the configuration may be
modified.
H 2 (amber) OUT OF SERVICE Permanently configured with function MA IN: B locked/ fault y.
H 17 (red) EDIT MODE Not configurable. H 17 indicates the input (edit) mode. Only when
the P139 is in this mode, can parameter settings be changed by
pressing the “Up” and “Down” keys. (See Section 6.2, (p. 6-2))
H 5 to H 16 ― For each of these LED indicators both colors (red & green) may
be configured freely and independently.
H4 TRIP
H3 ALARM
H2 OUT OF SERVICE
H1 HEALTHY
H17 EDIT MODE
H5
H6
H7
H8
H9
H10
H11
H12
H13
H14
H15
H16
Finally, as the 13th operating mode, every LED (except the permanently
configured ones) can be set to the mode ES Alarmunit. This mode has the
following flashing behavior:
● The LED starts flashing with the first starting of the signal that has been
assigned to it.
The LED assumes the color that has been assigned via setting parameter. If
both colors (red and green) have been configured to different signals, and
these two signals both become active then the LED flashes in amber color.
● If an LED reset is executed and the configured signal is still active the LED
changes to continuous light.
Important: If the LED was flashing in amber color then this color is kept,
even if one of the two signals is no longer active.
● If all the configured signals are no longer active at the time of the LED
reset, or become inactive at a later time, the LED goes out.
● If later, after the LED has gone out, any of the configured signals becomes
active again then the LED starts flashing again (in the assigned color).
If both colors have been configured and the LED shines continuously in
amber color, then it is possible that one of these two signals becomes
inactive and active again whilst the other signal stays active all the time. In
this case the LED starts flashing again with the starting of that signal. But
since the LED permanently keeps the amber color it is no longer possible to
tell the two signals from each other. Therefore general caution is
recommended whenever two different signals are configured to an LED
with this operating mode.
LED:
Oper. mode H xx
[ xxx xxx ]
10
11
12
13 ≥1
1: ES updating
2: ES manual reset
3: ES reset (fault)
4: ES reset (syst.dist) !G!
5: NE updating
6: NE manual reset
7: ES updating bl
8: ES manual reset bl -Hxx (red)
9: ES reset (fault) bl
10: ES rst (syst.dst) bl
11: NE updating bl
12: NE manual reset bl
13: ES Alarmunit
& LED:
State Hxx red
[ zzz zzz ]
LED: &
Fct.assig. Hxx red
[ yyy yyy ]
&
Signal 1 &
Signal 2 &
Signal 3 m out of n
Signal n
& S1 1
& R1
Selected signals
&
MAIN:
General starting
[ 040 000 ]
&
FT_RC:
System disturb. runn
[ 035 004 ]
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
19Z8100B
Fig. 3-53: Configuration and Operating Mode of the LED Indicators, showing the example of the “red” LED color.
A
B
C
MAIN:
Vref,nom V.T. sec.
[ 031 052 ]
1U
V̲ref
2U
MAIN: MAIN:
Conn. meas. circ. IP Inom device
[ 010 004 ] [ 010 003 ]
IA
X X∙Y I̲A
IB
X X∙Y I̲B
IC X X∙Y I̲C
1: Standard
IN (Y = 1)
2: Opposite
(Y = -1)
MAIN: MAIN:
Conn. meas. circ. IN IN,nom device
[ 010 019 ] [ 010 026 ]
X X∙Y I̲N
1: Standard
(Y = 1)
2: Opposite
(Y = -1)
MAIN:
VNG,nom V.T. sec.
[ 010 028 ]
n e
V̲N-G
n
MAIN:
Vnom V.T. sec.
[ 010 009 ]
U
V̲A-G
e V
V̲B-G
W
V̲C-G
N
19Z6402A
Fig. 3-54: Connecting the P139 measuring circuits (when the P139 is equipped with the RTD module; see
references in previous text).
Parameter Value
MAIN:
Meas. value rel. IP
MAIN: [ 011 030 ]
General start. int.
306 539
MAIN: c
Hardware fault
306 540
I̲A c1
I̲B c2
I̲C c3
c4
c5
c6
1 MAIN:
Current A p.u.
[ 005 041 ]
2 MAIN:
Current B p.u.
[ 006 041 ]
3 MAIN:
Current C p.u.
[ 007 041 ]
+
+ 4 MAIN:
+ Current Σ(IP) p.u.
[ 005 011 ]
5 MAIN:
COMP Current IP,max p.u.
[ 005 051 ]
6 MAIN:
Current IP,min p.u.
[ 005 056 ]
I̲max
MAIN:
I̲min Inom C.T. prim.
[ 010 001 ]
MAIN:
Current A prim.
[ 005 040 ]
MAIN:
Current B prim.
[ 006 040 ]
MAIN:
Current C prim.
[ 007 040 ]
MAIN:
Current Σ(IP) prim.
[ 005 010 ]
MAIN:
Curr. IP,max prim.
[ 005 050 ]
MAIN:
Curr. IP,min prim.
[ 005 055 ]
19Z6403A
MAIN:
IA p.u.,demand
[ 006 235 ]
MAIN:
IB p.u.,demand
[ 006 236 ]
MAIN:
IC p.u.,demand
[ 006 237 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Settl. t. IP,max,del IP,max p.u.,demand
[ 010 113 ] [ 005 037 ]
MAIN:
MAIN: IA p.u.,demand stor.
Current A p.u.
R [ 006 232 ]
[ 005 041 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Current B p.u. IB p.u.,demand stor.
[ 006 041 ] R [ 006 233 ]
MAIN:
MAIN: IC p.u.,demand stor.
Current C p.u. [ 006 234 ]
[ 007 041 ] R
MAIN:
MAIN: IP,maxp.u.,demand.st
Current IP,max p.u. [ 005 035 ]
[ 005 051 ] R
MAIN:
Inom C.T. prim.
[ 010 001 ]
MAIN:
IA prim,demand
[ 006 226 ]
MAIN:
IB prim,demand
[ 006 227 ]
MAIN:
IC prim,demand
[ 006 228 ]
MAIN:
IP,max prim.,demand
MAIN: [ 005 036 ]
Reset IP,max,st.USER
[ 003 033 ] MAIN:
IA prim,demand stor.
[ 006 223 ]
0
MAIN:
1 IB prim,demand stor.
[ 006 224 ]
MAIN: 0: don't execute
General reset USER
1: execute MAIN:
[ 003 002 ] IC prim,demand stor.
1: execute [ 006 225 ]
MAIN:
General reset EXT MAIN:
[ 005 255 ] IP,maxprim,demand.st
MAIN: [ 005 034 ]
Reset IP,max,st. EXT
[ 005 211 ]
19Z6404A
Fig. 3-56: Measured operating data - phase current, part 2: demand values (delayed and stored phase currents and
maximum phase current).
MAIN:
MAIN: Meas. value rel. IN
General start. int.
306 539
[ 011 031 ]
MAIN:
Hardware fault
306 540
I̲N
MAIN:
Current IN p.u.
[ 004 044 ]
MAIN:
IN,nom C.T. prim.
[ 010 018 ]
MAIN:
Current IN prim.
[ 004 043 ]
S8Z5097A
3.12.3.4 Display of Demand Values – Delayed and Stored Values of the Three
Phase Currents
The P139 offers the option of a delayed display of the three phase currents. This
functionality is equivalent to the display of the maximum value of the three
phase currents (see description above, Fig. 3-58, (p. 3-99) and Fig. 3-56, (p. 3-
97)). However, in this case, the delayed phase current display will have reached
90 % (not 95 %) of IA , IB or IC , respectively, after the set delay.
The stored phase currents are implemented as for the stored maximum phase
current.
The delay for these six operating data values is set at MAIN: Se ttl. t.
IP,max,del as for the delayed maximum phase current.
MAIN:
Current IP,max p.u.
[ 005 051 ]
MAIN:
IP,max p.u.,demand
[ 005 037 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Settl. t. IP,max,del Settl. t. IP,max,del
[ 010 113 ] [ 010 113 ]
MAIN:
Current IP,max p.u.
[ 005 051 ]
MAIN:
IP,maxp.u.,demand.st
[ 005 035 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Settl. t. IP,max,del Settl. t. IP,max,del
[ 010 113 ] [ 010 113 ]
MAIN:
Current IP,max p.u.
[ 005 051 ]
MAIN:
IP,maxp.u.,demand.st
[ 005 035 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Settl. t. IP,max,del Settl. t. IP,max,del
[ 010 113 ] [ 010 113 ]
MAIN:
Reset IP,max,st.USER
[ 003 033 ]
MAIN:
Reset IP,max,st. EXT
[ 005 211 ]
50Z0115A
Fig. 3-58: Operation of delayed and stored maximum phase current display – display of demand values.
V̲A-G COMP
V̲B-G
V̲C-G
V̲PG,max V̲PG,max
V̲PG,min V̲PG,min
+
+ Σ(VPG)/3 Σ(VPG)/3
+
+ V̲A-B
−
+ V̲B-C
−
+ V̲C-A
−
MAIN:
Phase sequence COMP
[ 010 049 ]
2 V̲PP,max V̲PP,max
1 2 V̲PP,min V̲PP,min
1: A - B - C
2: A - C - B
V̲neg V̲neg
V̲pos V̲pos
47Z0106A
Fig. 3-59: Determining the minimum and maximum phase-to-ground and phase-to-phase voltages as well as the
negative-sequence and positive-sequence voltages.
The measured voltage values are displayed both as per-unit quantities referred
to the nominal quantities of the P139 and as primary quantities. To allow a
display in primary values, the primary nominal voltage of the system transformer
needs to be set in the P139.
MAIN: C
General start. int. ≥1
306 539
MAIN: MAIN:
Hardware fault Meas. value rel. V
306 540
[ 011 032 ]
V̲A-G C1
V̲B-G C2
V̲C-G C3
V̲PG,max C4
V̲PG,min C5
Σ(VPG)/3 C6
V̲A-B C7
V̲B-C C8
V̲C-A C9
V̲PP,max C10
V̲PP,min C11
MAIN:
Voltage A-G p.u.
V̲neg C12
[ 005 043 ]
V̲pos C13 MAIN:
Voltage B-G p.u.
[ 006 043 ]
MAIN:
Voltage C-G p.u.
[ 007 043 ]
1 MAIN:
Voltage VPG,max p.u.
2 [ 008 043 ]
MAIN:
Voltage VPG,min p.u.
3 [ 009 043 ]
MAIN:
4 Volt. Σ(VPG)/√3 p.u.
[ 005 013 ]
MAIN:
5 Voltage A-B p.u.
[ 005 045 ]
6 MAIN:
Voltage B-C p.u.
7 [ 006 045 ]
MAIN:
8 Voltage C-A p.u.
[ 007 045 ]
9 MAIN:
Voltage VPP,max p.u.
[ 008 045 ]
10 MAIN:
Voltage VPP,min p.u.
11 [ 009 045 ]
MAIN:
12 Voltage Vneg p.u.
[ 009 017 ]
13 MAIN:
Voltage Vpos p.u.
[ 009 018 ]
MAIN:
Vnom V.T. prim. MAIN:
[ 010 002 ] Voltage A-G prim.
[ 005 042 ]
MAIN:
Voltage B-G prim.
[ 006 042 ]
MAIN:
Voltage C-G prim.
[ 007 042 ]
MAIN:
Volt. VPG,max prim.
[ 008 042 ]
MAIN:
Volt. VPG,min prim.
[ 009 042 ]
MAIN:
Volt. Σ(VPG)/3 prim.
[ 005 012 ]
MAIN:
Voltage A-B prim.
[ 005 044 ]
MAIN:
Voltage B-C prim.
[ 006 044 ]
MAIN:
Voltage C-A prim.
[ 007 044 ]
MAIN:
Volt. VPP,max prim.
[ 008 044 ]
MAIN:
Voltage VPP,min prim
[ 009 044 ]
MAIN:
Voltage VPP,min prim
[ 009 044 ]
12Z6204C
MAIN:
General start. int.
306 539
MAIN:
Hardware fault MAIN:
306 018 Meas. val. rel. VNG
[ 011 033 ]
V̲N-G
MAIN:
Voltage VNG p.u.
[ 004 042 ]
MAIN:
VNG,nom V.T. prim.
[ 010 027 ]
MAIN:
Voltage VNG prim.
[ 004 041 ]
19Z5064A
MAIN:
Meas. val. rel. Vref
[ 011 034 ]
MAIN:
Hardware fault
306 018
V̲ref
MAIN:
Voltage Vref p.u.
[ 005 047 ]
MAIN:
Vref,nom V.T. prim.
[ 010 100 ]
MAIN:
Voltage Vref prim.
[ 005 046 ]
47Z0109A
3.12.3.6 Measured Values for Power, Active Power Factor, and Angle
MAIN:
Inom C.T. prim.
[ 010 001 ]
MAIN:
Vnom V.T. prim.
[ 010 002 ]
MAIN:
Appar. power S p.u.
[ 005 026 ]
MAIN:
Active power factor
[ 004 054 ]
MAIN:
I̲A > 0.025 Inom Appar. power S prim.
MAIN: [ 005 025 ]
Meas. direction P,Q
[ 006 096 ]
I̲B > 0.025 Inom
MAIN:
Active power P p.u.
X X · Y [ 004 051 ]
I̲C MAIN:
> 0.025 Inom X X · Y Reac. power Q p.u.
[ 004 053 ]
X X · Y MAIN:
Active power P prim.
V̲A-G > 1.5 V X X · Y [ 004 050 ]
MAIN:
1: Standard Reac. power Q prim.
(Y = 1) [ 004 052 ]
V̲B-G > 1.5 V 2: Opposite
(Y = -1)
MAIN:
Load angle phi A
[ 004 055 ]
MAIN:
& C Load angle phi B p.u
[ 005 074 ]
MAIN:
Load angle phi B
[ 004 056 ]
MAIN:
& C Load angle phi C p.u
[ 005 075 ]
MAIN:
Load angle phi C
[ 004 057 ]
MAIN:
& C Angle phi N p.u.
[ 005 076 ]
MAIN:
Angle phi N
[ 004 072 ]
MAIN:
& C Angle ΣVPG/IN p.u.
[ 005 072 ]
MAIN:
Angle ΣVPG vs. IN
+ [ 005 009 ]
+
+
MAIN:
Hardware fault
306 018
19Z8003A
Fig. 3-63: Measured operating data – power, active power factor, and angle.
● Values for active and reactive power will always be calculated and
displayed as these quantities are required for the subsequent energy
measurement. Greater deviations in measurements may occur with low
phase currents or a critical power factor value.
● The active power factor will be calculated only if the apparent power value
exceeds 5% of the nominal apparent power Snom.
● Load angles will be displayed only if the respective phase current exceeds
0.1·Inom and if the phase-to-ground voltage exceeds 1.5 V.
● The angle between the measured values for the residual current and the
neutral-point displacement voltage will only be displayed if the residual
current exceeds 0.02·IN,nom and the neutral-point displacement voltage
exceeds 1.5 V.
The setting for MAI N: Meas . directi on P, Q may be changed from Standard to
Opposite if the user wishes to have the following measured operating data
displayed with the opposite sign (see Fig. 3-63, (p. 3-103)):
● MA IN : Act ive power P p.u.
● MA IN : R eac. pow er Q p.u .
● MAIN : Act iv e power P prim.
● MAI N: R eac. powe r Q pri m.
This setting parameter does not influence the remaining measured operating
data. It must be noted that inverting the sign will only affect the display of
measured operating data, all protection functions will internally use non-inverted
measured values.
I̲A
I̲B
I̲C
I̲N
MAIN:
1 2 Phase rel.,IN vs ΣIP
[ 004 073 ]
1: Equal phase
2: Reverse phase
47Z0112A
Fig. 3-64: Phase relation between calculated and measured residual current.
The P139 checks if the phase relations of calculated residual current and
measured residual current are coherent. If the phase displacement between the
two currents is ≤ 45°, then the indication Equal phase is displayed.
3.12.3.8 Frequency
MAIN:
General start. int. C
306 539
MAIN:
Hardware fault
306 018 >0.65⋅Vnom
MAIN:
V̲A-G + C Frequency f p.u.
[ 004 070 ]
V̲B-G -
MAIN:
f Frequency f
[ 004 040 ]
12Z6209A
The P139 determines the frequency from the voltage VA-B. This voltage needs to
exceed a minimum threshold of 0.65 Vnom in order for frequency to be
determined.
MAIN:
Op. mode energy cnt.
[ 010 138 ]
MAIN:
Active power P prim.
[ 004 050 ] ∫P(t) dt MAIN:
Act.energy outp.prim
R [ 005 061 ]
-∫P(t) dt MAIN:
Act.energy inp. prim
R [ 005 062 ]
MAIN:
Reac. power Q prim.
[ 004 052 ] ∫Q(t) dt MAIN:
MAIN: React.en. outp. prim
Reset meas.v.en.USER R [ 005 063 ]
[ 003 032 ]
0 -∫Q(t) dt MAIN:
React. en. inp. prim
R [ 005 064 ]
1 ≥1
0: don't execute
Overflow MAIN:
No.ov/fl.reac.en.out
Transfer [ 009 092 ]
MAIN:
Overflow No.ov/fl.reac.en.inp
[ 009 093 ]
Transfer
19Z8033A
Fig. 3-66: Determining the active and reactive energy output and input.
The P139 determines the active and reactive energy output and input based on
the primary active or reactive power.
There are two procedures available to determine active and reactive energy. If
procedure 1 is selected, active and reactive energy are determined every 2 s
(approximately). If procedure 2 is selected, active and reactive energy are
determined every 100 ms (approximately). In this way higher accuracy is
achieved.
Measured energy values are presented as text parameters with a value range of
about 0 … 6.5 TWh and a resolution of 10 kWh. In addition, 16 bit values and
overflow counters are provided, which are needed for transmission via serial
protocols (e.g. Modbus, DNP3, Courier).
Energy values as 32 bit / text Energy values as 16 bit values Overflow counters for the 16 bit
values Value range: 0 … 655,35 MWh energy values
Value range: 0 … Value range: 0 … 10000
6553500.00 MWh
(008 065) MAIN: Act .energy (005 061) MAI N: A ct. en ergy (009 090)
ou tp. prim outp.pri m MA IN: No.overfl .act.en.out
(008 066) MAIN: Act .energy (005 062) MAI N: A ct.en ergy (009 091)
in p. p rim inp. prim MA IN: No.overfl. act.e n.inp
(008 067) M AIN: React .en. (005 063) MA IN: React.e n. (009 092) MAI N: No.ov/
outp. prim out p. prim fl .re ac.en.ou t
(008 068) MAIN: R eact . en. (005 064) MA IN: React. en . (009 093) MA IN: No.ov/
inp. prim inp. prim f l.reac.en .in p
5%
2%
45° 70°
Phase Angle
S8Z0401B
Fig. 3-67: Error of measurement in the determination of energy output resulting from the phase angle error of the
P139.
Error of measurement:
● Approx. ±2% of the measured value for |cos φ| ≥ 0.7
● Approx. ±5% of the measured value for |cos φ| ≥ 0.3
● where the whole measuring range is −180° ≤ φ ≤ 180°.
For phase angles φ with |cos φ| < 0.3, or when the error of measurement
resulting from the maximum phase-angle error is not acceptable, external
counters should be used to determine the energy output.
MAIN:
Device on-line
[ 003 030 ]
0 0: No (= off)
1 MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
0: No (= off)
1: Yes (= on)
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ 152 xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
MAIN:
Enable protect. EXT
[ 003 027 ]
MAIN:
Prot. ext. disabled
MAIN: [ 038 046 ]
Disable protect. EXT
[ 003 026 ]
D5Z5004A
If the protection is disabled via a binary signal input that is configured for
M A I N : D i s a b l e p r o t e c t . E X T, the signal M A I N : B l o c k e d / f a u l t y is not issued.
MAIN:
Syst.IN enabled USER
[ 018 008 ]
0
MAIN:
1 System IN enabled
[ 040 133 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
System IN disabled
[ 040 134 ]
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
MAIN:
Syst.IN ext/user en.
[ 040 132 ]
MAIN:
System IN enable EXT
[ 040 130 ]
MAIN:
Enable syst. IN USER
[ 003 142 ]
1
0: don't execute
1: execute
MAIN:
Syst. IN disable EXT
[ 040 131 ]
MAIN:
Disable syst.IN USER
[ 003 141 ]
1
0: don't execute
1: execute
19Z5005A
Fig. 3-69: Disabling or enabling the residual current systems of the DTOC/IDMT protection.
MAIN:
Hld time dyn.par.PSx
[ * ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Switch dyn.param.EXT 1 Dynam. param. active
[ 036 033 ] [ 040 090 ]
t1 = 0 s &
Parameter MAIN:
Hld time dyn.par.PSx
set 1 018 009
set 2 001 211
set 3 001 212
set 4 001 213
12Z6205A
>0.05·Inom
I̲A MAIN:
Current flow A
[ 010 223 ]
MAIN:
I̲B Current flow B
[ 010 224 ]
MAIN:
I̲C Current flow C
[ 010 225 ]
19Z8039A
MAIN: MAIN:
I>lift rush restrPSx t lift rush rstr.PSx
MAIN: & C
Protection active [ * ] [ * ]
306 001
MAIN:
Rush restr. A trig.
& 1 t & [ 041 027 ]
I̲A
MAIN:
Rush restr. B trig.
& &
1 t [ 041 028 ]
I̲B
MAIN:
Rush restr. C trig.
& 1 &
t [ 041 029 ]
I̲C
>0.1 Inom
&
MAIN:
Op. rush restr. PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Inrush stabil. trigg
0 306 014
0: Without MAIN:
Rush I(2fn)/I(fn)PSx Parameter MAIN: MAIN:
1: Not phase-selective [ * ] Op. rush restr. PSx I>lift rush restrPSx
2: Phase-selective
set 1 017 097 017 095
fnom set 2 001 088 001 085
I(2⋅fn)/I(fn)
set 3 001 089 001 086
2*fnom
set 4 001 090 001 087
fnom
Parameter MAIN: MAIN:
2*fnom I(2⋅fn)/I(fn) Rush I(2fn)/I(fn)PSx t lift rush rstr.PSx
12Z7306A
MAIN:
Funct.Rush restr.PSx
[*]
m out of n
DTOC: 3 DTOC:
Starting I> Block.Start. I> Px
040 036 450 137
DTOC: 3
Starting I>> DTOC:
Block.Start. I>> Px
040 029
450 141
DTOC: 3
Starting I>>> DTOC:
Block.Start. I>>> Px
039 075
450 145
DTOC: 3
Starting I>>>> DTOC:
MAIN: Block.Start. I>>>> Px
Inrush stabil. trigg 016 174
460 554
306 014 DTOC:
Starting IN> DTOC:
040 077
Block. Start. IN>
MAIN: 450 149
Rush restr. A trig. DTOC:
Starting IN>> DTOC:
[ 041 027 ] Block. Start. IN>>
040 041
450 150
DTOC: DTOC:
Starting IN>>> Block. Start. IN>>>
MAIN: 039 078 450 151
Rush restr. B trig.
[ 041 028 ] DTOC:
Starting IN>>>> DTOC:
Block. Start. IN>>>>
035 031 450 152
DTOC: DTOC:
Starting Ineg> Block.Start. Ineg>
MAIN:
Rush restr. C trig. 036 145 450 153
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>>> DTOC:
036 147 Block.Start. Ineg>>>
450 155
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>>>> DTOC:
016 195
Block.Start. Ineg>>>>
460 555
IDMT1: 3
Starting Iref,P> IDMT:
Bl.Start.Iref,P> Px
040 080 450 156
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,N> IDMT:
040 081 Bl.Start.Iref,N>
450 160
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,neg> IDMT:
040 107
Bl.Start.Iref,neg>
450 161
IDMT2: 3
Starting Iref,P> IDMT2:
Bl.Start.Iref,P> Px
040 018 450 162
IDMT2: IDMT2:
Starting Iref,N> Bl.Start.Iref,N>
040 019 450 166
IDMT2: IDMT2:
Starting Iref,neg> Bl.Start.Iref,neg>
040 156 450 167
QV: QV:
Starting V< 3p Bl.Start. QV
014 074 460 556
Parameter MAIN:
Funct.Rush restr.PSx
Fig. 3-73: Selection of the stabilization criteria for the inrush stabilization.
MAIN: &
Protection active MAIN:
Selection meas. volt
f<>: [ 018 202 ]
Ready ≥1
[ 042 101 ]
c
Pf<:
Ready
[ 016 053 ]
V̲A-G fnom
VA-G √3 1
V̲B-G fnom
VA-G √3 2
V̲C-G fnom
VA-G √3 3
+ fnom
∑ 4
−
+ fnom
∑ 5
−
+ fnom
∑ 6
−
1⋯6 f<>:
V̲Meas
1: Voltage A-G
2: Voltage B-G
3: Voltage C-G
4: Voltage A-B
5: Voltage B-C
6: Voltage C-A
◄
MAIN:
Undervolt. block. V<
[ 018 200 ]
f<>:
Blocked by V<
[ 042 102 ]
Pf<:
Blocked by V<
MAIN: [ 016 056 ]
Evaluation time
[ 018 201 ]
f Φ
f<>:
No. periods reached
f<>:
fMeas
49Z8950A
Fig. 3-74: Measurement of frequency: measuring voltage, evaluation time, undervoltage blocking.
instantaneously if the measuring voltage falls below the set threshold of the
undervoltage stage.
In order to avoid frequency stage starting caused by brief frequency fluctuations
or interference, the evaluation time can be set by the user. The operate
conditions must be satisfied for at least the duration of the set evaluation time in
order for a signal to be issued.
MAIN:
Inp.asg. fct.block.1
[ 221 014 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2 MAIN:
Op. delay fct. block
Signal 3 [ 221 029 ]
Signal n
t 0 MAIN:
Selected signal Fct. block. 1 active
[ 221 015 ]
t 0 MAIN:
MAIN: Fct. block. 2 active
Inp.asg. fct.block.2 [ 221 023 ]
[ 221 022 ]
Selected signal
F0Z5016B
MAIN:
Fct.assign. block. 1
[ 021 021 ]
Function 1
m out of n
Function 2
Function n
MAIN:
Blocking 1 EXT
[ 040 060 ]
MAIN:
Fct.assign. block. 2
[ 021 022 ]
Function 1
m out of n
Function 2
Function n
MAIN:
Blocking 2 EXT
[ 040 061 ]
D5Z50CLA
3.12.11 Blocked/Faulty
MAIN:
Device on-line
[ 003 030 ]
0: No (= off) MAIN:
Device not ready
[ 004 060 ]
MAIN:
SFMON: Blocked/faulty
Blocking [ 004 065 ]
304 951
MAIN:
Trip cmd. blocked
[ 021 013 ]
MAIN:
Fct. assign. fault
[ 021 031 ]
Signal 1
m out of n
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signals
D5Z50EHA
functions can be selected that will issue the MA IN: Block ed/fault y signal by
setting a “m out of n” parameter.
3.12.12 Coupling between Control and Protection for the CB Closed Signal
Bay type selection defines the external device (DEV01 or DEV02 or ...) that
represents the circuit breaker. Coupling between control and protection for the
“Closed” position signal is made by the setting MA IN: Sig. asg. C B closed. As
a result, the CB status signal needs to be assigned to one binary signal input only
if this coupling is implemented.
MAIN:
Sig. asg. CB closed
[ 021 020 ]
DEV01:
Closed signal EXT
[ 210 031 ]
DEV02:
Closed signal EXT
[ 210 081 ]
DEV10:
Closed signal EXT
[ 211 231 ] Selected signal
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
19Z9301A
Fig. 3-78: Coupling between control and protection for the CB closed signal.
& MAIN:
CB open 3p
MAIN: &
CB open 3p EXT [ 031 040 ]
[ 031 028 ]
&
&
MAIN:
[ 031 028 ] & CB open >=1p
&
configured [ 031 039 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
CB closed 3p EXT & & CB closed 3p
[ 036 051 ] [ 031 042 ]
&
&
MAIN:
CB closed A EXT MAIN:
& & CB closed A
[ 031 029 ]
[ 031 035 ]
MAIN:
& & CB open A
[ 031 032 ]
[ 031 029 ]
configured
MAIN: MAIN:
CB closed B EXT & & CB closed B
[ 031 030 ] [ 031 036 ]
MAIN:
& & CB open B
[ 031 033 ]
[ 031 030 ]
configured
MAIN: MAIN:
CB closed C EXT & & CB closed C
[ 031 031 ] [ 031 037 ]
MAIN:
& & CB open C
[ 031 034 ]
[ 031 031 ]
configured
10 100 ms
5 0 t
MAIN:
CB pos.sig. implaus.
[ 031 041 ]
>0.05 Inom
Plausibility
check
I̲A
I̲B
I̲C
45Z1101B
MAIN:
Gen. trip signal 1
[ 036 005 ]
MAIN:
Parallel trip EXT
[ 037 019 ]
MAIN:
CB closed 3p EXT
[ 036 051 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Man.cl.cmd.enablUSER Rel.t. enab. man.cmd
[ 003 105 ] [ 003 088 ]
0
MAIN:
1 t Man. cl. cmd.enabl.
1 [ 039 113 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Man. close cmd. USER
[ 018 033 ]
0 &
0: don't execute
1: execute MAIN:
Man. close command
500ms [ 037 068 ]
MAIN:
MAIN: & Man. close cmd. EXT
Man.cl.cmd.enabl.EXT [ 041 022 ]
[ 041 023 ]
MAIN:
Man. close cmd. EXT
[ 041 022 ]
MAIN:
C Close cmd.pulse time
ARC: &
(Re)close request [ 015 067 ]
[ 037 077 ] MAIN:
ASC: & Close command
Close enable 1 [ 037 009 ]
[ 037 083 ] t
ASC:
Enabled
[ 018 024 ] &
&
ASC:
Manual close request
305 000 &
MAIN:
Reset c. cl/tr.cUSER
[ 003 007 ]
0 MAIN:
+ No. close commands
[ 009 055 ]
1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Rst.c.cl./tripc. EXT
[ 005 210 ]
19Z80CKB
The circuit breaker can be closed by the auto-reclosing control function (ARC), by
the automatic synchronism check (ASC), by parameters or via an appropriately
configured binary signal input. The close command by parameters or a binary
signal input is only executed if there is no trip command 1 present and no trip
has been issued by a protection device operating in parallel. Moreover, the close
command is not executed if there is a “CB closed” position signal present. The
duration of the close command can be set.
If the ARC function issues a close request while the ASC function is enabled, then
the close command requires a close enable by the ASC function.
MAIN:
Inp.asg. mult.sig. 1
[ 221 051 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
MAIN:
Mult. sig. 1 stored
MAIN: S 11
[ 221 054 ]
Inp.asg. mult.sig. 2
[ 221 052 ] R1
COMM1:
Reset mult. sig. 1 MAIN:
[ --- --- ] Mult. sig. 2 stored
S 11 [ 221 055 ]
COMM1:
Reset mult. sig. 2 R1
[ --- --- ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OUTP:
Reset latching
402 102
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
12Z62FMA
The multiple signals 1 and 2 are formed by the programmable logic function
using OR operators. The programmable logic output to be interpreted as multiple
signaling is defined by the configuration of the binary signal input assignment
with the corresponding multiple signaling. Both an updated and a stored signal
are generated. The stored signal is reset by the following actions:
● General reset
● Latching reset
● LED indicators reset
● A command received through the communication interface
If the multiple signaling is still present at the time of a reset, the stored signal
will follow the updated signal.
Additionally 8 user configurable group signals are available (MA IN : Group
signal 01 to MAI N : Grou p s ignal 08). For each of these signals the user can
select up to 32 internal signals and freely combine them using Boolean operators
NOT, AND, OR (settings MA IN: Fct.as g. grp. si g. 01 to MAI N: Fct .asg.
g rp.sig. 08), as described for configuration of LOGIC outputs (see Fig. 3-323,
(p. 3-403)).
These state signals are continuously updated. They provide no latching and no
settable pick up/ release delay timers. If such timed signaling is required, the
function groups LOGIC or LOG_2 shall be used.
MAIN:
Ground fault
[ 041 087 ]
V̲A-G
V̲B-G V̲min
V̲C-G
MAIN:
V̲min=V̲A-G Ground fault A
[ 041 054 ]
V̲min=V̲B-G
V̲min=V̲C-G
MAIN:
Ground fault B
[ 041 055 ]
MAIN:
Ground fault C
[ 041 056 ]
S8Z5081A
GFDSS: MAIN:
Grd. fault pow./adm. Ground fault
[ 009 037 ] [ 041 087 ]
GFDSS:
Ground fault (curr.)
[ 009 038 ]
TGFD:
Ground fault
[ 004 033 ]
GFDSS: MAIN:
Direct. forward/LS Gnd. fault forw./LS
[ 009 035 ] [ 041 088 ]
TGFD:
Forward / LS
[ 004 031 ]
GFDSS: MAIN:
Direct. backward/BS Gnd. fault backw./BS
[ 009 036 ]
[ 041 089 ]
TGFD:
Backward / BS
[ 004 032 ]
S8Z0182A
MAIN: MAIN:
Gen. trip signal 1 & Block start. signal
[ 036 005 ]
306 512
MAIN:
Gen. trip signal 2
[ 036 023 ]
MP:
Startup
[ 040 119 ]
MAIN:
Suppr.start.sig. PSx
[ * ]
0 t
DTOC: MAIN:
Starting A & Starting A
305 458
[ 040 005 ]
IDMT:
Starting A
304 359
DTOC: MAIN:
Starting B & Starting B
305 459 [ 040 006 ]
IDMT:
Starting B
304 360
DTOC:
Starting C MAIN:
305 460 & Starting C
IDMT: [ 040 007 ]
Starting C
304 361
DTOC: MAIN:
Starting N & Starting GF
305 461 [ 040 008 ]
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,N>
[ 040 081 ]
MAIN:
IDMT1: & Starting Ineg
Starting Iref,neg>
[ 040 107 ] [ 040 105 ]
DTOC: MAIN:
Starting Ineg> Starting A int.
[ 036 145 ] 306 513
DTOC: MAIN:
Starting Ineg>> Starting B int.
[ 036 146 ] 306 514
DTOC: MAIN:
Starting Ineg>>> Starting C int.
[ 036 147 ] 306 515
MAIN:
Starting G int.
MAIN: 306 516
Bl.tim.st.IN,neg PSx MAIN:
[ * ] Starting Ineg int.
306 517
0
& MAIN:
1 Bl. timer st. IN,neg
306 400
&
2
0: Without
Fig. 3-84: Phase-selective starting signals. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however, also applies to IDMT2 with
different numerical addresses.)
MAIN:
Gen. start. mode PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
0 Gen. start. mode PSx
[ * ]
1 1: With start. IN, Ineg
MAIN: MAIN:
General reset EXT + No. general start.
[ 005 255 ] [ 004 000 ]
R
DTOC:
Starting I>
[ 040 036 ]
IDMT1: MAIN:
Starting Iref,P> & General starting
[ 040 080 ] [ 040 000 ]
DTOC:
Starting I>> MAIN:
[ 040 029 ] General start. int.
306 539
DTOC:
Starting I>>>
[ 039 075 ]
IDMT1: &
Starting Iref,N>
[ 040 081 ]
DTOC: &
Starting IN>
[ 040 077 ]
DTOC:
Starting IN>> MAIN:
[ 040 041 ] tGS PSx
DTOC: [ * ]
Starting IN>>>
[ 039 078 ]
DTOC:
Starting IN>>>>
[ 035 031 ] MAIN:
tGS elapsed
[ 040 009 ]
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,neg>
[ 040 107 ]
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>
[ 036 145 ]
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>>
[ 036 146 ]
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>>>
[ 036 147 ]
MAIN:
Block start. signal
* Parameter MAIN: MAIN:
306 512 Gen. start. mode PSx tGS PSx
set 1 017 027 017 005
set 2 001 219 001 225
set 3 001 220 001 226
set 4 001 221 001 227
12Z6201A
Fig. 3-85: General starting. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however, also applies to IDMT2 with different numerical
addresses.)
DTOC: MAIN:
tI> elapsed ≥1 Timer stage P elaps.
[ 040 010 ] [ 040 031 ]
DTOC:
tI>> elapsed
[ 040 033 ]
DTOC:
tI>>> elapsed
[ 040 012 ]
IDMT1:
tIref,P> elapsed
[ 040 082 ]
DTOC: MAIN:
tIneg> elapsed Timer st. Ineg elaps
≥1 [ 040 050 ]
[ 036 148 ]
DTOC:
tIneg>> elapsed
[ 036 149 ]
DTOC:
tIneg>>> elapsed
[ 036 150 ]
IDMT1:
tIref,neg> elapsed
[ 040 109 ]
DTOC: MAIN:
tIN> elapsed ≥1 Timer stage N elaps.
[ 040 013 ] [ 040 032 ]
DTOC:
tIN>> elapsed
[ 040 121 ]
DTOC:
tIN>>> elapsed
[ 039 079 ]
DTOC:
tIN>>>> elapsed
[ 035 040 ]
IDMT1:
tIref,N> elapsed
[ 040 083 ]
DTOC: MAIN:
Trip signal tI> ≥1 TripSig. tI>/tIrefP>
[ 041 020 ] [ 040 042 ]
IDMT1:
Trip signal tIref,P>
[ 040 084 ]
DTOC: MAIN:
Trip signal tIneg> ≥1 TrSg.tIneg>/Iref,neg
[ 036 151 ] [ 040 051 ]
IDMT1:
Trip sig. tIref,neg>
[ 040 108 ]
DTOC: MAIN:
Trip signal tIN> ≥1 TripSig tIN>/tIrefN>
[ 041 021 ] [ 040 043 ]
IDMT1:
Trip signal tIref,N>
[ 040 085 ]
12Z5122B
Fig. 3-86: Multiple signaling by the DTOC and IDMT protection functions. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however,
also applies to IDMT2 with different numerical addresses.)
The trip signals generated by the DTOC and IDMT protection functions are
grouped together to form multiple signaling.
MAIN:
Trip cmd.block. USER
[ 021 012 ]
0
MAIN:
1 Trip cmd. blocked
0: No [ 021 013 ]
1: Yes
MAIN:
Trip cmd. block. EXT
[ 036 045 ] MAIN:
Man. trip cmd. USER
[ 003 040 ]
0
MAIN:
1 Manual trip signal
0: don't execute [ 034 017 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
Man. trip cmd. EXT
[ 037 018 ]
MAIN:
Fct.assig.trip cmd.1
[ 021 001 ]
m out of n
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3 MAIN:
Gen. trip signal
Signal n [ 036 251 ]
MAIN:
Selected signals Gen. trip signal 1
[ 036 005 ]
MAIN: MAIN:
Latching trip cmd. 1 Gen. trip command 1
[ 021 023 ] [ 036 071 ]
MAIN:
Min.dur. trip cmd. 1
0 [ 021 003 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Rset.latch.trip USER
[ 021 005 ]
1 MAIN:
Latch. trip c. reset
0: don't execute [ 040 139 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
Reset latch.trip EXT
[ 040 138 ]
64Z5044A
MAIN: MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1 No. gen.trip cmds. 1
[ 036 071 ] [ 004 006 ]
R
MAIN: MAIN:
Gen. trip command 2 No. gen.trip cmds. 2
[ 036 022 ] [ 009 050 ]
R
MAIN: MAIN:
Gen. trip command 3 No. gen.trip cmds. 3
[ 036 113 ] [ 009 056 ]
R
MAIN: MAIN:
Gen. trip command 4 No. gen.trip cmds. 4
[ 036 114 ] [ 009 057 ]
MAIN:
Reset c. cl/tr.cUSER
[ 003 007 ]
1
0: don't execute
MAIN: 1: execute
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
Q6Z0145A
MAIN:
Inp.assign. tripping
[ 221 010 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signal
MAIN:
Prot.trip>CB tripped
MAIN: [ 221 012 ]
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
0
1
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 2 2
[ 036 022 ]
3
0 3
0: Without function
1: Gen. trip command 1
2: Gen. trip command 2
3: Gen.trip command 1/2
MAIN:
Oper. mode CB Trip
[ 221 080 ]
1 2
1: ALSTOM D
2: W/o command
MAIN:
Inp. asg. CB trip
[ 221 013 ]
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
DEV10:
Switch. device open
[ 211 236 ] MAIN:
CB trip internal
Selected signal [ 221 006 ]
MAIN:
Inp.asg.CB tr.en.ext
[ 221 050 ]
MAIN:
CB tripped
[ 221 016 ]
Selected signal
MAIN:
Inp.asg. CB trip ext
[ 221 024 ]
Selected signal
ARC:
Sig.interr. CB trip
[ 036 040 ]
19Z8169A
The signal “CB tripped” depends on the mode of operation and is based on
different events:
Mode of operation: “ALSTOM D” (MAI N: Oper. mode C B Tr ip, 221 080):
In this mode of operation, in addition the MA IN: C B trip internal (221 006)
signal is formed.
The signal MA IN: CB tr ip i nte rnal is issued if the following conditions are met
simultaneously:
● The binary signal input configured for “tripping” is set to a logic value of
“1” or the selected trip command from the P139 is present.
● At the binary signal input configured as “CB trip” a logic value of “1” is
present.
Mode of operation: “W/o command” (MA IN: Ope r. mode CB Trip, 221 080):
The MAIN : CB t rip pe d signal will only be issued, if the circuit breaker is
tripping without any command issued by the P139. Commands via
communication interfaces, local control panel or binary inputs are treated in the
same manner. This mode of operation disables the MAIN: CB trip inte rnal
signal.
The CB trip signal of an external device can also be signaled. For this task, one
input needs to be configured for “MAIN: Inp. asg.C B t r.en.e xt“, a further
input for “MAIN : In p.asg. CB tri p ext“.
COMM1: MAIN:
Communication error ≥1 Communication error
[ 221 019 ]
304 422
DVICE:
Module A not fitted
307 140
19Z5070A
MAIN:
Date
[ 003 090 ]
MAIN:
Time of day
[ 003 091 ]
MAIN:
Time switching
[ 003 095 ]
MAIN:
Min-pulse clock EXT
[ 060 060 ]
MAIN:
Time tag
306 021
MAIN:
Time switching
Q6Z0152B
Fig. 3-91: Date/time setting and clock synchronization with minute pulses presented at a binary signal input.
Switching from standard to daylight saving time or back requires correct time
setting frames from the time synchronization master (according the applied
communication protocol).
The data stored in the operating data memory, the monitoring signal memory
and the event memories are date- and time-tagged. For correct tagging, the date
and time need to be set in the P139.
The time of different devices may be synchronized by a pulse given to an
appropriately configured binary signal input. The P139 evaluates the rising edge.
This will set the clock to the nearest full minute, rounding either up or down. If
several start/end signals occur (bouncing of a relay contact), only the last edge is
evaluated.
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1 1: execute
0: don't execute
1: execute
MAIN:
Reset indicat. USER
[ 021 010 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute MAIN:
≥1 Reset LED
306 020
MAIN:
Reset indicat. EXT
[ 065 001 ]
12Z6115A
Fig. 3-92: General reset, LED reset and measured event data reset from the local control panel.
LOC: OP_RC:
Reset key active & ≥1 Reset record. EXT
310 024 [ 005 213 ]
LOC:
Fct. reset key
[ 005 251 ]
m out of n
OP_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[005 213]
MAIN: MAIN:
Group reset 1 USER Group reset 2 USER
[ * ] [ * ]
0 0
1 ≥1 & 1 ≥1 &
0: don't execute 0: don't execute
m out of n m out of n
OP_RC: OP_RC:
Reset record. EXT Reset record. EXT
[005 213] [005 213]
12Z61RMB
Fig. 3-93: “CLEAR” key on the local control panel and, as an example, group resetting of the operating data
recording (e.g. as an example for the reset signal O P _ R C : R e s e t r e c o r d . E X T.
A complete list of all resetting parameters that can be used in the way shown in
Fig. 3-93, (p. 3-134) can be obtained from the separately available
DataModelExplorer: Look up the setting parameter MAIN: F ct .assign. re set 1
in the file P139‑661_en_Addresses.pdf, and there follow the link to the referenced
config. table.
MAIN:
Chann.assign.COMM1/2
[ 003 169 ]
1: COMM1->chann.1,(2-2)
2: COMM1->chann.2,(2-1)
"Logical"
Communic. interface
COMM1
Comm. interface
Channel 1
"Logical"
Communic. interface
COMM2
Comm. interface
Channel 2
45Z5171A
MAIN:
Test mode USER
[ 003 012 ]
0
MAIN:
1 ≥1 Test mode
[ 037 071 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Test mode EXT
[ 037 070 ]
D5Z50EBB
If tests are run on the P139, the user is advised to activate the test mode so that
all incoming signals via the serial interfaces will be identified accordingly.
PSS:
Control via USER
[ 003 100 ]
0: No
1: Yes PSS:
Control via user
PSS: [ 036 102 ]
Control via user EXT
[ 036 101 ] PSS:
Param.subs.sel. USER
INP: [ 003 060 ]
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ 152 xxx ]
1
2
U x1
3
U x2
4
U x3
1: Parameter subset 1
U xx
2: Parameter subset 2
Address 065 002
PSS:
1 4 Actual param. subset
[ 003 062 ]
PSS:
PS 1 active
[ 036 090 ]
PSS:
Activate PS 1 EXT PSS:
[ 065 002 ] PS 2 active
[ 036 091 ]
PSS: PSS:
Activate PS 2 EXT PS 3 active
[ 065 003 ] [ 036 092 ]
PSS: PSS:
Activate PS 3 EXT PS 4 active
[ 065 004 ] [ 036 093 ]
PSS:
Activate PS 4 EXT
[ 065 005 ]
1 4
PSS:
Keep time
[ 003 063 ]
1
PSS:
0 4 Ext.sel.param.subset
[ 003 061 ]
PSS:
PS 1 activated ext.
[ 036 094 ]
PSS:
PS 2 activated ext.
[ 036 095 ]
PSS:
PS 3 activated ext.
[ 036 096 ]
PSS:
PS 4 activated ext.
[ 036 097 ]
D5Z5002A
3.14.3 Signals
SFMON:
Fct. assign. warning
[ 021 030 ]
Signal 1
m out of n
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
SFMON:
Selected monit. sig. ≥1 Warning (LED)
[ 036 070 ]
SFMON:
SFMON: Warning (relay)
Hardware fault [ 036 100 ]
304 950
Q6Z0154B
The monitoring signals are also signaled via the output relay configured
SF MO N : Wa rning ( re lay). The output relay operates as long as an internal
fault is detected.
OP_RC:
Operat. data record.
[ 003 024 ]
Operating memory
MAIN:
Oper.-relev. signal
306 024
MAIN: OP_RC:
General reset USER No. oper. data sig.
[ 003 002 ] +
[ 100 002 ]
1: execute R
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OP_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 213 ]
OP_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 001 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
12Z61CMA
Fig. 3-98: Operating data recording and counter for signals relevant to system operation.
MT_RC:
Mon. signal record.
[ 003 001 ]
MAIN:
Time tag
306 021
SFMON:
Hardware fault
304 950
MT_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 003 008 ]
CT30 SFMON:
≥1 Overflow MT_RC
[ 090 012 ]
0
MT_RC:
1 ≥1 No. monit. signals
[ 004 019 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
MT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 240 ]
12Z6155A
Fig. 3-99: Monitoring signal recording and the monitoring signal counter.
OL_RC: OL_DA:
Record. in progress + Overload duration
[ 035 003 ] [ 004 102 ]
R
MAIN: ≥1
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 241 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 003 ]
1: execute
50Z0137A
OL_DA:
MP: T.taken f.startup,MP
Startup
[ 040 119 ] [ 005 096 ]
OL_DA:
Start-up current, MP
[ 005 098 ]
MP:
IP,max r.m.s./Iref
304 740
OL_DA:
Heat.dur.start-up,MP
[ 005 097 ]
19Z5280A
OL_RC:
Record. in progress C
[ 035 003 ]
THERM: OL_DA:
Status THERM replica Status THERM replica
[ 004 016 ] [ 004 147 ]
R
THERM: OL_DA:
I Load current THERM
305 202 [ 004 058 ]
R
THERM: OL_DA:
Object temperature Object temp. THERM
[ 004 137 ] [ 004 035 ]
R
THERM: OL_DA:
Coolant temperature Coolant temp. THERM
[ 004 149 ] [ 004 036 ]
R
THERM: OL_DA:
Pre-trip time left Pre-trip t.leftTHERM
[ 004 139 ] [ 004 148 ]
R
THERM: OL_DA:
Temp. offset replica Offset THERM replica
[ 004 109 ] [ 004 154 ]
R
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 241 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 003 ]
1: execute
12Z6238A
Fig. 3-102: Measured overload values from the thermal overload protection.
OL_RC:
Record. in progress
[ 035 003 ]
THERM:
Starting k*Iref>
[ 041 108 ] +
MP: R
Starting k*Iref> OL_RC:
No. overload
[ 041 057]
[ 004 101 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 241 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 003 ]
1: execute
19Z88C3A
OL_RC: C
Record. in progress
[ 035 003 ]
Signal 3 1
Signal n 1 OL_RC:
Overload recording 1
[ * ]
OL_RC:
n Overload recording 1
Measured value 1
1 033 020
Measured value 2
2 033 021
Measured value 3
3 033 022
Measured value N
4 033 023
MAIN:
Time tag
306 021 5 033 024
MAIN:
1 ≥1
General reset USER 0: don't execute
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
OL_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 241 ]
12Z6117A
GF_RC: GF_DA:
Record. in progress + Ground flt. duration
[ 035 005 ] [ 009 100 ]
R
MAIN: ≥1
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
GF_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 242 ]
GF_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 000 ]
1: execute
50Z01DWA
S1 1 & C
R1
GF_DA:
GFDSS: GF duration pow.meas
VNG> triggered & +
[ 009 024 ]
304 151
R
GFDSS:
GF (pow.) ready
[ 038 026 ] ≥1 R
GFDSS:
Grd. fault pow./adm.
[ 009 037 ] ≥1
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0144A
Fig. 3-106: Measurement and storage of the ground fault duration from steady state power evaluation.
GFDSS: C
Grd. fault pow./adm.
[ 009 037 ]
GF_DA:
I̲N Current IN p.u.
[ 009 021 ]
R
GFDSS:
Direct. forward/LS C
[ 009 035 ]
≥1
GFDSS:
Direct. backward/BS
[ 009 036 ]
GFDSS: GF_DA:
Current IN,act p.u. Curr. IN,act p.u.
[ 004 045 ] [ 009 022 ]
& ≥1 R
GFDSS: GF_DA:
Curr. IN,reac p.u. Curr. IN,reac p.u.
[ 009 023 ]
R
GF_DA:
GFDSS: Voltage VNG p.u.
V̲NG [ 009 020 ]
304 150
R
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0145A
Fig. 3-107: Residual current and neutral-point displacement voltage from steady state value evaluation.
S1 1 & C
R1
GFDSS: GF_DA:
+ GF durat. curr.meas.
IN> triggered
304 158 [ 009 026 ]
R
R
≥1
GFDSS:
Op. delay IN elapsed
304 157
≥1
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0148A
Fig. 3-108: Measurement and storing the ground fault duration as determined by steady state current evaluation.
GFDSS:
Op. delay IN elapsed C
304 157
GF_DA:
I̲N Current IN p.u.
[ 009 021 ]
R
GF_DA:
GFDSS: Curr. IN filt. p.u.
I̲N filtered [ 009 025 ]
304 159
R
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0151A
S1 1 & C
R1
GFDSS: GF_DA:
VNG> triggered + GF duration admitt.
& [ 009 068 ]
304 151
GFDSS: R
Admittance ready
[ 038 167 ] R
≥1
GFDSS:
Grd. fault pow./adm.
[ 009 037 ] ≥1
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0152A
Fig. 3-110: Measurement and storing the ground fault duration from admittance evaluation.
GFDSS:
Grd. fault pow./adm. C
[ 009 037 ]
I̲N GF_DA:
Current IN p.u.
[ 009 021 ]
R
GFDSS:
Op.del.Y(N)> elapsed C
304 175
GFDSS: GF_DA:
Admitt. Y(N) p.u. Admittance Y(N) p.u.
[ 004 191 ] [ 009 065 ]
R
GFDSS:
Direct. forward/LS C
[ 009 035 ] ≥1
GFDSS:
Direct. backward/BS
[ 009 036 ]
GFDSS:
Conduct. G(N) p.u. GF_DA:
Conduct. G(N) p.u.
[ 004 192 ]
[ 009 066 ]
& ≥1 R
GFDSS:
Suscept. B(N) p.u. GF_DA:
[ 004 193 ] Suscept. B(N) p.u.
[ 009 067 ]
R
GF_DA:
GFDSS: Voltage VNG p.u.
V̲NG
304 150
[ 009 020 ]
R
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z0153A
MAIN:
Ground fault GF_RC:
≥1 Record. in progress
[ 041 087 ] [ 035 005 ]
MAIN:
Gnd. fault forw./LS
[ 041 088 ]
MAIN:
Gnd. fault backw./BS
[ 041 089 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER GF_RC:
+ No. ground faults
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute [ 004 100 ]
≥1 R
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
GF_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 100 000 ]
1: execute
GF_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 242 ]
50Z01B8A
GF_RC: C
Record. in progress
[ 035 005 ]
Signal 3 1
Signal n GF_RC:
1 Ground flt.record. n
[ * ]
GF_RC:
n Ground flt.record. n
Measured value 1
1 033 010
Measured value 2
2 033 011
Measured value 3
3 033 012
Measured value N
1 ≥1
MAIN: 0: don't execute
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ] 1: execute
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
GF_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 242 ]
12Z6141A
FT_DA:
MAIN: Running time
General start. int. +
306 539 [ 004 021 ]
R
≥1
FT_RC: FT_DA:
Record. in progress + Fault duration
[ 035 000 ] [ 008 010 ]
R
MAIN: ≥1
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
50Z01A9A
FT_DA:
Start data acqu. PSx
[ * ]
1: End of fault
2: Trigger/Trip/End
FT_DA:
MAIN: Output meas. values
General start. int. 305 075
306 539
FT_DA:
Outp. flt.locat. PSx
FT_DA: [ * ]
Trigger EXT
[ 036 088 ]
1
MAIN: 2
Gen. trip signal 1
[ 060 005 ] 1: On general starting
2: On gen.start.w.trip
MAIN:
Gen. trip signal 2
FT_DA:
[ 060 023 ] Output fault locat.
305 076
Fig. 3-115: Enabling of measured fault data acquisition and fault location output.
A IA-kG / VA-G
B IB-kG / VB-G
C IC-kG / VC-G
FT_DA:
Abs. value kG PSx
[ * ]
FT_DA:
Angle kG PSx
[ * ]
I̲A
k̲G·I̲N FT_DA:
I̲B
I̲N·k̲G
I̲C 307 125
FT_DA:
I̲A-I̲N·k̲G
307 126
FT_DA:
I̲B-I̲N·k̲G
307 127
FT_DA:
I̲C-I̲N·k̲G
307 128
19Z5009A
MAIN:
Starting A int.
306 513
MAIN:
Starting B int.
306 514
MAIN:
Starting C int.
306 515
MAIN:
Starting G int.
306 516
FT_DA:
I̲A-I̲N·k̲G
307 126
FT_DA:
I̲B-I̲N·k̲G
307 127
FT_DA:
I̲C-I̲N·k̲G
307 128
I̲A
I̲B
I̲C
V̲A-G
V̲B-G
V̲C-G
MAIN:
Vmeas
306 544
MAIN:
Imeas
306 545
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop A-G
306 546
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop B-G
306 547
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop C-G
306 548
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop A-B
306 549
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop B-C
306 550
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop C-A
306 551
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop PG
306 552
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop PP
306 553
FT_DA:
Fault type
[ 010 198 ]
19Z8071A
The fault must be present for at least 60 ms so that fault measured variables
(short-circuit data) may be determined.
To determine short-circuit data the selected measured variables Imeas and Vmeas
are applied when the fault was identified by the fault data acquisition function.
One phase current is selected as the fault current corresponding to the
measuring loop selected. In the case of multi-phase starting, this is the current of
the leading phase in the cycle. The primary fault reactance is calculated from the
per-unit fault reactance using the nominal data for the set primary current and
voltage transformers.
The ground fault data are only determined if a phase-to-ground loop has been
selected for the measurement by the fault data acquisition function. The
geometric sum of the three phase currents is displayed as the ground fault
current. The ground fault angle is the phase displacement between ground fault
current and the selected measuring voltage.
FT_DA: C 1,2
Output meas. values
305 075
MAIN:
Inom C.T. prim.
[ 010 001 ]
MAIN:
Vnom V.T. prim.
[ 010 002 ]
MAIN: C2
Sel. meas. loop PG
306 552
60 ms 0
MAIN: C1
General start. int. ≥1
306 539
MAIN:
M.c.b. trip V EXT
≥1
[ 004 061 ] C 1,3,4
1 FT_DA:
MAIN: Fault current P p.u.
V.T. not fitted C2 [ 004 025 ]
306 554 R
MAIN: FT_DA:
Imeas 1 1 Fault current P prim
306 545
COMP [ 010 199 ]
R
2
I̲max 1 FT_DA:
Flt.volt. PG/PP p.u.
3 [ 004 026 ]
R
4 FT_DA:
1 Flt.volt. PG/PP prim
[ 010 217 ]
R
2 ... 3
MAIN: C1
Sel. meas. loop A-G 1
306 546
1 FT_DA:
Fault loop angle P
4 [ 004 024 ]
MAIN: C2 R
Sel. meas. loop B-G
306 547
MAIN: FT_DA:
C3 1 Fault impedance, sec
Sel. meas. loop C-G
306 548 [ 004 023 ]
R
MAIN:
Sel. meas. loop A-B C1
306 549
1 FT_DA:
Fault reactance,sec.
MAIN: R [ 004 028 ]
Sel. meas. loop B-C C2
306 550
MAIN: 1 FT_DA:
Sel. meas. loop C-A C3
Fault react., prim.
306 551 [ 004 029 ]
R
I̲A
1
I̲B 2 FT_DA:
2
Fault loop angle N
I̲C [ 004 048 ]
3 R
1 ... 3
2 FT_DA:
Fault curr. N p.u.
[ 004 049 ]
R
V<2V
FT_DA:
2 Fault curr. N prim.
[ 010 216 ]
R
MAIN: C
Vmeas
306 544
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT FT_DA:
[ 005 255 ] Meas. loop selected
[ 004 079 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED
306 020
19Z8055A
FT_DA:
Line length PSx
[ * ]
FT_DA:
Line reactance PSx
[ * ]
FT_DA: C
Output fault locat.
305 076
FT_DA:
FT_DA: Fault location
Fault reactance,sec. [ 004 022 ]
[ 004 028 ] R
MAIN: FT_DA:
General reset USER Fault locat. percent
[ 003 002 ] [ 004 027 ]
1: execute ≥1 R
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED Parameter FT_DA: FT_DA:
306 020 Line length PSx Line reactance PSx
set 1 010 005 010 012
set 2 010 006 010 013
set 3 010 007 010 014
set 4 010 008 010 015
50Z01B4B
FT_RC:
I>
[ 017 065 ]
FT_RC:
I̲A I> triggered
[ 040 063 ]
I̲B
I̲C
FT_RC:
Fct. assig. trigger
[ 003 085 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
m out of n
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signals
FT_RC: FT_RC:
Trigger
Trigger EXT ≥1
[ 036 089 ] [ 037 076 ]
FT_RC:
FT_RC: Record.trig active
Trigger USER [ 002 002 ]
[ 003 041 ]
0 0 1 min FT_RC:
≥1 Record. in progress
1 [ 035 000 ]
0: don't execute
MAIN: 1: execute
General start. int.
306 539
MAIN:
Gen. trip signal 1
[ 036 005 ]
MAIN:
Gen. trip signal 2
[ 036 023 ]
FT_RC:
MAIN: + No. of faults
General reset USER [ 004 020 ]
[ 003 002 ]
≥1 R
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT FT_RC:
[ 005 255 ] + No. system disturb.
[ 004 010 ]
FT_RC:
Reset record. USER R
[ 003 006 ]
1: execute
FT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 243 ]
FT_RC:
& System disturb. runn
≥1 [ 035 004 ]
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
& S1 1
R1
12Z6221A
FT_RC: C
Record. in progress
[ 035 000 ]
FT_RC:
Signal 1 + CT200 Fault mem. overflow
1 ≥1 [ 035 001 ]
Signal 2 1 R
Signal 3 1
Signal n 1 FT_RC:
Fault recording n
[ * ]
1
FT_RC:
Pre-fault time
[ 003 078 ]
FT_RC:
Post-fault time
[ 003 079 ]
FT_RC:
n Fault recording n
Fault memory n
1 003 000
2 033 001
3 033 002
MAIN:
General reset USER &
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute R
≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
FT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 243 ]
FT_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 003 006 ]
1 1: execute
0: don't execute
1: execute
12Z6161B
Protection signals, including the signals during the settable pre-fault and post-
fault times, are logged in chronological order with reference to the specific fault.
A total of eight faults, each involving a maximum of 200 start or end signals, can
be stored in the non-volatile fault memories. After eight faults have been
recorded, the oldest fault recording will be overwritten, unless memories have
been cleared in the interim. If more than 199 start or end signals have occurred
during a single fault, then FT_RC : F au lt mem. overflow will be entered as the
last signal. If the time and date are changed during the pre-fault time, the signal
F T_RC : F aulty t ime tag is generated.
In addition to the fault signals, the measured fault data will also be entered in the
fault memory.
The fault recordings can be read from the local control panel or through the PC or
communication interfaces.
FT_RC:
Record. in progress C
[ 035 000 ]
FT_RC:
Max. recording time
[ 003 075 ]
FT_RC:
Pre-fault time
[ 003 078 ]
FT_RC:
Post-fault time
[ 003 079 ]
f Analog channel 10
R
FT_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 003 006 ]
1: execute
≥1
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
FT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 243 ]
19Z8020A
DTOC:
General enable USER
[ 022 075 ]
0
DTOC:
1 Enabled
[ 040 120 ]
0: No
1: Yes
DTOC:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
Parameter DTOC:
Enable PSx
0
set 1 072 098
1 set 2 073 098
set 3 074 098
0: No set 4 075 098
1: Yes
19Z5089A
3.23.2 Selecting the Measured Variable for the Phase Current Stage
A setting specifies which current will be used by the P139 phase overcurrent
stages: either the measured phase current is used, or a value where the residual
current has been eliminated (I0 elimination).
That is, one of the following currents is used:
● The measured phase current
● The measured phase current shifted by one third of the calculated residual
current ( I̲ max − ⅓⋅Σ I̲ P)
● The measured phase current shifted by one third of the residual current
measured at the fourth transformer (T4), i. e. ( I̲ max − ⅓⋅I̲ N)
I̲A
DTOC:
I̲B I0 Elimin. I> PSx
I̲C
I̲max
+
⅓·ΣI̲P −
DTOC:
I>
310 069
0: without
+ 1: with I0 calculated
I̲N ⅓·I̲N − 2: with I0 measured
DTOC:
I0 Elimin. I>> PSx
DTOC:
I>>
310 070
0: without
1: with I0 calculated
2: with I0 measured
DTOC:
I0 Elimin. I>>> PSx
DTOC:
I>>>
310 071
0: without
1: with I0 calculated
2: with I0 measured
DTOC:
I0 Elimin. I>>>> PSx
DTOC:
I>>>>
460 552
Parameter DTOC: DTOC: DTOC: DTOC: 0: without
I0 Elimin. I> PSx I0 Elimin. I>> PSx I0 Elimin. I>>> PSx I0 Elimin. I>>>> PSx 1: with I0 calculated
set 1 013 150 013 154 013 158 013 162 2: with I0 measured
DTOC: DTOC:
Enabled &
Meas.value I/IN> PSx
[ 040 120 ] [ * ]
MAIN:
Protection active DTOC:
& c I> PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Dynam. param. active
DTOC:
[ 040 090 ] & c I> dynamic PSx
[ * ]
I̲A DTOC:
I> Starting A
I̲B DTOC:
I> Starting B
I̲C DTOC:
I> Starting C
DTOC:
Meas.val. I/IN>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c I>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c I>> dynamic PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
I>> Starting A
DTOC:
I>> Starting B
DTOC:
I>> Starting C
DTOC:
Meas.val.I/IN>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c I>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c I>>> dynamic PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
I>>> Starting A
DTOC:
I>>> Starting B
DTOC:
I>>> Starting C
DTOC:
Meas.v.I/IN>>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c I>>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c I>>>> dynamic PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
I>>>> Starting A
DTOC:
I>>>> Starting B
DTOC:
I>>>> Starting C
set 1 060 002 017 000 017 080 060 006 017 001 017 084
set 2 060 003 073 007 073 032 060 007 073 008 073 033
set 3 060 004 074 007 074 032 060 008 074 008 074 033
set 4 060 005 075 007 075 032 060 009 075 008 075 033
set 1 060 010 017 002 017 085 060 014 016 149 016 153
set 2 060 011 073 009 073 034 060 015 016 150 016 154
set 3 060 012 074 009 074 034 060 016 016 151 016 155
set 4 060 013 075 009 075 034 060 017 016 152 016 156
19Z8802A
DTOC:
I> Starting A
460 515
DTOC:
I> Starting B
460 516
DTOC:
I> Starting C
460 517
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 023 ]
DTOC:
V< (I>) PSx
[ * ]
Blocked
& ≥1 DTOC:
Starting A
fnom ≥1 305 458
& ≥1 DTOC:
fnom Starting B
≥1 305 459
V̲B-G VB-G √3 &
≥1 DTOC:
fnom & Starting C
≥1 305 460
V̲C-G VC-G √3 &
&
fnom ≥1 ≥1 DTOC:
+ Σ Starting I>
& [ 040 036 ]
−
&
fnom ≥1
+ Σ
&
−
&
fnom
+ Σ ≥1
&
−
&
COMP ≥1
V̲min &
DTOC:
tSD PSx
[ * ]
t 0
DTOC: DTOC:
≥1 ≥1 * Parameter V< (I>) PSx tSD PSx
MAIN: set 1 011 244 012 206
Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
[ 010 048 ] set 2 011 245 012 207
2: Isolated/res.ground. set 3 011 246 012 208
3 set 4 011 247 012 209
DTOC:
Block.Start. I> Px
450 137
19Z8116A
Fig. 3-126: Phase current stages, optional voltage check and blocking by inrush stabilization, stage I>.
DTOC:
I>> Starting A
460 518
DTOC:
I>> Starting B
460 519
DTOC:
I>> Starting C
460 520
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 023 ]
DTOC:
V< (I>>) PSx
[ * ]
Blocked
& ≥1 DTOC:
Starting A
fnom ≥1 305 458
& ≥1 DTOC:
fnom Starting B
≥1 305 459
V̲B-G VB-G √3 &
≥1 DTOC:
fnom & Starting C
≥1 305 460
V̲C-G VC-G √3 &
&
fnom ≥1 ≥1 DTOC:
+ Σ Starting I>>
& [ 040 029 ]
−
&
fnom ≥1
+ Σ
&
−
&
fnom
+ Σ ≥1
&
−
&
COMP ≥1
V̲min &
DTOC:
tSD PSx
[ * ]
t 0
DTOC: DTOC:
≥1 ≥1 * Parameter V< (I>>) PSx tSD PSx
MAIN: set 1 011 248 012 206
Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
[ 010 048 ] set 2 011 249 012 207
2: Isolated/res.ground. set 3 011 250 012 208
3 set 4 011 251 012 209
DTOC:
Block.Start. I>> Px
450 141
19Z8117A
Fig. 3-127: Phase current stages, optional voltage check and blocking by inrush stabilization, stage I>>.
DTOC:
I>>> Starting A
460 521
DTOC:
I>>> Starting B
460 522
DTOC:
I>>> Starting C
460 523
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 023 ]
DTOC:
V< (I>>>) PSx
[ * ]
Blocked
& ≥1 DTOC:
Starting A
fnom ≥1 305 458
& ≥1 DTOC:
fnom Starting B
≥1 305 459
V̲B-G VB-G √3 &
≥1 DTOC:
fnom & Starting C
≥1 305 460
V̲C-G VC-G √3 &
&
fnom ≥1 ≥1 DTOC:
+ Σ Starting I>>>
& [ 039 075 ]
−
&
fnom ≥1
+ Σ
&
−
&
fnom
+ Σ ≥1
&
−
&
COMP ≥1
V̲min &
DTOC:
tSD PSx
[ * ]
t 0
DTOC: DTOC:
≥1 ≥1 * Parameter V< (I>>>) PSx tSD PSx
MAIN: set 1 011 252 012 206
Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
[ 010 048 ] set 2 011 253 012 207
2: Isolated/res.ground. set 3 011 254 012 208
3 set 4 011 255 012 209
DTOC:
Block.Start. I>>> Px
450 145
19Z8118A
Fig. 3-128: Phase current stages, optional voltage check and blocking by inrush stabilization, stage I>>>.
DTOC: DTOC:
I>>>> Starting A Starting A
460 551 [ 305 458 ]
DTOC: DTOC:
I>>>> Starting B Starting B
460 530 [ 305 429 ]
DTOC: DTOC:
I>>>> Starting C Starting C
460 531 [ 305 460 ]
≥1 DTOC:
Starting I>>>>
[ 016 174]
DTOC:
Block.Start. I>>>> Px
460 554
19Z8807A
Fig. 3-129: Phase current stages, blocking by inrush stabilization, stage I>>>>.
DTOC:
Blocking tI> EXT
[ 041 060 ] DTOC:
C tI> PSx
DTOC:
Starting I> [ * ]
[ 040 036 ]
DTOC:
Mode timer start PSx
t 0
[ * ] DTOC:
& tI> elapsed
1: With starting
2: With direction [ 040 010 ]
&
SCDD:
Direction tI> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
&
2: Backward directional
&
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Fault P forward
[ 036 018 ]
SCDD:
Fault P backward
[ 036 019 ]
DTOC:
DTOC: C tI>> PSx
Blocking tI>> EXT
[ 041 061 ] [ * ]
DTOC:
Starting I>>
[ 040 029 ] t 0 DTOC:
& tI>> elapsed
[ 040 033 ]
&
SCDD:
Direction tI>> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
&
2: Backward directional
&
3: Non-directional
DTOC:
DTOC: C tI>>> PSx
Blocking tI>>> EXT
[ 041 062 ] [ * ]
DTOC:
Starting I>>>
[ 039 075 ] t 0 DTOC:
& tI>>> elapsed
[ 040 012 ]
&
SCDD:
Direction tI>>> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
&
2: Backward directional
&
3: Non-directional
DTOC:
DTOC:
Blocking tI>>>> EXT C tI>>>> PSx
DTOC:
Starting I>>>>
[ 016 174 ] t 0 DTOC:
& tI>>>> elapsed
[ 016 175 ]
&
SCDD:
Direction tI>>>> PSx
[*]
1: Forward directional
&
2: Backward directional
&
3: Non-directional
set 1 017 004 002 138 017 071 017 006 017 072
set 2 073 019 002 139 077 237 073 020 077 238
set 3 074 019 002 142 078 237 074 020 078 238
set 4 075 019 002 143 079 237 075 020 079 238
19Z8803A
DTOC: DTOC:
tI> elapsed Trip signal tI>
[ 040 010 ] [ 041 020 ]
SCDD:
Block. direct. tI>
304 461
DTOC: DTOC:
tI>> elapsed Trip signal tI>>
[ 040 033 ] [ 040 011 ]
SCDD:
Block. direct. tI>>
304 462
DTOC: DTOC:
tI>>> elapsed Trip signal tI>>>
[ 040 012 ] [ 040 076 ]
SCDD:
Block. Direct. tI>>>
310 067
DTOC: DTOC:
tI>>>> elapsed Trip signal tI>>>>
[ 016 175 ] [ 016 176 ]
SCDD:
Block. Direct. tI>>>>
460 553
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
19Z8804A
Fig. 3-131: Trip signals from the DTOC phase current stages.
When the inrush stabilization function (see Section 3.12.7, (p. 3-112)) is
triggered, the 1st stage of the negative-sequence current function is blocked.
When the short-circuit direction determination function (SCDD) is active, trip
signals from the DTOC negative-sequence current stages have no directional
dependence.
The trip signals from all negative-sequence current stages are blocked by the
auto-reclosing control function (ARC) when this function is able to issue a trip
command.
DTOC:
Block.Start. Ineg>
450 153
DTOC:
Block.Start. Ineg>>
450 154
DTOC:
Block.Start. Ineg>>>
450 155
DTOC:
Block.Start. Ineg>>>>
460 555
DTOC:
Enabled
[ 040 120 ] &
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
MAIN:
Dynam. param. active
[ 040 090 ]
DTOC:
Block. tIneg> EXT DTOC:
[ 036 141 ] C tIneg> PSx
[*]
MAIN:
Bl. timer st. IN,neg DTOC:
306 400
c Ineg> PSx
& [*]
t 0
DTOC:
DTOC: tIneg> elapsed
MAIN:
Phase sequence & c Ineg> dynamic
[*]
PSx [ 036 148 ]
[ 010 049 ]
DTOC:
I̲A Starting Ineg>
& [ 036 145 ]
I̲B Ineg
I̲C
DTOC:
& Trip signal tIneg>
ARC:
Blocking trip [ 036 151 ]
[ 042 000 ]
DTOC:
DTOC: tIneg>> PSx
Block. tIneg>> EXT C
[ 036 142 ] [*]
DTOC:
Ineg>> PSx
& c [*]
t 0 DTOC:
DTOC: tIneg>> elapsed
Ineg>> dynamic PSx [ 036 149 ]
& c [*]
DTOC:
& Starting Ineg>>
[ 036 146 ]
DTOC:
& Trip signal tIneg>>
[ 036 152 ]
DTOC: DTOC:
Block. tIneg>>> EXT tIneg>>> PSx
[ 036 143 ] [*]
DTOC:
c Ineg>>> PSx
& [*]
t 0 DTOC:
DTOC: tIneg>>> elapsed
[ 036 150 ]
& c Ineg>>> dynamic PSx
[*]
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>>>
& [ 036 147 ]
DTOC:
& Trip signal tIneg>>>
[ 036 153 ]
DTOC: DTOC:
Block. tIneg>>>> EXT tIneg>>>> PSx
[ 016 194 ] [*]
DTOC:
& c Ineg>>>>
[*]
PSx
t 0 DTOC:
DTOC: tIneg>>>> elapsed
[ 016 196 ]
& cIneg>>>> dynamic PSx
[*]
DTOC:
Starting Ineg>>>>
& [ 016 195 ]
MAIN:
Gen. start. mode PSx & DTOC:
[*] Trip sign. tIneg>>>>
[ 016 197 ]
1: With start. IN, Ineg
set 1 072 011 076 200 072 023 072 012 076 201 072 024 017 027
set 2 073 011 077 200 073 023 073 012 077 201 073 024 001 219
set 3 074 011 078 200 074 023 074 012 078 201 074 024 001 220
set 4 075 011 079 200 075 023 075 012 079 201 075 024 001 221
set 1 072 013 076 202 072 025 016 161 016 165 016 169
set 2 073 013 077 202 073 025 016 162 016 166 016 170
set 3 074 013 078 202 074 025 016 163 016 167 016 171
set 4 075 013 079 202 075 025 016 164 016 168 016 172 19Z8805B
DTOC: DTOC:
tIneg> elapsed Trip signal tIneg>
[ 036 148 ] & [ 036 151 ]
DTOC:
DTOC: Trip signal tIneg>>
tIneg>> elapsed & [ 036 152 ]
[ 036 149 ]
DTOC: DTOC:
tIneg>>> elapsed Trip signal tIneg>>>
[ 036 150 ] & [ 036 153 ]
DTOC: DTOC:
tIneg>>>> elapsed Trip sign. tIneg>>>>
[ 016 196 ] & [ 016 197 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
Fig. 3-133: Trip signals from the DTOC negative-sequence current stages.
3.23.6 Selecting the Measured Variable for the Residual Current Stage
A setting specifies which current will be used by the P139 as the residual current
of the stages IN>, IN>> and IN>>>: either the residual current calculated from
the three phase currents or the residual current directly measured at the fourth
transformer (T 4), or the residual current calculated with I0 elimination (Σ I̲ P −
⅓⋅I̲ N). For the IN>>>> stage, always the calculated residual current is used.
DTOC:
Eval. IN> PSx
I̲A [*]
I̲B
I̲C
1
I̲N 2
1 ... 3 DTOC:
IN>
310 063
1: Calculated
+ 2: Measured
I̲N/3 −
3: Calc with I0 elim.
DTOC:
Eval. IN>> PSx
[*]
1 ... 3 DTOC:
IN>>
310 064
1: Calculated
2: Measured
3: Calc with I0 elim.
DTOC:
Eval. IN>>> PSx
[ * ]
1 ... 3 DTOC:
IN>>>
310 065
1: Calculated
2: Measured
3: Calc with I0 elim.
DTOC:
IN>>>>
310 066
DTOC: DTOC: DTOC:
* Parameter Eval. IN> PSx Eval. IN>> PSx Eval. IN>>> PSx
There is also a separate setting for each residual current stage whether the
starting decision shall be based on the fundamental or on the r.m.s. value.
The trip signals from the residual current stages are only enabled if the operating
mode for the general starting has been set to With start. IN, Ineg.
The trip signals from all residual current stages are blocked by the auto-reclosing
control function (ARC) when this function is able to issue a trip command.
The trip signals from the DTOC function (stages IN>, IN>> and IN>>>) can be
blocked by the short-circuit direction determination function (SCDD). Depending
on the setting of the short-circuit direction determination function, the trip signal
of stages IN>, IN>> or IN>>> will be enabled.
DTOC: ≥1 DTOC:
Block. Start. IN> Starting N
DTOC:
Block. Start. IN>>
DTOC:
Block. Start. IN>>>
DTOC:
Block. Start. IN>>>> DTOC:
c tIN> PSx
DTOC: ≥1
Blocking tIN> EXT [ * ]
[ 041 063 ] DTOC:
Meas.value I/IN> PSx
[ * ] t 0 DTOC:
MAIN: tIN> elapsed
Bl. timer st. IN,neg
DTOC: [ 040 013 ]
& c IN> PSx
MAIN: [ * ]
Dynam. param. active
DTOC:
[ 040 090 ] & c IN> dynamic PSx
[ * ]
&
DTOC: [ 040 077 ]
I̲N
DTOC:
c tIN>> PSx
DTOC: ≥1
Blocking tIN>> EXT [ * ]
[ 041 064 ] DTOC:
Meas.val. I/IN>> PSx
[ * ] t 0 DTOC:
tIN>> elapsed
DTOC: [ 040 121 ]
& c IN>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& c IN>> dynamic PSx
[ * ] DTOC:
& Starting IN>>
[ 040 041 ]
DTOC:
c tIN>>> PSx
DTOC: ≥1
Blocking tIN>>> EXT [ * ]
[ 041 065 ] DTOC:
Meas.val.I/IN>>> PSx
[ * ] t 0 DTOC:
tIN>>> elapsed
DTOC: [ 039 079 ]
& c IN>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
& cIN>>> dynamic PSx
[ * ] DTOC:
& Starting IN>>>
[ 039 078 ]
DTOC:
c tIN>>>> PSx
DTOC: ≥1
Blocking tIN>>>> EXT [ * ]
[ 041 101 ] DTOC:
Meas.v.I/IN>>>> PSx
[ * ] t 0 DTOC:
tIN>>>> elapsed
DTOC: [ 035 040 ]
DTOC: & & c IN>>>> PSx
Enabled
[ * ]
[ 040 120 ]
MAIN: DTOC:
System IN enabled & c IN>>>> dyn. PSx
[ 040 133 ] [ * ] DTOC:
& Starting IN>>>>
[ 035 031 ]
set 1 017 008 060 002 017 003 017 081 017 010 060 006
set 2 073 027 060 003 073 015 073 035 073 028 060 007
set 3 074 027 060 004 074 015 074 035 074 028 060 008
set 4 075 027 060 005 075 015 075 035 075 028 060 009
set 1 017 009 017 086 017 019 060 010 017 018 017 087
set 2 073 016 073 036 073 029 060 011 073 017 073 037
set 3 074 016 074 036 074 029 060 012 074 017 074 037
set 4 075 016 075 036 075 029 060 013 075 017 075 037
DTOC: DTOC:
tIN> elapsed Trip signal tIN>
[ 040 013 ] &
[ 041 021 ]
SCDD:
Block. direct. tIN>
304 463
DTOC: DTOC:
tIN>> elapsed & Trip signal tIN>>
[ 040 121 ] [ 040 028 ]
SCDD:
Block. direct. tIN>>
304 464
DTOC: DTOC:
tIN>>> elapsed Trip signal tIN>>>
[ 039 079 ] &
[ 040 079 ]
SCDD:
Block. Direct. tIN>>>
310 068
DTOC: DTOC:
tIN>>>> elapsed Trip sign. tIN>>>>
[ 035 040 ] &
[ 035 046 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
MAIN:
Gen. start. mode PSx
[ * ] * Parameter MAIN:
Gen. start. mode PSx
1: With start. IN, Ineg
set 1 017 027
set 2 001 219
set 3 001 220
set 4 001 221
19Z8816A
Fig. 3-136: Trip signal from the DTOC residual current stages.
DTOC:
Puls.prol.IN>,intPSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
tIN>,interm. PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Hold-t. tIN>,intmPSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Trip sig. tIN>,intm.
DTOC: [ 039 073 ]
Starting IN> Hold-time logic
[ 040 077 ]
DTOC:
t2 N
305 454
DTOC:
Pulse prolong. runn.
305 462
DTOC:
H.-time tIN>,i. runn
[ 040 086 ]
MAIN:
General starting DTOC:
[ 040 000 ] tIN>,interm. elapsed
[ 040 099 ]
19Z5019A
DTOC:
Starting IN>
[ 040 077 ]
DTOC:
Pulse prolong. runn.
305 462
DTOC:
H.-time tIN>,i. runn
[ 040 086 ]
DTOC:
t2 N
305 454
DTOC:
Trip sig. tIN>,intm.
[ 039 073 ]
Settings
S8Z5001A
Fig. 3-138: Signal flow for values below the accumulation limit value.
DTOC:
Starting IN>
[ 040 077 ]
DTOC:
Pulse prolong. runn.
305 462
DTOC:
H.-time tIN>,i. runn
[ 040 086 ]
DTOC:
t2 N
305 454
DTOC:
Trip sig. tIN>,intm.
[ 039 073 ]
Settings
19Z5243A
Fig. 3-139: Signal flow for values at the accumulation limit value.
IDMT1:
General enable USER
[ 017 096 ]
0
IDMT1:
1 Enabled
[ 040 100 ]
0: No
1: Yes
IDMT1:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
Parameter IDMT1:
Enable PSx
0
set 1 072 070
1 set 2 073 070
set 3 074 070
0: No
set 4 075 070
1: Yes
19Z5020A
Fig. 3-140: Disabling or enabling IDMT protection. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however, also applies to IDMT2
with different numerical addresses.)
0 Definite Time t =k
a
Per IEC 255–3 t =k · I b
(I ) -1
ref
1 Standard Inverse 0.14 0.02
2 Very Inverse 13.50 1.00
3 Extremely Inverse 80.00 2.00
4 Long Time Inverse 120.00 1.00
a k ·R
Per IEEE C37.112 t = k ·( I + c) tr = I 2
(I )b - 1 1- ( I )
ref ref
5 Moderately Inverse 0.0515 0.0200 0.1140 4.85
6 Very Inverse 19.6100 2.0000 0.4910 21.60
7 Extremely Inverse 28.2000 2.0000 0.1217 29.10
a k ·R
Per ANSI t = k ·( I + c) tr = I 2
b
(I ) -1 1- ( I )
ref ref
8 Normally Inverse 8.9341 2.0938 0.17966 9.00
9 Short Time Inverse 0.2663 1.2969 0.03393 0.50
10 Long Time Inverse 5.6143 1.0000 2.18592 15.75
1
11 RI-Type Inverse t =k · 0.236
0.339 - I
(I )
ref
I
12 RXIDG-Type Inverse t = k · (5.8 - 1.35 · ln I )
ref
Once a ratio I/Iref greater than 20 is reached, the tripping time is bounded on the
lower end.
Characteristic 1: IEC 255–3, Standard Inverse Characteristic 2: IEC 255–3, Very Inverse
1000 1000
100 100
k=10
10 10
k=10
t/s k=1
t/s
1 1
k=1
k=0.1
0.1 k=0.05 0.1
k=0.1
k=0.05
0.01 0.01
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
I/Iref I/Iref
Characteristic 3: IEC 255–3, Extremely Inverse Characteristic 4: IEC 255–3, Long Time Inverse
1000 1000
100 100
k=10
10 10
k=1
t/s t/s
k=10
1 1
k=0.1
k=0.05
k=1
0.1 0.1
k=0.1
0.01 k=0.05 0.01
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
I/Iref I/Iref
Characteristic 5: IEEE C37.112, Moderately Inverse Characteristic 6: IEEE C37.112, Very Inverse
1000 1000
100 100
10 k=10 10
k=10
t/s t/s
1 k=1 1
k=1
I/Iref I/Iref
1000
100
10
t/s
k=10
1
k=1
0.1
k=0.1
0.01 k=0.05
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
I/Iref
1000 1000
100 100
10 10
t/s t/s
k=10
1 1
k=10
k=1
0.1 0.1
k=1
k=0.1
0.01 k=0.05 0.01
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 k=0.1
k=0.05
I/Iref I/Iref
1000
100
k=10
10
t/s k=1
1
k=0.1
0.1 k=0.05
0.01
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
I/Iref
100 100
k=10
k=10
10 10
k=0.1
k=0.05 k=0.1
0.1 0.1 k=0.05
0.01 0.01
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
I/Iref I/Iref
P G neg
t/s 10
IDMT:
Iref,y PSx
IDMT:
Min. trip time y PSx
1
1 10 100
P G neg
P G neg
P G neg
12Z6303B
Fig. 3-145: Influence of the minimum operate value and the minimum trip time on the IDMT characteristics.
3.24.4 Selecting the Measured Variable for the Phase Current Stage
In each of the function groups IDMT1 and IDMT2, a setting specifies which
current will be used by the P139 as the phase current of the stage I>: either the
maximum phase current is used, or a value where the residual current has been
eliminated (I0 elimination).
That is, one of the following currents is used:
● The maximum phase current
● The maximum phase current shifted by one third of the calculated residual
current ( I̲ max − ⅓⋅Σ I̲ P)
● The maximum phase current shifted by one third of the residual current
measured at the fourth transformer (T4), i. e. ( I̲ max − IN/3)
I̲A
IDMT1:
I̲B I0 Elimin. I> PSx
I̲C
I̲max
+
−
IDMT1:
I>
310 072
0: without
+ 1: with I0 calculated
I̲N I̲N/3 − 2: with I0 measured
IDMT2:
I0 Elimin. I> PSx
19Z8703A
3
IDMT: /
Bl.Start.Iref,P> Px
IDMT1:
Enabled &
[ 040 100 ] IDMT1:
Iref,P PSx
MAIN: & c
Protection active [ * ]
IDMT1:
& c Iref,P dynamic PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Dynam. param. active
1.05 Iref IDMT:
[ 040 090 ] Starting A
IDMT:
Starting B
IDMT1: c
Meas.value I/IN PSx IDMT:
[ * ] Starting C
≥1 IDMT1:
& Starting Iref,P>
I̲A [ 040 080 ]
&
I̲B
&
I̲C
◀ IDMT1:
Characteristic P PSx
◀ [ * ]
Setting
IDMT1:
Mode timer start PSx
◀ IDMT1:
Min. trip time P PSx IDMT1:
Characteristic P PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
& ≥1
↗ 1: With starting IDMT1:
Factor kt,P PSx 0: Definite Time
& [ * ] 1: IEC Standard Inverse
↗ 2: With direction 2: IEC Very Inverse
IDMT1: 3: IEC Extr. Inverse
SCDD: Setting Hold time P PSx
Direction tI> PSx 4: IEC Long Time Inv.
IDMT1: [ * ] 5: IEEE Moderately Inv.
[ * ] Release P PSx IDMT1: 6: IEEE Very Inverse
Release P PSx 7: IEEE Extremely Inv.
↗ 1: Forward directional & ≥1 1: Without delay [ * ] 8: ANSI Normally Inv.
2: Delayed as per char. IDMT1: 9: ANSI Short Time Inv.
↗ 2: Backward directional & Factor KI,P PSx 10: ANSI Long Time Inv.
[ * ] 11: RI-Type Inverse
↗ 3: Non-directional 12: RXIDG-Type Inverse
IDMT1:
Time Correction PSx
SCDD:
Fault P forward [ * ]
[ 036 018 ]
SCDD: c
Fault P backward c
[ 036 019 ] IDMT1:
Φ Memory P clear
IDMT1: [ 040 110 ]
Block. tIref,P> EXT
I̲P,max/Iref,P IDMT1:
[ 040 101 ] Hold time P running
[ 040 053 ]
IDMT1:
tIref,P> elapsed
[ 040 082 ]
set 1 072 050 072 003 060 018 072 056 007 226 072 077
set 2 073 050 073 003 060 019 073 056 007 227 073 077
set 3 074 050 074 003 060 020 074 056 007 228 074 077
set 4 075 050 075 003 060 021 075 056 007 229 075 077
set 1 072 053 017 071 072 071 072 059 007 250 013 143
set 2 073 053 077 237 073 071 073 059 007 251 013 144
set 3 074 053 078 237 074 071 074 059 007 252 013 145
set 4 075 053 079 237 075 071 075 059 007 253 013 146
19Z8834A
Fig. 3-147: Phase current stage for IDMT1. Note: The logic displayed here is not valid for IDMT2 as the parameters
I D M T 1 : F a c t o r K I , P P S x, I D M T 1 : T i m e C o r r e c t i o n P S x and I D M T 1 : M o d e t i m e r s t a r t P S x do not exist
with IDMT2.
The phase current stage or IDMT2 is displayed in Fig. 3-148, (p. 3-200). (Trip
signal: see Fig. 3-149, (p. 3-201).)
3
IDMT2: /
Bl.Start.Iref,P> Px
IDMT2:
Enabled &
[ 040 135 ] IDMT2:
Iref,P PSx
MAIN: & c
Protection active [ * ]
IDMT2:
& c Iref,P dynamic PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Dynam. param. active
1.05 Iref IDMT:
[ 040 090 ] Starting A
IDMT:
Starting B
IDMT2: c
Meas.value I/IN PSx IDMT:
[ * ] Starting C
≥1 IDMT2:
& Starting Iref,P>
I̲A [ 040 018 ]
&
I̲B
&
I̲C
◀
IDMT2:
◀ Characteristic P PSx
◀ [ * ] Setting
IDMT2:
Characteristic P PSx
IDMT2:
Setting Min. trip time P PSx
IDMT2: [ * ] 0: Definite Time
Release P PSx 1: IEC Standard Inverse
IDMT2:
Factor kt,P PSx 2: IEC Very Inverse
1: Without delay [ * ] 3: IEC Extr. Inverse
2: Delayed as per char. 4: IEC Long Time Inv.
IDMT2:
Hold time P PSx 5: IEEE Moderately Inv.
6: IEEE Very Inverse
[ * ]
7: IEEE Extremely Inv.
IDMT2: 8: ANSI Normally Inv.
Release P PSx
9: ANSI Short Time Inv.
[ * ] 10: ANSI Long Time Inv.
11: RI-Type Inverse
IDMT2: 12: RXIDG-Type Inverse
Block. tIref,P> EXT c
[ 040 136 ] c
IDMT2:
Φ Memory P clear
[ 040 178 ]
IDMT2:
Hold time P running
I̲P,max/Iref,P
[ 040 016 ]
IDMT2:
tIref,P> elapsed
[ 040 021 ]
Fig. 3-148: Phase current stage for IDMT2. IDMT represents IDMT2. (Note: The logic displayed here is not valid for
IDMT1.)
The phase current stage for IDMT1 is displayed in Fig. 3-147, (p. 3-199). (Trip
signal: see Fig. 3-150, (p. 3-201).)
IDMT1: IDMT1:
tIref,P> elapsed Trip signal tIref,P>
[ 040 082 ] [ 040 084 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
SCDD:
Bl.Direct. tIref,P>
304 465
IDMT:
ARC Starting Iref,P>
304 367
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,P>
[ 040 080 ]
12Z5111A
Fig. 3-149: Trip signal of the phase current stage for IDMT1.
IDMT2: IDMT2:
tIref,P> elapsed Trip signal tIref,P>
[ 040 021 ] [ 040 023 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
12Z5112A
Fig. 3-150: Trip signal of the phase current stages for IDMT2.
IDMT:
Bl.Start.Iref,neg>
450 161
IDMT1:
Enabled &
[ 040 100 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
IDMT1:
c Iref,neg PSx
& [ * ]
IDMT1:
Iref,neg dynamic PSx
& c [ * ]
1.05 Iref
I̲neg/Iref,neg
c
MAIN:
Phase sequence
[ 010 049 ]
IDMT1:
& Starting Iref,neg>
I̲A [ 040 107 ]
I̲B I̲neg
I̲C
IDMT1:
Character. neg. PSx Setting
[ * ] IDMT1:
Character. neg. PSx
IDMT1:
MAIN: Factor kt,neg PSx
Dynam. param. active [ * ]
[ 040 090 ] 0: Definite Time
IDMT1:
Min.trip time negPSx 1: IEC Standard Inverse
[ * ] 2: IEC Very Inverse
IDMT1: 3: IEC Extr. Inverse
Hold time neg PSx
[ * ] 4: IEC Long Time Inv.
IDMT1: IDMT1:
Block. tIref,neg>EXT Memory neg clear
[ 040 102 ] [ 040 111 ]
MAIN:
Bl. timer st. IN,neg IDMT1:
306 400 Hold time neg runn.
[ 040 113 ]
IDMT1:
tIref,neg> elapsed
[ 040 109 ]
IDMT1:
ARC: & Trip sig. tIref,neg>
Blocking trip [ 040 108 ]
[ 042 000 ]
set 1 017 027 072 051 072 004 072 057 013 143
set 2 001 219 073 051 073 004 073 057 013 144
set 3 001 220 074 051 074 004 074 057 013 145
set 4 001 221 075 051 075 004 075 057 013 146
set 1 072 054 072 078 072 072 072 060 007 254
set 2 073 054 073 078 073 072 073 060 007 255
set 3 074 054 074 078 074 072 074 060 008 002
set 4 075 054 075 078 075 072 075 060 008 005
19Z8835A
Fig. 3-151: Negative-sequence current stage. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however, also applies to IDMT2 with
different numerical addresses, and with the exception of parameters I D M T 1 : F a c t o r K I , n e g P S x and
I D M T 1 : T i m e C o r r e c t i o n P S x that do not exist for IDMT2.)
3.24.7 Selecting the Measured Variable for the Residual Current Stage
A setting specifies which current will be used by the P139 as the residual current:
either the residual current calculated from the three phase currents or the
residual current directly measured at the fourth current transformer (T 4), or the
residual current calculated with I0 elimination, i.e. the calculated current shifted
by one third of the residual current (Σ I̲ P − ⅓⋅I̲ N).
IDMT:
Factor KI,y PSx
I̲A [*]
I̲B
I̲C
1
I̲N 2
IDMT:
1 ... 3 IN
307 100
+ 1: Calculated
I̲N/3 −
2: Measured
3: Calc with I0 elim.
19Z8722A
IDMT:
Bl.Start.Iref,N>
IDMT1:
Enabled &
[ 040 100 ] IDMT1:
Iref,N PSx
MAIN: & c
System IN enabled [ * ]
[ 040 133 ]
IDMT1:
& c Iref,N dynamic PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Dynam. param. active
1.05 Iref
[ 040 090 ]
I̲N/Iref,N
IDMT1: c
Meas.value I/IN PSx
[ * ]
IDMT1:
& Starting Iref,N>
IDMT: [ 040 081 ]
IN
◀
IDMT1:
Characteristic N PSx
[ * ] Setting
IDMT1:
Mode timer start PSx IDMT1: IDMT1:
Factor kt,N PSx Characteristic N PSx
[ * ]
& ≥1 [ * ]
↗ 1: With starting 0: Definite Time
IDMT1:
& Min. trip time N PSx 1: IEC Standard Inverse
↗ 2: With direction 2: IEC Very Inverse
[ * ]
IDMT1: 3: IEC Extr. Inverse
SCDD: 4: IEC Long Time Inv.
Direction tIN> PSx Hold time N PSx
Setting [ * ] 5: IEEE Moderately Inv.
[ * ] 6: IEEE Very Inverse
IDMT1: IDMT1:
↗ 1: Forward directional Release N PSx Release N PSx 7: IEEE Extremely Inv.
& ≥1 8: ANSI Normally Inv.
[ * ]
9: ANSI Short Time Inv.
↗ 2: Backward directional & 1: Without delay IDMT1: 10: ANSI Long Time Inv.
2: Delayed as per char. Factor KI,N PSx
11: RI-Type Inverse
↗ 3: Non-directional [ * ] 12: RXIDG-Type Inverse
IDMT1:
SCDD: Time Correction PSx
Ground fault forward
[ * ]
[ 040 037 ]
SCDD: & c
Ground fault backw.
[ 040 038 ] IDMT1:
Φ Memory N clear
MAIN: [ 040 112 ]
Gen. start. mode PSx
IDMT1:
[ * ] Hold time N running
↗ 1: With start. IN, Ineg [ 040 054 ]
IDMT1: IDMT1:
Block. tIref,N> EXT tIref,N> elapsed
[ 040 103 ] [ 040 083 ]
MAIN:
Bl. timer st. IN,neg
set 1 072 052 072 005 060 018 072 058 007 226 072 055 013 143
set 2 073 052 073 005 060 019 073 058 007 227 073 055 013 144
set 3 074 052 074 005 060 020 074 058 007 228 074 055 013 145
set 4 075 052 075 005 060 021 075 058 007 229 075 055 013 146
set 1 072 079 017 073 072 073 072 061 001 173 017 027
set 2 073 079 077 240 073 073 073 061 001 174 001 219
set 3 074 079 078 240 074 073 074 061 001 175 001 220
set 4 075 079 079 240 075 073 075 061 001 176 001 221
19Z8836A
Fig. 3-153: Residual current stage for IDMT1. (Note: The logic displayed here is not valid for IDMT2 as the
parameters I D M T 1 : F a c t o r K I , N P S x, I D M T 1 : T i m e C o r r e c t i o n P S x and I D M T 1 : M o d e t i m e r s t a r t P S x
do not exist with IDMT2.)
The phase current stage for IDMT2 is displayed in Fig. 3-154, (p. 3-206). (Trip
signal: see Fig. 3-155, (p. 3-207).)
IDMT2:
Bl.Start.Iref,N>
IDMT2:
Enabled &
[ 040 135 ] IDMT2:
Iref,N PSx
MAIN: & c
System IN enabled [ * ]
[ 040 133 ]
IDMT2:
& c Iref,N dynamic PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Dynam. param. active
1.05 Iref
[ 040 090 ]
I̲N/Iref,N
IDMT2: c
Meas.value I/IN PSx
[ * ]
IDMT2:
& Starting Iref,N>
IDMT: [ 040 019 ]
IN
◀
IDMT2: Setting
Characteristic N PSx
IDMT2:
[ * ] Characteristic N PSx
IDMT2:
Factor kt,N PSx 0: Definite Time
[ * ] 1: IEC Standard Inverse
Setting 2: IEC Very Inverse
IDMT2: IDMT2:
Min. trip time N PSx 3: IEC Extr. Inverse
Release N PSx
4: IEC Long Time Inv.
[ * ]
5: IEEE Moderately Inv.
1: Without delay IDMT2: 6: IEEE Very Inverse
Hold time N PSx
2: Delayed as per char. 7: IEEE Extremely Inv.
[ * ] 8: ANSI Normally Inv.
IDMT2: 9: ANSI Short Time Inv.
Release N PSx 10: ANSI Long Time Inv.
[ * ] 11: RI-Type Inverse
MAIN: 12: RXIDG-Type Inverse
Gen. start. mode PSx
& c
[ * ]
↗ 1: With start. IN, Ineg IDMT2:
Φ Memory N clear
IDMT2:
Block. tIref,N> EXT [ 040 188 ]
[ 040 150 ] IDMT2:
Hold time N running
MAIN: [ 040 017 ]
Bl. timer st. IN,neg IDMT2:
tIref,N> elapsed
[ 040 022 ]
set 1 077 250 076 038 060 022 071 012 071 000
set 2 077 251 076 039 060 023 071 013 071 001
set 3 077 252 076 040 060 024 071 014 071 002
set 4 077 253 076 041 060 025 071 015 071 003
Fig. 3-154: Residual current stage for IDMT2. Note: The logic displayed here is not valid for IDMT1.
The residual current stage for IDMT1 is displayed in Fig. 3-153, (p. 3-205). (Trip
signal: see Fig. 3-156, (p. 3-207).)
IDMT1:
tIref,N> elapsed IDMT1:
[ 040 083 ] Trip signal tIref,N>
[ 040 085 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
SCDD:
Bl.Direct. tIref,N>
304 466
IDMT:
ARC Starting Iref,N>
304 368
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,N>
[ 040 081 ]
12Z5113A
Fig. 3-155: Trip signal from the residual current stage for IDMT1.
IDMT2:
tIref,N> elapsed IDMT2:
Trip signal tIref,N>
[ 040 022 ]
[ 040 024 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
12Z5114A
Fig. 3-156: Trip signal from the residual current stage for IDMT2.
Case A
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,P>
[ 040 080 ]
IDMT1:
Hold time P running
[ 040 053 ]
Per characteristic
Non-delayed
IDMT1:
tIref,P> elapsed
[ 040 082 ]
Case B
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,P>
[ 040 080 ]
IDMT1:
Hold time P running
[ 040 053 ]
Non-delayed
Per characteristic
IDMT1:
tIref,P> elapsed
[ 040 082 ]
Parameter IDMT1:
Hold time P PSx
set 1 072 071
set 2 073 071
set 3 074 071
set 4 075 071
19Z5025A
Fig. 3-157: Effect of hold time shown with a phase current stage as an example. Example A: Hold time determined
is not reached. Example B: Hold time determined is reached. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however, also applies
to IDMT2 with different numerical addresses.)
SCDD:
General enable USER
[ 017 070 ]
0
SCDD:
1 Enabled
[ 040 098 ]
0: No
1: Yes
SCDD:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
Parameter SCDD:
Enable PSx
0 set 1 076 235
set 2 077 235
1
set 3 078 235
0: No set 4 079 235
1: Yes
19Z5027A
Measurem. relation
Forward direction
αP
IA
VB-C
Backward direction
Line of direction
S8Z5005A
Fig. 3-159: Example for the forming of a directional phase current stage decision with a single-pole fault in phase A
to ground (A-G) and with an inductive system and a phase sequence A-B-C (clockwise rotary field direction)
SCDD:
Enabled
[ 040 098 ]
MCMON: SCDD:
Meas. circ. V faulty Blocked
[ 038 023 ] [ 040 062 ]
MAIN:
Starting A
[ 040 005 ]
MAIN:
Starting B
[ 040 006 ]
MAIN:
Starting C
[ 040 007 ]
>200 mV
V̲A-G ≥2
V̲B-G
V̲C-G
>0.1 Inom
SCDD:
Determin. P enabled
304 456
≥1
I̲A SCDD:
Phase curr.stage bl.
304 460
I̲B
I̲C
19Z5028B
After being enabled and depending on the direction determination decision one
of the following signals will be issued:
● With a fault in forward direction, SCDD: Fault P for ward
● With a fault in backward (reverse) direction, SCDD: Fault P backward
To inhibit transient contention problems starting and dropping out of a direction
determination decision in both directions is delayed for 30 ms.
MAIN:
Phase sequence
[ 010 049 ]
1: A - B - C
2: A - C - B
SCDD:
Determin. P enabled
304 456
MAIN:
Starting A int.
306 513
MAIN:
Starting B int. Starting Selected meas. var. Characteristic
306 514
at at
I̲A
Setting Setting
Phase sequence Phase sequence
I̲B
A–B–C A–C–B
I̲C
V̲A-G +
B I̲B V̲C-A +45° +135°
V̲C-G +
A-B I̲A V̲B-C +60° +150°
SCDD:
Fault P forward
[ 036 018 ]
Direction determin.
SCDD:
Fault P backward
[ 036 019 ]
19Z5029B
Fig. 3-161: Direction determination for phase current stages. (Note: Previous terminology of M A I N : P h a s e
s e q u e n c e was M A I N : R o t a r y f i e l d.)
3.25.4 Forming the Blocking Signal for the Phase Current Stages
To form the blocking signal for the two DTOC phase current stages and the IDMT
phase current stage the fault direction to evaluate the measuring decision may
be set separately for each of the stages to either “Forward directional”,
“Backward directional” or “Non‑directional”.
A blocking signal for the first DTOC phase current stage is formed when one of
the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tI> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tI > is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the second DTOC phase current stage is formed when one
of the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tI>> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tI>> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the third DTOC phase current stage is formed when one of
the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tI>>> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tI>>> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the fourth DTOC phase current stage is formed when one of
the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tI>>>> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tI>>>> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the IDMT phase current stage is formed when one of the
following conditions is met:
● The direction for tIref,P> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tIref,P> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
In case the direction determination function is not enabled (e.g. with a M.c.b.
trip) it is possible to select whether stages set to Forward directional may be
operated with biased tripping by enabling SCDD: Trip bias PSx.
SCDD:
Trip bias PSx
[ * ]
0: No
1: Yes
SCDD:
Phase curr.stage bl.
304 460
SCDD:
Direction tI> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
SCDD:
2: Backward directional Block. direct. tI>
304 461
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direction tI>> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
SCDD:
2: Backward directional Block. direct. tI>>
304 462
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direction tI>>> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
SCDD:
2: Backward directional Block. Direct. tI>>>
310 067
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direction tI>>>> PSx
[*]
1: Forward directional
SCDD:
2: Backward directional Block. Direct. tI>>>>
460 553
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direct. tIref,P> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
SCDD:
2: Backward directional Bl.Direct. tIref,P>
304 465
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Fault P forward
[ 036 018 ]
SCDD:
Fault P backward
[ 036 019 ]
SCDD: SCDD: SCDD: SCDD: SCDD: SCDD:
Parameter Trip bias PSx Direction tI> PSx Direction tI>> PSx Direction tI>>> PSx Direction tI>>>> PSx Direct. tIref,P> PSx
set 1 017 074 017 071 017 072 007 230 016 177 017 066
set 2 077 236 077 237 077 238 007 231 016 178 077 233
set 3 078 236 078 237 078 238 007 232 016 179 078 233
set 4 079 236 079 237 079 238 007 233 016 180 079 233
19Z8809A
Fig. 3-162: Forming the blocking signals for the phase current stages.
Line of direction
Backward direction
V̲G-N = -V̲N-G
IN αN
Forward direction
Measurem. relation
S8Z5006A
Fig. 3-163: Example for forming a directional decision in the residual current stage
SCDD:
Evaluation VNG PSx
[ * ]
V̲N-G 2
1
V̲A-G
V̲B-G 1 ... 2 SCDD:
VNG
V̲C-G 310 026
1: Calculated
2: Measured
Parameter SCDD:
Evaluation VNG PSx
set 1 071 056
set 2 071 057
set 3 071 058
set 4 071 059
19Z6450A
SCDD:
Enabled
[ 040 098 ]
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 023 ]
MAIN:
Starting G int.
306 516
DTOC:
Starting IN>>
[ 040 041 ]
SCDD:
DTOC: VNG> PSx
Starting IN>>>
[ 039 078 ] [ * ]
SCDD:
VNG
310 026
SCDD:
Determin. N enabled
304 455
I̲N SCDD:
Resid.curr.stage bl.
304 454
Parameter SCDD:
VNG> PSx
set 1 017 077
set 2 077 244
set 3 078 244
set 4 079 244
19Z6451A
After being enabled and depending on the direction determination decision one
of the following signals will be issued:
● With a fault in forward direction: SCDD: Ground fault for ward
● With a fault in backward direction: SCD D: Ground fault backw.
To inhibit transient contention problems starting and dropping out of a direction
determination decision in both directions is delayed for 30 ms.
SCDD:
SCDD: Charact. angle G PSx
Determin. N enabled
304 455
[ * ]
I̲N
Direction determin.
SCDD:
VNG
310 026
SCDD:
Ground fault forward
[ 040 037 ]
SCDD:
Ground fault backw.
[ 040 038 ]
Parameter SCDD:
Charact. angle G PSx
set 1 017 076
set 2 077 243
set 3 078 243
set 4 079 243
19Z6452A
3.25.8 Forming the Blocking Signal for the Residual Current Stages
To form the blocking signal for the two DTOC residual current stages and the
IDMT residual current stage the fault direction to evaluate the measuring
decision may be set separately for each of the stages to either Forward
directional, Backward directional or Non-directional.
A blocking signal for the first DTOC residual current stage is formed when one of
the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tIN> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tIN> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the second DTOC residual current stage is formed when one
of the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tIN>> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tIN>> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the third DTOC residual current stage is formed when one of
the following conditions is met:
● The direction for tIN>>> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tIN>>> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
A blocking signal for the IDMT residual current stage is formed when one of the
following conditions is met:
● The direction for tIref,N> is set to Forward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in backward direction.
● The direction for tIref,N> is set to Backward directional and the short-circuit
direction determination detects a fault in forward direction.
In case the direction determination function is not enabled (e.g. with a M.c.b.
trip) it is possible to select whether stages set to Forward directional may be
operated with biased tripping by enabling SCDD: Trip bias PSx. In case of a
phase current starting bias tripping in the residual current stage may be
suppressed by enabling SCDD : Bl ock. bi as G P Sx.
SCDD:
Block. bias G PSx
[ * ]
0
MAIN:
Starting A int. 1
306 513
0: No
MAIN: 1: Yes
Starting B int.
306 514
MAIN:
Starting C int.
306 515
SCDD:
Trip bias PSx
[ * ]
1: Yes
SCDD: SCDD:
Resid.curr.stage bl. Direction tIN> PSx
304 454 [ * ]
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direction tIN>> PSx
[ * ]
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direction tIN>>> PSx
[ * ]
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Direct. tIref,N> PSx
[ * ]
3: Non-directional
SCDD:
Ground fault forward
[ 040 037 ]
SCDD:
Ground fault backw.
[ 040 038 ]
SCDD: SCDD: SCDD: SCDD: SCDD: SCDD:
Parameter Block. bias G PSx Trip bias PSx Direction tIN> PSx Direction tIN>> PSx Direction tIN>>> PSx Direct. tIref,N> PSx
set 1 017 078 017 074 017 073 017 075 007 235 017 067
set 2 077 245 077 236 077 240 077 241 007 236 077 242
set 3 078 245 078 236 078 240 078 241 007 237 078 242
set 4 079 245 079 236 079 240 079 241 007 238 079 242
52Z0133A
Fig. 3-167: Forming the blocking signals for the residual current stages.
SCDD:
Fault P forward SCDD:
[ 036 018 ] Fault P or G forwd.
[ 040 039 ]
SCDD:
Ground fault forward
[ 040 037 ]
SCDD:
Fault P backward SCDD:
[ 036 019 ] Fault P or G backw.
[ 040 040 ]
SCDD:
Ground fault backw.
[ 040 038 ]
S8Z5029A
Fig. 3-168: Fault signals from phase or residual current stages forward or backward directional.
Should the result with a disabled voltage memory be VABmeas > 200 mV the
direction will be determined on the basis of VABmeas. The following signal is
issued: S CD D: Di rect. us ing V me as
If VABmeas < 200 mV, a forward fault is detected if the voltage memory is disabled
and if the pre-orientation is active (set under SCD D: Trip bias PSx), otherwise
the directional decision is blocked. The following signal is issued: SCDD: For w.
w/o measurem.
These signals are additionally delivered to the following signals:
● SC DD: Fau lt P f or ward
● SCD D : Faul t P ba ckward
● SCD D : Faul t P or G f orwd.
● SCDD : Fault P or G backw.
SOTF:
General enable USER
[ 011 068 ]
0
SOTF:
1 & Enabled
[ 040 069 ]
0: No
1: Yes * y PSU:
PS y active
1 036 090
2 036 091
3 036 092
4 036 093
PSU: SOTF:
PS y active Manual close timer
[ * ] [ 011 060 ]
&
MAIN: SOTF:
Protection active & tManual-close runn.
306 001 [ 036 063 ]
SOTF:
Par. ARC running EXT
[ 039 063 ]
ARC:
Close request
303 102
MAIN:
Manual close EXT
[ 036 047 ]
S1 1
R1 SOTF:
Bl. ARC by close cmd
305 675
SOTF:
Operating mode
[ 011 061 ]
5
1: Trip by I>
2: Trip by I>>
3: Trip by I>>>
4: Trip by gen. start.
5: Trip by I>>>>
DTOC:
Starting I> SOTF:
[ 040 036 ] & Trip signal
IDMT1: [ 036 064 ]
Starting Iref,P>
[ 040 080 ] &
DTOC:
Starting I>>
[ 040 029 ] &
DTOC:
Starting I>>>
[ 039 075 ] &
MAIN:
General start. int.
306 539 &
DTOC:
Starting I>>>>
[ 016 174 ]
19Z8810A
Fig. 3-169: Switch on to fault protection. (Only IDMT1 is shown; the logic, however, also applies to IDMT2 with
different numerical addresses.)
PSIG:
General enable USER
[ 015 004 ]
0
PSIG:
1 Enabled
[ 015 008 ]
0: No
1: Yes
0: No
1: Yes
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
PSIG:
Ext./user enabled
[ 037 023 ]
PSIG:
Enable EXT
[ 037 025 ]
PSIG:
Enable USER
[ 003 132 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
PSIG:
Disable EXT
[ 037 026 ]
PSIG:
Disable USER
[ 003 131 ]
0: don't execute
PSIG:
1: execute Ready
[ 037 027 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
PSIG:
Blocking EXT
[ 036 049 ]
PSIG: PSIG:
Telecom. faulty Not ready
[ 036 060 ] [ 037 028 ]
45Z5032A
Substation a L+ L-
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
-K1
PSIG:
Receive EXT
L+/L-
L-/L+
P139
Substation b L- L+
-K2
PSIG:
Receive EXT
L+/L-
L-/L+
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
P139
S8Z5031A
Fig. 3-171: Protective signaling over pilot wires, operating mode selected Transm.rel.break con.
No No No No
No No No Yes
No Yes No No
No Yes No Yes
Yes No No Yes
The signal PSIG: Trip s ignal is generated without delay after the DC loop is
closed again with the general starting condition present and the status signal for
a closed DC loop was issued to the binary signal input labeled PSIG: Receive
EX T. Delayed by the release time set at PSIG: Release t. send PSx the DC
loop is closed again after the general starting condition has dropped out.
When protective signaling is not ready the DC loop is open when the operating
mode is set to Transm.rel.make con. and it is closed when the operating mode is
set to Transm.rel.break con.
PSIG: PSIG:
Receive EXT Receive (signal)
[ 036 048 ] [ 037 029 ]
PSIG:
PSIG: Tripping time PSx
Ready C
[ 037 027 ] [ * ]
4
PSIG:
1: Without Trip signal
2: Phase curr. system [ 038 007 ]
3: Residual curr.system
4: Phase/resid.c.system
SCDD:
Fault P forward
[ 036 018 ]
SCDD:
Fault P backward
[ 036 019 ]
SCDD:
Ground fault forward
[ 040 037 ]
SCDD:
Ground fault backw.
[ 040 038 ]
PSIG:
Release t. send PSx
[ * ]
PSIG:
Send (signal)
[ 036 035 ]
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
[ 037 024 ]
PSIG:
Test telecom. USER
[ 015 009 ] PSIG:
DC loop op. mode PSx
[ * ]
0
1
1
0: don't execute 2
2: Transm.rel.make con.
PSIG:
Test telecom. chann.
[ 034 016 ]
PSIG:
Test telecom. EXT
[ 036 038 ]
19Z6423A
PSIG:
Release t. send PSx
[ * ]
PSIG:
Receive EXT Release time send
[ 036 048 ] + 600ms PSIG:
Telecom. faulty
MAIN: [ 036 060 ]
General starting
[ 040 000 ]
SFMON:
Telecom. faulty
[ 098 006 ]
Parameter PSIG:
Release t. send PSx
set 1 015 002
set 2 024 001
set 3 024 061
set 4 025 021
19Z5036A
ARC:
Ready
[ 004 068 ]
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
DTOC:
ARC starting I>
305 463
ARC:
HSR trip.time I>runn
303 154
ARC:
TDR trip.time I>runn
303 155
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
Terminated Terminated
ARC:
Oper. time running
[ 037 005 ]
ARC:
Dead time HSR runn.
[ 037 002 ]
ARC:
Dead time TDR runn.
[ 037 003 ]
MAIN:
Close command
[ 037 009 ]
Terminated
ARC:
Reclaim time running
[ 036 042 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
ARC:
Reclosure successful
[ 036 062 ]
MAIN:
Close cmd.pulse time [015 067 ]
ARC: Setting: 1
No. permit. TDR PSx
19Z5041A
ARC:
Operating mode PSx
[ * ]
19Z5037A
ARC:
General enable USER
[ 015 060 ]
0: No
1: Yes
ARC:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
0 Enabled
[ 015 064 ]
1
0: No
1: Yes
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
ARC:
Ext./user enabled
[ 037 013 ]
ARC:
Enable EXT
[ 037 010 ]
ARC:
Enable USER
[ 003 134 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
ARC:
Disable EXT
[ 037 011 ]
ARC:
Disable USER
[ 003 133 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
Parameter ARC:
Enable PSx
set 1 015 046
set 2 015 047
set 3 015 048
set 4 015 049
19Z5038A
ARC: ARC:
Blocking EXT Blocked
[ 036 050 ] [ 004 069 ]
ARC:
Enabled
[ 015 064 ]
MAIN:
Device on-line
[ 003 030 ]
0: No (= off) ARC:
Blocking time PSx
[ * ]
SOTF:
Bl. ARC by close cmd
305 675
MAIN: ARC:
Manual trip signal Block. time running
[ 034 017 ]
[ 037 004 ]
ARC:
Trip signal
[ 039 099 ]
Parameter ARC:
Blocking time PSx
set 1 015 058
set 2 024 032
set 3 024 092
set 4 025 052
19Z5040A
ARC:
CB clos.pos.sig. PSx
[ * ]
0: Without
1: With
MAIN:
CB closed 3p EXT
[ 036 051 ]
ARC:
Ready
[ 004 068 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
ARC:
CB drive ready EXT
[ 004 066 ]
ARC:
Not ready
ARC: [ 037 008 ]
Blocked
[ 004 069 ]
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
Parameter ARC:
CB clos.pos.sig. PSx
set 1 015 050
set 2 024 024
set 3 024 084
set 4 025 044
19Z5039A
ARC:
HSR trip.time I> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC: ARC:
ARC starting I> Trip time HSR elaps.
305 463 303 152
ARC:
HSR trip.time I>>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
ARC starting I>>
305 464
ARC:
HSRtrip.time I>>>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Starting I>>>
[ 039 075 ]
ARC:
HSRtr.time I>>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Starting I>>>>
[ 016 174 ]
ARC:
HSR trip.time IN>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
ARC starting IN>
305 465
ARC:
HSRtrip.time IN>>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
ARC starting IN>>
305 466
ARC:
HSRtrip.t. IN>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Starting IN>>>
[ 039 078 ]
ARC:
Block/reset HSR
303 104
19Z8850A
ARC:
TDR trip.time I> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC: ARC:
ARC starting I> Trip time TDR elaps.
305 463
303 153
ARC:
TDR trip.time I>>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
ARC starting I>>
305 464
ARC:
TDRtrip.time I>>>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Starting I>>>
[ 039 075 ]
ARC:
TDRtr.time I>>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Starting I>>>>
[ 016 174 ]
ARC:
TDR trip.time IN>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
ARC starting IN>
305 465
ARC:
TDRtrip.time IN>>PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
ARC starting IN>>
305 466
ARC:
TDRtrip.t. IN>>> PSx
[ * ]
DTOC:
Starting IN>>>
[ 039 078 ]
ARC:
Block/reset TDR
303 105
19Z8851A
ARC:
HSRtrip.t.Iref,P PSx
[ * ]
IDMT: ARC:
ARC Starting Iref,P> Trip time HSR elaps.
304 367 303 152
ARC:
HSRtrip.t.Iref,N PSx
[ * ]
IDMT:
ARC Starting Iref,N>
304 368
ARC:
HSRtr.t.Iref,neg PSx
[ * ]
IDMT1:
Starting Iref,neg>
[ 040 107 ]
ARC:
Block/reset HSR
303 104
ARC:
TDRtrip.t.Iref,P PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Trip time TDR elaps.
303 153
ARC:
TDRtrip.t.Iref,N PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
TDRtr.t.Iref,neg PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Block/reset TDR
303 105
set 1 015 094 015 096 015 034 015 095 015 097 015 035
set 2 024 106 024 107 024 108 024 118 024 119 024 120
set 3 024 156 024 157 024 158 024 168 024 169 024 170
set 4 025 106 025 107 025 108 025 118 025 119 025 120
12Z6230A
ARC:
Sig.asg.trip t.GFDSS
[ 015 105 ]
1: Starting LS
2: Starting Y(N)>
3: Starting LS/Y(N)>
ARC:
Starting Adm.
GFDSS: 303 170
Start.forward/LS adm
[ 016 141 ]
GFDSS:
Starting Y(N)> ARC:
[ 009 074 ] HSR trip t. adm. PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Trip time HSR elaps.
ARC: 303 152
Block/reset HSR
303 104
ARC:
TDR trip t. adm. PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Trip time TDR elaps.
303 153
ARC:
Block/reset TDR
303 105
ARC:
HSR trip t.GFDSS PSx
[*]
GFDSS:
Start.forward/LS pow
[ 016 136 ]
ARC:
TDR trip t.GFDSS PSx
[*]
ARC:
HSR trip.time GS PSx
[ * ]
ARC: ARC:
Block/reset HSR Trip time HSR elaps.
303 104 303 152
MAIN:
General starting
[ 040 000 ]
ARC:
TDR trip.time GS PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Trip time TDR elaps.
303 153
ARC:
Block/reset TDR
303 105
19Z5046A
ARC:
HSRtrip.t. LOGIC PSx
[ * ]
ARC: ARC:
Block/reset HSR Trip time HSR elaps.
303 104
303 152
ARC:
Start by LOGIC
[ 037 078 ]
ARC:
TDRtrip.t. LOGIC PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Trip time TDR elaps.
ARC: 303 153
Block/reset TDR
303 105
19Z5047A
ARC:
HSR block.f. I>>>PSx
[ * ]
1 ARC:
Block/reset HSR
303 104
0: No
1: Yes
ARC:
HSR not permitted
303 150
ARC:
TDR block.f. I>>>PSx
[ * ]
0
ARC:
1 Block/reset TDR
303 105
0: No
1: Yes
DTOC:
Starting I>>>
[ 039 075 ]
ARC:
Operating mode PSx
[ * ]
2: TDR only permitted
ARC:
Blocked
[ 004 069 ]
ARC:
TDR not permitted
303 113
19Z5048A
List parameter
LOGIC: Fct.assign m. outp. 1 (030 000) OR e.g. LOGIC: Input 04 EXT (034 003)
LOGIC: Fct.assi gnm. outp. 2 (030 004) OR LOGIC: Ou tput 01 (t) (042 033)
In general, any equation within the programmable logic function can be used to
start the ARC tripping time.
One of the options offered by the programmable logic is the triggering of the ARC
by an external protection device.
LOGIC:
Fct.assignm. outp. 1
[ 030 000 ]
LOGIC:
Op. mode t output 1
[ 030 001 ]
Signal 1 ARC:
Fct.assgn. tLOGIC
Signal 2 [ 015 033 ]
m out of n
Signal n
LOGIC: 1 out of n
Output 01
t 0
ARC:
Start by LOGIC
LOGIC: [ 037 078 ]
Output 01 (t)
LOGIC:
Fct.assignm. outp. 2
[ 030 004 ]
LOGIC:
Op. mode t output 2
[ 030 005 ]
m out of n
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
LOGIC: LOGIC:
Output 02 (t) Output 02 (t)
[ 042 035 ]
S8Z5049B
ARC: ARC:
Operating mode PSx Operative time PSx
[ * ]
[ * ]
ARC:
HSR dead time PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
TDR dead time PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
No. permit. TDR PSx
[ * ]
ARC:
Reclaim time PSx
[ * ]
ARC: ARC:
Enabled Trip signal
[ 015 064 ] [ 039 099 ]
ARC: ARC:
Ready Oper. time running
[ 004 068 ] [ 037 005 ]
ARC: ARC:
Blocked Cycle running
[ 004 069 ] [ 037 000 ]
MAIN: ARC:
General starting Dead time HSR runn.
[ 040 000 ] [ 037 002 ]
DTOC: ARC:
ARC starting I> Dead time TDR runn.
305 463 [ 037 003 ]
DTOC: ARC:
ARC starting I>> Reclaim time running
305 464 [ 036 042 ]
DTOC: ARC:
Starting I>>> (Re)close signal HSR
[ 039 075 ] [ 037 007 ]
DTOC: ARC:
ARC starting IN> (Re)close signal TDR
305 465 [ 037 006 ]
DTOC: ARC:
ARC starting IN>> Sig.interr. CB trip
305 466 [ 036 040 ]
DTOC: ARC:
Starting IN>>> Blocking trip
[ 039 078 ] [ 042 000 ]
IDMT: ARC:
ARC Starting Iref,P> (Re)close request
304 367 [ 037 077 ]
IDMT: ARC:
ARC Starting Iref,N> Close request
304 368 303 102
IDMT1: ARC:
Starting Iref,neg> HSR not permitted
303 150
[ 040 107 ]
ARC: ARC:
Starting Adm. TDR not permitted
303 170 303 113
ARC: ARC:
Start by LOGIC HSR
303 156
[ 037 078 ]
ARC: ARC:
Trip time HSR elaps. TDR
303 152 303 006
ARC:
Trip time TDR elaps.
303 153
ARC:
Test HSR A-B-C
[ 034 023 ]
ASC:
Active
305 003
ASC:
Close enable w.block
305 001
ASC:
Close enable
[ 037 083 ]
ASC:
Close rejection
[ 037 086 ]
ARC:
ARC: Close command
(Re)close request &
303 021
[ 037 077 ]
ASC:
Enabled
[ 018 024 ] &
&
ASC:
Manual close request
305 000
&
ARC:
Ready
[ 004 068 ]
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
DTOC:
ARC starting I>
305 463
ARC:
HSR trip.time I>runn
303 154
ARC:
Trip signal
[ 039 099 ]
DTOC:
Trip signal tI>
[ 041 020 ]
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
Terminated Terminated
ARC:
Oper. time running
[ 037 005 ]
ARC:
Dead time HSR runn.
[ 037 002 ]
MAIN:
Close command
[ 037 009 ]
ARC:
Reclaim time running
[ 036 042 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
ARC:
Reclosure successful
[ 036 062 ]
ARC:
Sig.interr. CB trip
[ 036 040 ]
19Z5050A
Fig. 3-188: HSR signal sequence (example shown is with ASC disabled – see also section “Joint Operation of the
ARC and ASC Functions”).
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
DTOC:
ARC starting I>
305 463
ARC:
HSR trip.time I>runn
303 154
ARC:
Trip signal
[ 039 099 ]
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
Terminated Terminated
ARC:
Oper. time running
[ 037 005 ]
ARC:
Dead time HSR runn.
[ 037 002 ]
ARC:
(Re)close request
[ 037 077 ]
Terminated
ASC:
Operat.time running
[ 037 093 ]
ASC:
Close enable
[ 037 083 ]
ASC:
Close rejection
[ 037 086 ]
MAIN:
Close command
[ 037 009 ]
ARC:
Reclaim time running
[ 036 042 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
ARC:
Reclosure successful
[ 036 062 ]
ARC:
Sig.interr. CB trip
[ 036 040 ]
19Z51BHA
Fig. 3-189: HSR signal sequence (example shown is with ASC enabled).
ARC:
Test HSR A-B-C USER
[ 011 066 ]
1 ARC:
Test HSR A-B-C
0: don't execute [ 034 023 ]
1: execute
ARC:
Test HSR A-B-C EXT
[ 037 017 ]
ARC: ARC:
Ready Reject test HSR
[ 004 068 ] [ 036 055 ]
S8Z5040A
ARC:
Ready
[ 004 068 ]
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
DTOC:
ARC starting I>
305 463
ARC:
HSR trip.time I>runn
303 154
ARC:
TDR trip.time I>runn
303 155
ARC:
Trip signal
[ 039 099 ]
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
ARC:
Oper. time running
[ 037 005 ]
ARC:
Dead time HSR runn.
[ 037 002 ]
ARC:
Dead time TDR runn.
[ 037 003 ]
MAIN:
Close command
[ 037 009 ]
Terminated Terminated
ARC:
Reclaim time running
[ 036 042 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
ARC:
Sig.interr. CB trip
[ 036 040 ]
ARC:
Reclosure successful
[ 036 062 ]
MAIN:
Close cmd.pulse time [015 067 ]
ARC: Setting: 2
No. permit. TDR PSx 19Z5051A
Fig. 3-191: Signal sequence of a failed HSR followed by a failed TDR and then by a final successful TDR (example
shown is with ASC disabled).
ARC:
ARC: + Number HSR A-B-C
(Re)close signal HSR [ 004 007 ]
[ 037 007 ]
R
ARC:
ARC: + Number TDR
(Re)close signal TDR [ 004 008 ]
[ 037 006 ]
R
ARC:
+ No. HSR successful
[ 016 198 ]
R
ARC:
+ No. HSR unsuccessful
[ 016 199 ]
R
ARC:
+ No. TDR successful
[ 016 211 ]
R
ARC:
+ No. TDR unsuccessful
[ 016 212]
R
ARC:
Reclosure successful
[ 036 062 ]
DEV03:
Control state
[ 210 118 ]
1: Open
2: Closed
ARC:
Reset counters USER
[ 003 005 ]
1
MAIN: 0: don't execute
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ] 1: execute
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
ARC:
Reset counters EXT
[ 005 244 ]
19Z8840A
Note: In this context, the voltage measured at the T90 is called "V(T90)" to avoid
mixing it up with VNG which is in most applications measured through T90.
This feature is enabled by setting ASC : Me as. V( T90 ) USER PSx to Yes, or by
configuring the parameter A SC: Meas .V( T90) E XT to some binary input, or a
communication protocol signal or programmable logic. Note, however, that in
this case it is still the responsibility of the system engineering to make sure that
the proper voltage (according to the setting ASC: M easure ment loop PS x,
see Fig. 3-194, (p. 3-258)) is indeed connected to transformer T90. Of course,
monitoring T90 instead of the three phase-to-ground voltages means to have a
single-phase-check instead of three phases.
Bus I Bus II
Line 1 Line 2
I>
I>
I>
I>
I>
I>
A B C A B C
Transformer Type T
module 4J / 4/5V
Option :
11 7 Vref T15
12 8
Current measuring
X032 inputs
1 1 IA T1
2 2
3 3 IB T2
4 4
5 5 IC T3
6 6
7 7 IN T4
8 8
47Z9314A
Fig. 3-193: Connecting the P139 measuring circuits for Synchronism Check 1.5CB application.
(If markings “P1” – “P2” and “S1” – “S2” are used for CT polarity then the dots shown here represent the “P1” and
“S1” terminals.)
ASC:
Meas.V(T90) USER PSx
[ 016 222 ]
≥1 ASC:
↗ 1: Yes Meas.V(T90) active
[ 016 240 ]
ASC:
Meas.V(T90) EXT
[ 016 221 ]
V̲(T90) 1
0⋯1 ASC:
ASC: Vmeas
Measurement loop PSx
[ * ]
V̲A-G Φ
V̲B-G
V̲C-G
+
∑
−
+
∑
−
+
∑
−
ASC:
Select. meas.loop PG
ASC:
Parameter Measurement loop PSx 1: Loop A-G
2: Loop B-G
set 1 031 060
3: Loop C-G
set 2 077 044
4: Loop A-B
set 3 078 044 5: Loop B-C
set 4 079 044 6: Loop C-A 19Z8925A
ASC:
General enable USER
[ 018 000 ]
0: No
1: Yes
ASC:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
0 ASC:
Enabled
1 [ 018 024 ]
0: No
1: Yes
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
ASC:
Ext./user enabled
[ 037 092 ]
ASC:
Enable EXT
[ 037 049 ]
ASC:
Enable USER
[ 003 136 ]
1
0: don't execute
1: execute
ASC:
Disable EXT
[ 037 061 ]
ASC:
Disable USER
[ 003 135 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
Parameter ASC:
Enable PSx
set 1 018 020
set 2 018 021
set 3 018 022
set 4 018 023
19Z5232A
signal input, then the ASC will be enabled by a positive edge of the input signal
and disabled by a negative edge. If only the ASC: Disable EXT function has
been assigned to a binary signal input, then a signal at this input will have no
effect.
If the ASC function is disabled an activation enable will always be issued.
MAIN:
M.c.b. trip V EXT
[ 004 061 ]
MAIN:
M.c.b. trip Vref EXT
[ 036 086 ]
ASC: ASC:
Blocking EXT Blocked
[ 037 048 ] [ 038 018 ]
ASC: ASC:
Enabled Ready
[ 018 024 ] [ 037 079 ]
ASC:
MAIN: Not ready
Protection active [ 037 082 ]
306 001
ASC:
Clos.rej.w.block PSx
[ * ]
ASC:
Close enable w.block
305 001
0 ASC:
Close reject.w.block
1 305 002
0: No
1: Yes
ASC:
Active for HSR PSx
[ * ]
ASC:
0 Active
305 003
1
0: No
1: Yes
ARC:
HSR
303 156
ASC:
Active for TDR PSx
[ * ]
0: No
1: Yes
ARC:
TDR
303 006
ASC:
Manual close request
305 000
19Z51BCA
ARC:
(Re)close request ASC:
[ 037 077 ] Gen. close request
306 012
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
DEV01: ASC:
Close request Manual close request
307 001
305 000
ASC:
AC effect. for DEV01
305 040
ASC:
AR close requ. USER
[ 008 238 ]
1 500ms 1
0: don't execute
1: execute
ASC:
AR Close request
[ 008 239 ]
ASC: 50ms 0
AR close request EXT 1
[ 008 236 ] 500ms
ASC: 50ms 0
Enabl.close requ.EXT
[ 037 063 ]
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ 152 xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U x4
U xx
ASC:
Test AR close r.USER
[ 008 237 ]
ASC:
Test
305 004
0
1 100ms 1 1
500ms
0: don't execute
1: execute
ASC: ASC:
Test AR close r. EXT Test AR close requ.
[ 000 106 ] [ 008 240 ]
19Z8073A
The ASC function can be triggered by ARC, via setting parameters, from an
appropriately configured binary signal input (ASC: Enabl. close requ. EXT), or
via a close request from the control function. Close requests via a setting
parameter, the binary signal input or the control function are accepted only if no
ARC cycle is running.
ARC:
(Re)close request ASC:
[ 037 077 ] Gen. close request
306 012
ARC:
Cycle running
[ 037 000 ]
DEV01: ASC:
Close request Manual close request
307 001
305 000
ASC:
AC effect. for DEV01
305 040
ASC:
MC close requ. USER
[ 018 004 ]
1 500ms 1
0: don't execute
1: execute
ASC:
MC Close request
[ 034 018 ]
ASC: 50ms 0
MC Close request EXT 1
[ 037 062 ] 500ms
ASC: 50ms 0
Enabl.close requ.EXT
[ 037 063 ]
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ 152 xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U x4
U xx
ASC:
Test MC close r.USER
[ 018 005 ]
ASC:
Test
305 004
0
1 100ms 1 1
500ms
0: don't execute
1: execute
ASC: ASC:
Test MC close r. EXT Test MC close requ.
[ 037 064 ] [ 034 019 ]
19Z8072A
The ASC operative time is started with the close request. If the close enable is
issued before the ASC operative time has elapsing, the close command is issued.
Otherwise an ASC : C l ose r ej e ction signal is generated for 100 ms.
ASC: ASC:
Cycle running Cycle running
[ 038 019 ] [ 038 019 ]
ASC: ASC:
Gen. close request Gen. close request
ASC: ASC:
Operat.time running Operat.time running
[ 037 093 ] [ 037 093 ]
① ①
ASC: ASC:
Close enable Close rejection
[ 037 083 ] [ 037 086 ]
100ms
100ms
MAIN: MAIN:
Close command Close command
[ 037 009 ] [ 037 009 ]
②
① ②
ASC: MAIN:
Parameter Operative time PSx Close cmd.pulse time
[ 015 067 ]
set 1 018 010
set 2 077 034
set 3 078 034
set 4 079 034 D5Z5073C
Fig. 3-199: Signal flow for a close enable and a close rejection.
ASC:
Operative time PSx
[ * ]
ASC:
Φ ASC:
Gen. close request Cycle running
[ 038 019 ]
ASC: ASC:
Test Close rejection
[ 037 086 ]
ASC: ASC:
Close reject.w.block Operat.time running
[ 037 093 ]
ASC:
Parameter Operative time PSx
Close enable conditions for Auto- Close enable conditions for Manual
reclose control close command
The automatic reclosure setting parameters become active when a close request
is issued by the integrated ARC (for an RRC, HSR or TDR) or by a close request
from an external ARC device sent to the binary signal input function A SC: AR
close reque st E XT.
yes yes
no no
47Z1085C_EN
Fig. 3-201: Functional sequence and close conditions for the Synchronism check.
ASC:
Meas.V(T90) active
[ 016 240 ]
ASC: &
Active
ASC:
AR op. mode PSx
[ * ] ASC:
c AR V> volt.check PSx
↗ 1: Voltage-checked ≥1 [ * ]
↗ 3: Volt./sync.-checked
V̲A-G 1V̲A-G·√3 &
V̲B-G 1V̲B-G·√3
V̲C-G 1V̲C-G·√3 0
V̲(T90) V̲(T90)⋅√3 1
0⋯1
0
ASC:
c AR V< volt.check PSx
1
[ * ]
0⋯1
&
◄
◄
ASC:
ASC:
Select. meas.loop PG
1
AR Op.mode v-chk.PSx ◄
2 [ * ]
& ≥1
V̲ref V̲ref·√3 1 1
2 &
2
&
1⋯2 3
& ≥1 &
4
&
6 &
◄
ASC:
AR tmin v-check PSx
[ * ]
t 0 1 ASC:
100ms Close enable,volt.ch
[ 037 085 ]
1 ASC:
≥1 ≥1
ARC: 100ms Close enable
HSR
[ 037 083 ]
ASC:
Close enable,sync.ch
[ 037 084 ]
ASC:
Enabled
[ 018 024 ]
set 1 018 025 026 017 018 017 018 029 018 018
set 2 018 026 077 043 077 040 018 030 077 041
set 3 018 027 078 043 078 040 018 031 078 041
set 4 018 028 079 043 079 040 018 032 079 041
19Z8980A
Depending on the operating mode selected for the voltage check, all three
phase-to-ground voltages (or – alternatively, see above – the voltage measured
at T90) need to exceed or fall below the set value in order to meet the condition
for voltage-checked closing. If the conditions corresponding to the set operating
mode for the voltage synchronism check are met, then the close enable is issued
after the set minimum time has elapsed.
The following operating modes for voltage checking can be selected separately
for each parameter subset:
● Vref but not V
● V but not Vref
● Not V and not Vref
● Not V or not Vref
● N V&Vref or V&n Vref
ASC:
Meas.V(T90) active
[ 016 240 ]
ASC: &
Active
ASC:
MC op. mode PSx
[ * ] ASC:
c MC V> volt.check PSx
↗ 1: Voltage-checked ≥1 [ * ]
↗ 3: Volt./sync.-checked
V̲A-G 1V̲A-G·√3 &
V̲B-G 1V̲B-G·√3
V̲C-G 1V̲C-G·√3 0
V̲(T90) V̲(T90)⋅√3 1
0⋯1
0
ASC:
c MC V< volt.check PSx
1
[ * ]
0⋯1
&
◄
◄
ASC:
ASC:
Select. meas.loop PG
1
MC op.mode v-chk.PSx ◄
2 [ * ]
& ≥1
V̲ref V̲ref·√3 1 1
2 &
2
&
1⋯2 3
& ≥1 &
4
&
6 &
◄
ASC:
MC tmin v-check PSx
[ * ]
t 0 1 ASC:
100ms Close enable,volt.ch
[ 037 085 ]
1 ASC:
≥1 ≥1
ARC: 100ms Close enable
HSR
[ 037 083 ]
ASC:
Close enable,sync.ch
[ 037 084 ]
ASC:
Enabled
[ 018 024 ]
set 1 000 056 000 064 000 068 000 060 000 072
set 2 000 057 000 065 000 069 000 061 000 073
set 3 000 058 000 066 000 070 000 062 000 074
set 4 000 059 000 067 000 071 000 063 000 075
19Z8981A
Fig. 3-203: Voltage-checked close enable for autoreclose control for manual close control.
ASC:
Meas.V(T90) active
[ 016 240 ]
MAIN:
Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
[ * ]
↗ 1: Low-imped. grounding
ASC: &
Active
ASC:
AR op. mode PSx
[ * ] ASC:
c AR V> sync.check PSx
↗ 2: Sync.-checked ≥1 [ * ]
↗ 3: Volt./sync.-checked
V̲A-G V̲A-G⋅√3 & & & ≥1
◄
◄
ASC: 1 ASC:
Select. meas.loop PG AR tmin sync.chk PSx
2 [ * ]
t1 t2
ASC: >
Test
ASC:
>R Volt. magnit. diff.
ASC:
c AR Delta Vmax PSx [ 004 091 ]
[ * ] ASC:
>R Frequ. difference
[ 004 090 ]
ΔVmax ASC:
ASC: >R Angle difference
Volt. sel. meas.loop [ 004 089 ]
[ 004 088 ]
MAIN:
Parameter Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
ASC:
◄
◄ c AR Delta f max PSx set 1 010 048
[ * ] set 2 001 076
c set 3 001 077
Δfmax set 4 001 078
ASC:
Parameter AR op. mode PSx
φ
set 1 018 025
◄
◄ set 2 018 026
set 3 018 027
ASC: ASC: set 4 018 028
Phi offset PSx AR Delta phi max PSx
[ * ] [ * ] ASC:
Parameter AR V> sync.check PSx
set 1 018 015 018 012 018 014 018 034 018 013
set 2 077 039 077 036 077 038 077 042 077 037
set 3 078 039 078 036 078 038 078 042 078 037
set 4 079 039 079 036 079 038 079 042 079 037
19Z8982A
Before a close enable signal is issued, the ASC checks the voltages for
synchronism. Synchronism is recognized if the following conditions are met
simultaneously:
● The three phase voltages and the reference voltage must exceed the set
threshold value.
When with a three-phase voltage the setting of MAIN: Neutr.pt. tr ea t.
PSx is Low-imped. grounding both the phase-to-ground and the phase-to-
phase voltages are checked.
If the setting is Isolated/res.ground. only the phase-to-phase voltages are
checked.
If the ASC is set to use the T90 voltage instead of the phase voltages (see
Fig. 3-194, (p. 3-258), Section 3.29.6.1, (p. 3-266)), then the voltage
measured at T90 and the reference voltage must exceed the set threshold
value.
If these conditions are met for at least the set time A SC : A R tmin s yn c.chk
PS x or AS C: MC t min sync.ch k P Sx, respectively, then a close enable signal
is issued. The ASC operating time for the determination of differences in voltage,
angle, and frequency is approximately 100 ms.
The voltage magnitude difference, angle difference, and frequency difference are
stored as measured synchronism data at the time the close request is issued. In
the event of another close request, they are automatically overwritten by the
new data.
ASC:
Meas.V(T90) active
[ 016 240 ]
MAIN:
Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
[ * ]
↗ 1: Low-imped. grounding
ASC: &
Active
ASC:
MC op. mode PSx
[ * ] ASC:
cMC V> sync.check PSx
↗ 2: Sync.-checked ≥1 [ * ]
↗ 3: Volt./sync.-checked
V̲A-G V̲A-G⋅√3 & & & ≥1
◄
◄
ASC: 1 ASC:
Select. meas.loop PG MC tmin sync.chk PSx
2 [ * ]
t1 t2
ASC: >
Test
ASC:
>R Volt. magnit. diff.
ASC:
c MC Delta Vmax PSx [ 004 091 ]
[ * ] ASC:
>R Frequ. difference
[ 004 090 ]
ΔVmax ASC:
ASC: >R Angle difference
Volt. sel. meas.loop [ 004 089 ]
[ 004 088 ]
MAIN:
Parameter Neutr.pt. treat. PSx
ASC:
◄
◄ c MC Delta f max PSx set 1 010 048
[ * ] set 2 001 076
c set 3 001 077
Δfmax set 4 001 078
ASC:
Parameter MC op. mode PSx
φ
set 1 000 056
◄
◄ set 2 000 057
set 3 000 058
ASC: ASC: set 4 000 059
Phi offset PSx MC Delta phi max PSx
[ * ] [ * ] ASC:
Parameter MC V> sync.check PSx
set 1 000 098 000 080 000 084 018 034 000 089
set 2 000 099 000 081 000 086 077 042 000 091
set 3 000 100 000 082 000 087 078 042 000 092
set 4 000 101 000 083 000 088 079 042 000 093
19Z8983A
ASC: ASC:
Cycle running Cycle running
[ 038 019 ] [ 038 019 ]
ASC: ASC:
Gen. close request Gen. close request
ASC: ASC:
Operat.time running Operat.time running
[ 037 093 ] [ 037 093 ]
① ①
ASC: ASC:
Close enable Close enable
[ 037 083 ] [ 037 083 ]
② ② ②
ASC: ASC:
Close rejection Close rejection
[ 037 086 ] [ 037 086 ]
100ms
① ②
ASC:
Parameter Operative time PSx ≥ 100 ms
set 1 018 010
set 2 077 034
set 3 078 034
set 4 079 034 19Z5230B
For test purposes a close request can be issued via a setting parameters or an
appropriately configured binary signal input (see Fig. 3-206, (p. 3-272)). In this
case no close command is issued and it is not counted.
Separate triggering parameters are available for testing the function with
parameters for manual (MC) and automatic (AR) reclosure.
The ASC cycle and the operating time are started by the test close request.
The network synchronism is checked during the whole operating time and
ASC: C lose en able is set accordingly. If at the end of the operate time no
network synchronism is registered, a 100 ms signal ASC : C lose r ejection is
issued.
3.29.8 Integrating the ASC Function into the Control and Monitoring of
Switchgear Units
ASC:
Enabled
[ 018 024 ]
ASC:
CB assignment PSx
[ * ]
No assignment
DEV01
DEV02
DEV03
DEVxx ASC:
AC effect. for DEV01
305 040
Sel. DEV01
ASC:
Close enable DEV01
305 041
ASC:
Close enable
[ 037 083 ]
ASC:
System integrat. PSx
[ * ]
2
1: Autom.synchron.check
2: Autom.synchr.control
12Z51BGB
Fig. 3-207: Integrating the ASC function into the control and monitoring of switchgear units.
ASC triggering by a close request from the control functions is also possible.
This requires that the circuit breaker is assigned to an external device and that
the ASC system integration is set to Autom.synchr.control. If the control function
issues a close request then the close command for the circuit breaker requires
the A SC : C lose e nabl e (see Section 3.46.6.6, (p. 3-421)).
However if AS C: System int e grat . P Sx is set to Autom.synchron.check ASC
will not interfere with any switching commands. Data generated and
continuously updated by the ASC function is transmitted – when configurations
have been set accordingly – to the central control station, where operators may
make decisions as to which external device is to be given a switching command.
ASC:
Transm.cycle,meas.v.
[ 101 212 ]
ASC:
Cycle running c
[ 038 019 ]
ASC:
Voltage Vref
[ 004 087 ]
ASC:
Volt. sel. meas.loop
[ 004 088 ]
ASC:
Volt. magnit. diff.
[ 004 091 ]
ASC:
Angle difference
[ 004 089 ]
ASC:
Frequ. difference
[ 004 090 ]
19Z5231B
The following measured values are obtained and calculated during an ASC cycle
and are transmitted during a set cycle time:
● Voltage from the reference voltage channel
● Voltage from the selected measuring loop
● Difference in phase voltage magnitudes
● Difference in phase angles
● Frequency difference
Outside of the ASC cycle the measured values have the status of Not measured.
ASC: >S
Manual close request 11 & >+
1 ASC:
>R No. RC aft. man.clos
>R
MAIN: [ 004 009 ]
Close command
[ 037 009 ]
ASC: >+
Gen. close request ASC:
>R No. close requests
[ 009 033 ]
ASC: >+
Close rejection ASC:
No. close rejections
[ 037 086 ] >R
[ 009 034 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
↗ 1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
ASC:
Reset counters EXT
[ 006 074 ]
ASC:
Reset counters USER
[ 003 089 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute 47Z1377B
GFDSS:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
0: No
1: Yes
GFDSS:
General enable USER
[ 016 060 ]
GFDSS:
Enabled
&
[ 042 096 ]
0
0: No
1: Yes
&
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
GFDSS:
Operating mode
[ 016 090 ]
1: Steady-state power
2: Steady-state current
3: Steady-state admitt. GFDSS:
& GF (pow.) ready
4: Power+Admitt. [ 038 026 ]
GFDSS: GFDSS:
GF (curr.) eval. EXT GF (pow.) not ready
[ 038 020 ] [ 038 027 ]
GFDSS:
& GF (curr.) ready
[ 038 028 ]
GFDSS:
GFDSS: GF (curr.) not ready
GF (pow.) block. EXT [ 038 029 ]
[ 020 227 ]
GFDSS:
GF (curr.) evaluat.
[ 039 071 ]
GFDSS:
& Admittance ready
GFDSS: [ 038 167 ]
Admittance block EXT
[ 020 226 ] GFDSS:
Admittance not ready
[ 038 168 ]
GFDSS:
& GF (pow.) ready
[ 038 026 ]
GFDSS:
GF (pow.) not ready
Parameter GFDSS: [ 038 027 ]
Enable PSx
set 1 001 050 GFDSS:
Admittance ready
set 2 001 051 [ 038 167 ]
set 3 001 052
set 4 001 053 GFDSS:
Admittance not ready
[ 038 168 ]
19Z9105A
Fig. 3-210: Enabling, disabling and readiness of the ground fault direction determination using steady-state values.
GFDSS:
Evaluation VNG PSx
[ * ]
V̲N-G 2
1
V̲A-G
V̲B-G 1 ... 2 GFDSS:
V̲NG
V̲C-G 304 150
1: Calculated
2: Measured
Parameter GFDSS:
Evaluation VNG PSx
set 1 016 083
set 2 001 011
set 3 001 012
set 4 001 013
12Z6241A
GFDSS: GFDSS:
GFDSS: VNG> PSx tVNG> PSx
GF (pow.) ready C
[ 038 026 ] [ * ] [ * ]
MAIN:
General start. int.
t 0 GFDSS:
306 539 Grd. fault power
[ 016 103 ]
GFDSS:
VNG> triggered
304 151
GFDSS:
f/fnom (power) PSx
C
[ * ]
GFDSS: GFDSS:
V̲NG V̲NG filtered
304 150 304 152
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Op.mode power PSx Meas. dir. power PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
I̲N
1 1
2 2
C C
GFDSS:
Direction LS
304 153
Q
GFDSS:
Direction BS
304 154
GFDSS:
P
304 155
GFDSS:
Q
304 156
Fig. 3-212: Direction determination with the “Steady-state power” operating mode.
VNG
BS
BS
GFDSS:
Sector angle BS PSx
GFDSS:
IN,act>/reac> BS PSx
IN
GFDSS:
IN,act>/reac> LS PSx
GFDSS:
Sector angle LS PSx
LS
LS
D5Z50BLA
Fig. 3-213: Characteristic of the ground fault direction determination using steady-state values, “cos φ” operating
mode.
VNG
BS LS
GFDSS: GFDSS:
IN,act>/reac> BS PSx IN,act>/reac> LS PSx
IN
BS LS
D5Z50BMA
Fig. 3-214: Characteristic of the ground fault direction determination using steady-state values, “sin φ” operating
mode.
GFDSS:
GF (pow.) ready
[ 038 026 ]
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Op.mode power PSx IN,act>/reac> LS PSx
[ * ] C
1, 3, 4 [ * ]
1: cos phi circuit
GFDSS:
P
304 155
IN,act 1, 3
GFDSS:
GFDSS: C IN,act>/reac> BS PSx
V̲NG filtered [ * ]
304 152
GFDSS:
Q
304 156
IN,reac 2, 4
GFDSS:
Curr. IN,reac p.u.
4 [ 004 046 ]
3 GFDSS:
Current IN,act p.u.
1 ... 2 [ 004 045 ]
GFDSS:
Direction LS
304 153
GFDSS:
Direction BS
304 154
GFDSS:
C Sector angle LS PSx
[ * ] GFDSS:
Start forw. int.
460 600
GFDSS:
C
Sector angle BS PSx
[ * ]
GFDSS:
Start backw. int.
460 601
Fig. 3-215: Output of the direction decisions with the “steady-state power” operating mode, part 1.
GFDSS:
Start.forward/LS pow
[ 016 136 ]
GFDSS:
Trp sig forw./LS pow
ARC: [ 020 228 ]
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ]
GFDSS:
Rel delay LS pow PSx
GFDSS: GFDSS: [ * ]
Hold time pow. PSx Op. delay LS pow PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
t 0
GFDSS:
t forward/LS power
GFDSS: 0
[ 016 109 ]
Start forw. int.
460 600 t
GFDSS:
Rel delay BS pow PSx
GFDSS: GFDSS: [ * ]
Hold time pow. PSx Op. delay BS pow PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
t 0
GFDSS:
t backward/BS power
GFDSS: 0
Start backw. int. [ 016 135 ]
460 601 t
GFDSS:
Start. backw. /BSpow
MAIN: [ 016 137 ]
General start. int.
306 539
GFDSS:
GF (pow.) ready
[ 038 026 ]
Fig. 3-216: Output of the direction decisions with the “steady-state power” operating mode, part 2.
GFDSS:
Admittance ready
[ 038 167 ]
GFDSS:
GF (pow.) ready
[ 038 026 ]
GFDSS:
Op. delay IN elapsed
304 157
GFDSS:
IN> triggered
304 158
GFDSS:
I̲N filtered
304 159
GFDSS:
Curr. IN filt. p.u.
[ 004 047 ]
GFDSS:
GFDSS: + No. GF (curr. meas)
Direction BS
[ 009 003 ]
304 154
R
GFDSS:
Reset counters USER
[ 003 004 ]
1 ≥1
0: don't execute
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
GFDSS:
Reset counters EXT
[ 005 245 ]
12Z61BRA
GFDSS: GFDSS:
MAIN: C VNG> PSx tVNG> PSx
General start. int. [ * ]
[ * ]
306 539
GFDSS:
Admittance ready t 0 GFDSS:
[ 038 167 ] Grd. fault adm.
[ 016 138 ]
GFDSS:
VNG> triggered
304 151
GFDSS:
V̲NG
304 150
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Oper. mode admit PSx Meas. dir. admit PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
I̲
1 1
2 2
GFDSS:
C Correction angle PSx
[ * ]
C C
GFDSS:
Direction LS
Q 304 153
GFDSS:
Direction BS
304 154
GFDSS:
P
304 155
GFDSS:
Q
304 156
Fig. 3-219: Direction determination with the “Steady-state admittance” operating mode.
been made a ground fault on the line side will issue the decision “LS” and a
ground fault on the busbar side will issue the decision “BS”. Phase-angle errors of
the system transformers can be compensated with the setting at
GFDS S: C or rect ion angle P Sx.
From version -657, the steady-state admittance mode and steady-state power
mode are in parallel. The settings (G F D S S : O p e r . m o d e a d m i t P S x,
G F D S S : M e a s . d i r . a d m i t P S x, G F D S S : O p . d e l a y L S a d m P S x,
G F D S S : R e l d e l a y L S a d m P S x, G F D S S : O p . d e l a y B S a d m P S x and
G F D S S : R e l d e l a y B S a d m P S x) are separated from steady-state power mode.
Please reconfigure these settings when converting existing (old) setting files.
VNG
BS
BS
GFDSS:
G(N)> / B(N)> BS PSx
GFDSS:
G(N)> / B(N)> LS PSx
LS
LS
19Z5059A
Fig. 3-220: Characteristic for ground fault direction determination using steady-state admittance, “cos φ” operating
mode.
VNG
BS LS
GFDSS: GFDSS:
G(N)> / B(N)> BS PSx G(N)> / B(N)> LS PSx
IN
BS LS
19Z5060A
Fig. 3-221: Characteristic for ground fault direction determination using Steady-state admittance, “sin φ” operating
mode.
GFDSS:
Admittance ready
[ 038 167 ]
GFDSS:
G(N)> / B(N)> LS PSx
C
GFDSS: [ * ]
Direction LS
304 153
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Direction BS Start.forward/LS adm
304 154
[ 016 141 ]
GFDSS:
Oper. mode admit PSx
[ * ] 1, 3, 4, 5 GFDSS:
1: cos phi circuit C G(N)> / B(N)> BS PSx
[ * ]
2, 3, 4, 5
2: sin phi circuit
GFDSS:
GFDSS: Start.backw. /BS adm
P [ 016 142 ]
304 155
G(N) 1, 3
GFDSS:
V̲NG
304 150
GFDSS:
Q
304 156
2, 4
B(N)
5
Y(N)
GFDSS:
Admitt. Y(N) p.u.
[ 004 191 ]
5
GFDSS:
Conduct. G(N) p.u.
4 [ 004 192 ]
3 GFDSS:
Suscept. B(N) p.u.
1 ... 2 [ 004 193 ]
GFDSS:
ARC: Trp sig forw./LS adm
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ] [ 020 234 ]
GFDSS: GFDSS:
GFDSS: Op. delay LS adm PSx Rel delay LS adm PSx
Hold time adm. PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
[*]
t 0 0 t GFDSS:
forward/LS adm
t [ 016 139 ]
GFDSS: GFDSS:
GFDSS: Op. delay BS adm PSx Rel delay BS adm PSx
Hold time adm. PSx [ * ] [ * ]
[*]
t 0 0 t GFDSS:
backward/BS adm
t [ 016 140 ]
MAIN:
General start. int.
306 539
GFDSS:
Admittance ready
[ 038 167 ]
Parameter GFDSS: GFDSS: GFDSS: GFDSS:
Oper. mode admit PSx G(N)> / B(N)> LS PSx G(N)> / B(N)> BS PSx Hold time adm. PSx
set 1 020 176 016 111 016 112 020 222
set 2 020 177 001 029 001 032 020 223
set 3 020 178 001 030 001 033 020 224
set 4 020 179 001 031 001 034 020 225
Fig. 3-222: Output of the direction decisions with the “Steady-state admittance” operating mode.
GFDSS:
Op.del.Y(N)> elapsed
304 175
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Oper.delay Y(N)> PSx Rel. delay Y(N)> PSx
GFDSS: GFDSS: GFDSS: [ * ] [ * ]
Admittance ready C Y(N)> PSx Hold time adm. PSx
[ 038 167 ] [ * ] [ * ]
t 0 0 t GFDSS:
Y(N) Non-dir. sig. Y(N)>
t
[ 009 075 ]
GFDSS:
Admittance ready
[ 038 167 ] GFDSS:
Trip signal Y(N)>
[ 009 072 ]
ARC:
Blocking trip
[ 042 000 ] GFDSS:
Starting Y(N)>
[ 009 074 ]
The admittance value from the ground return is used for evaluation. If the
admittance value exceeds the set threshold a ground fault signal is issued after
the settable operate delay has elapsed.
The trip signal from the non-directional ground fault determination is blocked by
the auto-reclosing control function (ARC) when this function is able to issue a trip
command.
GFDSS:
GFDSS: + No. GF admitt. Y(N)
Op.del.Y(N)> elapsed
[ 009 060 ]
304 175
R
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Grd. fault pow./adm. + No. GF power/admitt.
[ 009 037 ] [ 009 002 ]
R
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Direct. forward/LS + No. GF forward/LS
[ 009 035 ] [ 009 000 ]
R
GFDSS: GFDSS:
Direct. backward/BS + No. GF backward/BS
[ 009 036 ] [ 009 001 ]
R
GFDSS:
Reset counters USER
[ 003 004 ]
1 ≥1
MAIN: 0: don't execute
General reset USER 1: execute
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
GFDSS:
Reset counters EXT
[ 005 245 ]
12Z6191B
The number of ground faults and directional decisions are counted. The counters
may be reset individually or together with other counters (see Section 3.12.21,
(p. 3-133)).
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
TGFD:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
1
0: No
1: Yes
TGFD:
General enable USER
[ 016 040 ]
0 TGFD:
Enabled
1 [ 037 100 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Nominal frequ. fnom
[ 010 030 ]
50: 50 Hz
SFMON:
Fcts.not perm.f.60Hz
60: 60 Hz
[ 093 098 ]
TGFD:
Ready
[ 037 080 ]
TGFD:
Blocking EXT
[ 004 034 ]
TGFD:
Direct. determined
[ 004 030 ]
SFMON:
TGFD mon. triggered
[ 093 094 ]
TGFD:
Not ready
[ 037 081 ]
SFMON:
Module N DPR faulty TGFD:
[ 093 090 ] Hardware fault
304 207
SFMON:
Module N RAM faulty
[ 093 091 ]
SFMON:
Time-out module N
[ 093 092 ]
SFMON:
Invalid SW vers. N
[ 093 093 ]
SFMON:
DAC faulty module N Parameter TGFD:
[ 093 095 ] Enable PSx
SFMON: set 1 001 054
+15V faulty mod. N
[ 093 096 ] set 2 001 055
SFMON: set 3 001 056
-15V faulty mod. N set 4 001 057
[ 093 097 ]
12Z6282A
Fig. 3-225: Enabling, disabling and readiness of the transient ground fault detection function.
TGFD:
Evaluation VNG PSx
[ * ]
V̲N-G 2
1
V̲A-G
V̲B-G 1 ... 2 TGFD:
V̲NG
V̲C-G 304 200
1: Calculated
2: Measured
Parameter TGFD:
Evaluation VNG PSx
TGFD:
Hardware fault
304 207
TGFD:
TGFD: C IN,p> PSx
Ready
[ 037 080 ] [ * ]
I̲N TGFD:
IN,p triggered
304 201
TGFD:
VNG> PSx TGFD:
[ * ] Operate delay PSx
[ * ]
TGFD:
TGFD: Ground fault
V̲NG [ 004 033 ]
304 200
C TGFD:
VNG> (f0) triggered
304 202
TGFD:
VNG> triggered
304 203
S1 1
R1
S1 1
R1
S1 1
R1
TGFD:
Measurem. direc. PSx
[ * ]
TGFD:
1 Direction LS
304 204
1 TGFD:
Direction BS
2 304 205
1: Standard
2: Opposite
Directional decisions are output for the duration of the set buffer time. If buffer
time is set to 0 s, directional decisions are output until the neutral-point
displacement voltage's fundamental component no longer exceeds the trigger
threshold set at TGFD : V NG> P Sx.
If buffer time is set to blocked, directional decisions are stored until (manual)
reset through TGFD: Re s et si gnal USE R or TGF D: Re set signal EX T.
TGFD:
Hardware fault
304 207
TGFD:
Buffer time PSx
[ * ]
TGFD:
Forward / LS
TGFD: 1 [ 004 031 ]
Direction LS
R
304 204
TGFD:
TGFD: 1 Backward / BS
Direction BS [ 004 032 ]
304 205 R
TGFD:
VNG> (f0) triggered
304 202
S1 1
R1 Parameter TGFD:
Buffer time PSx
S1 1 set 1 016 043
set 2 001 070
R1
set 3 001 071
set 4 001 072
12Z62EVA
TGFD:
Reset signal USER
[ 003 009 ]
100 ms TGFD:
1 ≥1 Signals reset
[ 004 141 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
TGFD:
Reset signal EXT
[ 004 140 ]
MAIN: TGFD:
General reset USER ≥1 Reset signal
[ 003 002 ] 304 206
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
12Z61EWA
65 s 0
TGFD: SFMON:
30 ms TGFD mon. triggered
IN,p triggered &
304 201
[ 093 094 ]
TGFD:
VNG> triggered
304 203
TGFD:
VNG> (f0) triggered &
304 202
TGFD:
Ready
[ 037 080 ]
MT_RC:
Reset record. USER
[ 003 008 ]
1: execute
MT_RC:
Reset record. EXT
[ 005 240 ]
12Z61EXC
TGFD: TGFD:
Ground fault + No. GF
[ 004 033 ] [ 004 015 ]
R
TGFD: TGFD:
Forward / LS + No. GF forward/LS
[ 004 031 ] [ 004 013 ]
R
TGFD: TGFD:
Backward / BS + No. GF backward/BS
[ 004 032 ] [ 004 014 ]
R
TGFD:
Reset counters USER
[ 003 022 ]
1 ≥1
MAIN: 0: don't execute
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ] 1: execute
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
TGFD:
Reset counters EXT
[ 005 246 ]
12Z61EYA
MP:
General enable USER
[ 017 059 ]
0
MP:
1 Enabled
[ 040 115 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MP:
Enable PSx
[ * ] Parameter MP:
Enable PSx
set 1 024 148
0
set 2 024 147
1 set 3 024 197
set 4 025 147
0: No
1: Yes
19Z5073A
MP:
Enabled
[ 040 115 ]
MAIN: MP:
Protection active Iref PSx
306 001
[ * ]
I̲A
MP:
Factor kP PSx
I̲B [ * ]
I̲C
MP:
I̲max IP,max r.m.s./Iref IP,max r.m.s./Iref
304 740
Iref⋅kP
MP:
Operating mode PSx
[ * ]
MP:
0 Starting k*Iref>
[ 041 057 ]
1
0: Without THERM
1: With THERM
MP:
St. kP⋅Iref>/Istup>
304 703
MP:
Istup>
304 702
19Z5074A
● Mapping of heating:
Basically the overload memory is continuously incremented when the
maximum RMS phase current value measured will have exceeded the
threshold value of kP·Iref (overload range). The rate of this increase of the
storing value depends on the magnitude of the maximum RMS phase
current value and, to a certain extent, on the selected tripping
characteristic (MP: Ch ar acte r.type P PSx).
● Mapping of heat transfer:
After a startup has been identified and the maximum RMS phase current
value has fallen below the current threshold of 0.6·IStUp> (load range), then
the stored value is continuously and automatically pre-decreased, governed
by the settable heat dispersion time constant MP: Tau aft er s t. -up PSx
of the overload memory. This time constant is used to map the heat
transfer in the asynchronous motor from the copper of the rotor to the
rotor’s iron core. This continuous pre-decreasing of the stored value is
carried out linearly up to the minimum value stored after initial startup
(mentioned above) and depending on the count of the startup frequency
monitor. The rate for this pre-decreasing of the stored value is constant and
ranges at about 40% of the discharge (τ after startup = 20) within a time
duration of 60 s, for example.
● Mapping of cooling:
When the measured maximum RMS phase current value has fallen below
the current threshold of IkIref,P> and when the mapping of heat transfer, if
applicable, has been completed, then cooling of the protected object is
simulated by a continuous decreasing of the value stored in the overload
memory. If the machine is running, decreasing of the stored value will be
governed by the cooling time constant MP : Tau mach. runnin g P Sx and
will continue until the minimum loading state of 20% is reached. If the
machine is stopped, decreasing of the stored value will be governed by the
constant MP : Tau mach.s toppe d PSx and will continue until the
minimum loading state of 0% is reached. Decreasing of the stored value is
an exponential function of time. The cooling time duration from an initial
value m0 to an interim value of m(t) can be determined as follows:
● Machine running:
m0 - 0.2
t = τrotating machine · ln m(t ) - 0.2
● Machine stopped:
m0
t = τmachine stopped · ln m(t)
m in % Overload memory
100
80
60
40
20
t
S8Z5054B
● Logarithmic:
(I / I ref)2
t= (1 - m0) · t6I · 36 · ln
ref (I / I ref)2 - 1
where m0 in each case signifies the pre-charging of the overload memory at time
t = 0. With reference to the basic physical model (two-body model), the
logarithmic characteristic in the overload range also takes into account heat
transfer to the coolant, but this heat transfer becomes less significant as the
overcurrent increases. At I = 6·Iref, for example, the tripping time increase is only
about 1.4% and is thus below the specified accuracy of the protection device. For
a low overcurrent range, selection of the logarithmic characteristic provides
significantly higher tripping times than selection of the reciprocally squared
characteristic (see Fig. 3-236, (p. 3-306)), since the latter characteristic neglects
any heat transfer to the cooling medium in the overload range. The possibility of
choosing between two different tripping time characteristics takes into account
the fact that the user or the application may require a more restrictive or a less
restrictive type of protection. For currents in excess of 10 Iref, the tripping times
are limited in the direction of lower values.
The equation for determining the setting value t6Iref can be derived from the
above equations for tripping time t. For this the startup current Istartup and the
maximum permissible blocking time from cold tblock,cold for the asynchronous
motor must be known. Setting the overload protection function on the basis of
the “cold” tripping time where m0 = 0 % (“cold curve”) is permitted since the
conditions for a machine at operating temperature are automatically taken into
account. The conditional equations for the setting value t6Iref are therefore the
following:
● Reciprocally squared:
(I startup / I ref)2
t6I = tblock,cold · 36
ref
● Logarithmic:
1
t6I = tblock,cold ·
ref (I startup / I ref)2
36 · ln
(I startup / I ref)2 - 1
t in s
Startup
Overload
Load
Logarithmic
Reciprocally squared
S8Z5053A
10000
1000
100
t / s
10
0.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
I / IB
S8Z50D 6A
Fig. 3-236: Tripping characteristic of motor protection (at I/Iref = 2.5 we have m=0.2, at I/Iref > 2.5 we have m=0).
3.32.4.1 Logic Function for the Operating Mode with Thermal Overload
Protection (THERM)
For particular applications, the machine may be operated in the overload range
for a longer period of time. In such cases the motor protection function (MP) is
too restrictive. For such applications the MP and THERM protection functions are
combined. The MP protection function then serves as rotor protection and the
THERM protection function as stator protection.
When MP: Ope rati ng m ode P Sx is set to With THERM, the overload memory
will be incremented when the maximum RMS phase current is above the current
threshold set at MP: IStU p> PSx. If this threshold is not exceeded, the stored
value in the memory after a startup will initially be decremented until the
mapping of the heat transfer from the copper of the rotor to the rotor core is
complete. Thereafter, the value stored in the overload memory will remain
constant and the thermal model of the thermal overload protection function
(THERM) will become active. With the onset of another startup of the
asynchronous motor (not the first startup), the thermal model of the THERM
protection function will be temporarily blocked during the startup time.
1000
100
t / s 10
0.1
1 3 5 7 9 11
I / Iref
Fig. 3-237: Tripping characteristic of motor protection with operating mode With THERM (“cold” characteristic).
MP:
Therm.repl.block EXT
[ 040 044 ]
MP:
Character.type P PSx
[ * ]
Setting Setting
MP:
MP: MP: t6Iref PSx
Character.type P PSx Perm. No.st.-ups PSx [ * ]
MP:
Tau mach.running PSx
MP: [ * ]
St. kP⋅Iref>/Istup>
304 703
MP:
Tau mach.stopped PSx
[ * ]
MP:
IP,max r.m.s./Iref
304 740
MP:
Perm. No.st.-ups PSx
[ * ]
< 0.1⋅Iref
MAIN: MP:
Protection active RC permitted, Θ< PSx
306 001
[ * ]
Memory = 100%
With heavy starting
MP:
Speed monitor n> EXT Machine running
[ 040 045 ] With heavy starting
MP:
Reset therm. replica
[ 041 083 ]
MP:
Startup
[ 040 119 ]
MP:
sequence control Block. replica THERM
304 700
Not dur. 1st startup
MP:
Machine stopped
304 701
MP:
Istup>
304 702
MP: MP:
Startup + No. of start-ups
[ 040 119 ] [ 004 011 ]
R
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
12Z6231A
MP:
Reset replica USER
[ 022 073 ]
0
MP:
1 Reset therm. replica
[ 041 083 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
MP:
Reset replica EXT
[ 041 082 ]
MP:
Enabled
[ 040 115 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
19Z5077A
MP:
I< PSx
[ * ] MP:
tI< PSx
[ * ]
MP:
IP,max r.m.s./Iref
304 740 MP:
tI< elapsed
[ 040 047 ]
MP:
Machine stopped
304 701
19Z5078A
General
The P139 was subjected to risk analysis based on the DIN V 19 250 standard of
May 1994 (on basic safety considerations for measuring and protection relays) as
well as DIN V 19 251 of February 1995 (on measuring and protection relays,
specifications and measures for their fail-safe functioning) and owing to a lack of
more specific standards also based on DIN V VDE 0801 (on computers in safety
systems).
Based on this risk analysis involving the examination of extensive measures for
prevention and management of malfunction, the P139 has been classified in
specifications class 3. According to NAMUR NE 31 (NAMUR: German committee
on standards for measuring and control engineering), specifications class 3
corresponds to risk area 1. For this risk area, a protection device of single-
channel design with alarm signal and/or normally-energized arrangement
(“closed-circuit principle”) will normally suffice. In special cases, a requirement
for a higher specifications class can be met by a customized “1 out of 2” or “2
out of 3” circuit.
By connection and configuration of the output relay MAI N: Block ed/fault y, the
increased-safety machine can be switched off immediately or, alternatively, an
alarm signal can be given for delayed switch-off based on an assessment of the
operational conditions by trained staff.
During startup of the P139 and during its operation, cyclic self-monitoring tests
are run. In the event of a positive test result, a specified monitoring signal will be
issued and stored in a non-volatile (NV) memory – the monitoring signal memory
(see Chapter 11, (p. 11-1)). Monitoring signals prompted by a serious
hardware or software fault in the unit are always entered in the monitoring signal
memory. The entry of monitoring signals of lesser significance into the
monitoring signal memory is optional. The user can select this option by setting a
“m out of n” parameter.
The blocking of the protection device is governed by similar principles, that is,
signals prompted by a serious hardware or software fault in the unit always lead
to a blocking of the unit. The assignment of signals of lesser significance to the
signal MAI N: Fct . assi gn . fau lt by an “m out of n” parameter
(MAIN : Blocke d/faul ty) is optional.
K 908 OU TP: Fct . assignm. 150 214 Par/Conf MAIN: Fct. assign.
K 908 fau lt
z.B. K 901 OU TP: Fct . assignm. 150 193 Par/Conf SFMON: Warni ng
K 901 ( re lay)
THERM:
General enable USER
[ 022 050 ]
0
THERM:
1 & Enabled
[ 040 068 ]
0: No
1: Yes
THERM:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
0: No
1: Yes y PSU: Parameter THERM:
PS y active Enable PSx
19Z6112B
COMP
THERM:
Select current PSx
I̲max [ * ]
∑
0
I̲A +
1
I̲B +
+ 2
I̲C
0 ... 2 AR_MV THERM:
I
I̲N
0: Max. phase current
1: IN calculated
2: IN measured
THERM:
Parameter Select current PSx
A setting specifies which current will be used by the P139 for the Thermal
Overload Protection: either the maximum RMS phase current, or the residual
current calculated from the three phase currents or the residual current directly
measured at the fourth current transformer (T 4).
The thermal model uses these signals as a criterion to determine a fault in the
coolant temperature measurement. A fault at both measured value inputs
selected will lead to the issuance of the signal TH ER M: C TA e rror.
The setting for THERM: F unct.f .CTA fail .P Sx determines how the thermal
overload protection is to continue functioning when the coolant temperature
measurement has failed. The following functions can be selected to guarantee
continued and stable performance of the thermal overload protection when the
coolant temperature measurement has failed.
● Default temperature value:
The coolant temperature set at THERM: De fau lt CTA PSx is applied.
The thermal overload protection function is not blocked.
As a rule there is an erratic change of the measured value when a fault has
occurred in the coolant temperature measurement. The temperature
measured before such an erratic change is stored and applied. The thermal
overload protection function is not blocked.
● Last measured temperature:
The coolant temperature set at TH ERM: De fault CTA PSx is applied if no
last measured values are available because a device warm restart or a
parameter subset selection was carried out.
● Blocking:
The signals THERM : Warn ing and TH ERM: Trip s ignal are reset and
blocked. The thermal model will then be continued and displayed on the
basis of the measured current alone. All further measured values are issued
as Not measured.
All parameters relevant to coolant temperature (ambient) acquisition are hidden
if the analog module Y has not been fitted in the P139. The tripping time is
calculated by including the setting for THERM: De fault C TA PSx.
THERM:
Select meas.inputPSx
[ * ]
0: None
1: PT100
2: 20mA input
3: T1
n: Tx
&
MEASI: 11: T9
Open circ. PT100
[ 040 190 ]
MEASI:
Overload 20mA input
>1 &
[ 040 191 ]
MEASI: &
Open circ. 20mA inp.
[ 040 192 ] &
MEASI:
Open circ. Ty
[ * ]
THERM:
Sel. backup th. PSx
[ * ]
THERM:
With CTA
0
& 305 201
n
0: None
1: PT100
2: 20mA input
3: T1
THERM:
n: Ty & CTA error
11: T9 & [ 039 111 ]
&
THERM:
CTA error EXT
[ 038 062 ]
THERM:
Funct.f.CTA fail.PSx
[ * ]
2
& THERM:
Block. by CTA error
3 305 200
Tx, Ty
set 1 072 177 072 080 076 177 MEASI: 040 219 MEASI: 040 252
Open circ. T7 Open circ. T8
set 2 073 177 073 080 077 177
set 3 074 177 074 200 078 177 MEASI: 040 253
Open circ. T9
set 4 075 177 075 200 079 177
19Z6110B
The maximum permitted coolant temperature Θc,max is derived from the difference
between the T H E R M : M a x . p e r m . o b j . t m p . P S x and T H E R M : O / T f . I r e f p e r s .
P S x settings.
Θ/%
10000
1000
τ / min
100
200
10 110 1000
50
t / min
1
200
110
30
50
0.1
200
110
0.01
50 1
0.001
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
I / I ref
D5Z50BEB_EN
Fig. 3-244: Tripping characteristics of thermal overload protection (tripping characteristics apply to ΔϑP = 0 % and
identical settings for the maximum permissible coolant temperature and coolant temperature).
The selected current (THERM: I, see Section 3.33.2, (p. 3-316)) is used to track a
first-order thermal replica as specified in IEC 255-8. Other than the operating
mode dependent settings the following parameters will govern the tripping time:
● The set thermal time constant τ of the protected object,
THERM: Tim.con st.1, >Ibl PSx
● The accumulated thermal load Δϑ0
● The current measured coolant temperature Θc
● If the value of the selected current (THERM: I) is greater than 10·Iref then
only the fixed maximum value 10·Iref is used for calculating the tripping
time.
The tripping threshold in the two operating modes is calculated as follows:
I
(I )2 - Δϑ0
ref
t = τ · ln Θa - Θa,max
I
(I )2 - Δϑtrip · (1 - Θ )
ref max - Θa,max
The Δϑtrip tripping threshold is set to a fixed value of 100% if the operating mode
is Absolute replica.
3.33.10 Trip
THERM:
I
305 202
MAIN:
Protection active & c
306 001
THERM:
Enabled
[ 040 068 ]
THERM:
Starting k*Iref>
THERM: [ 041 108 ]
Block replica EXT
[ 041 074 ]
THERM:
Block. by CTA error & c
305 200
THERM:
Tim.const.1,>Ibl PSx
c [ * ]
THERM: THERM:
Iref PSx Tim.const.2,<Ibl PSx
[ * ] <0.1 Iref c
[ * ]
THERM: THERM:
Start.fact.OL_RC PSx O/T f.Iref pers. PSx
[ * ] c [ * ]
THERM:
k·Iref c Warning temp. PSx
[ * ]
THERM:
c Max.perm.obj.tmp.PSx
THERM: [ * ]
Absolute replica
[ 022 065 ] THERM:
c Max.perm.cool.tmpPSx
[ * ]
0 THERM: THERM:
c Rel. O/T warning PSx Within pre-trip time
[ * ]
1 [ 041 109 ]
THERM:
0: No Rel. O/T trip PSx SFMON:
c [ * ] Setting error THERM
1: Yes [ 098 035 ]
THERM:
c Default CTA PSx THERM:
[ * ] Setting error,block.
THERM: THERM: [ 039 110 ]
Relative replica Hysteresis trip PSx THERM:
[ 022 064 ] [ * ] Warning
THERM: [ 039 025 ]
0 Warning pre-trip PSx THERM:
[ * ] Trip signal
1 [ 039 020 ]
THERM:
0: No Buffer empty
1: Yes [ 039 112 ]
THERM:
THERM: Status THERM replica
With CTA c [ 004 016 ]
305 201
R THERM:
Coolant temperature I/Iref Object temperature
[ 004 137 ]
THERM: THERM:
Reset replica Coolant temperature
[ 039 061 ] [ 004 149 ]
c THERM:
Pre-trip time left
[ 004 139 ]
THERM:
Temp. offset replica
[ 004 109 ]
THERM:
Coolant temp. p.u.
Parameter THERM: THERM: THERM:
Iref PSx Start.fact.OL_RC PSx Tim.const.1,>Ibl PSx [ 004 178 ]
THERM:
set 1 072 179 072 180 072 187 Object temp. p.u.
set 2 073 179 073 180 073 187 [ 004 179 ]
set 3 074 179 074 180 074 187 THERM:
set 4 075 179 075 180 075 187 Therm. replica p.u.
[ 004 017 ]
Parameter THERM: THERM: THERM: THERM: THERM:
Tim.const.2,<Ibl PSx O/T f.Iref pers. PSx Warning temp. PSx Max.perm.obj.tmp.PSx Current I,therm prim
set 1 072 188 072 167 072 153 072 182 [ 007 220 ]
set 2 073 188 073 167 073 153 073 182 THERM:
Current I,therm p.u
set 3 074 188 074 167 074 153 074 182
[ 007 221 ]
set 4 075 188 075 167 075 153 075 182
set 1 072 185 072 184 072 181 072 186 072 183 072 191
set 2 073 185 073 184 073 181 073 186 073 183 073 191
set 3 074 185 074 184 074 181 074 186 074 183 074 191
set 4 075 185 075 184 075 181 075 186 075 183 075 191 47Z8842A
The trip threshold is set according to the selected operating mode with the
following parameters:
● Relative replica: THERM: Re l. O/T tri p PSx
● Absolute replica: TH ERM: Max. pe rm.obj. tmp.PSx
If a trip command is issued, the trip signal is maintained until the status of the
thermal replica has decreased by the value set at THER M: Hy st ere sis t rip
PSx, at least for a fixed time of 5 s.
3.33.11 Cooling
If the current falls below the default threshold of 0.1 Iref, the thermal replica is
applied with the time constant set at THERM: Tim .cons t. 2,<I bl PSx. This
element in the thermal model takes account of the cooling characteristics of
stopped motors.
3.33.13 Resetting
The thermal replica may be reset either via a setting parameter or via an
appropriately configured binary signal input. Resetting is possible even when
thermal overload protection is disabled. Thermal overload protection can be
blocked via an appropriately configured binary signal input.
THERM:
Reset replica USER
[ 022 061 ]
0
THERM:
1 Reset replica
[ 039 061 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
THERM:
Enabled
[ 040 068 ]
THERM:
Reset replica EXT
[ 038 061 ]
Q9Z5020A
I2>:
General enable USER
[ 018 090 ]
0
I2>:
1 Enabled
[040 073 ]
0: No
1: Yes
I2>:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
0: No
1: Yes
Parameter I2>:
Enable PSx
set 1 018 220
set 2 018 221
set 3 018 222
set 4 018 223
19Z5082A
I2>:
Blocking tIneg> EXT
[ 041 076 ]
I2>:
Blocking tIneg>> EXT
[ 041 077 ]
I2>:
Enabled
&
[ 040 073 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
I2>: & C
I2>: I2>:
Blocking EXT Ineg> PSx tIneg> PSx
[ 035 100 ] [ * ] [ * ]
t 0 I2>:
>0.1 Inom |I̲neg|/Inom tIneg> elapsed
[ 035 033 ]
I2>:
Starting Ineg>
I̲A [ 035 024 ]
I̲B
I2>: I2>:
I̲C Ineg>> PSx tIneg>> PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
I2>:
MAIN: tIneg>> elapsed
Phase sequence
[ 035 034 ]
[ 010 049 ]
I2>:
Starting Ineg>>
[ 035 025 ]
I̲neg
19Z5083B
V<>:
General enable USER
[ 023 030 ]
0: No
1: Yes
V<>:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Enabled
0 [ 040 066 ]
0: No
V<>:
1: Yes Ready
[ 042 003 ]
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty V<>:
[ 038 023 ] Not ready
[ 042 004 ]
Parameter V<>:
Enable PSx
set 1 076 246
set 2 077 246
set 3 078 246
set 4 079 246
19Z5085A
V<>:
Op. mode V< mon. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
0 V< ready
460 506
1
0: Without
1: With
V<>:
I enable V< PSx
[ * ]
I̲A
I̲B
I̲C
V<>:
Operating mode PSx
[ * ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
V<>:
Ready
[ 042 003 ]
fnom
V̲A-G
V̲B-G
fnom 1
V̲C-G
fnom
fnom
VA-G √3
fnom
2
VB-G √3
fnom
VC-G √3
1V̲A(-B)
1 2 1V̲B(-C)
1V̲C(-A)
1: Delta
2: Star
Parameter V<>:
Operating mode PSx
set 1 076 001
set 2 077 001
set 3 078 001
set 4 079 001
47Z0147A
V<>:
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tV> PSx
V<>: [ * ]
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V> PSx
[ * ]
1V̲A(-B) V<>:
tV> elapsed
[ 041 034 ]
1V̲B(-C)
1V̲C(-A) V<>:
Starting V>
[ 041 030 ]
V<>:
tV> 3-pole PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Blocking tV> EXT
[ 041 068 ]
V<>:
tV> 3-pole elapsed
[ 041 098 ]
V<>:
Starting V> 3-pole
[ 041 097 ]
V<>:
tV>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tV>> elapsed
[ 041 035 ]
V<>:
Starting V>>
[ 041 096 ]
V<>:
tV>> 3-pole PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Blocking tV>> EXT
[ 041 069 ]
V<>:
tV>> 3-pole elapsed
[ 010 227 ]
V<>:
Starting V>>>
[ 010 231 ]
V<>:
Starting V>/>> A(-B)
[ 041 031 ]
V<>:
Starting V>/>> B(-C)
[ 041 032 ]
V<>:
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tV>>> PSx
V<>: [ * ]
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V>>> PSx
[ * ]
1V̲A(-B) V<>:
tV>>> elapsed
1V̲B(-C) [ 010 233 ]
1V̲C(-A) V<>:
Starting V>>>
[ 010 231 ]
V<>:
tV>>> 3-pole PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Blocking tV>>> EXT
[ 010 246 ]
V<>:
tV>>> 3-pole elapsed
[ 010 234 ]
V<>:
Starting V>>> 3-pole
[ 010 232 ]
V<>:
Blocking tV< EXT
V<>:
[ 041 070 ] tV< PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V< ready
V<>:
tV< elapsed
V<>: [ 041 041 ]
V< PSx
[ * ]
Setting(s) blocked
1V̲A(-B) V<>:
Starting V<
1V̲B(-C) [ 041 037 ]
V<>:
tV< 3-pole PSx
1V̲C(-A) [ * ] V<>:
Fault V<
[ 041 110 ]
V<>:
tV< 3-pole elapsed
[ 042 006 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Starting V< 3-pole
V<>: [ 042 005 ]
tV<< PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Fault V< 3-pole
[ 041 111 ]
V<>:
V<< PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tV<< elapsed
[ 041 042 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Starting V<<
[ 041 099 ]
V<>: V<>:
tV<< 3-pole PSx Fault V<<
[ * ] [ 041 112 ]
V<>:
Blocking tV<< EXT
[ 041 071 ]
V<>:
tV>> 3-pole elapsed
[ 010 227 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>: V<>:
tV< elaps. transient Starting V<< 3-pole
[ 042 023 ] [ 010 228 ]
V<>:
tV< 3p elaps. trans.
[ 042 024 ]
V<>:
tV<< elapsed trans. V<>:
[ 042 025 ] Fault V<< 3-pole
[ 011 132 ]
V<>:
tV<< 3p elaps. trans
[ 010 230 ] V<>:
Starting V</<< A(-B)
[ 041 038 ]
V<>:
Parameter V<>: Starting V</<< B(-C)
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx [ 041 039 ]
set 1 076 048 V<>:
set 2 077 048 Starting V</<< C(-A)
[ 041 040 ]
set 3 078 048
set 4 079 048
Fig. 3-254: Undervoltage monitoring, Part 1: stages V< and V<<. (Transient pulse: See following diagram.)
V<>:
Blocking tV<<< EXT
V<>:
[ 010 247 ] tV<<< PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Hyst. V<> meas. PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V< ready
V<>:
tV<<< elapsed
V<>: [ 010 237 ]
V<<< PSx
[ * ]
Setting(s) blocked
1V̲A(-B) V<>:
Starting V<<<
1V̲B(-C) [ 010 235 ]
V<>:
tV<<< 3-pole PSx
1V̲C(-A) [ * ] V<>:
Fault V<<<
[ 011 134]
V<>:
tV<<< 3-pole elapsed
[ 010 239 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Starting V<<< 3-pole
[ 010 236 ]
V<>:
Fault V<<< 3-pole
[ 011 133 ]
V<>:
tTransient pulse PSx V<>:
tTransient pulse PSx
[ * ]
[ * ]
V<>: V<>:
tV< elapsed tV< elaps. transient
[ 041 041 ] [ 042 023 ]
V<>: V<>:
tV< 3-pole elapsed tV< 3p elaps. trans.
[ 042 006 ] [ 042 024 ]
V<>: V<>:
tV<< elapsed tV<< elapsed trans.
[ 041 042 ] [ 042 025 ]
V<>:
tV<< elapsed V<>:
[ 041 042 ] tV<< 3p elaps. trans
[ 010 230 ]
V<>:
tV<<< elaps. trans.
[ 010 238 ]
V<>:
tV<<< 3p elaps.trans
[ 010 240]
V<>:
tV</<</<<< el.trans
[ 042 007 ]
19Z8094A
Fig. 3-255: Undervoltage monitoring, Part 2: stage V<<< and transient pulse for stages V</<</<<<.
MAIN:
Phase sequence
[ 010 049 ]
MAIN:
Protection active & C
306 001
V<>:
Ready
[ 042 003 ]
fnom
V̲A-G V<>:
V̲pos
305 250
fnom
V̲B-G V̲pos
fnom
V̲C-G
V̲neg V<>:
V̲neg
305 251
D5Z50AYB
Fig. 3-256: Determination of positive- and negative-sequence voltages. (Note: The previous terminology for
MAIN: Phase sequence was MAIN: Rotary field.)
V<>: V<>:
Blocking tVpos> EXT Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx
[ 041 090 ] [ * ]
V<>: V<>:
Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx tVpos> PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
V<>:
Vpos> PSx
[ * ]
V<>: V<>:
V̲pos tVpos> elapsed
305 250 [ 042 012 ]
V<>:
Starting Vpos>
V<>:
Blocking tVpos>> EXT [ 042 010 ]
[ 041 091 ]
V<>:
tVpos>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Vpos>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tVpos>> elapsed
[ 042 013 ]
V<>:
Starting Vpos>>
V<>:
Blocking tVpos< EXT [ 042 011 ]
[ 041 092 ] V<>:
tVpos< PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V< ready
460 506
V<>: V<>:
Vpos< PSx tVpos< elapsed
[ * ] [ 042 016 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Starting Vpos<
[ 042 014 ]
V<>:
tVpos<< PSx
V<>: [ * ]
Blocking tVpos<< EXT V<>:
[ 041 093 ] Fault Vpos<
[ 041 113 ]
V<>:
tVpos<< elapsed
[ 042 017 ]
V<>:
Vpos<< PSx
[ * ] Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Starting Vpos<<
[ 042 015 ]
V<>:
Fault Vpos<<
[ 041 114 ]
V<>:
tTransient pulse PSx
[ * ] V<>:
Parameter V<>: V<>: tVpos< elaps. trans.
Vpos> PSx tVpos> PSx [ 042 026 ]
set 1 076 015 076 017
set 2 077 015 077 017 V<>:
tVpos<< elaps.trans.
set 3 078 015 078 017 [ 042 027 ]
set 4 079 015 079 017
19Z80AZA
V<>:
Blocking tVneg> EXT
[ 041 094 ]
V<>:
V<>: tVneg> PSx
Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx [ * ]
[ * ]
V<>:
Vneg> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
V<>: tVneg> elapsed
V̲neg
305 251 [ 042 021 ]
V<>: V<>:
Blocking tVneg>> EXT Starting Vneg>
[ 041 095 ] [ 042 019 ]
V<>:
tVneg>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
Vneg>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tVneg>> elapsed
[ 042 022 ]
V<>:
Starting Vneg>>
[ 042 020 ]
Parameter V<>: V<>: V<>: V<>: V<>:
Vneg> PSx tVneg> PSx Vneg>> PSx tVneg>> PSx Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx
set 1 076 023 076 025 076 024 076 026 076 049
set 2 077 023 077 025 077 024 077 026 077 049
set 3 078 023 078 025 078 024 078 026 078 049
set 4 079 023 079 025 079 024 079 026 079 049
D5Z52BAA
V<>:
Evaluation VNG PSx
[ * ]
∑
V̲A-G
+
V̲B-G 1
+
V̲C-G
+ 2
1 ... 2 V<>:
V̲NG
V̲N-G 305 252
1: Calculated
2: Measured
V<>:
Parameter Evaluation VNG PSx
Depending on the setting, the V<> function monitors either the neutral-point
displacement voltage calculated by the P139 from the three phase-to-ground
voltages or the neutral-point displacement voltage formed externally via the
fourth voltage measuring input, for example the neutral-point displacement
voltage from the open delta winding of the voltage transformers (see
Section 3.12, (p. 3-91)).
The neutral-point displacement voltage is monitored to determine whether it
exceeds set thresholds. This monitoring can be based either on the (Fourier-
filtered) fundamental or on the r.m.s. value. This can be set independently for
each stage with the settings V <>: Me as. V alu e VNG> PSx and V<>: Meas.
Va lue VN G>>PSx.
The triggers are followed by timer stages that can be blocked via appropriately
configured binary signal inputs.
V<>:
Blocking tVNG> EXT
[ 041 072 ]
↗ V<>:
Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx
[ * ] V<>:
tVNG> PSx
V<>: [ * ]
Meas. Value VNG> PSx
[ * ]
c
V<>:
MAIN: & c VNG> PSx
Protection active [ * ]
V<>:
Ready
t 0 V<>:
[ 042 003 ] tVNG> elapsed
[ 041 045 ]
V<>:
Blocking tVNG>> EXT V<>:
[ 041 073 ] Starting VNG>
[ 041 044 ]
V<>:
tVNG>> PSx
V<>: [ * ]
Meas. Value VNG>>PSx
[ * ]
c
V<>:
c VNG>> PSx
[ * ]
t 0 V<>:
V<>: tVNG>> elapsed
V̲NG
[ 041 046 ]
V<>:
Starting VNG>>
[ 042 008 ]
t 0
V̲ref V<>:
tVref> elapsed
[ 007 047 ]
V<>:
V<>: Starting Vref>
Blocking tVref>> EXT [ 007 051 ]
[ 007 037 ]
V<>:
tVref>> PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
C Vref>> PSx C
[ * ]
t 0
V<>:
tVref>> elaps.
[ 007 048 ]
V<>: V<>:
Blocking tVref>>>EXT Starting Vref>>
[ 010 248 ] [ 007 052 ]
V<>:
tVref>>> PSx
[ * ]
MAIN: V<>:
Protection active C Vref>>> PSx C
306 001
[ * ]
MCMON:
M.circ. Vref flty.
[ 007 213 ]
t 0
V<>:
tVref>>> elapsed
[ 010 242 ]
V<>:
Starting
[ 010 241Vref>>>
]
Parameter V<>:
Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx
set 1 076 049
set 2 077 049
set 3 078 049
set 4 079 049
V<>:
Blocking tVref< EXT
[ 007 039 ]
V<>:
V<>: tVref< PSx
Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
V<>:
C Vref< PSx C V<>:
tVref< elapsed
[ * ] [ 007 053 ]
V̲ref V<>:
Fault Vref<
[ 007 061 ]
V<>:
Fault Vref<<
[ 007 062 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Blocking tVref<<<EXT V<>:
[ 010 249 ] Starting Vref<<
[ 007 056 ]
V<>:
tVref<<< PSx
V<>:
[ * ] tVref<< elapsed
[ 007 054 ]
MAIN: V<>:
Protection active Vref<<< PSx
306 001
C C
[ * ]
MCMON:
M.circ. Vref flty.
[ 007 213 ]
V<>:
Fault Vref<<<
[ 011 135 ]
Setting(s) blocked
V<>:
Starting Vref<<<
[ 010 243 ]
V<>:
tTransient pulse PSx
[ * ]
V<>:
tVref< elaps. trans.
[ 007 057 ]
V<>:
tVref<< elaps.trans.
[ 007 060 ]
V<>:
tVref<<< elaps.trans
[ 010 245 ]
Parameter V<>: V<>:
tTransient pulse PSx Hyst. V<> deduc. PSx V<>:
tVref</<</<<< el.tr.
set 1 076 029 076 049 [ 007 063 ]
set 2 077 029 077 049
set 3 078 029 078 049
set 4 079 029 079 049
f<>:
General enable USER
[ 023 031 ]
1 f<>:
& Enabled
[ 042 100 ]
0: No
1: Yes
f<>:
Enable PSx
[ * ]
f<>:
1 Not ready
0
[ 042 140 ]
1
f<>:
0: No & Ready
1: Yes [ 042 101 ]
f<>:
Blocked by V<
[ 042 102 ]
MAIN:
General starting
[ 040 000 ]
f<>:
Parameter Enable PSx
f<
Δf
Δt Δt
t
Start Δt Start Δt
Function blocked
Trip Δf/Δt
F5Z0128C
sense to take the mean value of the frequency gradient into account for load-
shedding systems.
In this operating mode of over-/underfrequency protection, frequency monitoring
must be set for “underfrequency monitoring”.
Monitoring the mean value of the frequency gradient is started with the starting
of frequency monitoring. If the frequency decreases by the set value Δf within
the set time Δt, then the Δf/Δt monitoring function operates instantaneously and
generates a trip signal. If a frequency change does not lead to an operate
decision of the monitoring function, then the Δf/Δt monitoring function will be
blocked until the underfrequency monitoring function drops out. The trip signal
can be blocked by way of an appropriately configured binary signal input.
f<>:
Blocking f1 EXT
[ 042 103 ]
f<>:
Oper. mode f1 PSx
[ * ]
1: f
2: f with df/dt
f<>:
f1 PSx
3: f w. Delta f/Delta t [ * ]
MAIN:
Nominal frequ. fnom
[ 010 030 ]
f<>:
f<>: tf1 PSx
Ready [ * ]
[ 042 101 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
f<>:
f<>: Trip signal f1
Blocked by V< [ 042 111 ]
[ 042 102 ]
MAIN:
M.c.b. trip V EXT
[ 004 061 ]
f<>:
Starting f1
[ 042 107 ]
f<>:
df1/dt PSx
[ * ]
f<>:
No. periods reached
305 701
f<>:
fMeas df/dt
305 726
f<>:
Start. cond. met Starting f1/df1
[ 042 108 ]
SFMON:
f> Setting error f<>
f<>: [ 098 028 ]
Delta f1 PSx
[ * ]
f<>:
Delta t1 PSx
[ * ]
df/dt
f<>:
Delta f1 triggered
[ 042 109 ]
Start. cond. met
f<>:
Delta t1 elapsed
[ 042 110 ]
47Z0152A
Pf<:
General enable USER
[ 015 202]
0
Pf<:
1 Enabled
[ 016 052]
0: No
1: Yes
Pf<:
Enable PSx
[*]
0 Parameter Pf<:
Enable PSx
1 set 1 015 206
0: No set 2 015 207
set 3 015 208
1: Yes
set 4 015 209
19Z8821A
⋮
Pf<:
f10 active
[ 016 089 ]
MCMON: ≥1
Meas.circ.V,I faulty
[ 037 020 ] Pf<:
& Ready
Pf<:
Blocked by V< [ 016 053 ]
[ 016 056 ]
Pf<:
Enabled
[ 016 052 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
19Z8822B
The frequency calculation depends on the measured voltages. The active power
calculation depends on the measured voltages and currents. Therefore the
function group Pf< can only be configured in devices with voltage and current
inputs.
Under certain conditions the Pf< will be blocked and the signal Pf<: Blocked
will be issued, provided that one of the following conditions is met:
● Frequency measurement is not possibe. P f <: Block ed by V < is issued.
● A voltage or current measuring circuits defect has been identified (by
internal functions MCMON: Me as .ci rc.V ,I fau lty).
● No frequency stage has been activated.
Pf< protection can only start if the Pf< is ready. For the purpose the following
conditions need to be met simultaneously:
● Protection is activated (on).
● Pf< is enabled.
● Pf< is not blocked.
Q/S
Blocking
of Pf< trip
Sector angle
P P
G
Q Q
Imin
P/S
P P
G
Q Q
Sector angle
Pmin
19Z8824A
If the active power check generates a trip enabling decision then the starting of
the underfrequency stage triggers the timer stage (016 004) Pf<: tPF< PS x.
After the timer has elapsed the trip signal (016 059) Pf <: Trip signal Pf< is
issued. The timer stage can be blocked by the binary input signal (016 030)
Pf<: Blocking t PF< EXT. Moreover, it is reset if the underfrequency decision
or the active power decision is dropped.
Pf<: Pf<:
Pf<: Imin PSx Pmin PSx
Ready c
[ * ] [ * ]
[ 016 053 ]
Pf<:
& c Sector angle PSx
I̲A
[ * ]
I̲B
Q/S
Blocking
of Pf< trip
P P
G
Q Q
Imin
S̲ = P + jQ P/S
V̲A-G P P
G
V̲B-G Q
Sector angle
Q
V̲C-G Pmin
Pf<:
Blocking of Pf< trip Blocked by Pmin
Pf<: [ 016 057 ]
Pmin PSx
[ * ] ≥1
↗ Blocked
◄
c
Pf<:
& Starting Pf<
↗ active stage fx
[ 016 058 ]
fmeas
Pf<:
Pf<: tPF< PSx
Blocking tPF< EXT c
[ * ]
[ 016 030 ]
t 0 Pf<:
Trip signal Pf<
[ 016 059 ]
P<>:
General enable USER
[ 014 220 ]
0: No
1: Yes
P<>:
Enabled PSx
[ * ]
P<>:
Enabled
0 [ 036 250 ]
1
Parameter P<>:
0: No Enabled PSx
1: Yes set 1 014 252
set 2 014 253
set 3 014 254
set 4 014 255
45Z5051A
P<>:
Enabled
[ 036 250 ]
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 023 ]
fnom
I̲A P<>:
P
402 631
fnom
I̲B
fnom
I̲C
fnom
V̲A-G
fnom
V̲B-G
fnom
V̲C-G
P<>:
P+
402 633
P<>:
P-
402 634
P<>:
Q
402 632
P<>:
Q+
402 635
P<>:
Q-
402 636
45Z5052A
P<>:
Operate delay P> PSx
[ * ]
P<>: P<>:
Blocking tP> EXT Release delay P> PSx
[ 035 082 ] [ * ]
P<>:
Diseng. ratio P> PSx 0
[ * ]
1
0: No P<>:
Starting P>
1: Yes [ 035 086 ]
P<>:
P
402 631
P<>:
Direction P> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
P+
402 633
P<>:
P-
402 634
P<>:
Direction P>> PSx
[ * ]
3: Non-directional
P<>: P<>:
P>> PSx Operate delay P>>PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
P<>:
Release delay P>>PSx
P<>: [ * ]
Diseng. ratio P>>PSx
[ * ]
P<>:
Signal P>> delayed
[ 035 090 ]
P<>:
Blocking tP>> EXT
[ 035 083 ]
Fig. 3-272: Active power monitoring when the set thresholds are exceeded.
The P139 monitors the active power with two-stage functions to detect when it
exceeds the set thresholds. The resetting ratio of the threshold stages can be
set.
When the active power exceeds the set thresholds, a starting signal depends on
the P<>: Start w. Di re ct. PSx. If P <>: Start w. D irect. PSx is set to yes,
measured direction should match the set direction, or the starting signal will not
issued. The starting signal is followed by the set operate and resetting delays.
P<>:
Direction P> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
P<>: Trip signal P>
Signal P> delayed [ 035 088 ]
[ 035 087 ]
P<>:
P+
402 633
P<>:
P-
402 634
P<>:
Direction P>> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
P<>: Trip signal P>>
Signal P>> delayed [ 035 091 ]
[ 035 090 ]
45Z5054A
Fig. 3-273: Direction-dependent trip signal of the active power protection function when the set thresholds are
exceeded.
P<>:
Operate delay Q> PSx
[ * ]
P<>: P<>:
Blocking tQ> EXT Release delay Q> PSx
[ 035 084 ] [ * ]
P<>:
Diseng. ratio Q> PSx 0
[ * ]
1
0: No P<>:
Starting Q>
1: Yes [ 035 092 ]
P<>:
Q
402 632
P<>:
Direction Q> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
Q+
402 635
P<>:
Q-
402 636
P<>:
Direction Q>> PSx
[ * ]
3: Non-directional
P<>: P<>:
Q>> PSx Operate delay Q>>PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
P<>:
Release delay Q>>PSx
P<>: [ * ]
Diseng. ratio Q>>PSx
[ * ]
P<>:
Signal Q>> delayed
[ 035 096 ]
P<>:
Blocking tQ>> EXT
[ 035 085 ]
Parameter P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>:
Q> PSx Diseng. ratio Q> PSx Operate delay Q> PSx Release delay Q> PSx Direction Q> PSx Start w. Direct. PSx
set 1 017 160 017 164 017 168 017 172 017 176 021 074
set 2 017 161 017 165 017 169 017 173 017 177 021 075
set 3 017 162 017 166 017 170 017 174 017 178 021 076
set 4 017 163 017 167 017 171 017 175 017 179 021 07
Fig. 3-274: Reactive power monitoring when the set thresholds are exceeded.
The P139 monitors the reactive power with two-stage functions to detect when it
exceeds the set thresholds. The resetting ratio of the threshold stages can be
set.
When the reactive power exceeds the set thresholds, a starting signal depends
on the P< >: St art w . Di re ct . PSx. If P <>: Start w . Dire ct . PSx is set to
yes, measured direction should match the set direction, or the starting signal will
not issued. The starting signal is followed by the set operate and resetting
delays.
P<>:
Direction Q> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
P<>: Trip signal Q>
Signal Q> delayed [ 035 094 ]
[ 035 093 ]
P<>:
Q+
402 635
P<>:
Q-
402 636
P<>:
Direction Q>> PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
P<>: Trip signal Q>>
Signal Q>> delayed [ 035 097 ]
[ 035 096 ]
45Z5056A
Fig. 3-275: The direction-dependent trip signal of the reactive power protection function when the set thresholds
are exceeded.
P<>:
Operate delay P< PSx
[ * ]
P<>: P<>:
Blocking tP< EXT Release delay P< PSx
[ 035 050 ] [ * ]
0: No P<>:
Starting P<
1: Yes [ 035 054 ]
P<>:
Fault P<
[ 035 057 ]
P<>:
P
402 631
P<>:
Direction P< PSx
[ * ]
3: Non-directional
P<>: P<>:
P<< PSx Operate delay P<<PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
P<>:
Release delay P<<PSx
P<>: [ * ]
Diseng.ratio P<< PSx
[ * ]
P<>:
Signal P<< delayed
[ 035 061 ]
Setting(s) blocked
P<>:
Blocking tP<< EXT
[ 035 051 ]
Parameter P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>:
P< PSx Diseng. ratio P< PSx Operate delay P< PSx Release delay P< PSx Direction P< PSx Start w. Direct. PSx
set 1 017 030 017 034 017 060 017 226 017 230 021 074
set 2 017 031 017 035 017 061 017 227 017 231 021 075
set 3 017 032 017 036 017 062 017 228 017 232 021 076
set 4 017 033 017 037 017 063 017 229 017 233 021 077
Fig. 3-276: Active power monitoring when values fall below set thresholds.
The P139 monitors the active power with two-stage functions to detect when it
falls below the set thresholds. The resetting ratio of the threshold stages can be
set. When the active power falls below the set thresholds, a starting signal
depends on the P <>: Start w. Di rect. P Sx. If P<>: St art w. D irect. PSx
is set to yes, measured direction should match the set direction, or the starting
signal will not issued. The starting signal is followed by the set operate and
resetting delays.
P<>:
Direction P< PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional P<>:
& Trip signal P<
P<>: & [ 035 058 ]
Signal P< delayed
[ 035 055 ]
&
&
P<>:
tP< elapsed trans.
[ 035 056 ] & P<>:
& Trip signal P< trans
[ 035 059 ]
P<>:
P+ 402 633
&
P<>:
P- 402 634
&
P<>:
Starting P<<
[ 035 060 ]
P<>:
Direction P<< PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
& Trip signal P<<
P<>: & [ 035 064 ]
Signal P<< delayed
[ 035 061 ]
&
&
&
Fig. 3-277: The direction-dependent trip signal of the active power protection function when values fall below set
thresholds.
The P139 determines the sign of the active power. If the sign is positive, a
forward-directional decision is issued; if it is negative, a backward- (reverse-)
P<>:
Starting P<
035 054
P<>:
Operate delay P< PSx
*
P<>:
Release delay P< PSx
*
2
P<>:
Signal P< delayed
035 055
P<>:
tP< elapsed trans.
035 056 3
P<>:
Fault P<
035 057
1 2 3
19Z5278A
Fig. 3-278: Performance of the transient signal and the fault signal issued by the active power monitoring.
P<>:
Operate delay Q< PSx
[*]
P<>: P<>:
Blocking tQ< EXT Release delay Q< PSx
[ 035 052 ] [*]
0: No P<>:
Starting Q<
1: Yes [ 035 066 ]
P<>:
Fault Q<
[ 035 069 ]
P<>:
Q
402 632
P<>:
Direction Q< PSx
[*]
3: Non-directional
P<>: P<>:
Q<< PSx Operate delay Q<<PSx
[*] [*]
P<>:
Release delay Q<<PSx
P<>: [*]
Diseng.ratio Q<< PSx
[*]
P<>:
Signal Q<< delayed
[ 035 011 ]
Setting(s) blocked
P<>:
Blocking tQ<< EXT
[ 035 053]
Parameter P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>: P<>:
Q< PSx Diseng. ratio Q< PSx Operate delay Q< PSx Release delay Q< PSx Direction Q< PSx Start w. Direct. PSx
set 1 018 035 018 044 018 052 018 056 018 081 021 074
set 2 018 036 018 045 018 053 018 057 018 082 021 075
set 3 018 037 018 046 018 054 018 058 018 083 021 076
set 4 018 038 018 047 018 055 018 059 018 084 021 077
Fig. 3-279: Reactive power monitoring when values fall below set thresholds.
P<>:
Starting Q<
[ 035 066 ]
P<>:
Direction Q< PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
P<>:
3: Non-directional Trip signal Q<
P<>: &
[ 035 155 ]
Signal Q< delayed &
[ 035 067 ]
&
&
P<>:
tQ< elapsed trans.
P<>:
[ 035 068 ] & Trip sig. Q< trans.
& [ 035 156 ]
P<>:
Q+
402 635 &
P<>:
Q-
402 636
&
P<>:
Starting Q<<
[ 035 010 ]
P<>:
Direction Q<< PSx
[ * ]
1: Forward directional
2: Backward directional
3: Non-directional
P<>:
& Trip signal Q<<
[ 035 176 ]
P<>: &
Signal Q<< delayed
[ 035 011 ]
&
&
P<>:
P<>: & Trip sig. Q<< trans.
tQ<< elapsed trans. &
[ 035 177 ]
[ 035 016 ]
&
Fig. 3-280: Direction-dependent trip signal of the reactive power protection function when values fall below set
thresholds.
P<>:
Starting Q<
035 066
P<>:
Operate delay Q< PSx
*
P<>:
Release delay Q< PSx
*
2
P<>:
Signal Q< delayed
035 067
P<>:
tQ< elapsed trans.
035 068 3
P<>:
Fault Q<
035 069
1 2 3
Parameter P<>: P<>: P<>:
Operate delay Q< PSx Release delay Q< PSx tTransient pulse PSx
set 1 018 052 018 056 018 246
set 2 018 053 018 057 018 247
set 3 018 054 018 058 018 248
set 4 018 055 018 059 018 249
19Z5279A
Fig. 3-281: Performance of the transient signal and the fault signal issued by the reactive power monitoring.
Apparent power S
> 0,010 Snom
P<>:
& Direction P forw.
P<>: [ 035 181 ]
Starting P>
[ 035 086 ]
P<>:
Starting P>>
[ 035 089 ]
P<>:
Starting P<
[ 035 054 ]
P<>:
Starting P<<
[ 035 060 ]
P<>:
& Direction P backw.
P<>: [ 035 191 ]
P+
402 633
P<>:
P-
402 634
19Z5274B
Fig. 3-282: Directional starting signal issued by the active power monitoring.
P<>:
Q+
402 635
P<>:
Q-
402 636
P<>:
Direction Q forw.
&
P<>: [ 035 193 ]
Starting Q>
[ 035 092 ]
P<>:
Starting Q>>
[ 035 095 ]
P<>:
Starting Q<
[ 035 066 ]
P<>:
Starting Q<<
[ 035 010 ]
P<>:
& Direction Q backw.
[ 035 194 ]
Apparent power S
> 0,010 Snom
19Z5275B
Fig. 3-283: Directional starting signal issued by the reactive power monitoring.
QV:
General enable USER
[ 013 147 ]
0
QV:
1 Enabled
[ 013 181 ]
0: No
1: Yes
QV:
Enabled PSx
[*]
0 Parameter QV:
Enabled PSx
1 set 1 013 223
0: No set 2 013 224
set 3 013 225
1: Yes
set 4 013 226
19Z8811A
QV:
Blocking EXT
[ 013 149 ]
MAIN:
Rush restr. A trig.
[ 041 027 ]
MAIN:
Rush restr. B trig.
[ 041 028 ]
QV:
Blocked
MAIN: [ 013 182 ]
Rush restr. C trig.
[ 041 029 ]
QV:
Enabled
[ 013 181 ] QV:
Ready
[ 013 183 ]
MCMON: QV:
Meas.circ.V,I faulty Enabled PSx
[ 037 020 ] [ 013 225 ]
MAIN:
M.c.b. trip V EXT
[ 004 061 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
19Z8812A
Under certain conditions the QV will be blocked and the signal QV: Block ed will
be issued, provided that one of the following conditions is met:
P P
19Z8814A
Reactive power is calculated based on all three phase currents and voltages. The
reactive power threshold and reactive power flow are monitored to determine
whether the reactive power is in operation area.
There are in total three conditions which must be present at the same time to
release the directional reactive power condition.
● All three phase currents exceed Q V: Imi n PSx.
● The reactive power exceeds QV : Qm in P Sx.
● The angle of the apparent power is within the set operation direction.
(Power direction check see Section 10.2.7, (p. 10-10))
For forward directional setting:φ ≤ φS ≤ 180∘ − φ
QV: QV:
t1 PSx Min.dur.tr.cmd.1 PSx
[ * ] [ * ]
QV: t 0 QV:
Ready & t 0 Trip command t1
≥1
[ 013 183 ] [ 014 077 ]
QV: QV:
Starting QV Trip signal t1
[ 014 088 ] [ 014 075 ]
QV: QV:
t2 PSx Min.dur.tr.cmd.2 PSx
QV:
Starting V< 3p [ * ] [ * ]
[ 014 074 ]
t 0 QV:
QV: t 0
Starting V< 3p ≥1 Trip command t2
[ 014 073 ] [ 014 078 ]
QV: QV:
Bl.Start. QV Trip signal t2
[ 014 076 ]
CBF:
General enable USER
[ 022 080 ]
0
CBF:
1 & Enabled
[ 040 055 ]
0: No
1: Yes
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
0: don't execute
1: execute
CBF: &
Disable EXT
[ 038 042 ]
CBF:
Disable USER
[ 003 015 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
47Z1138B
CBF: CBF:
Enabled Not ready
[ 040 055 ]
≥1
[ 040 025 ]
CBF:
&
Blocking EXT
[ 038 058 ]
≥1
CBF:
t1 3p
[ 022 165 ]
blocked &
CBF:
t2
[ 022 166 ]
blocked
CBF:
Delay/starting trig.
[ 022 155 ]
blocked
CBF:
Delay/fault beh. CB
[ 022 171 ]
blocked
CBF:
Delay/CB sync.superv
[ 022 172 ]
blocked
19Z6130B
CBF:
I<
[ 022 160 ]
I̲A CBF:
Current flow A
[ 038 230 ]
I̲B CBF:
Current flow B
[ 038 231 ]
I̲C CBF:
Current flow C
[ 038 232 ]
CBF:
Current flow Phx
[ 038 233 ]
CBF:
Evaluation IN
[ 022 184 ]
0: Without
1: Calculated c1
2: Measured
c2
+
+ 1
CBF:
+ IN<
[ 022 180 ]
I̲N 2
≥1
1 ... 2 CBF:
Current flow N
[ 038 235 ]
CBF:
IN
460 394
64Z1103C
This function is used to detect a break in current flow safely, immediately and
pole-selectively. The CBF function continuously compares sampled current values
with the set threshold value CBF: I<.
As long as current flow criteria are met the monitoring function will continuously
issue the phase selective signals C BF: Cu rren t fl ow A, C BF: Current flo w B,
C BF: Cu rrent flow C and the multiple signal CBF : C urr ent flow Phx.
Moreover, there is a residual current monitoring function which can be enabled/
disabled. For this either the residual current value measured directly at the CT or
the value derived from the three phase currents may be used.
As long as a residual current exceeding the comparator threshold is flowing, the
current flow criterion is not met and the corresponding signal (CBF: Curre nt
flow N) is issued. When the residual current monitoring function is disabled, no
monitoring is carried out and the C BF: Curre nt fl ow N = No signal is issued
continuously.
≥1 & ≥1 CBF:
CB pos. implausible
& [ 038 210 ]
MAIN: &
CB closed A EXT
[ 031 029 ] &
MAIN:
CB closed B EXT
[ 031 030 ]
MAIN:
CB closed C EXT
[ 031 031 ]
MAIN: ≥1
CB open 3p EXT
[ 031 028 ]
&
MAIN:
CB closed 3p EXT
[ 036 051 ]
MAIN:
CB pos.sig. implaus.
[ 031 041 ] 47Z8831A
Trip signals included in MAI N: Ge n. tri p com mand 1, which use CB status
signals in addition to current flow monitoring, can be selected with the parameter
C BF: Fct.assig nm. CBAux..
Applying CB status signals depends on the type of auxiliary contacts available.
The P139 can check the following CB status signals for plausibility and evaluate
them:
● The open signal from the circuit breaker, MA I N: CB open 3p E XT
● The closed signal from the circuit breaker, MA IN: CB clos e d 3p EXT
● The phase-selective CB status signals
The evaluation of the CB status signals is blocked, if the configuration of the
respective binary signal inputs or the signal levels are not plausible. As a result,
the P139 will issue the C BF: CB pos . implausi bl e signal. The evaluation of
current criteria is not affected by this blocking.
The configuration or the CB status signals are considered not plausible, if:
● if at least one phase-selective CB status signal and a 3-pole CB status
signal (e.g. MAIN: C B clos ed A EXT and MA IN : C B open 3p EXT)
have been assigned to binary inputs
● or if only one or two phase-selective CB status signals have been assigned
to binary inputs
● or if both MA IN: CB cl ose d 3p EXT and MAI N: CB open 3p EXT have
been configured and the signal MA IN: CB pos .s ig. implaus . is issued.
As an alternative the status signals from the external device may be used by the
P139. Assigning necessary for this is made with the parameters MAI N: Sig.
asg. C B op en or MA IN : Sig. asg. CB cl ose d. Status signals from external
devices are processed similarly to the MA IN: CB ope n 3p E XT and MAIN: CB
cl ose d 3 p EXT CB status signals.
CBF:
Fct.assignm. CBAux.
[ 022 159 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2 m out of n
…
Signal 3
CBF:
CB pos. implausible ≥1 &
[ 038 210 ]
CBF: & & >S
Current flow A & 11
1
[ 038 230 ] >R
CBF:
Current flow B
[ 038 231 ] ◄ ◄
CBF:
Current flow C
[ 038 232 ]
CBF:
Current flow N ≥1 &
CBF:
[ 038 235 ] >S Startup 3p
11 [ 038 211 ]
MAIN: ≥1 1
CB open 3p EXT ≥1 ≥1 >R
[ 031 028 ]
MAIN:
CB closed 3p EXT
[ 036 051 ]
MAIN: ≥1 ≥1
CB closed A EXT
[ 031 029 ]
MAIN:
CB closed B EXT
[ 031 030 ]
MAIN:
CB closed C EXT
[ 031 031 ]
◄
CBF:
Start with man. trip
[ 022 154 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Trip cmd. blocked &
[ 021 013 ]
MAIN: & ≥1
Gen. trip signal 1
[ 036 005 ]
MAIN:
Manual trip signal
[ 034 017 ] &
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx >S
[ xxx yyy ] 11
1
>R &
U x01
U x02
U x03
U xxx & ≥1
Startup of the circuit breaker failure protection function will occur when the CB is
recognized as closed during a startup criterion. The following criteria are
evaluated as a startup criterion:
CBF: CBF:
Not ready c t1 3p
[ 040 025 ] [ 022 165 ]
CBF: CBF:
Startup 3p t 0 Trip signal t1
[ 038 211 ] [ 038 215 ]
CBF: CBF:
c t2 CB failure
[ 022 166 ] [ 036 017 ]
CBF:
t 0 Trip signal t2
[ 038 219 ]
&
CBF:
CB faulty EXT
[ 038 234 ]
19Z6433A
CBF:
Min.dur. trip cmd.t1
[ 022 167 ]
MAIN: CBF:
Trip cmd. blocked t 0 Trip command t1
[ 021 013 ] & ≥1
[ 038 220 ]
CBF:
Trip signal t1 ≥1
[ 038 215 ]
CBF:
Latching trip cmd.t1
[ 022 169 ]
0 & S 1 1
1 R 1
CBF:
0: No Min.dur. trip cmd.t2
1: Yes [ 022 168 ]
CBF:
t 0 ≥1 Trip command t2
&
CBF: [ 038 224 ]
Trip signal t2
[ 038 219 ] ≥1
CBF:
Latching trip cmd.t2
[ 022 170 ]
0 & S 1 1
1 R 1
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Latch. trip c. reset
[ 040 139 ]
19Z6134B
While trip signals issued by the CB failure protection have no timer stages
available, the user can set minimum time-delays for trip commands.
By appropriate setting it can be selected that trip commands, issued by the CB
failure protection function, will operate in latching mode. The corresponding trip
command, set to latch mode, will remain active until reset by operating
parameters or through an appropriately configured binary signal input.
CBF:
Delay/starting trig.
[ 022 155 ]
MAIN: t 0 CBF:
General starting & Trip signal
[ 040 000 ] [ 040 026 ]
CBF: CBF:
Starting trig. EXT Starting
[ 038 016 ] [ 038 021 ]
19Z6135B
The signal CBF: St ar ting will be issued when the signal CBF: Starting t r ig.
E XT is presented to an appropriately configured binary signal input and a
general starting condition is present. The signal CBF: Delay/st art ing trig . will
be issued after timer stage C BF: Tri p s ignal. has elapsed.
CBF: CBF:
CB pos. implausible Delay/fault beh. CB
[ 038 210 ]
CBF: [ 022 171 ]
I<
[ 022 160 ]
t 0 CBF:
& Fault behind CB
[ 038 225 ]
I̲A &
I̲B
I̲C
MAIN:
CB open 3p EXT
[ 031 028 ]
MAIN:
CB closed 3p EXT
[ 036 051 ]
19Z6136D
CBF:
CB pos. implausible
[ 038 210 ]
MAIN:
CB open 3p EXT ≥1
[ 031 028 ] CBF:
MAIN: Delay/CB sync.superv
CB closed 3p EXT [ 022 172 ]
[ 036 051 ]
CBF:
CBF: t 0 TripSig CBsync.super
I< & [ 038 226 ]
[ 022 160 ]
I̲A
≥1
I̲B
I̲C
<3
CBF:
CBsync.superv A open
& [ 038 227 ]
CBF:
CBsync.superv B open
& [ 038 228 ]
CBF:
CBsync.superv C open
& [ 038 229 ]
19Z6137B
CBM:
General enable USER
[ 022 010 ]
0
CBM:
1 Enabled
[ 044 130 ]
0: No
1: Yes
48Z5404A
3.41.2 Variants
The wear condition of a circuit breaker may be determined using a variety of
methods:
● Monitoring the mechanical switching operations
● Accumulating ruptured current values
● Accumulating the squared ruptured current values
● Calculating the current-time integral of ruptured and accumulated current
values
● Calculating the remaining switching operations with reference to the CB
wear characteristic.
100000
Number of permissible CB operations
10000
1000
100
10
0.1 1 10 100
Disconnection current in kA 19Z6123A_EN
The knee points in Fig. 3-299, (p. 3-375) are necessary to set the wear
characteristic for the circuit breaker:
● The circuit breaker's nominal current (CBM: I nom, CB) and the permitted
number of CB operations at nominal current (CBM: Perm. CB op.
I nom,C B)
● The circuit breaker's mean ruptured current (CBM: Med. cu rr. It rip,CB)
and the permitted number of CB operations at mean ruptured current
(C BM: P erm. CB op. I m ed,C B)
● The circuit breaker's maximum ruptured current (CBM: Max. curr.
It rip,CB) and the permitted number of CB operations at maximum
ruptured current (CBM: P e rm. CB op. Imax ,CB)
The mean ruptured current is not available for all types of circuit breakers.
In such a case the parameters for this knee point are to be set to Blocked. A knee
point is not considered in the characteristic when at least one of the parameters
for the knee point is set to Blocked.
For proper performance of circuit breaker monitoring it should be observed that
the knee points must be applied in a logically correct sequence (continuously
descending). When set currents and numbers of CB operations are not plausible
according to the characteristic the P139 will issue an error message and block
circuit breaker monitoring.
Where:
● Inom,CB: Nominal current for the CB
● n(Inom,CB): Max permitted number of CB operations at Inom,CB
● Id,CB: Ruptured current
● n(Id,CB): Permitted number of CB operations at Id,CB according to wear
characteristics
● nrem,0(Inom,CB): Remaining permitted number of CB operations at Inom,CB
before disconnection
● nrem,(Inom,CB): Remaining permitted number of CB operations at Inom,CB after
disconnection
the maximum cycle time has elapsed. Measured values from the respective CB
tripping are canceled and the CBM: tmax> A (CBM: tmax> B, CBM: tmax >
C) signal is issued.
CBM:
Sig. asg. trip cmd.
[ 022 152 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2 m out of n
Signal n
CBM:
Selected signal internal trip cmd.
310 025
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
19Z6124B
The external devices' “open” state signal may be linked to the control function's
“open” state signal by setting the C BM: Si g. asg. trip cmd.. parameter so
that the function in the P139 will be triggered by CB auxiliary contacts.
MAIN:
Sig. asg. CB open
[ 021 017 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2 m out of n
Signal n
MAIN:
CB open 3p EXT
[ 031 028 ]
19Z6125C
20,00
15,00
10,00
5,00
0,00
-5,00
-10,00
-15,00
-20,00
Calculating the
current-time integral
19Z6126A
Fig. 3-302: Calculation of the current-time integral when CBM is triggered by a general trip command 1.
MAIN:
Protection active & C
306 001
CBM: CBM:
Enabled Operating mode
[ 044 130 ] [ 022 007 ]
C
1
&
CBM:
2 C Inom,CB
& [ 022 012 ]
MAIN:
3
& Inom C.T. prim.
[ 010 001 ]
1: With trip cmd. only
CBM:
Perm. CB op. Inom,CB
2: With CB sig.EXT only [ 022 013 ]
3: CB sig. EXT or trip CBM:
CBM: Med. curr. Itrip,CB
Blocked
[ 044 199 ] [ 022 014 ]
CBM: CBM:
internal trip cmd. Perm. CB op. Imed,CB
310 025 [ 022 015 ]
CBM:
Internal CB trip CBM:
310 030
Max. curr. Itrip,CB
[ 022 016 ]
fnom
I_x CBM:
Perm. CB op. Imax,CB
[ 022 017 ]
CBM:
Corr.acqu.t. CB sig.
[ 022 018 ]
C
CBM:
Corr. acqu.time trip
CBM: [ 007 249 ]
Set No. CB oper. A
[ * ]
CBM: CBM:
Set remain. CB op. A Itrip A
[ * ] R [ * ]
CBM:
Set ΣItrip A CBM:
I*t A
[ * ] R [ * ]
CBM:
Set ΣItrip**2 A CBM:
[ * ] Itrip,prim A
R [ * ]
CBM:
Set ΣI*t A
CBM:
[ * ] Itrip**2 A
R [ * ]
CBM:
ΣItrip A
S [ * ]
CBM:
ΣItrip**2 A
S [ * ]
CBM:
ΣI*t A
S [ * ]
CBM:
No. of CB oper. A
S [ * ]
CBM:
Remain. No. CB op. A
S [ * ]
CBM:
Initialize values
[ 003 011 ]
CBM:
Reset meas.val. USER
[ 003 013 ]
A / IA 022 131 022 134 022 137 022 140 022 143 008 011 008 014
B / IB 022 132 022 135 022 138 022 141 022 144 008 012 008 015
C / IC 022 133 022 136 022 139 022 142 022 145 008 013 008 016
B / IB 009 048 009 062 009 213 009 052 009 073 009 078 009 088
C / IC 009 049 009 063 009 214 009 053 009 076 009 079 009 089
52Z0145A
been replaced. The available interfaces on the P139 may be used to set
measured values in the circuit breaker monitoring function.
Only such measured values and counter values in the P139 may be set to new
values that do not have their default values set to Blocked.
The stored value will remain unchanged if the default value is set to Blocked.
Executing the set command results in initializing all default values in the P139 to
Blocked.
CBM:
C Remain No. CB op. <
[ 022 020 ]
CBM: CBM:
Remain. No. CB op. A Sig. Rem. No.CB op.<
[ 008 014 ] [ 044 136 ]
CBM:
Remain. No. CB op. B
[ 008 015 ]
CBM:
Remain. No. CB op. C
[ 008 016 ]
19Z6121B
At the same time each switching operation will increment the P139's counter for
the number of CB operations. The number of CB operations performed is
displayed. A threshold value can be set with the parameter CBM: No. CB
ope rat ions >. An alarm is issued should the number of CB operations
performed exceed this threshold.
CBM:
C No. CB operations >
[ 022 019 ]
CBM: CBM:
No. of CB oper. A Sig. No. CB op. >
[ 008 011 ] [ 044 135 ]
CBM:
No. of CB oper. B
[ 008 012 ]
CBM:
No. of CB oper. C
[ 008 013 ]
19Z6122B
CBM: CBM:
General enable USER Blocked
[ 044 199 ]
[ 022 010 ]
&
CBM:
Blocking EXT
[ 044 128 ]
CBM:
Blocking USER
[ 022 150 ]
0: No
1: Yes
48Z5346B
MAIN: 300ms 0
SFMON:
M.c.b. trip V EXT M.c.b. trip V
[ 004 061 ] [ 098 000 ]
MCMON:
Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 023 ]
MCMON: SFMON:
Undervoltage Meas. circ. V faulty
[ 038 038 ] [ 098 017 ]
MCMON:
Phase sequ. V faulty
[ 038 049 ] MCMON:
M.circ. Vref flty.
[ 007 213 ]
MCMON:
M.circ. V,Vref flty.
[ 040 078 ]
MCMON: SFMON:
FF, Vref triggered M.circ. V,Vref flty.
[ 038 100 ] [ 098 023 ]
MAIN:
M.c.b. trip Vref EXT
[ 036 086 ] 300ms 0 SFMON:
M.c.b. trip Vref
[ 098 011 ]
MCMON:
Meas.circ.V,I faulty
[ 037 020 ]
MCMON: SFMON:
Meas. circ. I faulty Meas.circ.V,I faulty
[ 040 087 ] [ 098 016 ]
MAIN: MCMON:
M.c.b. trip VNG EXT M.circ. VNG flty.
[ 002 183 ] [ 007 214 ]
52Z0146A
where IP,max is the highest of the three phase currents and IP,min is the lowest;
Idiff> is the set operate value MCMON: I di ff>. In order to suppress short-term
transients, the measuring stage Idiff> is followed by a set operate-delayed timer
stage MC MON : Ope rate de lay.
If connection is to two current transformers only (phase ANC connection only)
evaluation of current IB can be disabled by an appropriate selection for the
operating mode.
MCMON:
General enable USER
[ 014 001 ]
0
MCMON:
1 Enabled
[040 094 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MCMON:
Op. mode Idiff>
[ 017 028 ]
2 1, 3
0: Without
1: IA, IC
1, 2, 3
2: IA, IB, IC
I̲A
1
I̲B 2
I̲C 3
|I̲P,max|
|I̲P,max|-|I̲P,min|
|I̲P,min|
|I̲P,max|-|I̲P,min|/
MAIN:
General starting |I̲P,max|
[ 040 000 ]
>0.05 Inom
MCMON: MCMON:
Idiff> Operate delay
[ 017 024 ] [ 017 023 ]
MCMON:
Meas. circ. I faulty
[040 087 ]
SFMON:
Meas. circ. I faulty
[098 005 ]
19Z5087A
MCMON:
Operate delay
[ 017 023 ]
MAIN:
General starting
[ 040 000 ]
MCMON: >0.05 Inom
Enabled C
[ 040 094 ]
I̲A
I̲B
I̲C
MCMON:
Op. mode Vmin< monit
[ 018 079 ]
2 &
3 &
1: Vmin<
2: Vmin< with I enable
MAIN: 3: Vmin< w.CB cont.enab
CB closed 3p EXT
[ 036 051 ]
MCMON:
Vmin<
& C
[ 017 022 ] MCMON:
t 0
Undervoltage
&
[ 038 038 ]
V̲A-G +
SFMON:
V̲B-G - Undervoltage
[ 098 009 ]
+
V̲C-G -
+
>0.65 Vnom
C
MCMON:
& & Meas. voltage o.k.
[ 038 048 ]
MCMON:
Phase sequ. monitor.
[ 018 019 ]
0: No
1: Yes
>0.4 Vnom
C
&
& C
MAIN:
Phase sequence
[ 010 049 ]
MCMON:
Phase sequ. V faulty
[ 038 049 ]
t 0 SFMON:
Phase sequ. V faulty
[ 098 001 ]
19Z5088C
MCMON:
FF,Vref enabled USER
MCMON:
[ 014 013 ] Oper. delay FF, Vref
[ 014 012 ] SFMON:
FF, Vref triggered
0 [ 098 022 ]
t 0
1 & MCMON:
FF, Vref triggered
0: No [ 038 100 ]
1: Yes
MCMON:
Blocking FF,Vref EXT
[ 018 099 ]
V̲ref
|V̲ref|-|V̲Meas|≥
ASC: 0.1 Vnom
Vmeas
MAIN:
CB closed 3p
[ 031 042 ] 49Z8978A
The P139 includes “Fuse Failure” monitoring of the reference voltage function,
which is required by the “Automatic Synchronism Check” (ASC).
Fuse Failure monitoring of the reference voltage is only possible if the ASC
function has been configured. This is specifically applied when no auxiliary
contact is available on the voltage transformer m.c.b. If fuse failure monitoring is
not desired it can be disabled by setting parameters.
Fuse Failure monitoring must be able to discriminate between a short circuit in
the three-phase network being monitored and a reference voltage missing
because of a short circuit or an open circuit in the secondary circuits of the
reference voltage.
LIMIT:
General enable USER
[ 014 010 ]
0
LIMIT:
1 Enabled
[ 040 074 ]
0: No
1: Yes
LIMIT: LIMIT:
I> tI>
[ 014 004 ] [ 014 031 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
LIMIT:
tI> elapsed
[ 040 220 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
I̲A I>> tI>>
[ 014 020 ] [ 014 032 ]
I̲B
I̲C
LIMIT:
I̲max tI>> elapsed
[ 040 221 ]
I̲min
LIMIT: LIMIT:
I< tI<
[ 014 021 ] [ 014 033 ]
LIMIT:
tI< elapsed
[ 040 222 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
I<< tI<<
[ 014 022 ] [ 014 034 ]
LIMIT:
tI<< elapsed
[ 040 223 ]
47Z0153A
Fig. 3-311: Limit Value Monitoring of minimum and maximum phase current.
LIMIT: LIMIT:
Enabled LIMIT:
C VPP> tVPP>
[ 040 074 ] &
[ 014 027 ] [ 014 039 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
t 0 LIMIT:
tVPP> elapsed
[ 040 228 ]
V̲C-G
t 0 LIMIT:
V̲PP,max tVPP>> elapsed
[ 040 229 ]
V̲PP,min
LIMIT: LIMIT:
C VPP< tVPP<
[ 014 029 ] [ 014 041 ]
t 0 LIMIT:
tVPP< elapsed
[ 040 230 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
C VPP<< tVPP<<
[ 014 030 ] [ 014 042 ]
t 0
LIMIT:
tVPP<< elapsed
[ 040 231 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
C VPG> tVPG>
[ 014 023 ] [ 014 035 ]
t 0 LIMIT:
tVPG> elapsed
[ 040 224 ]
t 0 LIMIT:
V̲PG,max tVPG>> elapsed
[ 040 225 ]
V̲PG,min
LIMIT: LIMIT:
C VPG< tVPG<
[ 014 025 ] [ 014 037 ]
t 0
LIMIT:
tVPG< elapsed
[ 040 226 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
C VPG<< tVPG<<
[ 014 026 ] [ 014 038 ]
t 0 LIMIT:
tVPG<< elapsed
[ 040 227 ]
47Z0154B
Fig. 3-312: Limit Value Monitoring of maximum and minimum phase-to-phase voltage and maximum and minimum
phase-to-ground voltage.
LIMIT:
Enabled
[ 040 074 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
LIMIT: LIMIT:
VNG> tVNG>
[ 014 043 ] [ 014 045 ]
V̲A-G
LIMIT:
V̲B-G tVNG> elapsed
[ 040 168 ]
V̲C-G
LIMIT: LIMIT:
VNG>> tVNG>>
[ 014 044 ] [ 014 046 ]
LIMIT:
tVNG>> elapsed
[ 040 169 ]
S8Z52G8A
LIMIT:
Starting IDC,lin>
[ 040 180 ]
LIMIT:
Enabled LIMIT: LIMIT:
[ 040 074 ] IDC,lin> tIDC,lin>
[ 014 110 ] [ 014 112 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
MEASI: LIMIT:
Curr. IDC,lin. p.u. tIDC,lin> elapsed
[ 004 136 ] [ 040 182 ]
LIMIT:
Starting IDC,lin>>
[ 040 181 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
IDC,lin>> tIDC,lin>>
[ 014 111 ] [ 014 113 ]
LIMIT:
tIDC,lin>> elapsed
[ 040 183 ]
LIMIT:
Starting IDC,lin<
[ 040 184 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
IDC,lin< tIDC,lin<
[ 014 114 ] [ 014 116 ]
LIMIT:
tIDC,lin< elapsed
[ 040 186 ]
LIMIT:
Starting IDC,lin<<
[ 040 185 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
IDC,lin<< tIDC,lin<<
[ 014 115 ] [ 014 117 ]
LIMIT:
tIDC,lin<< elapsed
[ 040 187 ]
S8Z52G6A
The direct current, linearized by the analog measured data input, is monitored by
two stages to determine if it exceeds or falls below set thresholds. If any of the
measured values exceed or fall below the corresponding upper or lower limit
values then a signal is issued after the associated time period has elapsed.
LIMIT:
General enable USER
[ 014 010 ]
LIMIT:
Enabled
[ 040 074 ]
0: No
1: Yes
LIMIT: LIMIT:
MAIN: Vref> tVref>
Device on-line [ 042 144 ] [ 042 148 ]
[ 003 030 ]
1: Yes (= on)
LIMIT:
tVref> elapsed
[ 042 152 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
Vref>> tVref>>
[ 042 145 ] [ 042 149 ]
LIMIT:
Vref tVref>> elapsed
[ 042 153 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
Vref< tVref<
[ 042 146 ] [ 042 150 ]
LIMIT:
tVref< elapsed
[ 042 154 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
Vref<< tVref<<
[ 042 147 ] [ 042 151 ]
LIMIT:
tVref<< elapsed
[ 042 155 ]
19Z5215A
LIMIT:
Starting T>
[ 040 170 ]
LIMIT:
Enabled
[ 040 074 ] LIMIT: LIMIT:
T> tT>
[ 014 100 ] [ 014 103 ]
MAIN:
Protection
306 active
001
MEASI:
Temperature T LIMIT:
[ 004 133 ] tT> elapsed
[ 040 172 ]
LIMIT:
Starting T>>
[ 040 171 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
T>> tT>>
[ 014 101 ] [ 014 104 ]
LIMIT:
tT>> elapsed
[ 040 173 ]
LIMIT:
Starting T<
[ 040 174 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
T< tT<
[ 014 105 ] [ 014 107 ]
LIMIT:
tT< elapsed
[ 040 176 ]
LIMIT:
Starting T<<
[ 040 175 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
T<< tT<<
[ 014 106 ] [ 014 108 ]
LIMIT:
tT<< elapsed
[ 040 177 ]
19Z5212A
LIMIT:
Starting T1>
[ 040 200 ]
LIMIT:
Enabled
[ 040 074 ] LIMIT: LIMIT:
T1> tT1>
[ 014 120 ] [ 014 122 ]
MAIN:
Protection active
306 001
LIMIT:
MEASI: tT1> elapsed
Temperature T1 [ 040 202 ]
[ 004 224 ]
LIMIT:
Starting T1>>
[ 040 201 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
T1>> tT1>>
[ 014 121 ] [ 014 123 ]
LIMIT:
tT1>> elapsed
[ 040 203 ]
LIMIT:
Starting T1<
[ 040 204 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
T1< tT1<
[ 014 124 ] [ 014 126 ]
LIMIT:
tT1< elapsed
[ 040 206 ]
LIMIT:
Starting T1<<
[ 040 205 ]
LIMIT: LIMIT:
T1<< tT1<<
[ 014 125 ] [ 014 127 ]
LIMIT:
tT1<< elapsed
[ 040 207 ]
19Z5213A
Fig. 3-317: Monitoring the measured temperature value T1 as an example for measured temperature values T1 to
T9.
Main sensor Backup sensor from group 2, Backup sensor from group 3,
with setting: with setting:
Group 1 - 2 or Group 1 - 2/3 Group 1 - 2/3
T1 T4 T7
T2 T5 T8
T3 T6 T9
Should temperature sensor T1 fail, with the setting Group 1 - 2/3, it will replaced
by T4. Should temperature sensor T4 also fail it will replaced by T7.
Group 1 - 2
Group 1 - 2/3
MEASI:
Open circ. T1
040 193
LIMIT:
tT1>> elapsed LIMIT:
tTx>> elapsed
040 203
MEASI:
Open circ. T4
040 208
LIMIT:
tT4>> elapsed Tx: T1 or
041 153 backup sensor
LIMIT:
tT7>> elapsed
041 183
MEASI:
Open circ. T2
040 194
LIMIT:
tT2>> elapsed
040 213 LIMIT:
tTx>> elapsed
MEASI: tTx>> for 2 of 3
Open circ. T5 LIMIT:
limit values 2out of3 with T1,2,3
040 209
elapsed [ 041 248 ]
LIMIT:
tT5>> elapsed Tx: T2 or
041 163 backup sensor
MEASI: (T5 or T8)
Open circ. T8
040 252
LIMIT:
tT8>> elapsed
041 193
MEASI:
Open circ. T3
040 195
LIMIT:
tT3>> elapsed
LIMIT:
040 163 tTx>> elapsed
MEASI:
Open circ. T6
040 218
LIMIT:
tT6>> elapsed Tx: T3 or
041 173 backup sensor
MEASI: (T6 or T9)
Open circ. T9
040 253
LIMIT:
tT9>> elapsed
041 243
19Z5210B
Fig. 3-318: Using backup sensors (M E A S I : B a c k u p T e m p S e n s o r P S x) with the “2-out-of-3” Limit Value
Monitoring function.
Limit values resulting from temperature values measured by main sensors (from
group 1) or their corresponding backup sensors are processed by the “2-out-of-3”
Limit Value Monitoring function, L IMIT: 2ou t of 3 w ith T1, 2,3. This is
displayed in the diagram above.
All functions associated with temperature sensors operate in a parallel mode. In
this way the “2-out-of-3” Limit Value Monitoring function, LI MIT: 2 out of3 wit h
T4,5,6 may use temperature sensors from group 2 even though these backup
sensors are configured to group 1.
MEASI:
Open circ. T4
[ 040 208 ] LIMIT:
tT4>> elapsed
LIMIT:
tT4>> elapsed without open circuit
[ 041 153 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. T5 tTx>> for 2 of 3
[ 040 209 ] LIMIT: LIMIT:
tT5>> elapsed limit values 2out of3 with T4,5,6
LIMIT: elapsed [ 041 249 ]
tT5>> elapsed without open circuit
[ 041 163 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. T6
[ 040 218 ] LIMIT:
tT6>> elapsed
LIMIT:
tT6>> elapsed without open circuit
[ 041 173 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. T7
LIMIT:
[ 040 219 ] tT7>> elapsed
LIMIT:
tT7>> elapsed without open circuit
[ 041 183 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. T8
[ 040 252 ] LIMIT: tTx>> for 2 of 3 LIMIT:
tT8>> elapsed limit values 2out of3 with T7,8,9
LIMIT: [ 041 250 ]
elapsed
tT8>> elapsed without open circuit
[ 041 193 ]
MEASI:
Open circ. T9
[ 040 253 ] LIMIT:
tT9>> elapsed
LIMIT:
tT9>> elapsed without open circuit
[ 041 243 ]
19Z5211B
Fig. 3-319: Limit Value Monitoring function “2-out-of-3” for temperature sensors T4 to T6 and T7 to T9. If
M E A S I : B a c k u p T e m p S e n s o r P S x is set to None this scheme will also apply to temperature sensors T1 to T4.
RTD RTD
Phase RTD
Main Temp. Sensor
A B C Ambient temperature/
RTD Coolant temperature
Backup Temp. Sensor
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
RTD
Stator
RTD
RTD
Rotor
Bearing Bearing
Stator
19Z5236
Fig. 3-320: Temperature measurements on a motor to be used with the Limit Value Monitoring function (LIMIT) and
the Thermal Overload protection (THERM).
TRMON:
General enable USER
[ 018 040 ]
1 c
0: No
1: Yes
TRMON: TRMON:
Insul. Alarm 1 EXT Insul. Alarm 1
[ 016 241 ] [ 016 250 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Buchholz Alarm 1 EXT Buchholz Alarm 1
[ 016 242 ] [ 016 251 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Buchholz Trip 1 EXT Buchholz Trip 1
[ 016 243 ] [ 016 252 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Insul. Alarm 2 EXT Insul. Alarm 2
[ 016 244 ] [ 016 253 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Buchholz Alarm 2 EXT Buchholz Alarm 2
[ 016 245 ] [ 016 254 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Buchholz Trip 2 EXT Buchholz Trip 2
[ 016 246 ] [ 016 255 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Insul. Alarm 3 EXT Insul. Alarm 3
[ 016 247 ] [ 018 007 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Buchholz Alarm 3 EXT Buchholz Alarm 3
[ 016 248 ] [ 018 016 ]
TRMON: TRMON:
Buchholz Trip 3 EXT Buchholz Trip 3
[ 016 249 ] [ 018 039 ]
49Z8942A
Binary signals in the P139 may be linked by logical “OR” or “AND” operations
with the option of additional NOT operations by setting L OGIC: Fct.assignm.
outp. 1 (or LOGI C : F ct.ass ignm . outp. 2 to L OGIC : Fct .as sign m.outp.
128, or LOG_2 : F ct .ass ignm. outp. 1 to L OG_2: Fct .as sign m. out p. 4).
The Boolean equations need to be defined without the use of brackets. The
following rule applies to the operators: “NOT” before “AND” before “OR”.
A maximum of 32 elements can be processed in one Boolean equation. In
addition to the signals generated by the P139, initial conditions for governing the
equations can be set using setting parameters, through binary signal inputs, or
through the serial interfaces.
Logical operations of the function group LOGIC can be controlled through the
binary signal inputs in different ways.
The binary input signals LOGIC: I npu t 01 E XT (or L OGIC: In put 0 2 EXT, …,
LOGIC: In put 4 0 EXT) have an updating function, whereas the input signals
LOGIC: Set 1 EXT (or LOGIC: Set 2 EXT, …, LOGI C: Set 8 EXT) are
latched. The logic can only be controlled from the binary signal inputs configured
for LOGI C: S et 1 EXT if the corresponding reset input L OGIC: Res et 1 EXT)
has been configured for a binary signal input. If only one or neither of the two
functions is configured, then this is interpreted as “Logic externally set”. If the
input signals of the two binary signal inputs are implausible (such as when they
both have a logic value of “1”), then the last plausible state remains stored in
memory. (For LOG_2, there are no such parameters for assigning binary input
signals.)
WARNING
HAZARD OF UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
⚫ When using the programmable logic, it is necessary to carry out a
functional type test to conform with the requirements of the relevant
protection/control application. In particular, it is necessary to verify that
the requirements for the implementation of logic linking (by setting) as
well as the time performance during startup of the P139, during operation
and when there is a fault (blocking of the P139) are fulfilled.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unintended
equipment operation.
LOGIC:
Set 1 USER
[ 034 030 ]
0
LOGIC:
1 1 has been set
[ 034 067 ]
0: No
1: Yes
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
U x1
U x2
U x3
U xx
LOGIC:
Address 034 051 1 set externally
[ 034 075 ]
Address 034 059
LOGIC:
Set 1 EXT
[ 034 051 ]
LOGIC:
Reset 1 EXT
[ 034 059 ]
49Z9107A
Fig. 3-322: Control of logic operations via setting parameters or stored input signals. (The logic does not apply to
LOG_2.)
LOGIC:
General enable USER
LOGIC:
[ 031 099 ] Enabled
[ 034 046 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN: LOGIC:
Protection active Fct.assignm. outp. 1
306 001
[ 030 000 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
LOGIC: LOGIC:
Input 01 EXT Op. mode t output 1
[ 034 000 ] [ 030 001 ]
0
LOGIC:
Input 16 EXT
[ 034 015 ] 1
2
3
LOGIC:
1 has been set 4
[ 034 067 ]
5
0 5
LOGIC:
8 has been set
[ 034 074 ] 0: Without timer stage
LOGIC:
Time t1 output 1
1: Oper./releas.delay
[ 030 002 ]
2: Oper.del./puls.dur.
LOGIC: LOGIC:
1 set externally Time t2 output 1
[ 034 075 ] 3: Op./rel.delay,retrig
[ 030 003 ]
4: Op.del./puls.dur.,rt
5: Minimum time
LOGIC:
8 set externally LOGIC:
[ 034 082 ] Output 01 (t)
[ 042 033 ]
LOGIC:
Set 1 USER
[ 034 030 ]
LOGIC:
Set 8 USER
[ 034 037 ]
LOGIC:
Trigger 1
[ 034 038 ]
0
LOGIC:
1 Output 01
[ 042 032 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
LOGIC:
Trigger 8
[ 034 045 ]
1
0: don't execute
1: execute
D5Z52CDA
Fig. 3-323: Setting options for programmable logic, function group LOGIC (shown here for output 1).
LOG_2:
General enable USER
LOG_2:
[ 011 137 ] Enabled
[ 011 138 ]
0: No
1: Yes LOG_2:
Op. mode t output 1
[ 050 001 ]
MAIN: LOG_2:
Protection active Fct.assignm. outp. 1
306 001 [ 050 000 ] 0
1
Signal 1 2
3
Signal 2
4
Signal 3 5
0 5
Signal n
0: Without timer stage
LOG_2:
1: Oper./releas.delay Time t1 output 1
2: Oper.del./puls.dur. [ 050 002 ]
3: Op./rel.delay,retrig
LOG_2:
4: Op.del./puls.dur.,rt Time t2 output 1
5: Minimum time [ 050 003 ]
LOG_2:
Output 1 (t)
[ 052 033 ]
LOG_2:
Output 1
[ 052 032 ]
19Z80CDA
Fig. 3-324: Setting options for programmable logic, function group LOG_2 (shown here for output 1).
The output signal of an equation can be fed into a further, higher order, equation
as an input signal thus creating a sequence of interlinked Boolean equations. The
equations are processed in the sequence defined by the order of each equation.
It should be noted that in the case of overlapping equations, the result is
provided by the equation with the highest order.
The output signal of each equation is fed to a separate timer stage with two
timer elements and a choice of operating modes. This offers the possibility of
assigning a freely configurable time characteristic to the output signal of each
Boolean equation. In the Minimum time operating mode, the setting of timer
stage t2 has no effect. The following diagrams (Fig. 3-325, (p. 3-405) to
Fig. 3-329, (p. 3-407)) show the time characteristics for the various timer stage
operating modes.
If the P139 is switched to offline the equations are not processed and all outputs
are set to the “0” logic level.
t2 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t1
t1 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t) t2 t2
t1, t2 > 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t2 t1 t2
D5Z50BYA
Fig. 3-325: Operating mode 1: Pickup/reset delay (Oper./releas.delay). (This diagram is also valid for LOG_2, if the
signal parameters are replaced by the corresponding ones from LOG_2 .)
t2 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t1
t1 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t) t2 t2
t1, t2 > 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t2 t1 t2
D5Z50BZA
Fig. 3-326: Operating mode 2: Pulse, delayed pickup (Oper.del./puls.dur.). (This diagram is also valid for LOG_2, if
the signal parameters are replaced by the corresponding ones from LOG_2 .)
t2 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t1
Retrigger pulse
t1 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t2 t2
t2
Retrigger pulse
t1, t2 > 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t2 t1 t2
t2
t2
D5Z50CAA
Fig. 3-327: Operating mode 3: Pickup/reset delay, retriggerable (Op./rel.delay,retrig). (This diagram is also valid for
LOG_2, if the signal parameters are replaced by the corresponding ones from LOG_2 .)
t2 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t1
t1 = 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t2 t2
Retrigger pulse
t1, t2 > 0s
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t2 t1 t2
t1 t1
D5Z50CBA
Fig. 3-328: Operating mode 4: Pulse, delayed pickup, retriggerable (Op.del./puls.dur.,rt). (This diagram is also valid
for LOG_2, if the signal parameters are replaced by the corresponding ones from LOG_2 .)
LOGIC:
Output n
LOGIC:
Output n (t)
t1 t1
D5Z50CCA
Fig. 3-329: Operating mode 5: Minimum time (Minimum time). (This diagram is also valid for LOG_2, if the signal
parameters are replaced by the corresponding ones from LOG_2 .)
LOGIC:
Sig.assig. outp. 1
[ 044 000 ]
Signal 1 EXT
[ AAA AAA ]
Signal 2 EXT
[ BBB BBB ]
Signal 3 EXT
[ CCC CCC ]
Signal n EXT
[ NNN NNN ]
Signal 1 EXT
Address AAA AAA
LOGIC: [ AAA AAA ]
Output 01
[ 042 032 ]
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
-Uxxx
LOGIC:
Sig.assig.outp. 1(t)
[ 044 001 ]
Signal 2 EXT
Address BBB BBB
[ BBB BBB ]
LOGIC:
Output 01 (t)
[ 042 033 ]
INP:
Fct. assignm. U xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
-Uxxx
D5Z52FBA
Fig. 3-330: Signal assignment to outputs of Boolean equations. (This diagram is also valid for LOG_2, if the
parameters from LOGIC are replaced by the corresponding ones from LOG_2 .)
MAIN:
Type of bay
[ 220 000 ]
MAIN:
Auto-assignment I/O
[ 221 065 ]
BB1
Q0
MAIN:
Direct motor control
306 029
MAIN:
DEVxx is a C.B.
306 044
19Z50AQA
The bay type defines the layout of a bay with its switchgear units on the HMI, an
automated I/O assignment and the system/bay interlocking equations for all
required switchgear units. Vol. 2, Chapter A5, (p. A5-1) provides a description
of all bay types which are pre-defined (generally for all Easergy MiCOM 30
devices) and therefore immediately available. The selection of a bay type can be
done with the parameter (220 000) MA IN: Type of bay.
Once the user has selected a bay type, the P139 can automatically configure the
binary inputs and output relays with function assignments for the control of
switchgear units. This automatic assignment is defined via the parameter
MAI N: Aut o-assignme nt I/O.
The assignment of inputs and outputs for an automatic configuration is shown in
the List of Bay Types (Vol. 2, Chapter A5, (p. A5-1)).
Should the required bay type be missing from the standard selection then the
user can contact the manufacturer of the P139 to request the definition of a
customized bay type to load into the P139.
It is also possible – using a special Bay Configuration Tool (BTC) being part of
Easergy Studio – to create a customized bay type and upload it to the P139.
To create customized bay types, the “Bay Type Configurator” (BTC), version 2.7
or higher, is needed. Older versions of the BTC can create not compatible hex files
and thus can lead to communication failures.
The same parameter – MAIN: Type of bay – can then be used to select (i. e.
activate) this user-defined bay type. Note that there is no restriction to only one
user-defined bay type: In fact, multiple customized bay types can be created with
different IDs and be loaded into the P139. When using the BTC to create a bay
type, it is recommended to always use an ID number in the range of 5000 …
9999 for any customized bay type, because the pre-defined standard bay types
use IDs in the reserved range of 0001 … 4999. If the user tries to select a non-
existing ID via (220 000) MAI N: Type of bay (i. e. an ID for which neither a
standard nor a customized bay type is defined), then the selection will be
rejected and an error message “Signal from device: Bay type not assigned
(0x8073)” will be reported in the “kommprot.txt” log file.
MAIN:
Inp.asg. ctrl.enabl.
[ 221 057 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
...
Signal n
MAIN:
Inp.asg.interl.deact
[ 221 007 ]
Selected signal
MAIN:
SI active USER
[ 221 002 ]
≥1 MAIN:
Subst. interl. act.
0 [ 221 000 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
BI active USER
[ 221 003 ]
≥1 MAIN:
Bay interlock. act.
0 [ 221 001 ]
0: No
1: Yes
49Z88ABC
Fig. 3-332: General enable for switch commands issued by the control functions; activating or canceling the
interlocks.
Before a switching unit within the bay is closed or opened by the control
functions of the P139, the P139 first checks whether the switch command may be
executed. A switch command will be executed if the optional control enable has
been issued and the interlock conditions are met. The interlock conditions are
defined in the interlocking logic for each switching unit within the bay that is
subject to control actions and for each control direction (Open/Close). Different
conditions are defined for the bay interlock equations to operate with or without
station interlock. The check of bay or station interlock equations can be cancelled
for all electrically controllable switchgear units within a bay. If the station
interlock is active, it may be cancelled selectively for each switching unit and
each control direction.
The bay and station interlocks may be cancelled through an appropriately
configured binary signal input. This cancellation is effective for all of the
operating modes “Local”, “Remote” and “Remote & Local” (setting LOC: Fct.
a ssign. L/R k ey = R & L <-> L). In other words, the functionality of the binary
input for cancelling the bay and station interlocks is independent of the operating
mode of the control point for switching between local and remote control.
ILOCK:
Rset ILOCK violation
[ 221 123 ]
0 t
DEV01: ≥1 ≥1 MAIN:
Open cmd. rejection Interlock equ. viol.
⋮ [ 221 018 ]
DEVxx:
Open cmd. rejection
DEV01: ≥1
Close cmd. rejection
⋮
DEVxx:
Close cmd. rejection
19Z83ADA
Cmd start:
Internal no
Command
parameter rejected.
check OK?
yes
no
Interlocking Command
check OK? rejected.
yes
DEV01:
Inp.asg. sw.tr. plug
[ 210 014 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
⋮
Signal n
Without function ≥1
Selected signal
DEV01:
≥1 Switch. device open
DEV01:
Gr. assign. debounc. [ 210 036 ]
[ 210 011 ] & DEV01:
Switch.device closed
≥1 [ 210 037 ]
DEV01:
=1 1 Dev. interm./flt.pos
>S [ 210 038 ]
11 &
1
>R
Selected group >S &
11
◄ >R
1
c
◄
DEV01:
Open signal EXT Φ & >S
11
[ 210 030 ] Debouncing 1
>R
&
DEV01:
Closed signal EXT Chatter suppression DEV01:
[ 210 031 ] Op.time switch. dev.
[ 210 004 ]
t 0
&
DEV01:
Stat.ind.interm.pos.
[ 210 027 ]
& ≥1
0 5s 0 &
&
1
0: No ◄
1: Yes
0
0⋯3 DEV01:
Control state
0: Intermediate pos. [ 210 018 ]
1: Open
2: Closed
3: Faulty position 19Z50AJB
Fig. 3-335: Processing Status Signals from Manually Operated Switchgear Units.
monitoring or until the contacts on the switchgear unit are back to a defined
position – either “Open” or “Closed” – the signal “Intermediate position” is
issued.
If DEV01: Int erm. pos . suppr. is set to Yes, the previous switchgear unit
status will continue to be signaled to the communication interfaces while the
switchgear unit is operating. Once the contacts on the switchgear unit have
reached their new position, the updated status is signaled accordingly to the
communication interfaces. This parameter has no impact to internal signals, such
as DEV01: Swit ch. device ope n, D EV 01: Switch.device closed or
D EV01: D ev. inte rm./f lt. pos.
The signal “Faulty position” is issued if the contacts on the switchgear unit have
not reached either their “Open” or “Closed” position after the set time period for
running time monitoring and the delay time set in MAIN: Delay
Man.Op .Supe rv. have elapsed. If DEV 01: Stat.ind.interm.pos. is set to
Yes, a delay time of 5 s is started. Once this time period has elapsed and there is
no status signal for the position, the state actually present at the binary inputs
will be signaled.
LOC:
Loc.acc.block.active
[ 221 005 ]
LOC:
Return t. illum. trg
305 550
LOC:
Return t.select. trg
305 551
MAIN:
Interlock equ. viol.
[ 221 018 ]
DEV01
DEV01:
Open request
307 000
DEV01:
Close request
307 001
MAIN:
Electrical control
[ 221 061 ]
2: Local
1: Remote
LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
[ 221 004 ]
DEV01:
Inp.asg.el.ctrl.open
[ 210 019 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
Signal n
Selected signal
DEV01:
Inp.asg.el.ctr.close
[ 210 020 ]
Selected signal
COMM1:
Open command DEV01
[ --- --- ]
COMM1:
Close command DEV01
[ --- --- ]
DEV01:
Latching time
[ 210 005 ]
DEV01:
End open command
307 002
DEV01:
End close command
307 003
MAIN:
Direct motor control
306 029
DEV01:
Latching time elaps.
MAIN:
307 012
End command
306 028
DEV01:
Latching time runn.
COMM1:
Motor rel. mon. trg. 307 011
[ --- --- ]
1) Keys, local control
19Z50AAA
DEV01:
Open request
DEV01:
Close request
DEV01:
Fct.asg.BI w/o SI op
[ 210 041 ]
ILOCK:
Output 01
[ 250 032 ]
⋮
ILOCK:
Output 32
[ 250 063 ] & DEV01:
ILOCK: Enable BI open
Output 01 & ≥1
MAIN:
Bay interlock. act. &
DEV01:
[ 221 001 ] Fct.asg.BI w/o SI cl
[ 210 042 ] & ≥1 DEV01:
Open cmd. rejection
MAIN:
Subst. interl. act. ≥1
[ 221 000 ]
MAIN:
Communication error
[ 221 019 ] & DEV01:
ILOCK: Enable BI close
Output 02 & ≥1
DEV01:
Open w/o stat.interl ≥1
[ 210 025 ]
&
↗ 1: Yes & ≥1 DEV01:
Close cmd. rejection
DEV01:
Close w/o stat. int. ≥1
[ 210 026 ]
&
↗ 1: Yes DEV01:
Fct.assig.BIwSI open
[ 210 039 ]
ILOCK:
Output 03 &
DEV01:
Fct.assig.BIwSI clos
[ 210 040 ]
ILOCK:
Output 04 &
&
&
DEV01:
Enable SI Open
DEV01:
Enable SI Close 19Z50AEB
Fig. 3-337: Assignment of the equations of the interlocking logic to the switching commands; enabling of switching
commands by the bay interlock function.
3.46.6.4 Bay Interlock for Operation with the Station Interlock Function
MAIN:
Communication error
[ 221 019 ]
DEV01:
Close request
307 001
DEV01:
Open request
307 000
MAIN:
Bay interlock. act.
[ 221 001 ]
DEV01:
Enable BI open
307 004
DEV01:
Enable BI close
307 005 COMM1:
Open request DEV01
MAIN:
[ --- --- ]
Subst. interl. act.
[ 221 000 ]
DEV01:
Open w/o stat.interl
[ 210 025 ] DEV01:
Enable SI Open
307 019
0
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1: COMM1:
Enable SI open DEV01 Close request DEV01
[ --- --- ] [ --- --- ]
DEV01:
Close w/o stat. int.
[ 210 026 ]
DEV01:
Enable SI Close
307 020
0: No
1: Yes
COMM1:
Enabl.SI close DEV01
[ --- --- ]
19Z50AFA
DEV01:
With gen. trip cmd.1
[ 210 021 ]
MAIN:
DEVxx is a C.B.
306 044
0
DEV01:
1 Protection trip cmd.
307 013
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 1
[ 036 071 ]
DEV01:
With gen. trip cmd.2
[ 210 022 ]
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Gen. trip command 2
[ 036 022 ]
DEV01:
With close cmd./prot
[ 210 023 ]
1 DEV01:
Protect. close cmd.
307 014
0: No
1: Yes
MAIN:
Close command
[ 037 009 ]
D3Z75FNA
DEV01:
Protection trip cmd.
DEV01:
Protect. close cmd.
↗ MAIN:
Cmd. dur.long cmd.
[ 221 230 ]
↗ MAIN:
Cmd. dur. short cmd.
[ 221 231 ]
DEV01:
Oper. mode cmd.
[ 210 024 ]
1 & 1
t
2
& 1
t
3
1: Long command
2: Short command
3: Time control
& 1
t
& 1
t DEV01:
MAIN: ≥1 Open command
Device on-line [ 210 028 ]
&
[ 003 030 ]
DEV01:
↗ 0: No (= off) & ≥1 Close command
& [ 210 029 ]
MAIN:
Mon. mot. drives tr.
[ 221 056 ]
MAIN:
Enable control
[ 221 058 ]
MAIN:
Bay interlock. act. ≥1
[ 221 001 ]
&
DEV01:
Enable BI open
DEV01:
Enable SI Open
DEV01:
Open cmd blocked
DEV01:
Open request
&
≥1
&
DEV01:
Enable BI close
DEV01:
Enable SI Close
DEV01:
Close cmd blocked
DEV01: & ≥1
Close request
ASC:
AC effect. for DEV01
&
ASC:
Close enable DEV01 19Z81AGB
Dependent on the operating mode (set at D EV 0 1: Ope r. mode cmd.) set for
commands, switching commands are issued for the set timer durations or
according to time control.
When the automatic synchronism check (ASC) is active and the parameter
AS C: Syst em int egrat . P Sx is set to Autom.synchr.control a “Close” request
will automatically issue a “Close” command for the circuit breaker after a close
enable was issued by the ASC.
DEV01: c
Function group DEV01
[ 210 047 ]
DEV01:
Block cmd open
[ 218 120 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
DEV01:
Open cmd blocked
Signal n 460 513
Selected signal
DEV01:
Block cmd close
[ 218 160 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
DEV01:
Close cmd blocked
Signal n 460 514
Selected signal
19Z8103A
DEV01:
Inp.asg. sw.tr. plug
[ 210 014 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
⋮
Signal n
Without function ≥1
Selected signal
DEV01:
≥1 Switch. device open
DEV01:
Gr. assign. debounc. [ 210 036 ]
[ 210 011 ] & DEV01:
Switch.device closed
≥1 [ 210 037 ]
DEV01:
=1 1 Dev. interm./flt.pos
>S [ 210 038 ]
11 &
1
>R
Selected group >S &
11
◄ >R
1
≥1 DEV01:
End open command
c
≥1 DEV01:
◄ End close command
DEV01:
Open signal EXT Φ & >S
11
[ 210 030 ] Debouncing 1
>R
&
DEV01:
Closed signal EXT Chatter suppression DEV01:
[ 210 031 ] Op.time switch. dev.
[ 210 004 ]
◄ ◄
MAIN: t 0
Direct motor control & ≥1 ≥1
DEV01: &
Open command &
DEV01:
[ 210 028 ] Switch. device runn.
DEV01: &
Close command DEV01:
Stat.ind.interm.pos.
[ 210 029 ]
& [ 210 027 ]
DEV01:
Start runn.time mon.
& & ≥1
0 5s 0 &
&
1
0: No ◄
1: Yes
0
0⋯3 DEV01:
DEV01: Control state
StartCmdTime superv. [ 210 018 ]
0: Intermediate pos.
[ 210 007 ]
1: Open
2: Closed
19Z80AKB
After sending an Open / Close command, running time monitoring for the
switchgear unit is started.
The P139 expects that the switchgear unit has reached its intermediate position
within a period of time that can be configured via DEV01: StartCmdTime
superv . (for DEV01, respective setting parameters exist for the other DEVxx). If
the switchgear unit has not reached its intermediate position after this time has
elapsed then the command is deactivated and an exceeded timer is flagged by
the signal MA IN : Startcmdti me e xcee d.. In case of a switchgear unit for
which it is (almost) impossible to detect the intermediate position (for example a
Circuit Breaker) it is recommended to switch off this monitoring by setting the
parameter to Blocked.
Moreover, the P139 expects a status signal – “Open” or “Closed” to be issued by
the switchgear unit within the duration of running time monitoring. The status
signal for the position of the contacts on the switchgear unit is present at
appropriately configured binary inputs on the P139, which can be set to
debouncing and chatter suppression mode (see Section 3.50.1.1, (p. 3-446)). For
the duration of running time monitoring or until the contacts on the switchgear
unit are back to a defined position – either “Open” or “Closed” – the signal
“Intermediate position” is issued.
If DEV01: Int erm. pos. s u ppr. is set to Yes, the previous switchgear unit
status will continue to be signaled to the communication interfaces while the
switchgear unit is operating. Once the contacts on the switchgear unit have
reached their new position, the updated status is signaled accordingly to the
communication interfaces. This parameter has no impact to internal signals, such
as DEV01: Swi tch. de vice ope n, DEV 01: Swit ch. device closed or
D EV01: Dev. int erm./flt.pos.
If the contacts on the switchgear unit have not reached either their “Open” or
“Closed” position after the set time period for running time monitoring has
elapsed the signal Faulty position is issued. If DE V0 1: Stat .in d.in ter m. pos. is
set to Yes, a delay time of 5 s is started. Once this time period has elapsed and
there is no status signal for the position, the state actually present at the binary
inputs will be signaled.
If the operating mode without external termination contacts was selected
(MAIN : W. e xt. cmd. termi n.. is set to No) the switching command is
terminated after the set latching time has elapsed, when either the ‘Open’ or
‘Closed’ position status signal is received or the set time period for running time
monitoring has elapsed (see Fig. 3-336, (p. 3-417)).
If the operating mode with external termination contacts was selected
(MAIN : W. e xt. cmd. termi n.. is set to Yes) the switching command is
terminated, after the set latching time has elapsed, when a termination
command is issued while the set time period for running time monitoring is
active.
DEV01:
Close command
[ 210 029 ]
3
1
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
DEV01:
Switch.device closed
[ 210 037 ]
1 3 4
10 ms DEV01: DEV01:
Latching time Op.time switch. dev.
[ 210 005 ] [ 210 004 ]
19Z5201B
Fig. 3-343: Sequence for time control of switching commands without external termination control, example for
switching operation “close”.
DEV01:
Close command
[ 210 029 ]
DEV01:
3
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
DEV01:
Switch.device closed
[ 210 037 ]
DEV01:
Inp. asg. end Close
[ 210 016 ]
1 3
10 ms DEV01:
Latching time
[ 210 005 ]
19Z5202B
Fig. 3-344: Sequence for time control of switching commands with external termination control, example for
switching operation “close”.
DEV01: + MAIN:
Start runn.time mon. No. motor drive op.
307 008
R [ 221 025 ]
MAIN:
Perm.No.mot.drive op
MAIN: [ 221 027 ]
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute COMP
MAIN: n
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
MAIN:
Reset LED MAIN:
306 020 n>No. permiss. oper. Mon. mot. drives tr.
[ 221 056 ]
n=1
MAIN:
Mon.time mot.drives
[ 221 026 ]
MAIN:
Cool.time mot.drives t
[ 221 028 ]
19Z6417A
Fig. 3-345: Monitoring the Motor Drives in Case of Direct Motor Control.
For bays with direct motor drive control of load disconnecting switches, isolating
links or grounding switches, a monitoring function is provided to protect motors
from overheating.
The number of switching operations within a set monitoring period is counted. If
the number of switching operations within the monitoring period exceeds the set
limit, the signal MAI N: Mon. mot. drive s tr . is issued. For the duration of the
set cooling time, no control commands to motor-driven switchgear units will be
executed. Once the set cooling time has elapsed, the control commands are
enabled again.
DEV01:
Operation counter
[ 210 043 ]
DEV01:
m CT=m Operation counter
[ 210 043 ]
DEV01:
Open command
[ 210 028 ] ≥1 +
DEV01:
Oper.count.limit
R
DEV01: [ 218 211 ]
Close command
[ 210 029 ]
COMP
[ 003 002 ] 1 ≥1 DEV01:
1: execute Warning op.count.
[ 219 081 ]
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
19Z8104A
The diagram above shows the example of function group DEV01. The logic,
however, is valid for all DEVxx with the appropriate parameters.
All Open and Close commands to the switchgear unit are counted. One counter
per DEVxx function group is available for this purpose.
Moreover, a limit value can optionally be set for the counter value. If the counter
value reaches the set limit a warning signal is issued. Due to safety reasons the
switchgear control will not be blocked when the set limit has been reached.
For further processing each of these fault signals may be configured to selection
parameters from the function groups LED (assignment to LED indicators), OUTP
(assignment to output relays), LOGIC (processing by the programmable logic
function), COMMx / IEC / GOOSE (signaling via the control system) or they may be
mapped to the signal panel as an alarm signal. Acknowledging from the local
control panel HMI is done by pressing the CLEAR (C) key.
If the status signal from the motor relay is issued during the monitoring time
period, the running time monitoring of the motor relay is started simultaneously
with this status signal. Monitoring of the switching command is then the same as
with electromechanically operated switchgear units.
If the operating mode without external termination contacts was selected the
“Close” command to the motor relay is terminated after the set latching time has
elapsed, when either the “Open” or “Closed” position status signal is received or
the set time period for running time monitoring has elapsed (see Fig. 3-336,
(p. 3-417)). The monitoring time period is again started with the termination of
the “Close” command to the motor relay and after it has elapsed the control
commands “Open” or “Close” are also terminated. The same is valid for the
shunt windings.
If the operating mode with external termination contacts was selected
(MAI N: W . e xt . cmd. te rmin . is set to Yes) the switching command to the
motor relay is terminated after the set latching time has elapsed, when a
termination command is issued while the set time period for running time
monitoring is active. With the setting MAI N: e xt.c md.ter m. w/o PI = No, the
switching command is also terminated when either the “Open” or “Closed”
position status signal is received. The switching command to the motor relay is
always terminated after the set latching time has elapsed. The monitoring time
period is again started with the termination of the “Close” command to the motor
relay and after it has elapsed the control commands “Open” or “Close” are also
terminated.
MAIN:
Device on-line
[ 003 030 ]
0: No (= off)
MAIN:
W. ext. cmd. termin.
[ 221 063 ]
0: No
1: Yes
DEV01:
Switch. device runn.
307 010
DEV01:
Latching time runn.
307 011
DEV01:
Inp. asg. end Open
[ 210 015 ]
Signal 1
Signal 2
Signal 3
&
Signal n
Selected signal
DEV01:
Inp. asg. end Close
[ 210 016 ]
Selected signal
MAIN:
Direct motor control
306 029
DEV01:
Close command
[ 210 029 ]
& & CMD_1:
MAIN: & Command C011
ext.cmd.term. w/o PI [ 200 051 ]
[ 221 115 ]
DEV01:
Latching time elaps.
307 012
MAIN:
Mon.time Dir.Contr.
[ 221 060 ]
COMM1:
& Motor rel. mon. trg.
SIG_1: Debouncing [ --- --- ]
Signal S012 EXT
[ 226 092 ] &
MAIN:
Chatter suppression & & End command
306 028
MAIN: DEV01:
Cmd.end f. DC fail. & Start runn.time mon.
307 008
[ 221 111 ]
SIG_1:
Logic signal S012
0
& [ 226 093 ]
1
0: No
MAIN: 1: Yes
DC fail. cmd. End
[ 221 108 ]
19Z81AHA
CMD_1:
Command C011
[ 200 051 ]
DEV01:
Close command
[ 210 029 ]
CMD_1:
Command C012
[ 200 056 ]
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
DEV01:
Switch.device closed
[ 210 037 ]
Fig. 3-348: Sequence of time monitoring for direct motor control without external termination, example for
switching operation “close”.
DEV01:
Close command
[ 210 029 ]
CMD_1:
Command C012
[ 200 056 ]
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
DEV01:
Switch.device closed
[ 210 037 ]
DEV01:
Inp. asg. end Close
[ 210 016 ]
10 ms MAIN: DEV01:
Mon.time Dir.Contr. Latching time
[ 221 060 ] [ 210 005 ]
19Z5204C
Fig. 3-349: Sequence of time monitoring for direct motor control with external termination, example for switching
operation “close”.
CMD_1: CMD_DC1
● Direct control of starting sequence with impulse command.
This is applicable only to Three Position Drives (see function group TPDx,
Section 3.47, (p. 3-437), not to 2-pole standard devices. Moreover, this
requires external high-precision contacts for command reset and for
breaking the power circuit of the motor drive.
The operation of this command is delayed by the set value MAIN: DC o p.
delay t 1.
The command is reset either when the timer M AIN: DC1 impulse t 2 has
elapsed, or with positive indication of the final switchgear position.
CM D_1: CM D_DC2
● Direct control without check back signal.
The operation of this command is delayed by the set value MAIN: DC op.
de lay t 1.
The command is reset with positive indication of the final switchgear
position, but this reset is delayed by the set value MAIN: DC2/3 release
de lay.
CMD_1: CM D_DC 3
● Direct control with check back signal.
The operation of this command is delayed by the set value MAIN: DC op.
delay t1.
The command is reset…:
o with positive indication of the final switchgear position, if
MAI N: e xt.cmd. term. w /o P I = No, or
o with the single-pole signal “SIG_DC3” (SI G_1: Logic SIG_DC3).
In either case the reset is delayed by the set value MAIN: DC2 /3 relea se
de lay.
If none of these reset conditions is met after the set monitoring time-delay
has elapsed the reaction of the P139 depends on the setting
MA IN: C md.e nd f . DC f ail.:
0 t 0 K x1
1 K x2 -K xxx
0: No K x3
1: Yes K xx
MAIN:
DC1 impulse t2
[ 221 241 ]
CMD_1:
& 1 & CMD_DC1
t [ 202 001 ]
COMM1:
Command CMD_DC1
[ - - - - - - ]
LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
[ 221 004 ]
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
19Z8120A
Fig. 3-350: Direct control of starting sequence with impulse command (C M D _ 1 : C M D _ D C 1).
0 t 0 K x1
1 K x2 -K xxx
0: No K x3
1: Yes
K xx
DEV01: MAIN:
Latching time DC2/3 release delay
[ 210 005 ] [ 221 242 ]
CMD_1:
& 1 1 CMD_DC2
t t [ 202 006 ]
COMM1:
Command CMD_DC2
[ - - - - - - ]
LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
[ 221 004 ]
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
19Z8121A
0 t 0 K x1
1 K x2 -K xxx
0: No K x3
1: Yes
K xx
DEV01: MAIN:
Latching time DC2/3 release delay
[ 210 005 ] [ 221 242 ]
CMD_1:
& 1 1 CMD_DC3
t t [ 202 011 ]
COMM1:
Command CMD_DC3
[ - - - - - - ]
LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
[ 221 004 ]
DEV01: &
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
MAIN:
ext.cmd.term. w/o PI
[ 221 115 ]
0: No
1: Yes
SIG_1:
SIG_DC3 config.
[ 233 007 ]
1 c
COMM1:
0: No Signal SIG_DC3,log
1: Yes [ --- ---]
Debouncing
& &
SIG_1:
Logic SIG_DC3
SIG_1:
SIG_DC3 EXT Chatter suppression
[ 233 005 ]
[ 233 004 ]
19Z8122A
The logic shown here is an example for the case of TPD1 with the setting DEV02
for the disconnector and DEV03 for the grounding switch. The logic, however,
also applies to other configurations with different parameter addresses.
DEV02:
Open command
[ 210 078 ]
DEV02:
Close command
[ 210 079 ]
DEV02:
Control state
[ 210 068 ]
1: Open
2: Closed
3: Faulty position
DEV03:
Open command &
[ 210 128 ]
DEV03:
Close command
[ 210 129 ]
DEV03:
Control state
[ 210 118 ]
1: Open
2: Closed
3: Faulty position
& ≥1 TPD1:
Cmd. counter-clockw.
[ 219 002 ]
&
≥1 + TPD1:
Operation counter
MAIN: [ 219 005 ]
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ]
1: execute ≥1 R
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
TPD1:
Oper.count.limit
[ 219 006 ]
COMP
TPD1:
Warning op.count.
[ 219 007 ]
& ≥1 S1 1 MAIN:
Shunt trip overrun
R1 [ 221 114 ]
&
19Z8101A
ILOCK:
Fct.assignm. outp. 1
[ 250 000 ]
MAIN:
Fct. block. 1 active
[ 221 015 ]
MAIN:
Fct. block. 2 active
[ 221 023 ]
MAIN:
DC fail. cmd. End
[ 221 108 ]
MAIN:
DC fail. cmd.start
[ 221 109 ]
MAIN:
DEV op.time exceeded
[ 221 110 ]
LOGIC:
Output 01
[ 042 032 ]
LOGIC:
Output 01 (t)
[ 042 033 ]
DEV01:
Switch. device open
[ 210 036 ]
DEV01:
Switch.device closed
[ 210 037 ]
DEV01:
Dev. interm./flt.pos
[ 210 038 ]
SIG_1:
Logic signal S001
[ 226 005 ]
GOOSE:
Ext.Dev01 closed
[ 109 002 ]
GOOSE:
Ext.Dev01 interm.pos
[ 109 003 ]
ILOCK:
Output 01
[ 250 032 ]
LIMIT:
tVPP> elapsed
[ 040 228 ]
& ≥1
ILOCK:
Output 01
[ 250 032 ]
49Z9112A
MAIN:
Cmd. dur.long cmd. OUTP:
[ 221 230 ] Fct.assignment K xxx
[ xxx xxx ]
MAIN:
Cmd. dur. short cmd.
[ 221 231 ]
K x1
CMD_1: CMD_1:
Command C001 config. Oper. mode cmd. C001 K x2 -K xxx
[ 200 004 ] [ 200 002 ]
K x3
K xx
0 1
0: No 3
1: Yes
1: Long command
2: Short command
3: Persistent command
CMD_1:
& 1 ≥1 Command C001
& t [ 200 001 ]
COMM1:
Command C001
[ - - - - - - ]
LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
[ 221 004 ]
& 1
t
&
19Z50ALB
Fig. 3-355: Functional sequence for single-pole commands, as illustrated for Command C001.
SIG_1: SIG_1:
Signal S001 config. Gr.asg. debounc.S001
[ 226 007 ] [ 226 003 ]
0: No Selected group
1: Yes
Debouncing SIG_1:
Logic signal S001
SIG_1: [ 226 005 ]
Signal S001 EXT
[ 226 004 ]
Chatter suppression
SIG_1:
Min. sig. dur. S001
[ 226 002 ]
COMM1:
Signal S001,log
[ --- ---]
SIG_1:
Oper. mode sig. S001
[ 226 001 ]
0: Without function
1: Start/end signal
2: Transient signal
19Z50AMA
Fig. 3-356: Functional sequence for single-pole signals with the example for logic signal S001.
SIG_1:
Gr.asg. debounc.S001
[ 226 003 ]
1: Group 1
2: Group 2
3: Group 3
4: Group 4
5: Group 5
6: Group 6
7: Group 7
8: Group 8
SIG_1:
Signal S001 EXT
[ 226 004 ]
DEV01:
Gr. assign. debounc.
[ 210 011 ]
8 MAIN:
Debounce time gr. 1
1: Group 1 [ 221 200 ]
2: Group 2 MAIN:
Chatt.mon. time gr.1
3: Group 3
[ 221 201 ]
4: Group 4
MAIN:
5: Group 5 Change of state gr.1
6: Group 6 [ 221 202 ]
7: Group 7
8: Group 8
Debouncing
&
COMM1:
DEV01: Chatter suppression Debounced signal
Closed signal EXT 304 400
[ 210 031 ] Group 1
DEV01:
Open signal EXT
[ 210 030 ]
19Z5067B
Fig. 3-357: Group assignment and setting of debouncing and chatter suppression, illustrated for group 1.
In the acquisition of signals for control purposes, the functions real time
acquisition (time tagging), debouncing and chatter suppression are included as
standard. Each of these signals can be assigned to one of eight groups and for
each of these groups the debouncing time and chatter suppression can be set.
Matching of these two parameters achieves the suppression of multiple spurious
pickups.
3.50.1.1.1 Debouncing
Telegram with
time tag 1s 2e
Signal sequence
time tag
F0Z5011B
Fig. 3-358: Signal flow with debouncing when time tagging occurs with the 1st pulse edge (e.g. parameter
M A I N : T i m e t a g set to the value 1stEdge,OpMem unsort or 1stEdge,OpMem sorted.) Example: Set debouncing
time: 50 ms, s: start, e: end.
The first pulse edge of a signal starts a timer stage running for the duration of
the set debouncing time. Each pulse edge during the debouncing time re-triggers
the timer stage.
If the signal is stable until the set debouncing time elapses, a telegram
containing the time tag of the first pulse edge is generated. As an alternative the
time tag may be generated after debouncing by setting parameter MAIN: Time
ta g to the value After debounce time.
After the set debouncing time has elapsed, the state of the signal is checked. If it
is the same as prior to the occurrence of the first pulse edge, no telegram is
generated.
Time-tagged entries of the first pulse edge are only generated after debounce
time has elapsed. If these entries are saved without delay (setting of
MAI N: Time tag to the value 1stEdge,OpMem unsort) they are not necessarily
saved in chronological order in the operating data memory. If above parameter
has been set to the value 1stEdge,OpMem sorted then all entries are always
saved in chronological order in the operating data memory.
Time Tag
The following overview illustrates how the (221 098) MAIN: Time tag setting is
operating.
}
(no time tag, internal signal to start debouncing)2)
1stEdge,OpMem sorted:
(226 005) S IG_1 : L ogic signal S0 01
● on COMM1/IEC T L
1stEdge,OpMem unsort:
(226 005) SIG_1: Logic signal S001
● on COMM1/IEC T L
T = Time tag
L = Log of state
Telegram with
time tag 1s 2e 3s 4e
Signal sequence
20ms 200ms
20ms 200ms
20ms 200ms
200ms
time tag
Debouncing
F0Z5012A
Fig. 3-359: Signal flow for debouncing and chatter suppression. Set debouncing time: 20 ms, set chatter monitoring
time: 200 ms, number of admissible signal changes: 4, s: start, e: end.
Sending of the first telegram starts a timer stage running for the duration of the
set monitoring time. While the timer stage is elapsing, telegrams are generated
for the admissible signal changes. The number of admissible signal changes can
be set. After the first “inadmissible” signal change, no further telegrams are
generated and the timer stage is re-triggered. While the timer stage is elapsing,
it is re-triggered by each new signal change. Once the timer stage has elapsed,
each signal change triggers a telegram.
3.51.2 Debouncing
Count
Signal sequence
50ms
19Z50APA
The first positive pulse edge of the binary input signal to be counted will trigger a
timer stage which will continue to run for the set debouncing time period. Each
positive pulse edge during the debouncing time re-triggers the timer stage. The
binary input signal will be counted if it is stable during the set debouncing time
period.
The debouncing time can be set separately for each of the four counters.
After the set debouncing time has elapsed, the state of the signal is checked. If it
is the same as prior to the occurrence of the first pulse edge, it will not be
counted.
60/(set cycle time) comes to an integer. In all other cases the counter values are
transmitted at time intervals determined by a free running internal clock.
COUNT:
General enable USER
[ 217 000 ]
0
COUNT:
1 Enabled
0: No [ 217 001 ]
MAIN: 1: Yes
Device on-line COUNT:
[ 003 030 ] Count 1
1: Yes (= on) [ 217 100 ]
COUNT: COUNT:
Debounce t. count. 1 m CT=m Count 1
[ 217 160 ] [ 217 100 ]
+
COUNT: Debouncing
Set counter 1 EXT
R
[ 217 130 ]
COUNT:
Transmit counts USER
[ 217 008 ]
0
COUNT:
1 Transmit counts
[ 217 010 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
C
COUNT:
Transmit counts EXT
[ 217 009 ]
COUNT:
Cycle t.count transm
C
[ 217 007 ] COMM1:
Count 1
[ --- --- ]
G
COUNT:
Reset USER
[ 217 003 ]
= 0 min
0
COUNT:
1 Reset
[ 217 005 ]
0: don't execute
1: execute
COUNT:
Reset EXT
[ 217 004 ]
MAIN:
General reset USER
[ 003 002 ] 1
1: execute
MAIN:
General reset EXT
[ 005 255 ]
19Z82ANA
Fig. 3-361: Binary Count. (This diagram shows counter 1 as an example. The displayed logic is also valid for
counters 2 to 4, where C O U N T : S e t c o u n t e r 1 E X T and C O U N T : C o u n t 1 have to be replaced by the
respective parameters.
TIMER:
Calendar 1
TIMER: c
General enable USER [ 014 178 ]
[ 014 199 ]
TIMER: m out of n
Monday
[ 014 139 ]
.
.
.
TIMER:
Sunday
[ 014 169 ]
Φ
Hardware clock
TIMER:
Start hour 1
[ 014 089 ]
TIMER:
Start minute 1
[ 014 102 ]
TIMER:
End hour 1
[ 014 109 ]
TIMER:
End minute 1
[ 014 118 ]
Φ
TIMER:
Timer stage 1
[ 015 006 ]
19Z8854A
Fig. 3-362: TIMER logic (Calendar 1 shown as an example for 4 calendar timers).
4 Design
The P139 is available in different types of cases and with different combinations
of modules.
Irrespective of the type a P139 is equipped with a detachable HMI or a fixed local
control panel. The local control panel is covered with a tough film so that the
specified degree of IP protection will be maintained. In addition to the essential
control and display elements, a parallel display consisting of multi-colored LED
indicators is also incorporated (see Section 6.2, (p. 6-2)). The meaning of the
various LED indications is shown in plain text on a label strip.
The PC interface (9-pin D-Sub female connector) is located under the hinged
cover at the bottom of the local control panel.
4.1 Designs
The P139 is available in a surface-mounted and a flush-mounted case. Depending
on the connection type – pin-terminal or ring-terminal connection – the case sizes
differ. The location diagrams (Section 5.7, (p. 5-30)) show the available
combinations of case widths and connection types.
Electrical connections are made via plug-in threaded terminal blocks. The
threaded terminal blocks in the surface-mounted case are accessible from the
front of the device after unscrewing the torx head steal screws on the sides (see
Fig. 4-1, (p. 4-3), ➀) and removing the local control panel. The local control
panel can then be secured by inserting the tabs in the slots in the left side wall
(see Fig. 4-1, (p. 4-3), ➁). The flush-mounted case is connected at the back
of the case.
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ The local control panel (or front element) is connected to processor
module P by a plug-in connecting cable. Make sure the connector position
is correct. Do not bend the connecting cable!
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage
or unintended equipment operation.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Do not open the secondary circuit of live system current transformers! If
the secondary circuit of a live CT is opened, there is the danger that the
resulting voltages will endanger personnel and damage the insulation.
⚫ For pin-terminal connection devices, the terminal block for system current
transformer connection is not a shorting block! Therefore always short-
circuit the system current transformers before loosening the threaded
terminals.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Fig. 4-1: Surface-mounted case, removal of local control panel (or – in case of a detachable HMI – the case front
panel). The illustration shows the 84TE case with (fixed) local control panel.
147.5
177.5
184.5
213.4 257.1
242.6
260.2
227.9
213.4 253.6
203.0
155.4
159.0
168.0
5.0
5.0
181.3
Fig. 4-3: Flush-mounted case 40 TE with panel opening, flush-mount method 1 (without angle brackets).
(Dimensions in mm.)
101.6
177.5
213.4 227.9
242.6 253.6
260.2
6.4
186.5
101.6
224.5
242.6
Fig. 4-4: Flush-mounted case 40 TE with panel opening, flush-mount method 2 (with angle brackets and frame).
(Dimensions in mm.)
434.8 257.1
464.0
481.6
177.5
227.9
434.8 253.6
284.9
259.0
25.9
159.0
168.0
5.0
5.0
410.0
Fig. 4-6: Flush-mounted case 84 TE with panel opening, flush-mount method 1 (without angle brackets).
(Dimensions in mm.)
101.6
177.5
434.8 227.9
253.6
464.0
481.6
6.4
186.5
101.6
445.9
464.0
Fig. 4-7: Flush-mounted case 84 TE with panel opening, flush-mount method 2 (with angle brackets and frame).
(Dimensions in mm.)
20.7
206.0
46.3
197.5
192.5
148.0
168.0
3.0
181.3
Key:
● ●: standard equipment,
● ○: optional,
● ☐: depending on order,
● *: Module is not depicted in the terminal connection diagrams (Section 5.7,
(p. 5-30)).
● →xx: Module has to be fitted into slot number xx.
● 1st→xx, 2nd→yy [etc.]: If several modules of the same type may be ordered,
these must be fitted into the appropriate slots in a particular order: If only
one has been ordered it must be fitted into slot xx (i. e. slot yy is not
permitted). If two modules have been ordered these must be fitted into
slots xx and yy, etc.
9651517 D ff Binary I/O module (6 binary inputs, 6 high- X(6I 6H) 4TE ○ ○ ○
break contacts), Standard variant with 1st→ 1st→ 1st→
switching threshold at 65% of 24 VDC 06 06 12
(VA,min)
2nd→ 2nd→ 2nd→
9651518 A ff Binary I/O module (6 binary inputs, 6 high- 07 07 14
break contacts), Special variant with
switching threshold at 65% of 110 VDC
(VA,nom)
The location of the individual modules and the position of the threaded terminal
blocks in the P139 are shown in the location figures and terminal connection
diagrams (Section 5.7, (p. 5-30)).
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ When electrical equipment is in operation, dangerous voltage will be
present in certain parts of the equipment.
⚫ Proper and safe operation of this device depends on appropriate shipping
and handling, proper storage, installation and commissioning, and on
careful operation, maintenance and servicing. For this reason only
qualified personnel shall work on or operate this device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Switch off the auxiliary power supply before any work in the terminal strip
area.
⚫ Switch off all the power supplies in connection to the equipment before
any work in the terminal strip area to isolate the device.
⚫ Do not touch the terminal strip area when equipment is in operation.
⚫ Do not remove or add wires in the terminal strip area when equipment is
in operation.
⚫ Short-circuit the system current transformers before disconnecting wires
to the transformer board (valid only for pin terminals, not required for ring
terminals which have a shortening block).
⚫ A protective conductor (ground/earth) of at least 1.5 mm2 must be
connected to the protective conductor terminal on the power supply board
and on the main relay case.
⚫ Do never remove the protective conductor connection to the device casing
as long as other wires are connected to it.
⚫ Where stranded conductors are used, insulated crimped wire end ferrules
must be employed.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Note: Regarding the appropriate wiring connections of the equipment refer to the
document Px3x_Grounding_Application_Guide_EN_h.pdf.
WARNING
HAZARD OF UNSAFE OPERATION
⚫ The user should be familiar with the warnings in the Safety Guide
(SFTY/5LM/L11 or later version) before working on the equipment.
⚫ The user should be familiar with the safety messages in Chapter 5,
Chapter 10, Chapter 11 and Chapter 12 and with the content of Chapter 13
of this technical manual, before working on the equipment.
⚫ Proper and safe operation of this device depends on appropriate shipping
and handling, proper storage, installation and commissioning, and on
careful operation, maintenance and servicing. For this reason only
qualified personnel shall work on or operate this device.
⚫ Any modifications to this device must be in accordance with the manual. If
any other modification is made without the express permission of
Schneider Electric, it will invalidate the warranty, and may render the
product unsafe.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unintended
equipment operation.
The signals MAI N: Bl ocked/faulty and SFMON: War ning (LED) are
permanently assigned to the LEDs labeled OUT OF SERVICE and ALARM and can
be assigned to output relays to indicate the health of the device.
It is recommended that the signals MA IN: Blocke d/faulty and
SFMON : Wa rning ( LED) are communicated to the substation automation
system for alarm purposes, using hardwiring via output relays or the
communication interface.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
In case of usage of the equipment with DHMI:
⚫ A protective conductor (ground/earth) of at least 1.5 mm2 (US: AWG14 or
thicker) must be connected to the DHMI protective conductor terminal to
link the DHMI and the main relay case; these must be located within the
same substation.
⚫ The DHMI communication cable must not be in contact with hazardous live
parts.
⚫ The DHMI communication cable must not be routed or placed alongside
high-voltage cables or connections. Currents can be induced in the cable
which may result in electromagnetic interference.
⚫ We recommend to use only cables of category CAT6 (or better), which has
been tested up to a length of 10 m.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE OR LIFETIME REDUCTION
⚫ The instructions given in the Section 5.5, (p. 5-14) (“Protective and
Operational Grounding”) should be noted. In particular, check that the
protective ground connection is secured with a tooth lock washer, as per
the diagram “Installing the protective grounding conductor terminal” (Fig.
5-8. (p. 5-15)).
⚫ If a cable screen is added to this connection or removed from it, then the
protective grounding should be checked again.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury
or equipment damage.
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE OR LIFETIME REDUCTION
⚫ Do not sustain exposure to high humidity during storage, the value shall
not exceed 75 % relative humidity.
⚫ Once the device has been unpacked, it is recommended to energize it
within the three following months.
⚫ The device has to be energized at least once in 4 years, if it is not in
permanent operation.
⚫ Where electrical equipment is being installed, sufficient time should be
allowed for acclimatization to the ambient temperature of the environment
before energization.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage,
unintended equipment operation or reduction of equipment lifetime.
Px3x-xxxxxxxx-3xx-4xx-6xx-7xx- 48 - 250 V
9xx-8xx Vx-
100 - 230 V
SER No. 3xxxxxxx /xx/xx
In 1/5A 50 / 60Hz
E.Serial No. 3.xxxxxx.x
E.Reg No. STxxxxxxxxx Vn 50 - 130V
Fig. 5-1: Example of the type identification label of a device from the Easergy MiCOM 30 family.
The P139 design version can be determined from the order number. A
breakdown of the order number is given in Chapter “Order Information”
(Chapter 15, (p. 15-1)).
5.4 Installation
The dimensions and mounting dimensions for surface-mounted cases are given
in Section 4.2, (p. 4-4). When the P139 is surface-mounted on a panel, the wiring
to the P139 is normally run along the front side of the mounting plane. If the
wiring is to be at the back, an opening can be provided above or below the
surface-mounted case. Fig. 5-2, (p. 5-7) shows such an opening.
D5Z50MBA
Fig. 5-2: Opening (cutout) for running the connecting leads to an 40 TE surface-mounted case.
The opening width for the 40 TE surface-mounted case: 213 mm (shown in this
figure), for the 84 TE surface-mounted case: 435 mm. The other dimensions are
the same for all cases.
Flush-mounted cases are designed for control panels. The dimensions and
mounting dimensions are given in Chapter “Design”. When the P139 is mounted
on a cabinet door, special sealing measures are necessary to provide the degree
of protection required for the cabinet (IP 51).
Connection of protective grounding conductor: See “Protective and Operational
Grounding” (Section 5.5, (p. 5-14))
For flush-mount method 1 (without angle brackets and frame), the procedure is
as follows:
Before the P139 can be installed into a control panel, the local control panel (or
the front element of the case for devices with detachable display) must be taken
down. The local control panel is removed as described below:
1. Remove both top and bottom hinged flaps from the device. (Lift/lower
both hinged flaps 180° up/down. Hold them in the middle and bend them
slightly. The side mountings of both hinged flaps can then be disengaged.)
2. Remove the M3.5 screws (see Fig. 5-3, (p. 5-9)).
3. Then remove the local control panel.
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ The local control panel (or front element) is connected to processor
module P by a plug-in connecting cable. Make sure the connector position
is correct. Do not bend the connecting cable!
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage
or unintended equipment operation.
Then remove the lower M4 screws and only loosen the upper M4 screws (see
Fig. 5-3, (p. 5-9)). Now insert the P139 into the panel opening from the rear
so that the upper M4 screws fit into the corresponding holes. Then tighten all the
M4 screws. After this, replace the local control panel.
NOTICE
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ When replacing the local control panel, take care not to tighten the screws
with too much strength! (Fastening torque 1.5 to 1.8 Newton meters).
⚫ If the control panel thickness is ≥ 2 mm, the longer screws as enclosed
within the device packing must be used.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
< 3 mm
M4
M3.5
12Y6181B
Fig. 5-3: Installation of a case into a control panel. Flush-mount method 1 (without the angle brackets and frame ).
Example for a device with a 40 TE case.
NOTICE
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ The equipment provides increased mechanical robustness if either the
surface-mounted case or for the flush-mounted case flush-mount method 2
(with angle brackets and frame, see Fig. 5-5, (p. 5-10)) is used.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Secure connection of protective grounding conductor: See Section 5.5, (p.
5-14).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
For flush-mount method 2 (using the angle brackets and frame), the procedure is
as follows:
1. Remove the screws as shown in Fig. 5-4, (p. 5-10), ➀ and mount the
enclosed angle brackets using these same screws.
2. Then push the device into the control panel cutout from the front.
3. Secure the device to the control panel by using the enclosed M6 screws
(see Fig. 5-5, (p. 5-10)).
4. Assemble the cover frame and snap-fasten onto the fixing screws.
45Z5058A
Angle brackets
M6
B6
6.4
M6 x 15
Height: 204mm
for
Frame 280mm
Width:
E case
the 40T
12Y6183B
Fig. 5-5: Installation of a case into a control panel, flush-mount method 2 (with angle brackets and frame). Example
for a device in a 40 TE case.
The cover frame width of the 40 TE surface-mounted case is: 280 mm, of the
84 TE case is: 486 mm. The cover frame height is for all cases: 204 mm.
NOTICE
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ The equipment provides increased mechanical robustness if either the
surface-mounted case or for the flush-mounted case flush-mount method 2
(with angle brackets and frame, see Fig. 5-5, (p. 5-10)) is used.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Secure connection of protective grounding conductor: See Section 5.5, (p.
5-14).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Connection flange
Tapped bush
Bolt
61Y5077A
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Secure connection of protective grounding conductor: See Section 5.5, (p.
5-14).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Covering flange
Rack frame
61Y5078A
Fig. 5-7: Installing the P139 in a cabinet with a 19″ mounting rack.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Secure connection of protective grounding conductor: See Section 5.5, (p.
5-14).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The device must be reliably grounded to meet protective equipment
grounding requirements.
⚫ The surface-mounted case is grounded using the bolt and nut,
appropriately marked, as the ground connection. The flush-mounted case
must be grounded in the area of the rear sidepieces at the location
provided. The bracket is marked with the protective ground symbol: .
The cross-section of the ground conductor must conform to applicable
national standards. A minimum cross section of 2.5 mm² (≤ AWG12) is
required.
⚫ In addition, a protective ground connection at the terminal contact on the
power supply module (identified by the letters “PE” on the terminal
connection diagram) is also required for proper operation of the device.
The cross-section of this ground conductor must also conform to applicable
national standards. A minimum cross section of 1.5 mm² (US: AWG14 or
thicker) is required.
⚫ If a detachable HMI is installed, a further protective conductor (ground/
earth) of at least 1.5 mm² (US: AWG14 or thicker) must be connected to
the DHMI protective conductor terminal to link the DHMI and the main
relay case; these must be located within the same substation.
⚫ All grounding connections must be low-inductance, i.e. it must be kept as
short as possible.
⚫ The protective conductor (earth) must always be connected to the
protective grounding conductor terminal in order to guarantee the safety
given by this setup.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
1
2 1
3
2
4
4
PE terminal PE terminal
surface-mount. case flush-mount. case
1 Nut M4 1 Nut M4
4 Bolt M4 4 Bolt M4
19Y5220B
5.6 Connection
The P139 Feeder Management and Bay Control must be connected in accordance
with the terminal connection diagram as indicated on the type identification
label. The relevant terminal connection diagrams that apply to the P139 are to be
found either in the supporting documents supplied with the device, or in
Section 5.7, (p. 5-30).
In general copper conductors with a cross section of 2.5 mm² (US: AWG12) are
sufficient to connect a system current transformer to a current input on the P139.
To reduce CT knee-point voltage requirements, it may be necessary to install
shorter copper conductors with a greater cross section between the system
current transformers and the current inputs on the P139. Copper conductors
having a cross section of 1.5 mm² (US: AWG14) are adequate to connect binary
signal inputs, the output relays and the power supply input.
All connections run into the system must always have a defined potential.
Connections that are pre-wired but not used should preferably be grounded when
binary inputs and output relays are isolated. When binary inputs and output
relays are connected to common potential, the pre-wired but unused connections
should be connected to the common potential of the grouped connections.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ When increased-safety machinery is located in a hazardous area the
device must always be installed outside of this hazardous area to protect
this equipment.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The power supply must be turned off for at least 5 s before power supply
module V is removed. Otherwise there is the danger of an electric shock.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Do not open the secondary circuit of live system current transformers! If
the secondary circuit of a live CT is opened, there is the danger that the
resulting voltages will endanger personnel and damage the insulation.
⚫ For pin-terminal connection devices, the terminal block for system current
transformer connection is not a shorting block! Therefore always short-
circuit the system current transformers before loosening the threaded
terminals.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
A
B
C Transformer Type T
module 4J –/4/5V
X041 X042
1 1
2 2 IA
3 3
4 4 IB
5 5
6 6 IC
7 7
8 8 IN
X041
13 1 U
14 2 V
15 3 W
16 4 N
P139
19Z9111A
Fig. 5-10, (p. 5-19) shows the standard connection for ground fault direction
determination by steady-state values where the voltage measuring circuit is
connected to an open delta winding. With this connection configuration,
“forward/LS” is displayed if a ground fault occurs on the line side. A reversed
connection is possible for the system current or voltage transformer if the
appropriate setting is configured.
Connection to Connection to
Holmgreen group Window-type CT
A
B BS
C
A B C
Ring Pin
X042
K k 7 7
I̲N
8 8
L l
17 N(e)
18
E(n)
l
P139
LS 49Z9109A
Fig. 5-10: Connecting the steady-state ground fault direction determination function to Holmgreen-configuration
and core balance transformers.
transmitting relay must be wired, and in the second case the make contact must
be wired. The figures show the connection for the setting Transm. rel. break con.
Protection device a L+ L-
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
[ 037 024 ]
-K1
L+
PSIG:
Receive EXT
L-
[ 036 048 ]
P139
Protection device b L- L+
PSIG:
Receive EXT -K2
[ 036 048 ]
L+
L-
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
[ 037 024 ]
P139
D5Z50DBA
L+ L-
Protection device a
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
[ 037 024 ]
L+
PSIG:
Receive EXT
L-
[ 036 048 ]
P139
L-
Protection device b L+
PSIG:
Send (transm.relay)
[ 037 024 ]
PSIG: L+
Receive EXT
[ 036 048 ] L-
P139
D5Z50DCA
PT 100
P139
S8Z52H9A
Kxx CB
49Z9005A
In order to ascertain that the inductive coil current is switched off from the CB
auxiliary contacts, the setting of minimum pulse duration for trip commands
(MAI N: Min.dur. t rip cmd. 1 etc.) and close command need to consider the
operating times of the circuit breaker and its auxiliary contacts. Sufficient margin
has to be applied for pulse duration. A common setting is to double operating
time of the circuit breaker, e.g. for a CB trip operation time top of 100 ms, the
minimum trip pulse time should be 0.2 s (see the following figure).
CB Closed (52a)
top
tmop= 2*top
MAIN:
Min.dur. trip cmd. 1
49Z9006A
This of course also applies to device open/close command outputs operated with
fix (short or long) command duration (e.g. DEVxx Oper. mode cmd. = Short
command).
If the Px30 output contact triggers an auxiliary relay which opens or closes the
CB consecutively, then it should be verified, that the make/continuous/break coil
currents of this auxiliary relay are within the limit values given in Section 2.5.7,
(p. 2-12).
Note: Upon testing such command outputs, the CB (or equivalent auxiliary
components) must not be mechanically locked, so that the auxiliary 52a/b
contact could operate and break the DC current. If the CB has to stay locked,
tripping or closing circuit has to be opened by terminal disconnection or test
switch.
CIRCUIT BREAKER DRIVE Q1 DRIVE Q2 DRIVE Q8 TRIGGER. Shunt wd. MOTOR RELAY
‑K200.1
P139
‑X061 3 5 9 ‑X062 2 6 8 ‑X071 3 5 ‑X072 6 8
P139
‑X061 2 8 ‑X062 5 ‑X071 2
E1 E3 E1 E3 E1 E3 ‑X073 8
M1 M2 M3 X//Y
‑U706
P139
E4 E4 E4 ‑X073 9
‑K200.3
‑X072 7 9
‑K705.2 ‑K706.2
P139
‑X072 5
S8Z01G3A
Fig. 5-16: Connection example, motor with shunt winding for a direct motor control, bay type No. 89
(A23.105.M04), feeder bay with circuit breaker, double busbar.
5.6.3.1 PC Interface
The PC interface is provided so that personnel can operate the device from a
personal computer (PC).
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The PC interface is not designed as a permanent connection.
Consequently, the female connector does not have the extra insulation
from circuits connected to the system that is required per IEC/EN
60255-27. Therefore DO NOT leave any permanent cable connection on
the PC interface connector at the HMI front panel.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
UNEXPECTED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
⚫ Do not use a PC with active termination on any connection pin of the
RS232 interface. Wrong termination can drive the device to delay
operating actions from the HMI as long as this wrong termination is active
on the PC interface.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unintended
equipment operation.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Do not connect or disconnect the RS 485 or fiber-optic interface when the
supply voltage for the device is under power and in operation.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
An RS 485 data transmission link between a master and several slave devices
can be established by using the optional communication interface. The
communication master could be, for instance, a central control station. Devices
linked to the communication master, e.g. P139, are set-up as slave devices.
The RS 485 interface available on the P139 was designed so that data transfer in
a full duplex transmission mode is possible using a 4-wire data link between
devices. Data transfer between devices using the RS 485 interface is set up only
for a half duplex transmission mode. To connect the RS 485 communication
interface the following must be observed:
● Only twisted pair shielded cables must be used, that are common in
telecommunication installations.
● At least one symmetrical twisted pair of wires is necessary.
● Conductor insulation and shielding must only be removed from the core in
the immediate vicinity of the terminal strips and connected according to
national standards.
● All shielding must be connected to an effective protective ground surface at
both ends.
● Unused conductors must all be grounded at one end.
A 4‑wire data link as an alternative to a 2-wire communications link is also
possible. A cable with two symmetrical twisted pair wires is required for a 4-wire
data link. A 2-wire data link is shown in Fig. 5-17, (p. 5-27), and a 4-wire data
link is shown in Fig. 5-18, (p. 5-28) as an example for channel 2 on the
communication module. The same is valid if channel 1 on the communication
module is available as a RS 485 interface.
2-wire data link:
The transmitter must be bridged with the receiver on all devices equipped
electrically with a full duplex communication interface, e.g. the P139. The two
devices situated at either far end must have a 200 to 220 Ω resistor installed to
terminate the data transmission conductor. In devices from the Easergy MiCOM
30 family, and also in the P139, a 220 Ω resistor is integrated into the RS 485
interface hardware and can be connected with a wire jumper. An external
resistor is therefore not necessary.
4-wire data link:
Transmitter and receiver must be bridged in the device situated on one far end
of the data transmission conductor. The receivers of slave devices, that have an
electrically full-duplex communication interface as part of their electrical system,
e.g. the P139, are connected to the transmitter of the communication master
device, and the transmitters of slave devices are connected to the receiver of the
master device. Devices equipped electrically with only a half duplex RS 485
communication interface are connected to the transmitter of the communication
master device. The last device in line (master or slave device) on the data
transmission conductor must have the transmitter and receiver terminated with
a 200 to 220 Ω resistor each. In devices from the Easergy MiCOM 30 family, and
also in the P139, a 220 Ω resistor is integrated into the RS 485 interface
-X9/-X10
− 1 −
D1[T] + 2 + D2[R]
− 4 −
D2[R] + 5 + D1[T]
XXXX P139
-X9/-X10 1 2 3 4 5
− + − + − + − +
P139 XXXX
Fig. 5-17: 2-wire data link. (Note: the setting M A I N : C h a n n . a s s i g n . C O M M 1 / 2 decides about whether -X9
(=channel 1) or -X10 (=channel 2) is used.)
-X9/-X10
D1[T] D2[R]
D2[R] D1[T]
XXXX P139
-X9/-X10
P139 XXXX
Fig. 5-18: 4-wire data link. (Note: the setting M A I N : C h a n n . a s s i g n . C O M M 1 / 2 decides about whether -X9
(=channel 1) or -X10 (=channel 2) is used.)
For CH1/CH2 connection diagram, please refer to Section 5.7, (p. 5-30)
B A ETH
ACT
LNK
A ETH
ACT
LNK
ETH A
ETH A
ETH B
ETH A
ETH B
ETH C
ETH C
ETH C
ETH C
IRIG B
IRIG B
IRIG B
IRIG B
Fig. 5-19: SEB Fiber. Fig. 5-20: SEB Fig. 5-21: REB Fiber. Fig. 5-22: REB
Copper. Copper.
Connector Connections
ETH A Fiber/Copper
ETH B Fiber/Copper
ETH C Copper
IRIG-B Demodulated (DC IRIG-B)/ Modulated (AC IRIG-B)
Tab. 5-1: Connector functionality.
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10
P A A T X X X V X
CH1 CH3 4I 6I 6I 24I 4I 4H
CH2 6H 6H 8O
A N T X X Y X
SEB 4I 6I 6I 4I 6I
LC/ 4V 6O 6O 3O
RJ45 24I X
T X X
A 4I 6I 6O
REB Y 5V 8O
LC/ 4I
RJ45
Y
9T
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
P A A T X X X X V
CH1 CH3 4I 6I 6I 24I 4H 4I
CH2 6H 6H 8O
A N T
4I
X
6I
X
6I
Y
4I
X
6I
SEB
4V 6O 6O 3O
X
LC/
RJ45 24I
T X X
4I 6I 6O
A
REB Y
5V 8O
LC/ 4I
RJ45
Y
9T
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
V̲ref 10 1 10 1
11 7
T15 11 2 K_04 11 2
12 8 11 2
12 3 K_05 K_02 12 3
13 4
12 3 + 13 4
K_06
Current measuring 14 5 K_07 14 5 K_03
inputs
15 6 15 6
X042 Option: 16 7 K_08 16 7
1 1 I̲A 17 8 X__3 17 8 Signal
► T1
Signal inputs 18 9
inputs
2 2 18 9
Vin Vin
3 3 I̲B U_01 U_01
► T2
X__3 19 1 X__3
4 4 Vin
19 1 K_03 U_02
I̲C
20 2 + 19 1
5 5
► T3 20 2
Vin
U_02
20 2
Vin
U_03
6 6 21 3 21 3
I̲N 22 4 22 4
7 7
► T4 Vin
U_03 26 8 23 5
Vin
U_04
8 8 23 5 K_04 24 6
Vin 27 9 + Vin
24 6 U_04 25 7 U_05
26 8
Power supply Vin
25 7 27 9 U_06
+ V
aux
26 8 −
U100
27 9
X8 X32
1 TX
X//Y U18 X//Y U23
7
RS 422 / 485 +UB
IRIG-B
RS 232
time synchronization
X11
1
U21
Port B
Port B X14
X14 1
and Ethernet RX > X//Y U30
service interface IRIG-B
Port C
time synchronization
X//Y U28 RJ45
X15 TX
1 X11
> X//Y U31 1
(DC IRIG-B)
Demodulated
RJ45
2 Isolated GND U21
3 and Ethernet and Ethernet
service interface service interface
Modulated Port C Port C
(AC IRIG-B)
X15 X15
1 1
IRIG-B
> X//Y U31 > X//Y U31
time synchronization RJ45 RJ45
X11
(DC IRIG-B)
1 Demodulated
IRIG-B IRIG-B
2 Isolated GND U21
time synchronization time synchronization
3
X11 X11
Modulated (DC IRIG-B) (DC IRIG-B)
(AC IRIG-B) 1 Demodulated 1 Demodulated
H4 TRIP
H3 ALARM
H2 OUT OF SERVICE
H1 HEALTHY
H17 EDIT MODE
H5
H6
H7
H8
H9
H10
H11
H12
H13
H14
H15
H16
Fig. 6-1: View of the local control panel and layout of the LED indicators for the graphic display.
Panel Level: The “up”/“down” keys switch between the pages of the Measured
Value Panel.
Menu Tree Level: Press the “up” and “down” keys to navigate up and down
through the menu tree in a vertical direction. If the unit is in input mode, the
“up” and “down” keys have a different function.
Input mode: Settings can only be changed in the input mode, which is signaled
by the LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE. Press the “up” and “down” keys in this
mode to change the setting value.
● “Up” key: the next higher value is selected.
● “Down” key: the next lower value is selected.
With list settings, press the “up” and “down” key to change the logic operator of
the value element.
Menu Tree Level: Press the “left” and “right” keys to navigate through the
menu tree in a horizontal direction. If the unit is in input mode, the “left” and
“right” keys have a different function.
Input mode: Settings can only be changed in the input mode, which is signaled
by the LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE. When the “left” and “right” keys are
pressed, the cursor positioned below one of the digits in the change-enabled
value moves one digit to the right or left.
● “Left” key: the cursor moves to the next digit on the left.
● “Right” key: the cursor moves to the next digit on the right.
In the case of a list setting, press the “left” and “right” keys to navigate through
the list of items available for selection.
Panel Level: Press the ENTER key at the Panel level to go to the menu tree.
Menu Tree Level: Press the ENTER key to enter the input mode. Press the
ENTER key a second time to accept the changes as entered and exit the input
mode. The LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE signals that the input mode is
active.
Press the CLEAR key to reset the LED indicators and clear all measured event
data. The records in the recording memories are not affected by this action.
Input mode: When the CLEAR key is pressed all changes entered are rejected
and the input mode is exited.
Press the READ key to access a selected event recording from either the Panel
level or from any other point in the menu tree.
The local/remote key is effective in the Bay Panel except where a binary signal
input has been configured for this function.
The local/remote key is the transfer switch between remote and local control
(setting R <-> L), or between remote&local and local control (setting R & L <->
L). If the “Local/Remote” key is set to switch from Remote control to Local
control, then this can only occur if the password has first been entered first.
Switching from Local to Remote control will occur without checking the password.
Panel Level: Pressing the page key shows the next panel.
Menu Tree Level: When the page key is pressed the Menu Tree Level is exited
and the Bay Panel is accessed.
Bay Panel: The Selection key is effective only in the Bay Panel and only if local
control is activated.
If local control has been selected, pressing the selection key selects the
switchgear unit to be controlled. The selected external device will be marked by
an asterisk (*) – as long as no external device names are displayed. Otherwise
the external device name will flash and will be displayed in the status line.
Signal Panel: The Selection key is used to select a flashing signal (not yet
acknowledged) and will also automatically switch to pages that might be
available. When the last flashing signal has been reached pressing the Selection
key again will start with the first flashing signal.
To access a selected event recording from either the panel level or from any
other point in the menu tree, press the “READ” key .
From the control and display panels (e.g. measured value panels or the bay
panel) the user can access the menu tree level by pressing the “ENTER” key.
To return to the previously selected control and display panel from the menu tree
level the user must simultaneously press the keys “Cursor up” and “RESET”. (If
previously no panel was selected, i.e. after a system restart, then the bay panel,
if available, is accessed.)
After the set LOC : Au tom. retu rn ti me has elapsed the protection unit will
also return automatically from the menu tree level to the control and display
panel last selected.
The user can move from a bay panel to a measured value panel by pressing the
key “Cursor left” and back again by pressing the key “Cursor right”.
Bay Panel Signal Panel Measured Value Panel(s) Event Panel Record View
(state-dependent)
Device type
After start-up of the device, the display is at the Panel Level. The Bay Panel is
displayed.
Locked Q8
1: Remote
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
Step 1 Press the Enter key to go from the Panel Level to the P139
Parameters
Menu Tree Level.
Step 0 From the Menu Tree Level, the user can jump to the Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Device on-line
Panel Level from any position within the menu tree. No (=off)
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
After the set return time has elapsed (setting in menu tree: “Par/Conf/LOC”), the
display will switch automatically to the Bay Panel.
Schneider Electric points out that changing default users and default passwords
constitutes an important security measure for the product. Therefore Schneider
Electric recommends to change the default passwords after the first usage of the
device. Not changing the default passwords can lead to the risk of undesirable
changes by third parties.
6.10.1 Usage
Step 6 If decided not to login (by pressing the 'CLEAR' key), User not selected
Aborted with C key
the message is displayed for 2 seconds.
2: Closed
3: Faulty position
0: Intermediate pos.
2: Closed
3: Faulty position
0: Intermediate pos.
Disconnector 1: Open
2: Closed
3: Faulty position
0: Intermediate pos.
2: Closed
3: Faulty position
0: Intermediate pos.
2: Closed
BB2
value will also be displayed in bar chart form.
Q1 Q2
A configuration step determines whether the measured
value will also be displayed in bar chart form. The Q0
BB2
display has been configured for the measured value.
or Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
1: Remote
1000A ↑
Current A prim. ↓
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
1: Remote
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
Step 1 Press the “local/remote” key (L/R) to switch the device to P139 10:33:22
local operation. The Bay Panel is no longer displayed.
The device type appears in the first line and eight ********
asterisks (*) appear in the fourth line as a prompt to
enter the password.
“Left”
*
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
1: Remote
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
Step 3a Press the Selection key to select a switchgear unit. LOC: Oper ati on
(Pressing the key again selects the next switchgear unit, mode = LOC Direct:
etc.) Only switchgear units that are electrically
controllable can be selected. P139 10:33:22
BB1
BB2
The external device designation for the selected
Q1 Q2
switchgear unit –“Q0”, for example – is displayed in
flashing characters. If the display of external device Q0
designations has been disabled, the selected switchgear Q9
unit will be marked by a flashing asterisk (*).
Locked Q8
If LOC: Op erat ion mode is set to LOC SBO option 2, 2: Local
1088A
the switchgear unit's position also changes; the position Q0
to-last line. This is a signal for the user, that the “Open” Locked Q8
(or “Close”) key may now be pressed. 2: Local
SELECT<O>/<I>
Q0
LOC: Operati on
mode = LOC SBO
option 1:
P139 10:33:22
BB1
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
SELECT<O>/<I>
Q0
BB2
switchgear unit.
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
If the check of bay interlock conditions determines that LOC: Oper ation
an operation can be carried out, then the switch mode = LOC Direct:
command is executed.
The “off-end” (intermediate position) symbol is displayed P139
BB1
10:33:22
BB2
while the switchgear unit is operating. While the switch
Q1 Q2
command is being executed, no further switchgear unit
can be selected. Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
Step 4b If LOC: Op erat ion mod eis set to LOC SBO option 1 or
LOC SBO option 2, there is one more operation step:
If the check of bay interlock conditions determines that LOC: Oper ati on
an operation can be carried out, then the next-to-last line mode = LOC SBO
displays the symbol of the the selected switching option 1:
operation (e.g. [O]) together with a prompt to the Enter or
key (in flashing characters). P139 10:33:22
BB1
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
OPERATE<O><ENTER>
Q0
LOC: Operati on
mode = LOC SBO
option 2:
P139 10:33:22
BB1
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
OPERATE<O><ENTER>
Q0
Step 4c For LOC: Op erat ion mode = LOC Direct: LOC: Operatio n
If the check of interlock conditions determines that mode = LOC Direct:
switching is not allowed, then the selected switchgear
unit is no longer highlighted. P139
BB1
10:33:22
BB2
If the LED indicators have been configured accordingly,
Q1 Q2
the LED indicator for MAI N: Interl ock e qu. vi ol . will
be illuminated. Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
Step 4d For L OC: Oper at ion mode = LOC SBO option 1 or LOC LOC: Oper ati o n
SBO option 2: mode = LOC SBO
If the check of bay interlock conditions determines that option 2:
an operation cannot be carried out, then the next-to-last
line displays the error message “SBO not OK” for P139
BB1
10:33:22
BB2
5 seconds, using flashing letters.
Q1 Q2
After these 5 seconds the P139 cancels the selection of
the switchgear unit and displays the Bay Panel as at the Q0
end of step 2. Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
SBO not OK
Q0
LOC: Operation
mode = LOC SBO
option 1:
P139 10:33:22
BB1
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
SBO not OK
Q0
Step 5 For LOC: Op erat ion mode = LOC SBO option 1 or LOC
SBO option 2: P139
BB1
10:33:22
BB2
If the operation can be carried out, the Enter key can be
Q1 Q2
pressed. After this, the switch command is executed.
Q0
The “off-end” (intermediate position) symbol is displayed
Q9
while the switchgear unit is operating. No new
switchgear unit can be selected until the execution of the Locked Q8
2: Local
current command has been finished. 1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
2: Local
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
BB2
Q1 Q2
Q0
Q9
Locked Q8
1: Remote
1088A ↑
Curr. IP,max prim. ↓
Moreover, the first line shows the associated function group. The second line
shows the full text for this signal.
Description Display
■INP:
State U 1604
□MAIN:
M.c.b. trip Vref EXT
■FT_RC:
Fault mem. overflow
■LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
■OUTP:
Outp. relays blocked
□PSS:
Activate PS 3 EXT
■LOGIC:
Reset 3 EXT
■ INP:
State U 1604
□ MAIN:
M.c.b. trip Vref EXT
■ FT_RC:
Fault mem. overflow
■ LOC:
Rem.acc.block.active
■ OUTP:
Outp. relays blocked
□ PSS:
Activate PS 3 EXT
■ LOGIC:
Reset 3 EXT
Step 0 The uppermost line of the display shows the type of Meas.values 16:57:33
measured values being displayed. In this example, the Voltage A-B prim.
display shows measured operating values (abbreviated 20.7 kV
as “Meas. values”). The time of day is shown at the Voltage B-C prim.
upper right of the display. 20.6 kV
Voltage C-A prim.
Up to six selected measured values can be displayed
20.8 kV
on the Panel simultaneously. Current A prim.
415 A
Current B prim.
416 A
Current C prim.
417 A
↓↑
Step 1 If more than six measured values have been selected, Meas.values 16:57:35
they can be viewed one page at a time by pressing the Voltage A-B norm.
“up” or ”down” keys. The device will also show the 0.7 kV
next page of the Measured Value Panel after the set or Voltage B-C norm.
Hold-time for Panels (setting in menu tree: “Par/Conf/ 0.6 kV
LOC”) has elapsed. Voltage C-A norm.
0.8 kV
Current A norm.
1.5 A
Current B norm.
1.6 A
Current C norm.
1.7 A
↓↑
Step 0 The uppermost line of the display shows the panel Events 16:57:33
designation and the current time of day. Below this 20.04.13
line, the signals are shown in chronological order. The 05:21:32.331 MAIN
arrows at the bottom of the display area indicate that Trip command
additional signals can also be displayed. Start
05:21:35.501 MAIN
Trip command
End
21.04.13
00:03:57.677 MAIN
Blocked/faulty
Start
↓↑
Step 1 Pressing the “up” or “down” keys will display the Events 16:57:35
signals one at a time.
05:21:35.501 MAIN
or Trip command
End
21.04.13
00:03:57.677 MAIN
Blocked/faulty
Start
08:10:59.688 GRUND
Blocked/faulty
End
↓↑
PX yyy
Unit
type
Oper/
Folder Cyclic measurements
plane 2
Oper/Cycl/
Folder Meas. operating data
plane 3
Oper/Cycl/Data/
Function MAIN
groups
Oper/Cycl/Data/MAIN
Data Date
01.01.16 dd.mm.yy
points
Step 0 In this example, the user switches from plain text mode Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Device online
to address mode. No (=off)
Step 1 To switch from address mode to plain text mode or vice Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
003.030
versa, press the CLEAR key and either the “left” key or 0
the “right” key simultaneously. This can be done at any
point in the menu tree. +
or
Press the ENTER key. Eight asterisks (*) appear in the User Password?
********
display.
Step 2 The LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will light up. This Oper/CtrlTest/LOC
Param. change enabl.
indicates that the setting can now be changed by No
pressing the “up” or “down” keys.
Step 4 Press the enter key again. The LED indicator will go out. Oper/CtrlTest/LOC
Param. change enabl.
The unit is enabled for further setting changes. Yes
The same procedure applies to any setting change unless the global change-
enabling function has been activated. This method is recommended for a single
setting change only. If several settings are to be changed, then the global
change-enabling function is preferable. In the following examples, the global
change-enabling function has been activated.
It is important to press the “up” key first and release it last in order to avoid
unintentional deletion of stored data.
Even when the change-enabling function is activated, not all settings can be
changed. For some settings it is also necessary to disable the protective function
(MAIN: Devi ce on-l ine, menu tree: Par/Func/Glob/MAIN). Such settings include
the configuration settings, by means of which the device interfaces can be
adapted to the system. The following entries in the “Change” column of the
“Telegram Documentation” (part of the separately available
“DataModelExplorer”) indicate whether values can be changed or not:
● “on”: The value can be changed even when the protective function is
enabled.
● “off”: The value can only be changed when the protective function is
disabled.
● “–”: The value can be read out but cannot be changed.
The device is factory-set so that the protective function is disabled.
Press the ENTER key. Eight asterisks (*) appear in the User Password?
********
display.
Step 3 he LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will light up. The Par/Conf/LOC
Autom. return time
last digit of the value is highlighted by a cursor 50000̲ s
(underlined).
Step 4 Press the “left” or “right” keys to move the cursor to Par/Conf/LOC
Autom. return time
the left or right. 5000̲0 s
Step 6 Press the ENTER key. The LED indicator labeled EDIT Par/Conf/LOC
Autom. return time
MODE will go out and the device will now operate with 50010 s
the new value. Press the keys to select another setting
for a value change.
Step 7 If you wish to reject the new setting while you are still Par/Conf/LOC
Autom. return time
entering it (LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE is on), 50000 s
press the CLEAR key. The LED indicator will go out and
the device will continue to operate with the old value.
A further setting can be selected for a value change by
pressing the keys.
Step 0 Select a list setting (in this example, the parameter Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
MAIN: Fct .assig.t rip cmd.1 at “Par/Func/Glob/
MAIN” in the menu tree). The down arrow (↓) indicates ↓
that a list setting has been selected.
Step 1 Press the “down” key. The first function and the first Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
selected signal will appear in the third and fourth lines, #01 DIST
respectively. The symbol “#01” in the display indicates Trip zone 1
the first item of the selection. If MAI N: Withou t
function appears for the first item, then this means
that no function assignment has yet been made.
Once the end of the list is reached, the display shown Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
on the right will appear. #05 MAIN
?????
Step 3 Press the ENTER key at any position in the list. The LED Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
indicator labeled EDIT MODE will light up. #02 DIST
Trip zone 2
Step 5 Select the operator or the class using the “up” and Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
“down“ keys. In this particular case, only the “OR” OR #02 DIST
operator can be selected. There is no limitation on the Trip zone 4
selection of classes.
Step 6 Press the ENTER key. The LED indicator will go out. The Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
assignment has been made. The unit will now operate OR #02 DIST
with the new settings. Trip zone 4
If no operator has been selected, the “OR” operator is
always assigned automatically when the ENTER key is
pressed. There is no automatic assignment of classes.
Step 7 Press the “up” key to exit the list at any point in the Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
list.
↓
Step 8 If you wish to reject the new setting while you are still Par/Func/Glob/MAIN
Fct.assign.trip cmd.
entering it (LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE is on), OR #02 DIST
press the CLEAR key. The LED indicator labeled EDIT Trip zone 2
MODE will be extinguished.
Step 0 Select the entry point for the operating data memory. Oper/Rec/OP_RC
Operat. data record.
Step 1 Press the “down” key to enter the operating data Oper/Rec/OP_RC
01.01.13 11:33 ARC
memory. The latest entry is displayed. Enabled USER
No
Step 2 Press the “left” key repeatedly to display the entries Oper/Rec/OP_RC
01.01.13 11:33 PSIG
one after the other in chronological order. Once the Enabled USER
end of the operating data memory has been reached, Yes
pressing the “left” key again will have no effect.
Step 3 Press the “right” key to display the previous entry. Oper/Rec/OP_RC
01.01.13 11:33 ARC
Enabled USER
No
Step 4 Press the “up” key at any point within the operating Oper/Rec/OP_RC
Operat. data record.
data memory to return to the entry point.
↓
Step 0 Select the entry point for the monitoring signal Oper/Rec/MT_RC
Mon. signal record.
memory.
↓
Step 1 Press the “down” key to enter the monitoring signal Mon. signal record.
01.01.13 13:33 SFMON
memory. The oldest entry is displayed. Checksum error param
Step 2 Press the “right” key repeatedly to display the entries Mon. signal record.
01.01.13 10:01 SFMON
one after the other in chronological order. If more than Exception oper. syst.
30 monitoring signals have been entered since the last
reset, the “overflow” signal is displayed as the last
entry.
Step 3 Press the “left” key to display the previous entry. Mon. signal record.
01.01.13 13:33 SFMON
Checksum error param
Step 4 If the “down” key is held down while a monitoring Mon. signal record.
01.01.13 13:33 SFMON
signal is being displayed, the following additional Checksum error param
information will be displayed:
Step 5 Press the “up” key at any point within the monitoring Oper/Rec/MT_RC
Mon. signal record.
signal memory to return to the entry point.
↓
Step 0 Select the entry point for the first fault memory, for Events/Rec/FT_RC
Fault recording 1
example. If the memory contains entries, the third line 01.01.13 10:00:33
of the display will show the date and time the fault ↓
began. If the third line is blank, then there are no entries
in the fault memory.
Step 1 Press the “down” key to enter the fault memory. First, Fault recording 1
FT_RC
the fault number is shown. In this example it is the 22nd Event
fault since the last reset. 22
Step 2 Press the “right” key repeatedly to see first the Fault recording 1
200 ms FT_DA
measured fault data and then the binary signals in Running time
chronological order. The time shown in the second line is 0.17 s
the time, measured from the onset of the fault, at which
the value was measured or the binary signal started or Fault recording 1
ended. 0 ms FT_RC
Record. in progress
Once the end of the fault has been reached (after the Start
“right” key has been pressed repeatedly), pressing the
“right” key again will have no effect.
Fault recording 1
241 ms FT_RC
Record. in progress
End
Step 3 Press the “left” key to see the previous measured value Fault recording 1
0 ms FT_RC
or the previous signal. Record. in progress
Start
Step 4 Press the “up” key at any point within the fault memory Events/Rec/FT_RC
Fault recording 1
to return to the entry point. 01.01.13 10:00:33
↓
6.12.7 Resetting
All information memories – including the event memories and the monitoring
signal memory – as well as the LED indicators can be reset manually. In addition,
the LED indicators are automatically cleared and initialized at the onset of a new
fault – provided that the appropriate operating mode has been selected – so that
they always indicate the latest fault.
The LED indicators can also be reset manually by pressing the CLEAR key, which
is always possible in the standard control mode. This action also triggers an LED
indicator test and an LCD display test. The event memories are not affected by
this action, so that inadvertent deletion of the records associated with the reset
signal pattern is reliably prevented.
Because of the ring structure of the event memories, the data for eight
consecutive events are updated automatically so that manual resetting should
not be necessary, in principle.
Deleting the event memories completely (e.g. after a function test), can be
accomplished by various resetting actions including the configuration of a group
resetting for several memories. An overview of all resetting actions can be found
in section “Resetting Actions” in Chapter “Operation”.
Resetting a single memory from the local control panel is described in the
following with the example of a fault memory. In this example the global change-
enabling function has already been activated.
Step 0 Select the reset setting. Line 3 of the display shows the Oper/CtrlTest/FT_RC
Reset recording
number of faults since the last reset, 10 in this 10
example.
Press the ENTER key. Eight asterisks (*) appear in the User Password?
********
display.
Step 2 The LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will light up. Oper/CtrlTest/FT_RC
Reset recording
10
Don't execute
Step 3 Press the “Up” or “Down” keys to change the setting to Oper/CtrlTest/FT_RC
Reset recording
Execute. 10
Execute
Step 4 Press the ENTER key. The LED indicator labeled EDIT Oper/CtrlTest/FT_RC
Reset recording
MODE will be extinguished. The value in line 3 is reset 0
to 0.
Press the ENTER key. Eight asterisks (*) appear in the User Password?
********
display.
Step 2 The LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will light up. This Oper/CtrlTest/MAIN
Man. trip cmd. USER
indicates that the setting can now be changed by Don't execute
pressing the “up” or “down” keys.
Step 4 Press the enter key again. The LED indicator labeled Oper/CtrlTest/MAIN
Man. trip cmd. USER
EDIT MODE will go out. The unit will execute the Don't execute
command.
Step 5 As long as the LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE is on, Oper/CtrlTest/MAIN
Man. trip cmd. USER
the control action can be terminated by pressing the Don't execute
CLEAR key. The LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will
be extinguished.
1 2
Press the ENTER key. Eight asterisks (*) appear in the User Password?
********
display.
Step 2 The LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will light up. The Par/Conf/LOC
Password
third line shows an underscore character ( _ ) as the _
prompt for entering a new password.
Step 3 Enter the new password, which in this example is done Par/Conf/LOC
Password
by pressing the “up” key followed by the “down” key. *
Par/Conf/LOC
Password
**
Step 4 Press the enter key again. Asterisks appear in the third Par/Conf/LOC
Password
line, and a cursor (underscore) in the fourth line **
prompts the user to enter the new password again. _
Par/Conf/LOC
Password
**
**
Step 6a Press the ENTER key again. If the password has been Par/Conf/LOC
Password
re-entered correctly, the LED indicator labeled EDIT ********
MODE goes out and the display appears as shown on
the right. The new Password is now valid.
Press the ENTER key. Eight asterisks (*) appear in the User Password?
********
display.
Step 2 The red LED indicator labeled EDIT MODE will be Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
illuminated. The current Password L/R will appear in the 1423
third line.
Step 3 Enter the new password, which in this example is done Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
by pressing the “up” key followed by the “down” key. *
Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
**
Step 4 Press the enter key again. Asterisks appear in the third Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
line, and a cursor (underscore) in the fourth line **
prompts the user to enter the new Password L/R again. _
Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
**
**
Step 6a Press the ENTER key again. If the new Password L/R has Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
been re-entered correctly, the red LED indicator labeled ********
EDIT MODE will be extinguished and the display
appears as shown on the right. The new Password L/R is
now valid.
Step 7 The change of the Password L/R can be canceled at any Par/Conf/LOC
Password L/R
time before Step 7 by pressing the CLEAR key. If this is ********
done, the original Password L/R continues to be valid.
7 Settings
7.1 Parameters
The P139 must be adjusted to the system and to the protected equipment by
appropriate settings. This chapter gives instructions for determining the settings,
which are located in the folder titled “Parameters” in the menu tree. The
sequence in which the settings are listed and described in this chapter
corresponds to their sequence in the menu tree.
The P139 devices are supplied with a factory-set standard configuration of
settings that, in most cases, correspond to the default settings or become
apparent after a “cold restart”. The P139 is blocked in that case. All settings
must be re-entered after a cold restart.
Note
Detailed information about all parameters, including complete selection tables and
IEC 60870‑5‑103 protocol properties, are separately available as a set of interlinked
PDF files for user-friendly navigation, packed in one ZIP archive named
DataModelExplorer_P139_en_P01.zip.
In contrast to P139 versions before P139‑630, the implementation of the IEC 61850
protocol now features parameters that cannot be modified from the local control
panel (HMI) or with the operating program. Instead, these parameters are set with
a special IEC 61850 operating software, named “IED Configurator”.
Therefore these settings are not listed in this chapter or the following chapter.
These parameters are described in Chapter “IEC 61850 Settings via IED
Configurator”.
as a separate ZIP archive file) gives information about the configuration options
for all binary inputs.
The P139 identifies the installed modules during startup. If a given binary I/O
module is not installed or has fewer binary signal inputs than the maximum
number possible at this slot, then the configuration addresses for the missing
binary signal inputs are automatically hidden in the menu tree.
When configuring binary inputs, one should keep in mind that the same function
can be assigned to several signal inputs. Thus one function can be activated from
several control points having different signal voltages.
The configuration in slots A and B and the configuration for the binary inputs
U C01 to U C08 will be changed with the selection of a new bay type. (Whether
automatic configuration occurs, is defined in the setting MA IN: Auto-
assignme nt I /O.) Depending on the connection type chosen for the P139 – pin-
type or ring-type cable socket terminals – the symbolic slots A, B and C refer to
the following slots:
Symbolic slot Pin-type cable socket terminals Ring-type cable socket terminals
A 06 12
B 07 14
C 08 16
The configuration of binary inputs for each bay type – in the case of auto-
assignment – is given in the List of Bay Types in the Appendix.
In the case of auto-assignment, the following notes apply:
Before selecting a new bay type, make sure that the binary inputs at slots A and B
as well as the binary inputs U C01 to U C08 are configured for functions from the
DEVxx function groups only. Otherwise there will be an error message, and the new
bay type will not be activated.
Before selecting a new bay type, make sure that all binary inputs specified in the
List of Bay types for the selected bay type are actually available in the device.
Otherwise there will be an error message, and the new bay type will not be
activated.
In order to ensure that the device will recognize the input signals, the triggering
signals must persist for at least 30 ms. The operating mode for each binary
signal input can be defined.
The user can specify whether the presence (active ‘high’ mode) or absence
(active ‘low’ mode) of a voltage shall be interpreted as the logic “1” signal.
The contact data for the all-or-nothing relays permits them to be used either as
command relays or as signal relays. It is important to note that the contact rating
of the binary I/O modules (X) varies (see Chapter “Technical Data”). One signal
can also be assigned simultaneously to several output relays for the purpose of
contact multiplication.
Selecting a new bay type can change the configuration for slots A and B.
(Whether automatic configuration occurs, is defined in the setting MA IN : Auto-
assignme nt I/O.) Depending on the connection type chosen for the P139 – pin-
type or ring-type cable socket terminals – the symbolic slots A and B correspond
to the following slots:
Symbolic slot Pin-type cable socket terminals Ring-type cable socket terminals
A 06 12
B 07 14
The configuration of output relays for each bay type – in the case of auto-
assignment – is given in the List of Bay Types in the Appendix.
In the case of auto-assignment, the following notes apply:
Before selecting a new bay type, make sure that the output relays at slots A and B
are configured for functions from the DEVxx function groups only. Otherwise there
will be an error message, and the new bay type will not be activated.
Before selecting a new bay type, make sure that all output relays specified in the
List of Bay types for the selected bay type are actually available in the device.
Otherwise there will be an error message, and the new bay type will not be
activated.
An operating mode can be defined for each output relay. Depending on the
selected operating mode, the output relay will operate in either an energize-on-
signal (ES) mode or a normally-energized (NE) mode and in either a latching or
non-latching mode. For output relays operating in latching mode, the operating
mode setting also determines when latching will be cancelled.
mixture of red and green, i.e. when both functions assigned to the LED indicator
are simultaneously present.
Parameter Address
139 0 65535
[spacer]
The device type is displayed. This display cannot be altered.
[spacer] DVICE: S oft ware ve rsi on 1X X 024 219
[spacer]
The setting defines the software version of the device. This display cannot be
altered.
[spacer] DVICE: S W date 002 122
[spacer]
Date the software was created. This display cannot be altered.
Note: The centuries are not displayed. The supported dates range from January
1st, 1997, until November 7th, 2098.
[spacer] DVICE: S W ve rsion communic. 002 103
[spacer]
Software version for the device's communication software. This display cannot
be altered.
[spacer] DVICE: DM I EC 618 50 ve rsion 002 059
[spacer]
Software version of the communication software based on the device's protocol
per IEC 61850. This display cannot be altered.
[spacer] DVICE: Lang uage v ersion 002 123
[spacer]
Identification of the change level of the texts of the data model. This display
cannot be altered.
[spacer] DVICE: Text vers .dat a mode l 002 121
1 0 255
[spacer]
Using the ‘text replacement tool' provided by the operating program, the user
can change the parameter descriptors (plain text designations) and load them
into the device. These customized data models contain an identifier defined by
the user while preparing the data model. This identifier is displayed at this point
in the menu tree. Standard data models have the identifier ‘0' (factory-set
default).
[spacer] DVICE: F numb er 002 124
0 0 9999
[spacer]
The F number is the serial number of the device. The display cannot be altered.
[spacer] DVICE: AFS Orde r No. 001 000
0:
Parameter Address
0:
[spacer]
Order numbers for the device. The user cannot alter this number.
[spacer] DVICE: Order ext . No. 1 000 003
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
Parameter Address
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
0 0 999
[spacer]
Order extension numbers for the device.
[spacer] DVICE: M odule v ar. slot 1 086 050
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Item number of the module inserted in the respective slot 1 to 21.
The display always shows the actual component configuration at any given time.
[spacer] DVICE: M odule vers . slot 1 086 193
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Index letter specifying the version of the module fitted in the respective slot.
[spacer] DVICE: Variant of module A 086 047
[spacer]
Item number of module A in this design version.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Index letter specifying the version of module A.
[spacer] DVICE: M AC add ress module A 104 061
2:
[spacer]
MAC address for the network hardware of the Ethernet module. This address is
introduced during manufacture and can only be read.
[spacer] DVICE: Variant of module L 086 048
[spacer]
Item number of module L in this design version.
[spacer] DVICE: Vers ion of module L 086 191
[spacer]
Index letter specifying the version of module L.
[spacer] DVICE: Variant of module B 086 049
[spacer]
Item number of module B in this design version.
[spacer] DVICE: Vers ion of module B 086 192
[spacer]
Index letter specifying the version of the digital bus module B.
[spacer] DVICE: Variant module B (a) 086 046
[spacer]
Item number of the analog bus module B in this design version.
[spacer] DVICE: Vers ion m odul e B (a) 086 189
[spacer]
Index letter specifying the version of the digital bus module B.
[spacer] DVICE: IP addres s 111 000
2:
2:
2:
[spacer]
Display of the IP address (or subnet mask, MAC address, respectively) of the
Ethernet interface of the processor module. This can be useful for network
analysis, especially if these settings have been retrieved via DHCP.
[spacer] DVICE: Cust omer ID data 1 000 040
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Set your numerically coded user data here for your records.
[spacer] DVICE: Location 001 201
0:
[spacer]
Reference input for the device's location as selected by user.
[spacer] DVICE: De vice ID 000 035
0 0 9999
[spacer]
ID code for use by the PC programs for operating and setting. Further
instructions on this setting are given in the description of the respective
operating program.
[spacer] DVICE: S ubst ation ID 000 036
0 0 9999
[spacer]
ID code for use by the PC programs for operating and setting. Further
instructions on this setting are given in the description of the respective
operating program.
[spacer] DVICE: Fee de r ID 000 037
0 0 9999
[spacer]
ID code for use by the PC programs for operating and setting. Further
instructions on this setting are given in the description of the respective
operating program.
[spacer] DVICE: De vice password 1 000 048
0 0 9999
Parameter Address
0 0 9999
[spacer]
ID code used by the operating program for identification purposes. See
description of the respective operating program for more detailed setting
instructions.
[spacer] DVICE: S W ve rsion DHMI 002 131
[spacer]
Internal software version numbers.
Parameter Address
1: Yes
[spacer]
When set to Yes it is apparent that the device is fitted with the local control
panel (HMI).
Parameter Address
2 0 65535
[spacer]
Version of Cyber Security implementation within the device. Easergy MiCOM 30
is starting with value 2 to be compatible with other Schneider Electric devices.
[spacer] CS: Num ber of us e rs 180 002
0 0 9999
[spacer]
Actual number of users in RBAC configuration.
[spacer] CS: Comms log out 180 032
0: don't execute
[spacer]
If executed, the current logged in user at PC port or via Tunneling interface is
logged out (can be only executed by Comms).
[spacer] CS: HM I logout 180 033
0: don't execute
[spacer]
If executed, the current logged in user at HMI interface is logged out (can be
only executed by HMI).
[spacer] CS: Comms us ername 180 043
0:
[spacer]
Display of the name of the user which is logged in either at PC-port or via
Tunneling.
[spacer] CS: HM I us ername 180 034
0:
[spacer]
Display of the name of the user which is logged in at HMI.
[spacer] CS: Us e r acces s role 180 013
0:
[spacer]
Role(s) of user which is actually logged in. It will be set by the device after
successful login and will be cleared when user is logged off. Of the first 5 roles of
a user, the first 3 chars of the roles names will be displayed separated with one
blank between each.
[spacer] CS: Max log in at te mpts 180 011
0 0 9999
[spacer]
Number of possible login attempts or blocked (blocked means no limitation of
attempts).
[spacer] CS: Log in at te mpt s l eft 180 010
0 0 9999
[spacer]
Remaining login attempts.
Parameter Address
0 0 1800 s
[spacer]
Time how long login shall be blocked after erroneous login attempts or blocked
(blocked means it will not getting active).
[spacer] CS: Block time left 180 012
0 0 1800 s
[spacer]
Remaining blocking login time after erroneous login attempts.
[spacer] CS: Res ult E PW s ett ing 180 041
0 -5 0
[spacer]
Display of a value to informe on the result of the password setting. (EPW =
Encrypted Password)
[spacer] CS: Change p inco de 180 003
0 0 0
[spacer]
Change the PIN code using the navigation keys of the HMI. It is not necessary at
communication interface.
[spacer] CS: Config dis abled 180 044
1: Yes
[spacer]
Configure disabled or not.
[spacer] CS: Recovery Pass wor d 180 014
0:
[spacer]
Display of the Token and allow entry for reset to factory password.
[spacer] CS: Res et RBAC 180 045
12 1 12
[spacer]
Only on HMI. Starting reset timer and display code.
Parameter Address
2: Reference language
[spacer]
Language in which texts will be displayed on the user interface (HMI).
[spacer] LOC: De cim al de limit er 003 021
1: Dot
[spacer]
Character to be used as decimal delimiter on the local control panel.
[spacer] LOC: Pas s word 003 035
1234 0 4444
[spacer]
The password to be used for changing settings from the local control panel can
be defined here.
[spacer] LOC: Pas s word L / R 221 040
1423 0 4444
[spacer]
The password used to change the setting from “Remote” to “Local” control can
be defined here. (Switching from “Local” to “Remote” control occurs without
checking the password.)
[spacer] LOC: Dis pl. ex t.de v.de sig 221 032
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the external device designations shall be displayed
on the Bay Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Dis play L/ R 221 070
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the control site – “Local” or “Remote” – shall be
displayed on the bay panel.
[spacer] LOC: Dis pl. inte rl. stat . 221 071
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the “Locked” or “Unlocked” status shall be
displayed on the bay panel.
[spacer] LOC: Bus bar1 Name by Use r 218 191
0:
0:
0:
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the busbar designations to be displayed on the Bay Panel. At
LOC: Bus bar1 Name by Use r any text (max. 3 characters) may be
entered which will then be used as the designation, if the associated parameter
LOC: De signat ion busbar 1 has been set to BB-User Name. When
instead one of the pre-defined designations is selected at L OC: Designat ion
busbar 1 it will be used and L OC : Busbar 1 Name by User will be
ignored. A designation with more than 3 characters is internally truncated. (The
same is true of BB2,...)
[spacer] LOC: BB S ect.1-Name Use r 218 195
0:
0:
[spacer]
Setting for the busbar section designations to be displayed on the Bay Panel. At
LOC: BB S ect.1-Name Use r any text (max 3 characters) may be entered
which will then be used as the designation, if the associated parameter
LOC: De signat. bus se ct .1 has been set to BB-Sect.User Name. When
one of the pre-defined designations is selected at LOC: De signat. bus
sect.1 it will be used and LOC : BB S ect .1 -Na meUse r will be ignored. A
designation with more than 3 characters is internally truncated. (The same is
true of busbar section 2.)
[spacer] LOC: Character se t 221 038
[spacer]
The user can choose between several character sets to represent switchgear
and their switching states on the Bay Panel.
Note: Character set 3 is identical to character set 1 in the factory default
setting, but can be replaced by an user-defined character set, by applying an
accessory tool to the operating program.
[spacer] LOC: Fct. re set ke y 005 251
[spacer]
Selection of counters and memories that are reset by pressing the RESET key on
the local control panel. (Resetting LED indicators and measured event values is
permanently assigned internally, so that they are always reset when the RESET
key is pressed.)
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection of up to 16 functions to be triggered when pressing the read key.
Event counters and event recordings are offered for selection. If several
functions have been selected then they will be sequentially triggered by
repeated pressing of the read key.
[spacer] LOC: Oper ation mode 011 240
0: LOC Direct
[spacer]
This setting defines which of the three implemented operating modes the P139
shall use for the local control of switchgear units via LOC.
[spacer] LOC: SI reque st 221 118
1: Yes
[spacer]
This setting defines whether or not the check of the interlock equations, that is
carried out with the local control of switchgear units, also includes a check of
station interlocking.
[spacer] LOC: Fct. ass ign. L/R k e y 225 208
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the (electric) key-operated switch switches
between remote / local control (L↔R) or between remote+local control / local
control (R&L↔L).
[spacer] LOC: Fct. m enu jmp li st 1 030 238
[spacer]
Selection of specified functions which will be sequentially displayed by repeated
reading of the menu jump list 1 (or 2).
[spacer] LOC: Fct. Operat ion P anel 053 007
[spacer]
Definition of the values to be displayed on the Measured Value Panel also
referred to as the Operation Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Fct. Ove r lo ad Pane l 053 005
[spacer]
Definition of the values to be displayed on the Overload Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Fct. Grd.Fault Pane l 053 004
[spacer]
Definition of the values to be displayed on the Ground Fault Panel.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Definition of the values to be displayed on the Fault Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Fct. Sig nal Panel 221 072
[spacer]
Definition of the values to be displayed on the Signal Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Aut.activ.S ign.P ane l 221 073
[spacer]
Activation of the automatic switching to the Signal Panel at every change of
state of a configured signal.
[spacer] LOC: St at.ind.S ign.P anel 221 074
[spacer]
Definition of display type of active / inactive signals on the Signal Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Indicat.S ign .P anel 221 075
[spacer]
Definition of signal type at change of state and response to an acknowledge
command.
[spacer] LOC: Sig n.caus .S ign.P anel 221 078
[spacer]
Definition of cause for signaling (every change of state / incoming signals only).
[spacer] LOC: Fct.as g. num. dis pl. 221 041
[spacer]
Definition of the measured values to be displayed on the Bay Panel in numerical
form.
[spacer] LOC: Fct. asg . b ar displ. 221 042
[spacer]
Definition of the measured values to be displayed on the Bay Panel in bar form.
Note: Measured values to be displayed in bar chart form must also be selected
for display as numerical measured values. However, not all measured values
that can be displayed in numerical form can also be displayed in bar chart form!
In such cases, a dummy or placeholder must be included in the selection list for
the bar chart display at the same point at which a measured value that cannot
be displayed in bar chart form appears in the selection list for numerical
measured values.
Example: Current IB is to be displayed. In this case, either the primary current
IB or the per-unit current IB shall be selected for the numerical display. The per-
unit current IB shall be entered at the same position in the selection list for the
bar chart display.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Disabling the bar chart display or definition of the orientation of the bar chart to
display measured values on the Bay Panel.
[spacer] LOC: Scal. bar dis play I 221 044
[spacer]
Scaling of measured current values to be displayed in bar chart form.
[spacer] LOC: Scal. bar dis play V 221 045
[spacer]
Scaling of measured voltage values to be displayed in bar chart form.
[spacer] LOC: Dis play b ar scale 221 046
[spacer]
Setting this window can disable the scalable bar chart.
[spacer] LOC: Hold- tim e for P anels 031 075
[spacer]
Setting for the time period during which a panel is displayed, before switching to
the next panel. This setting is only relevant if more values are selected than can
be shown on the LC-Display.
[spacer] LOC: Hold- t. meas.v. dis pl 031 072
Blocked 1 60 s
[spacer]
Always when the time period set here has elapsed the next value will be shown
on the Bay Panel display. With a setting to Blocked this automatic switching
forward to the next measured value will be deactivated. Independent of this the
next or the previous configured measured value may be selected by pressing
the keys “cursor down” or “cursor up”.
[spacer] LOC: Autom . re t ur n t ime 003 014
[spacer]
If the user does not press a key on the local control panel during this set time
period, the change-enabling function is deactivated.
[spacer] LOC: Re t ur n time selec t. 221 030
[spacer]
If the user does not press a key on the local control panel during this set time
period, then the selection of a switchgear unit is cancelled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
If the user does not press a key on the local control panel during this set time
period, then the backlighting of the LCD display is switched off, and any
switchgear selection that might have been made is cancelled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Bay and device addresses are used to address the device in communication via
the PC interface. An identical setting must be selected for both addresses.
[spacer] PC: Baud rate 003 081
[spacer]
Baud rate of the PC interface.
[spacer] PC: Parit y bit 003 181
[spacer]
Set the same parity that is set at the interface of the PC connected to the P139.
[spacer] PC: Spontan. sig. e nable 003 187
[spacer]
Enable for the transmission of spontaneous signals via the PC interface.
[spacer] PC: Select. s pontan. si g. 003 189
[spacer]
Selection of spontaneous signals for transmission via the PC interface.
[spacer] PC: Trans m.enab.cyc l. dat 003 084
[spacer]
Enable for the cyclic transmission of measured values via the PC interface.
[spacer] PC: Cycl. d ata ILS t e l. 003 185
[spacer]
Selection of the measured values that are transmitted in a user-defined
telegram via the PC interface.
[spacer] PC: De lta V 003 055
[spacer]
A measured voltage value is transmitted via the PC interface if it differs by the
set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] PC: De lta I 003 056
[spacer]
A measured current value is transmitted via the PC interface if it differs by the
set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] PC: IP addr es s 111 004
192 0 255
Parameter Address
168 0 255
1 0 255
2 0 255
[spacer]
IP address of the Ethernet interface of the P139's processor module.
This is the Ethernet interface of the processor module and can be used for
special service activities, e.g. for uploading new firmware.
Note: In the operating program, the complete IP address is displayed at PC: IP
addr es s. The device’s front panel display only displays the IP address
distributed to these four data model addresses:
● PC : IP add re ss,
● PC: IP addr e ss 1,
● PC: IP ad dress 2,
● PC: I P ad dres s 3.
Note: This interface can only be used if it has been configured (PC: IP
addr es s, PC: Subn et mas k, PC : IP addre ss mode) and activated via
PC: IP Enable conf ig..
[spacer] PC: Subnet mas k 111 008
255 0 255
255 0 255
255 0 255
0 0 255
[spacer]
Subnet mask of the Ethernet interface of the processor module.
Note: In the operating program, the complete mask is displayed at
PC: Subnet mas k. The device’s front panel display only displays the mask
distributed to these four data model addresses:
● PC: Subnet mask,
● PC: Sub net mas k 1,
● PC: S ubnet mask 2,
● PC: S ubne t mask 3.
Parameter Address
1: DHCP
[spacer]
Setting of the method how the IP address of the Ethernet interface of the
processor module shall be defined.
● DHCP: The IP address shall be retrieved from a DHCP server.
● Fix: The setting of P C: IP addre ss shall be used.
● Device address: The setting of PC : IP addr ess shall be used for the
first three number values of the IP address, the fourth number value of the
IP address shall be the value of PC : De v ic e addr ess.
[spacer] PC: IP Enable co nf ig. 111 017
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Activating the Ethernet interface of the processor module.
[spacer] PC: De lta P 003 059
[spacer]
The active power value is transmitted via the PC interface if it differs by the set
delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] PC: De lta f 003 057
[spacer]
The measured frequency value is transmitted via the PC interface if it differs by
the set delta from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] PC: De lta meas.v.ILS te l 003 155
[spacer]
The telegram is transmitted if a measured value differs by the set delta quantity
from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] PC: De lta t 003 058
[spacer]
All measured values are transmitted again via the PC interface after this time
period has elapsed – provided that transmission has not been triggered by the
other delta conditions.
[spacer] PC: Time-out 003 188
[spacer]
Setting for the time to elapse after the last telegram exchange via the PC
interface before activating the second communication channel of
communication module A.
Parameter Address
communication
interface 1
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group COMM1 or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
[spacer] COMM 1: General enabl e USE R 003 170
0: No
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling communication interface 1.
[spacer] COMM 1: Basic IEC87 0-5 e nabl e 003 215
[spacer]
Common settings for enabling all protocols based on IEC 870-5-xxx.
[spacer] COMM 1: Addit . - 10 1 e nable 003 216
[spacer]
Enabling additional settings that are relevant for the protocol based on
IEC 870-5-101.
[spacer] COMM 1: Addit . I LS e nable 003 217
[spacer]
Enabling additional settings that are relevant for the ILS protocol.
[spacer] COMM 1: MODB US e nable 003 220
[spacer]
Enabling settings relevant for the MODBUS protocol.
[spacer] COMM 1: DNP3 enable 003 231
[spacer]
Enabling settings relevant for the DNP 3.0 protocol.
[spacer] COMM 1: COUR IER e nable 103 040
[spacer]
Enabling settings relevant for the COURIER protocol.
[spacer] COMM 1: Com m unicat. prot ocol 003 167
[spacer]
Select the communication protocol that shall be used for the communication
interface.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The user may select between two variants of the 103 protocol.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-xxx protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: MODB US prot . variant 003 214
[spacer]
The user may select between two variants of the MODBUS protocol.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Line idle stat e 003 165
[spacer]
Setting for the line idle state indication.
[spacer] COMM 1: Baud rat e 003 071
[spacer]
Baud rate of the communication interface.
[spacer] COMM 1: Parity bit 003 171
[spacer]
Set the same parity that is set at the interface of the control system connected
to the P139.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The P139 monitors telegram transmission to make sure that no excessive pause
occurs within a telegram. This monitoring function can be disabled if it is not
required.
Note: This setting is only necessary for modem transmission.
[spacer] COMM 1: Mon. tim e pol ling 003 202
[spacer]
The time between two polling calls from the communication master must be less
than the time set here.
[spacer] COMM 1: Octet comm. addre ss 003 072
[spacer]
The communication address and the ASDU address are used to identify the
device in communication via the interface. An identical setting must be selected
for both addresses.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 1: Oct.2 comm.addr.DNP 3 003 240
[spacer]
In the DNP 3.0 protocol, a 16-bit address is used to identify devices.
The address that can be set here is the higher-order octet, whereas the address
set at COM M1: Octet comm. addr ess is the lower-order octet of the
DNP address.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
1: Single character E5
[spacer]
The following transmission frame formats are available (according to the
standard):
● Short message FT 1.2: short message with a fixed block length of 5
characters
● Single character E5: single control character
[spacer] COMM 1: Tes t monit or on 003 166
[spacer]
Setting specifying whether data shall be recorded for service activities.
[spacer] COMM 1: Name of manufac ture r 003 161
[spacer]
Setting for the name of the manufacturer.
Note:
● This setting can be changed to ensure compatibility.
● This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Octet address ASD U 003 073
[spacer]
The communication address and the ASDU address are used to identify the
device in communication via the interface. An identical setting must be selected
for both addresses.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 1: Spontan. s ig. enabl e 003 177
[spacer]
Enable for the transmission of spontaneous signals via the communication
interface.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection of spontaneous signals for transmission via “logical” communication
interface 1.
[spacer] COMM 1: Transm .enab.c ycl.dat 003 074
[spacer]
Enabling of cyclic transmission of measured values via the communication
interface.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Cycl. dat a ILS t e l. 003 175
[spacer]
Selection of the measured values that are transmitted in a user-defined
telegram via the communication interface.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta V 003 050
[spacer]
A measured voltage value is transmitted via the communication interface if it
differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta I 003 051
[spacer]
A measured current value is transmitted via the communication interface if it
differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta P 003 054
[spacer]
The active power value is transmitted via the communication interface if it
differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The measured frequency value is transmitted via the communication interface if
it differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta me as. v.ILS t el 003 150
[spacer]
The telegram is transmitted if a measured value differs by the set delta quantity
from the last measured value transmitted.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta t 003 053
[spacer]
All measured values are transmitted again via the communication interface after
this time period has elapsed – provided that transmission has not been triggered
by the other delta conditions.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta t ( e ne r gy) 003 151
[spacer]
The measured values for active energy and reactive energy are transmitted via
the communication interface after this time has elapsed.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Cont in. ge ner al scan 003 077
[spacer]
A continuous or background general scan means that the P139 transmits all
settings, signals, and monitoring signals through the communication interface
during slow periods when there is not much activity. This ensures that there will
be data consistency with a connected control system. The time to be set defines
the minimum time difference between two telegrams.
Note: This setting is hidden unless an IEC 870-5 protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the communication address length.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Octet 2 comm. addr. 003 200
[spacer]
Setting for the length of the higher-order communication address.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Caus e transm. le ngth 003 192
[spacer]
Setting for the length of the cause of transmission.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Address le ngt h AS DU 003 193
[spacer]
Setting for the length of the common address for identification of telegram
structures.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 1: Octet 2 addr. ASD U 003 194
[spacer]
Setting for the length of the common higher-order address for identification of
telegram structures.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 1: Addr.le ngth inf. obj. 003 196
[spacer]
Setting for the length of the address for information objects.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Oct.3 addr. inf.obj. 003 197
[spacer]
Setting for the length of the higher-order address for information objects.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Inf .No.<- >funct.t ype 003 195
[spacer]
Setting specifying whether information numbers and function type shall be
reversed in the object address.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the time tag length.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: AS DU1 / ASDU20 conv . 003 190
[spacer]
Setting specifying whether telegram structure 1 or 20 shall be converted as a
single signal or double signal.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 1: AS DU2 conver si on 003 191
[spacer]
Setting specifying whether telegram structure 2 shall be converted as a single
signal or double signal.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 1: Init iali z. signal 003 199
[spacer]
Setting specifying whether an initialization signal shall be issued.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Balance d ope ration 003 226
[spacer]
Setting that determines whether communication takes place on a balanced basis
(full duplex operation).
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
[spacer] COMM 1: Directi on bit 003 227
[spacer]
Setting for the transmission direction. Normally this value will be set to '1' at
the control center and to '0' at the substation.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Tim e- out int erv al 003 228
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum time that will elapse until the status signal for the
acknowledgment command is issued.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the IEC 870-5-101 protocol is set.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
MODBUS registers in the range 00301 to 00400 are assigned to the selected
commands. Assignment is made in the order of selection. This means that the
first command is given the register no. 00301, the second the register no.
00302, etc.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Reg.asg. sel ec. si g. 003 211
[spacer]
MODBUS registers in the range 10301 to 10400 are assigned to the selected
signals. Assignment is made in the order of selection. This means that the first
signal is given the register no. 10301, the second the register no. 10302, etc.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Reg.asg. sel . m. val. 003 212
[spacer]
MODBUS registers in the range 30301 to 30400 are assigned to the selected
measured values. Assignment is made in the order of selection. This means that
the first measured value is given the register no. 30301, the second the register
no. 30302, etc.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Reg.asg. sel . par am. 003 213
[spacer]
MODBUS registers in the range 40301 to 40400 are assigned to the selected
parameters. Assignment is made in the order of selection. This means that the
first parameter is given the register no. 40301, the second the register no.
40302, etc.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta t (MO DBUS) 003 152
[spacer]
All MODBUS registers are transmitted again through the communication
interface after this time has elapsed.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Autom .eve nt c onfirm. 003 249
[spacer]
Setting specifying whether an event must be confirmed by the master in order
for an event to be deleted from the 'event queue'.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the MODBUS protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Number of bits that must pass between the receipt of the 'request' and the start
of sending the 'response'.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Phys . Char . Time out 003 242
[spacer]
Number of bits that may be missing from the telegram before receipt is
terminated.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Link Confirm. M ode 003 243
[spacer]
Setting for the acknowledgment mode of the link layer.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Link Confirm.Timeout 003 244
[spacer]
Setting for the time period within which the master must acknowledge at the
link layer.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Link Max. Re tr ie s 003 245
[spacer]
Number of repetitions that are carried out on the link layer if errors have
occurred during transmission (such as failure to acknowledge).
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Appl.Co nfirm.T ime out 003 246
[spacer]
Setting for the time period within which the master must acknowledge at the
application layer.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Appl. Ne e d Time De l. 003 247
[spacer]
Time interval within which the slave requests time synchronization cyclically
from the master.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection of data points and data classes for object 1 – binary inputs.
Assignment of indices is made in the order of selection, beginning with 0.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Ind ./cl. bin.output s 003 233
[spacer]
Selection of data points and data classes for object 10 – binary outputs.
Assignment of indices is made in the order of selection, beginning with 0.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Ind ./cl. bin. count . 003 234
[spacer]
Selection of data points and data classes for object 20 – binary counters.
Assignment of indexes is made in the order of selection, beginning with 0.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Ind ./cl. analog inp. 003 235
[spacer]
Selection of data points and data classes for object 30 – analog inputs.
Assignment of indices is made in the order of selection, beginning with 0.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Ind ./cl. analog outp 003 236
[spacer]
Selection of data points and data classes for object 40 – analog outputs.
Assignment of indices is made in the order of selection, beginning with 0.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta m e as. v. ( DNP 3 ) 003 250
[spacer]
Initialization value of threshold values for transmission of measured values in
object 30. The threshold values can be changed separately by the master for
each measured value by writing to object 34, 'analog input reporting deadband'.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta t (DNP 3) 003 248
[spacer]
Cycle time for updating DNP object 30 (analog inputs).
Note: This setting is hidden unless the DNP 3.0 protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection of commands to be issued via the COURIER protocol.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the COURIER protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Signal se lec tion 103 043
[spacer]
Selection of signals to be transmitted via the COURIER protocol.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the COURIER protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Meas . v al. sel ect ion 103 044
[spacer]
Selection of measured values to be transmitted via the Courier protocol.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the Courier protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Param et er s ele ct ion 103 045
[spacer]
Selection of settings to be altered via the Courier protocol.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the Courier protocol is enabled.
[spacer] COMM 1: Delta t ( COURIE R) 103 046
[spacer]
Cycle time at the conclusion of which the selected measured values are again
transmitted.
Note: This setting is hidden unless the COURIER protocol is enabled.
Parameter Address
communication
interface 2
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group COMM2 or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
[spacer] COMM 2: General enabl e USE R 103 170
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling communication interface 2.
[spacer] COMM 2: Line idle stat e 103 165
[spacer]
Setting for the line idle state indication.
[spacer] COMM 2: Baud rate 103 071
[spacer]
Baud rate of the communication interface.
[spacer] COMM 2: Parity bit 103 171
[spacer]
Set the same parity that is set at the interface of the control system connected
to the P139.
[spacer] COMM 2: Dead t ime moni toring 103 176
[spacer]
The P139 monitors telegram transmission to make sure that no excessive pause
occurs within a telegram. This monitoring function can be disabled if it is not
required.
Note: This setting is only necessary for modem transmission.
[spacer] COMM 2: Mon. tim e pol ling 103 202
[spacer]
The time between two polling calls from the communication master must be less
than the time set here.
[spacer] COMM 2: Posit ive ackn. faul t 103 203
0: No
[spacer]
It is possible to set whether or not faults can be acknowledged positively after
transmission (and consequently deleted from the fault overview at the
COMM2/PC interface).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The communication address and the ASDU address are used to identify the
device in communication via the interface. An identical setting must be selected
for both addresses.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 2: Name of manufac ture r 103 161
[spacer]
Setting for the name of the manufacturer.
Note: This setting can be changed to ensure compatibility.
[spacer] COMM 2: Octet address ASD U 103 073
[spacer]
The communication address and the ASDU address are used to identify the
device in communication via the interface. An identical setting must be selected
for both addresses.
“ASDU”: Application Service Data Unit
[spacer] COMM 2: Spontan. s ig. enabl e 103 177
[spacer]
Enable for the transmission of spontaneous signals via the communication
interface.
[spacer] COMM 2: Se le ct. s pont an.sig. 103 179
[spacer]
Selection of spontaneous signals for transmission via communication interface 2.
[spacer] COMM 2: Transm.enab.c ycl.dat 103 074
[spacer]
Enable for the cyclic transmission of measured values via the communication
interface.
[spacer] COMM 2: Cycl. dat a ILS t e l. 103 175
[spacer]
Selection of the measured values transmitted in a user-defined telegram via the
communication interface.
[spacer] COMM 2: Delta V 103 050
[spacer]
A measured voltage value is transmitted via the communication interface if it
differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
A measured current value is transmitted via the communication interface if it
differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] COMM 2: Delta P 103 054
[spacer]
The active power value is transmitted via the communication interface if it
differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] COMM 2: Delta f 103 052
[spacer]
The measured frequency value is transmitted via the communication interface if
it differs by the set delta quantity from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] COMM 2: Delta m e as. v.ILS t el 103 150
[spacer]
The telegram is transmitted if a measured value differs by the set delta quantity
from the last measured value transmitted.
[spacer] COMM 2: Delta t 103 053
[spacer]
All measured values are transmitted again via the communication interface after
this time period has elapsed – provided that transmission has not been triggered
by the other delta conditions.
Parameter Address
interface
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group COMM3 or including it in the configuration.
This setting parameter is only visible if the relevant optional communication
module is fitted.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
[spacer] COMM 3: General enabl e USE R 120 030
0: No
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling communication interface 3.
[spacer] COMM 3: Baud rat e 120 038
[spacer]
Adjustment of the baud rate for telegram transmission via the guidance
interface (InterMiCOM interface) so as to meet the requirements of the
transmission carrier.
[spacer] COMM 3: Source addr es s 120 031
1: 1
[spacer]
Address for send signals.
[spacer] COMM 3: Receiving addr es s 120 032
2: 2
[spacer]
Address for receive signals.
[spacer] COMM 3: Fct. ass ignm. se nd 1 121 001
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Assignment of functions for the 8 send signals.
[spacer] COMM 3: Fct. ass ignm. re c. 1 120 001
[spacer]
Configuration (assignment of functions) for the 8 receive signals
[spacer] COMM 3: Ope r. m ode rec eiv e 1 120 002
1: Direct intertrip
1: Direct intertrip
1: Direct intertrip
1: Direct intertrip
[spacer]
Selection of Blocking or Direct intertrip for the operating mode of receive signals
1 to 4 (single-pole transmission).
[spacer] COMM 3: Ope r. m ode rec eiv e 5 120 014
1: Direct intertrip
1: Direct intertrip
1: Direct intertrip
Parameter Address
1: Direct intertrip
[spacer]
Selection of Permissive or Direct intertrip for the operating mode of receive
signals 5 to 8 (two-pole transmission).
[spacer] COMM 3: Default value rec . 1 120 060
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
[spacer]
Definition of the default value for the 8 receive signals.
[spacer] COMM 3: Tim e- out comm.faul t 120 033
50 10 60000 ms
[spacer]
This timer triggers the alarm signals COMM3: C ommunications f aul t
and S F MON: Communic .fault CO M M3 the received signals to their user-
defined default values. Time-out occurs when the set time has elapsed since the
most recent 100% valid telegram was received.
[spacer] COMM 3: Sig.as g. comm.fault 120 034
0: None
[spacer]
Using this setting, the alarm signal can be configured (assigned) to the
corresponding PSIG input signal.
[spacer] COMM 3: Tim e- out link fail. 120 035
5 0 600 s
[spacer]
Time indicating a persistent failure of the transmission channel. After this timer
stage has elapsed, alarm signals C OMM 3: C omm. link failure and
SFMO N: Comm .link fail.C OMM3 are raised. These can be mapped to
give the operator a warning LED or contact to indicate that maintenance
attention is required.
Parameter Address
Blocked 1 100 %
[spacer]
Percentage of corrupted messages compared to total messages transmitted
before an alarm is raised (CO M M3 : Lim.e x ce e d.,tel.e rr. and
SFMO N: Lim .e x ce ed.,t e l.e r r.). When this threshold is exceeded, the
receive signals are set to their user-defined default values.
Parameter Address
Communication
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group IEC or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Important notice: Some of the parameters in function group IEC are set with
the IEC 61850 configuration tool “IED Configurator”, they cannot be modified
from the local control panel (HMI) or with the operating program, and therefore
these parameters are listed separately.
[spacer] IEC: Ge neral enable US ER 104 000
[spacer]
Enabling and disabling function group IEC.
[spacer] IEC: IEC 61850 e nabl e 104 077
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling IEC 61850.
[spacer] IEC: IEC60870-5-1 0 4e nable 104 078
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling IEC 60870-5-104.
[spacer] IEC: ET H COM M Mode 104 080
[spacer]
Selection of the redundant Ethernet protocol between PRP, HSR and RSTP.
[spacer] IEC: IEC prot. vari ant 104 084
[spacer]
Selection of the enabled Ethernet protocol.
[spacer] IEC: Block Port A/ B 104 073
[spacer]
When Port A/B blocked is activated, Port A for SEB or Port A&B for REB will be
disabled.
[spacer] IEC: Block Port C 104 074
[spacer]
When Port C blocked is activated, Port C will be disabled.
[spacer] IEC: Switch Con fig. Bank 104 043
[spacer]
This parameter can only be sent individually. Accepting the previously set
communication parameters as the active communication settings.
Parameter Address
2:
[spacer]
Name of the configuration bank currently valid.
Setting is carried out with the IED Configurator.
[spacer] IEC: Active Conf ig. Ve r s. 104 046
2:
[spacer]
Version number of the configuration bank currently valid.
Setting is carried out with the IED Configurator.
[spacer] IEC: Inact . C onfig. Name 104 047
2:
[spacer]
Name of the inactive configuration bank.
Setting is carried out with the IED Configurator.
[spacer] IEC: Inact . C onfig. Ve r s . 104 048
2:
[spacer]
Version number of the inactive configuration bank.
Setting is carried out with the IED Configurator.
[spacer] IEC: IED nam e 104 057
2:
[spacer]
Explicitly assigned unit name for the function in the system (IED); is part of the
Logical Device Name.
Setting is carried out with the IED Configurator.
Important note: According to the IEC standard the name must consist of only
letters (A..Z, a..z), digits (0..9) and underscore characters (_), and neither a digit
nor the underscore character must be the first character. Note that a non-
standard name causes problems with the IEC 61850 communication.
[spacer] IEC: IP address 104 001
2:
[spacer]
Assigned IP address of the device for the server function in the system.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: IP Address.
[spacer] IEC: Subnet m ask 104 005
2:
[spacer]
The subnet mask defines which part of the IP address is addressed by the sub-
network and which part by the device that is logged-on to the network.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: SubNet Mask.
Parameter Address
2:
[spacer]
This parameter shows the IPv4 address of the network gateway for
communication links to clients outside of the local network.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: Gateway Address.
[spacer] IEC: IP address 2 104 070
2:
[spacer]
Assigned IP address 2 of the device for the server function in the system.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: IP Address Interface 2 (If fitted).
[spacer] IEC: Subnet m ask 2 104 071
2:
[spacer]
The subnet mask 2 defines which part of the IP address 2 is addressed by the
sub-network and which part by the device that is logged-on to the network.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: SubNet Mask Interface 2 (If fitted).
[spacer] IEC: Gat eway addre s s 2 104 072
2:
[spacer]
This parameter shows the IPv4 address of the network gateway 2 for
communication links to clients outside of the local network.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: Gateway Address Interface 2 (If fitted).
[spacer] IEC: IP address VLAN 1 104 091
2:
2:
[spacer]
Assigned IP address of VLAN in the system.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: IP Address.
[spacer] IEC: Identifier VLAN 1 104 092
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
[spacer]
Assigned VLAN ID in the system.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: Vlan ID.
[spacer] IEC: Subnet m ask VL AN 1 104 093
2:
Parameter Address
2:
[spacer]
The subnet mask of VLAN defines which part of the IP address is addressed by
the sub-network and which part by the device that is logged-on to the network.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: VLAN Subnet Mask.
[spacer] IEC: Gat eway add re s s VL 1 104 094
2:
2:
[spacer]
This parameter shows the network gateway of the VLAN for communication links
to clients outside of the local network.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator" with Communications: Gateway Address.
[spacer] IEC: SNTP s erve r 1 IP 104 202
2:
[spacer]
IP address of the preferred server used for clock synchronization.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator".
[spacer] IEC: SNTP s erve r 2 IP 104 210
2:
[spacer]
IP address of the backup server used for clock synchronization.
Note: This is an information parameter ('read only') and its value is set from the
"IED Configurator".
[spacer] IEC: SGCB Re svT ms 104 199
30 0 600
[spacer]
The configuration attribute ResvTms defines the time interval in seconds a
reservation of a SGCB is granted to a client. A reservation of a SGCB starts after
a successful SettingGroup edition has been successfully processed with the
service SelectEditSG.
[spacer] IEC: SigGGI O1 sel ect ion 104 064
[spacer]
Optional signal assignment for a transmission per communication protocol
IEC 61850 based on the selection table of the binary inputs (opto coupler
inputs).
[spacer] IEC: Diff . local time 104 206
[spacer]
Time difference between UTC and local time at the devices' substation (IED).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Time difference of the daylight saving time to standard time.
[spacer] IEC: Switch.day l.sav .ti me 104 219
[spacer]
This setting defines whether an automatic switching to daylight saving time is
wanted. If it is wanted, the time switching is executed upon receiving a related
SNTP frame.
[spacer] IEC: Dayl.sav.time s tar t 104 220
[spacer]
These three parameters define the date (e.g. at what day of the year) for
switching from standard time over to daylight saving time. Available for
IEC: Dayl.sav.time s tar t are the values First, Second, Third, Fourth, and
Last. For IEC: Dayl.sav.ti me st . d the seven weekdays are available so
that for example a setting like “on the last Sunday in March” may be used.
[spacer] IEC: Dayl.sav.t.st .0:00 + 104 223
[spacer]
Time period in minutes after midnight when daylight saving time is switched to
standard time. If for example the clock is advanced one hour from 2:00 AM to
3:00 AM the parameter IE C: D ayl.sav .t .st .0:00 + is set to 120 (minutes).
[spacer] IEC: Dayl.sav.time e nd 104 225
[spacer]
This parameter defines the date and time of day for the clock changeover from
daylight saving time to standard time. The setting is similar to that for the clock
changeover to daylight saving time.
Parameter Address
Orientated
Substation Events
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group GOOSE or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden.
Parameters included in this function group are only effective when function
group IEC is configured and enabled and when the parameters in this function
group have been activated by setting the parameter IEC: Switch Conf ig.
Bank.
[spacer] GOOSE: Gene ral e nable US ER 106 001
0: No
[spacer]
Enabling and disabling function group GOOSE.
[spacer] GOOSE: Input 1 fct.assig. 107 006
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Function assignment of the virtual binary GOOSE inputs (GosGGIO1/Pos1.stVal,
GosGGIO1/Pos2.stVal, …) to a binary logical state signal on the device so that
they can be processed further by the protection, control or logic functions.
Signals configured here contain the received and pre-processed state of data
attributes configured for GOOSE receipt.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group VINP or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
[spacer] VINP: General e nable USE R 115 000
0: No
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling VINP function.
[spacer] VINP: I nput 1 fct.ass ig. 115 150
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Function assignment of the virtual binary inputs VINP to a binary logical state
signal on the device so that they can be processed further by the protection,
control or logic functions.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group IRIGB or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
[spacer] IRIGB: Gener al e nable US ER 023 200
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling the IRIG-B interface.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Input filter which is activated when either the mode Active "high", filt. or Active
"low", filt. has been selected for INP: Ope r. mode U xxx. In order to
suppress transient interference peaks at the logic signal inputs it is suggested to
set this parameter to 6 [steps].
[spacer] INP: Fct. as signm. U 301 152 217
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Assignment of functions to binary signal inputs.
[spacer] INP: Oper. m ode U 301 152 218
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
Parameter Address
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
Parameter Address
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
Parameter Address
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
Parameter Address
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
Parameter Address
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
Parameter Address
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
1: Active "high"
[spacer]
Selection of operating mode for binary signal inputs.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group MEASI or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden.
[spacer] MEASI: Ge ne ral enabl e US E R 011 100
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling analog measured data input.
[spacer] MEASI: E nable IDC p. u. 037 190
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum current that must flow in order for the P139 to display a
measured value > 0 (zero suppression).
[spacer] MEASI: I DC < ope n circuit 037 191
[spacer]
If the input current falls below the set threshold, the P139 will issue an “open
circuit” signal.
[spacer] MEASI: I DC 1 037 150
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the input current that will correspond to a linearized value that has
been set accordingly.
[spacer] MEASI: I DC ,lin 1 037 151
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the linearized current that will correspond to an input current that
has been set accordingly.
[spacer] MEASI: S caled val. IDC ,lin1 037 192
[spacer]
Setting for the scaled value of IDC,lin1.
[spacer] MEASI: S caled val.IDC ,l in2 0 037 193
[spacer]
Setting for the scaled value of IDC,lin20.
[spacer] MEASI: T ype of Te mpSe ns or s 004 254
0: PT 100
[spacer]
Selection of the temperature sensor type (PT 100, NI 100 or NI 120).
Parameter Address
output
060 000: MAIN: Without function
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Assignment of functions to output relays.
[spacer] OUTP: Oper. mode K 3 01 151 046
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
Parameter Address
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
Parameter Address
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
Parameter Address
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
Parameter Address
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
[spacer]
Selection of operating mode for output relays.
Parameter Address
output
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group MEASI or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden. If the function group is cancelled from the
configuration, then all associated settings and signals are hidden.
[spacer] MEASO: Ge ne ral e nable US ER 031 074
0: No
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling the measured data output function.
[spacer] MEASO: Fct . as s ignm. BC D 053 002
[spacer]
Selection of the measured value to be transmitted in BCD form.
[spacer] MEASO: Hold t ime output BC D 010 010
[spacer]
Setting for the transmission time of the selected measured value in BCD form.
[spacer] MEASO: Scale d min. val. B C D 037 140
0 0 399
Parameter Address
399 0 399
[spacer]
The variable Mx is to be issued in BCD form.
For measured values in the range “measured values to be issued” the output
value should change linearly with the measured value.
● Range of measured values for the variable Mx: Mx,RL1 ... Mx,RL2
● Range of associated scaled measured values: 0 ... 1
● Range of measured values to be issued: Mx,min ... Mx,max
● Range of scaled measured values to be issued: Mx,scal,min ... Mx,scal,max
● Designation of the set values in the data model: “Scaled min. val. BCD” ...
“Scaled max. val. BCD”
with:
Mx,scal,min = (Mx,min - Mx,RL1)/(Mx,RL2 - Mx,RL1)
Mx,scal,max = (Mx,max - Mx,RL1)/(Mx,RL2 - Mx,RL1)
BCD display values for measured values in the range “measured values to be
issued”; range: “BCD-Out min. value” ... “BCD-Out max. value”
BBCD display values for measured values ≤ Mx,min; range: “BCD-Out min.
value”
BCD display values for measured values ≥ Mx,max; range: “BCD-Out max.
value”
[spacer] MEASO: Fct . as s ignm. A- 1 053 000
[spacer]
Selection of the measured value to be transmitted in analog form.
[spacer] MEASO: Hold t ime output A- 1 010 114
[spacer]
Setting for the time delay for output of the selected measured value.
[spacer] MEASO: Scale d m in. val. A-1 037 104
Parameter Address
[spacer]
After conversion via a characteristic the selected measured value Ax (x = 1, 2) is
to be issued as an output current. For this purpose a range “measured values to
be issued” is defined. In this range the characteristic has two linear sections,
which are separated by a knee point.
● Range of measured values for the variable Mx: Mx,RL1 ... Mx,RL2
● Range of associated scaled measured values: 0 ... 1
● Range of measured values to be issued: Mx,min ... Mx,max
● Range of scaled measured values to be output: Mx,scal,min ... Mx,scal,max
● Designation of the set values in the data model: „Scaled min. val. Ax“ ...
„Scaled max. val. Ax“
with:
Mx,scal,min = (Mx,min - Mx,RL1)/(Mx,RL2 - Mx,RL1)
Mx,scal,max = (Mx,max - Mx,RL1)/(Mx,RL2 - Mx,RL1)
● Designation of value for knee point: Mx,knee
● Designation of scaled knee point value: Mx,scaled,knee
● Designation of this set value in the data model: „Scaled knee val. Ax“
with:
Mx,scaled,knee = (Mx,knee - Mx,RL1)/(Mx,RL2 - Mx,RL1)
[spacer] MEASO: AnOut min. v al. A- 1 037 107
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Output current range for measured values in the range “measured values to be
issued”; designation in the data model: “An-Out min. val. Ax” ... “An-Out max.
val. Ax”
Output current to be set for measured values ≤ Mx,min; designation in the data
model: “An-Out min. val. Ax”
Output current to be set for measured values ≥ Mx,max; designation in the data
model: “An-Out max. val. Ax”
Output current to be set for measured values = Mx,knee; designation in the data
model: “AnOut knee point Ax”
with:
Mx,min ... Mx,max: measured values to be issued
[spacer] MEASO: Output value 1 037 120
[spacer]
Measured values of external devices, which must be scaled to 0 to 100%, can be
issued.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the function assigned to LED indicator H 17.
The function LOC: Edit mode is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: O pe rating mode H 1 085 182
1: ES updating
[spacer]
The operating mode ES updating is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: O pe rating mode H 2 085 002
1: ES updating
[spacer]
The operating mode ES updating is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: O pe rating mode H 3 085 005
1: ES updating
[spacer]
The ES updating operating mode is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: O pe rating mode H 4 085 008
3: ES reset (fault)
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
Parameter Address
1: ES updating
1: ES updating
[spacer]
Selection of operating mode for LED indicators.
[spacer] LED: O pe rating mode H 17 085 183
1: ES updating
[spacer]
The operating mode ES updating is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: F ct.ass ig. H 1 gre e n 085 184
[spacer]
Display of the operational readiness of the protection device.
The function MAIN: He althy is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: F ct.ass ig. H 2 y ell. 085 001
[spacer]
Display of the function assigned to LED indicator H 2.
The function MAIN: Blocke d/ fault y is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: F ct.ass ig. H 3 y ell. 085 004
[spacer]
Display of the function assigned to LED indicator H 3.
The function SFM ON: Warning (LED ) is permanently assigned.
[spacer] LED: F ct.ass ig. H 4 red 085 007
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Assignment of functions to LED indicators.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Assignment of communication interfaces to physical communication channels.
[spacer] MAIN: Auto- assig nme nt I/ O 221 065
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling of automatic assignment of binary inputs and outputs to
the set bay type.
[spacer] MAIN: Type of bay 220 000
[spacer]
Configuration of a bay type.
[spacer] MAIN: Prim .S ource TimeS ync 103 210
0: COMM1/IEC
[spacer]
Selection of the primary source for date and time synchronization. Available are
COMM1/IEC, COMM2/PC, IRIG-B or a binary input for minute signal pulses.
[spacer] MAIN: Backup SourceT ime Sy nc 103 211
1: COMM2/PC
[spacer]
Selection of the backup source for date and time synchronization. Available are
COMM1/IEC, COMM2/PC, IRIG-B or a binary input for minute signal pulses. The
backup source is used when there is no synchronization generated by the
primary source after MAIN: Time s ync. time-out has elapsed.
[spacer] MAIN: Tim e s ync. t ime -out 103 212
Blocked 1 60 min
[spacer]
Time-out setting for the time synchronization generated by the primary source.
Parameter Address
1: Current IA
2: Current IB
3: Current IC
5: Voltage A-G
6: Voltage B-G
7: Voltage C-G
4: Current IN
8: Voltage VNG
0: Without
[spacer]
The user specifies the channel on which each physical variable is recorded.
Parameter Address
current protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group DTOC or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group IDMT1 or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group IDMT2 or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
direction
determination
0: Without
[spacer]
Canceling function group SCDD or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group SOTF or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group PSIG or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
control
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group ARC or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
synchronism check
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group ASC or including it in the configuration. If any function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
direction
determination using
steady-state values
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group GFDSS or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Cancelling function group TGFD or including it in the configuration.
If any function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group MP or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group THERM or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
tion
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group I2> or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
tion
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group V<> or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
underfrequency pro‐
tection
0: Without
[spacer]
Canceling function group f<> or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
shedding
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group Pf< or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group P<> or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
directional reactive
power protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group QV or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
failure protection
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group CBF or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
condition monitoring
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group CBM or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group MCMON or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group LIMIT or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group TRMON or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group LOGIC or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group LOG_2 (“Logic 2”) or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden.
Parameter Address
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function groups DEV01 to DEV03 or including them in the
configuration. If any function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all
associated settings and signals are hidden.
[spacer] DEV01: Funct . type, s ignal 210 034
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
Parameter Address
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
[spacer]
Setting the function type of the signal.
Note: If the IEC 870-5-101 communication protocol has been set, then the 'low
address' of the information object will be defined by this setting. If the ILS-C
protocol has been set, then this setting will correspond to DN2.
[spacer] DEV01: Inform. No., signal 210 035
1 0 254
3 0 254
5 0 254
7 0 254
9 0 254
11 0 254
13 0 255
15 0 254
17 0 254
19 0 254
[spacer]
Setting the information number of the signal.
Note: If the IEC 870-5-101 communication protocol has been set, then the 'high
address' of the information object will be defined by this setting. If the ILS-C
protocol has been set, then this setting will correspond to DN3.
[spacer] DEV01: Funct . type, c ommand 210 032
242 1 254
242 1 254
Parameter Address
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
242 1 254
[spacer]
Setting for the function type of the command.
Note: If the IEC 870-5-101 communication protocol has been set, then the “low
address” of the information object will be defined by this setting. If the ILS-
C protocol has been set, then this setting will correspond to DN2.
[spacer] DEV01: Inform. No., command 210 033
65 0 254
67 0 254
69 0 254
71 0 254
73 0 254
75 0 254
77 0 254
79 0 254
81 0 254
Parameter Address
83 0 254
[spacer]
Setting the information number of the command.
Note: If the IEC 870-5-101 communication protocol has been set, then the 'high
address' of the information object will be defined by this setting. If the ILS-C
protocol has been set, then this setting will correspond to DN3.
Parameter Address
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group TPDx or including it in the configuration. If the function
group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings and
signals are hidden.
[spacer] TPD1: T PD1 Dis co nnect or 219 003
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
[spacer]
Every function group TPDx defines a virtual device, each of which consists of a
disconnecting and a grounding switch. This setting selects which of the
connected ordinary 2-pole devices is the disconnector and which is the
grounding switch.
Parameter Address
1: With
[spacer]
Cancelling function group SIG_1 or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
[spacer] SIG_1: S ignal S 00 1 config. 226 007
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Cancelling the signal or including it in the configuration. If a signal is cancelled,
then all associated settings and signals are hidden.
[spacer] SIG_1: S IG_DC 3 config. 233 007
[spacer]
Cancelling the signal SIG_DC3 or including it in the configuration. This signal is
used to terminate a direct motor control command in combination with the
single-pole command CM D_1 : CMD_DC 3.
If this signal is cancelled, then all associated settings are hidden.
Parameter Address
commands
1: With
[spacer]
Cancelling function group CMD_1 or including it in the configuration.
If the function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated
settings and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
[spacer] CMD_1: Com mand C 0 01 config. 200 004
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Cancelling the command or including it in the configuration. If the command is
cancelled, then all associated settings and signals are hidden, with the
exception of this setting.
[spacer] CMD_1: CMD_DC1 config. 202 004
[spacer]
Cancelling command CMD_DC1 or including it in the configuration. This
command is used for Three Position Drives, the operation is delayed by the set
value MAIN: DC o p. de lay t1, and it is terminated either with positive
indication of the final switchgear position, or when the timer MAIN: DC1
impulse t 2 has elapsed.
If the command is cancelled, then all associated settings and signals are hidden,
with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Cancelling command CMD_DC2 or including it in the configuration. This
command is used for direct motor control, the operation is delayed by the set
value MAIN: DC o p. de lay t1, and it is terminated with positive indication
of the final switchgear position, but this reset is delayed by the set value
MAIN: DC 2/3 rele ase de lay.
If the command is cancelled, then all associated settings and signals are hidden,
with the exception of this setting.
[spacer] CMD_1: CMD_DC3 config. 202 014
[spacer]
Cancelling command CMD_DC3 or including it in the configuration. This
command is used for direct motor control, the operation is delayed by the set
value MAIN: DC o p. de lay t1, and it is terminated with the signal
SIG_1: Logic SIG_DC3 or – if MAIN: e xt .cmd.term. w/o PI = No –
with positive indication of the final switchgear position; in any case this reset is
delayed by the set value MAIN: DC 2 /3 re le as e delay.
If the command is cancelled, then all associated settings and signals are hidden,
with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
1: With
[spacer]
Cancelling function group ILOCK or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group COUNT or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden, with the exception of this setting.
Parameter Address
0: Without
[spacer]
Cancelling function group TIMER or including it in the configuration. If the
function group is cancelled from the configuration, then all associated settings
and signals are hidden.
7.1.3.1 Global
Parameter Address
[spacer]
When command blocking is activated, commands are rejected at the PC
interface.
[spacer] PC: Sig./m eas .val.bl ock . 003 086
[spacer]
When signal and measured value blocking is activated, no signals or measured
data are transmitted through the PC interface.
Parameter Address
communication
interface 1
1: Yes Fig. 3-12, (p. 3-20)
[spacer]
When command blocking is activated, commands are rejected at communication
interface 1.
[spacer] COMM 1: Sig./ meas.block .US E R 003 076
[spacer]
When signal and measured value blocking user is activated, no signals or
measured data are transmitted through communication interface COMM1.
Parameter Address
communication
interface 2
0: No Fig. 3-20, (p. 3-29)
[spacer]
When command blocking is activated, commands are rejected at communication
interface 2.
[spacer] COMM 2: Sig./ meas.block .US E R 103 076
[spacer]
When signal and measured value blocking user is activated, no signals or
measured data are transmitted through communication interface COMM2.
Parameter Address
Communication
1: Yes
[spacer]
When command blocking is activated, commands are rejected at IEC
communication interface.
[spacer] IEC: Ctrl b lock e d use r 221 125
[spacer]
When control blocking is activated, controls are rejected at IEC communication,
i.e no output data (digital by relays) will be issued to the process.
[spacer] IEC: Sig./me as.block.US E R 104 088
0: No
[spacer]
When signal and measured value blocking user is activated, no signals or
measured data are transmitted through IEC communication interface.
Parameter Address
output
0: No Fig. 3-43, (p. 3-72)
[spacer]
When this blocking is activated, all output relays are blocked.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Switching the device off-line or on-line. Some parameters can only be changed
when protection is disabled.
[spacer] MAIN: Tes t m ode USER 003 012
[spacer]
When the test mode user is activated, signals or measured data for PC and
communication interfaces are labeled 'test mode'.
[spacer] MAIN: Nominal fr equ. fnom 010 030
50: 50 Hz Hz
[spacer]
Setting for the nominal frequency of the protected system.
[spacer] MAIN: Phase s eque nce 010 049
[spacer]
Setting the phase sequence A-B-C or A-C-B.
(Alternative terminology: Setting for the rotary field's direction, either clockwise
or anticlockwise.)
[spacer] MAIN: Tim e tag 221 098
1: 1stEdge,OpMem sorted
[spacer]
For bay control function signals detected via binary signal inputs and
conditioned with debouncing it is now possible to select whether the time tag for
the signal is to be issued after debouncing or when the first pulse edge is
detected. Furthermore it is defined whether entries in the operating data
memory are made in chronological order or not.
[spacer] MAIN: Inom C.T. prim. 010 001
[spacer]
Setting for the primary nominal current of the main current transformers for
measurement of phase currents.
[spacer] MAIN: DTOC/ I DM T 2phas e 011 226
0: No
[spacer]
If this parameter is set to w/o starting, then the protection functions DTOC and
IDMT ignore current IB, as if it were constantly equal 0, and only the currents IA
and IC are analyzed. If it is set to with starting, 3 phase currents will be
analyzed. For Phase B, only the starting signal will be issued but not a tripping.
[spacer] MAIN: IN,nom C.T. prim. 010 018
[spacer]
Setting for the primary nominal current of the main current transformer for
measurement of residual current.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the primary nominal voltage of the system transformer for
measurement of phase-to-ground and phase-to-phase voltages.
[spacer] MAIN: VNG,nom V.T . pr im. 010 027
[spacer]
Setting for the primary nominal voltage of the system transformer for
measurement of neutral-point displacement voltage.
[spacer] MAIN: Vref ,nom V.T. pri m. 010 100
[spacer]
Setting for the primary nominal voltage of the system transformer for
measurement of reference voltage for automatic synchronism check.
[spacer] MAIN: Inom de vice 010 003
[spacer]
Setting for the secondary nominal current of the system transformer for
measurement of phase currents. This also corresponds to the nominal device
current.
[spacer] MAIN: IN,nom dev ice 010 026
[spacer]
Setting for the secondary nominal current of the system transformer for
measurement of residual current. This also corresponds to the nominal device
current.
[spacer] MAIN: Vnom V.T. sec. 010 009
[spacer]
Setting for the secondary nominal voltage of the system transformer for
measurement of phase-to-ground and phase-to-phase voltages.
[spacer] MAIN: VNG,nom V.T . sec . 010 028
[spacer]
Setting for the secondary nominal voltage of the system transformer for
measurement of neutral-point displacement voltage.
[spacer] MAIN: Vref ,nom V.T. s ec . 031 052
[spacer]
Setting for the secondary nominal voltage of the system transformer for
measurement of reference voltage for automatic synchronism check.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Short-circuit direction determination depends on the connection of the
measuring circuits. If the connection is as shown in Chapter “Installation and
Connection”, then the setting must be Standard, if the P139's 'forward' decision
is to be in the direction of the outgoing feeder. If the connection direction is
reversed or – given a connection scheme according to Chapter “Installation and
Connection” – if the 'forward' decision is to be in the busbar direction, then the
setting must be Opposite.
[spacer] MAIN: Conn. m eas . circ. IN 010 019
[spacer]
Direction determination of the ground fault measuring systems depends on the
connection of the measuring circuits. If the connection is as shown in Chapter
“Installation and Connection”, then the setting must be Standard, if the P139's
'forward' decision is to be in the direction of the outgoing feeder.
If the connection direction is reversed or – given a connection scheme according
to Chapter “Installation and Connection” – if the 'forward' decision is to be in the
busbar direction, then the setting must be Opposite.
[spacer] MAIN: Me as. direct ion P,Q 006 096
[spacer]
This parameter allows inverting the sign for the following measured operating
values:
● MAIN: Active powe r P prim.
● MAIN: R eac. power Q prim.
● MAIN: Active powe r P p.u.
● M AIN: Reac. powe r Q p. u.
[spacer] MAIN: Me as. value re l. IP 011 030
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum current that must be exceeded so that measured
operating values of the phase currents and, if applicable, derived currents are
displayed.
[spacer] MAIN: Me as. value re l. IN 011 031
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum current that must be exceeded so that the measured
operating value of the residual current is displayed.
[spacer] MAIN: Me as. value re l. V 011 032
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum voltage that must be exceeded so that measured
operating values of the phase-to-ground voltages, phase-to-phase voltages, and,
if applicable, derived voltages are displayed.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum voltage that must be exceeded so that the measured
operating value of the neutral-point displacement voltage is displayed.
[spacer] MAIN: Me as. val. re l. Vref 011 034
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum voltage that must be exceeded so that the measured
operating value of the reference voltage for the automatic synchronism check is
displayed.
[spacer] MAIN: Op. m ode ene r gy cnt . 010 138
[spacer]
Selection of the procedure to determine the active and reactive energy output.
1st procedure: Data acquisition every 2s (approximately). 2nd procedure: Data
acquisition every 100ms (approximately)
[spacer] MAIN: Se tt l. t. IP,max,de l 010 113
[spacer]
Setting for the time after which the delayed maximum current display shall
reach 95% of the maximum current IP,max.
[spacer]
Assigning specific memories and counters which are to be reset jointly if
MAIN: Group res e t 1 USER is enabled.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as sign. res et 2 005 249
[spacer]
Assigning specific memories and counters which are to be reset jointly if
MAIN: Group res e t 2 USER is enabled.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as sign. bloc k. 1 021 021
[spacer]
Assignment of functions that will be blocked simultaneously when blocking
input 1 (MAIN: B lock ing 1 EX T) is activated.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as sign. bloc k. 2 021 022
[spacer]
Assignment of functions that will be blocked simultaneously when blocking
input 2 (MAIN: B lock ing 2 EX T) is activated.
[spacer] MAIN: Trip cm d.block . USER 021 012
[spacer]
Blocking the trip commands from the local control panel.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Assignment of signals that trigger trip command 1.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as sig.t ri p cmd.2 021 002
[spacer]
Assignment of the signals that trigger trip command 2.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as sig.t ri p cmd.3 021 046
[spacer]
Assignment of signals that trigger trip command 3.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as sig.t ri p cmd.4 021 047
[spacer]
Assignment of signals that trigger trip command 4.
[spacer] MAIN: Min.dur . trip cmd. 1 021 003
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum duration of trip command 1.
[spacer] MAIN: Min.dur . trip cmd. 2 021 004
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum duration of trip command 2.
[spacer] MAIN: Min.dur . trip cmd. 3 021 032
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum duration of trip command 3.
[spacer] MAIN: Min.dur . trip cmd. 4 021 033
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum duration of trip command 4.
[spacer] MAIN: Latching tr ip cmd. 3 021 025
0: No
[spacer]
Specification as to whether trip command 3 should latch.
[spacer] MAIN: Latching tr ip cmd. 4 021 026
0: No
[spacer]
Specification as to whether trip command 4 should latch.
[spacer] MAIN: Latching tr ip cmd. 1 021 023
[spacer]
Specification as to whether trip command 1 should latch.
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
Specification as to whether trip command 2 should latch.
[spacer] MAIN: Clos e cmd.puls e ti me 015 067
[spacer]
Setting for the duration of the close command.
[spacer] MAIN: tCB,clos e 000 032
[spacer]
This setting determines the CB closing time. In slightly asynchronous power
systems, the CB closing time is taken into account by the automatic
synchronism check (ASC) to issue of a close command. This is possible only if
ASC: AR with tCB PSx = Yes.
[spacer] MAIN: Re l.t . e nab. man.c md 003 088
[spacer]
Setting for the release time of the enable for the manual close command.
[spacer] MAIN: Fct. as s ign. fault 021 031
[spacer]
Selection of the signals to be signaled as Blocked/Faulty in addition to the
messages that always result in the message Blocked/Faulty.
[spacer] MAIN: Sig . as g. C B open 021 017
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used by the P139 to evaluate the “CB open”
position signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Sig . as g. C B cl ose d 021 020
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used by the P139 to evaluate the “CB closed”
position signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Deb ounce time gr . 1 221 200
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the debouncing time.
[spacer] MAIN: Chatt.m on. time gr.1 221 201
[spacer]
Setting for the chatter monitoring time.
[spacer] MAIN: Change of state gr.1 221 202
0 0 254
0 0 254
0 0 254
0 0 254
0 0 254
Parameter Address
0 0 254
0 0 254
[spacer]
Setting the number of signal changes allowed during the chatter monitoring
time before chatter suppression operates.
[spacer] MAIN: Cmd . d ur.long cmd. 221 230
20 1 254 s
[spacer]
Setting for the command duration for a long command.
[spacer] MAIN: Cmd . d ur. short cmd. 221 231
1 1 254 s
[spacer]
Setting for the command duration for a short command.
[spacer] MAIN: Oper. mode CB Trip 221 080
[spacer]
Definition of the operating mode of the CB trip.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg. ctr l.enabl. 221 057
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used to issue a general command output enable.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg.int er l.deact 221 007
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used to disable interlocking of control commands
for switchgear.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg. L/R key s w. 221 008
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used to switch from remote control to local
control.
[spacer] MAIN: Electrical c ontrol 221 061
1: Remote
[spacer]
This setting determines whether the binary inputs, that are configured to control
switchgear, will be active with remote control or local control.
[spacer] MAIN: Delay Man.Op.S upe r v. 221 079
3 0 255 s
[spacer]
After the delay time period, to be set in this window, has elapsed (with the
signal “Sw. dev. interm. pos.” already present and the status signal continuously
absent), the actual switchgear status signal, as obtained from the respective
binary inputs, will be issued. (See also “Processing status signals from manually
operated switchgear”.)
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used to signal the tripping of an external
protection device. This signal is used to form the CB trip signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Prot.t rip>CB tr ipped 221 012
[spacer]
Selection of the protection function trip command that will be used to form the
CB trip signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp. as g. CB t ri p 221 013
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used by the P139 to signal the “CB open” position
signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg.CB tr.en. ext 221 050
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used to enable the CB trip signal of an external
device.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg. CB t rip ex t 221 024
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal used to carry the CB trip signal of an external
device.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg. m ult.sig. 1 221 051
[spacer]
Definition of the function that will be interpreted as a multiple signal (group
signal).
[spacer] MAIN: Fct.as g. grp.s ig. 0 1 019 184
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection up to 32 internal signals to be grouped using Boolean operators NOT,
AND, OR.
Parameter Address
selection
0: No Fig. 3-96, (p. 3-138)
[spacer]
If parameter subset selection is to be handled from the integrated local control
panel rather than via binary signal inputs, choose the setting Yes.
[spacer] PSS: Param.subs.se l. USE R 003 060
[spacer]
Selection of the parameter subset from the local control panel.
[spacer] PSS: Ke ep tim e 003 063
[spacer]
The setting of this timer stage is relevant only if parameter subset selection is
carried out via the binary signal inputs. Any voltage-free pause that may occur
during selection is bridged. If, after this time period has elapsed, no binary
signal input has yet been set, then the parameter subset selected from the local
control panel shall apply.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection of the signals whose appearance shall result in the signals “Warning
(LED)” and “Warning (relay)” and in the activation of the LED indicator labeled
“ALARM”. Signals caused by faulty hardware and leading to blocking of the
device are not configurable. They always result in the above signals and
indication.
[spacer] SFMO N: M on.s ig. re t enti on 021 018
Blocked 0 240 h
[spacer]
This setting defines the duration (in hours) for which a device-internal fault is
stored, so that a decision may be taken between an automatic warm restart and
an automatic device blocking. (Setting to Blocked may be considered the same
as unlimited storage.)
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This setting defines the signals that will trigger fault recording.
[spacer] FT_RC: I> 017 065
[spacer]
This setting defines the threshold value of the phase currents that will trigger
fault recording and fault data acquisition.
[spacer] FT_RC: Pre- fault time 003 078
[spacer]
Setting for the time during which data will be recorded before the onset of a
fault (pre-fault recording time).
[spacer] FT_RC: Post -f ault ti me 003 079
[spacer]
Setting for the time during which data will be recorded after the end of a fault
(post-fault recording time).
[spacer] FT_RC: Max. re cording t ime 003 075
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum recording time per fault. This includes pre-fault and
post-fault recording times.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Enable/disable the DTOC and IDMTx residual current stages. (IDMTx: IDMT1,
IDMT2)
[spacer] MAIN: Se le ction meas. v olt 018 202
[spacer]
Setting for the voltage that shall be used for frequency measurement.
[spacer] MAIN: Evaluat ion t ime 018 201
[spacer]
Setting for the evaluation time. The operate conditions must be met for the
duration of the set evaluation time in order for a signal to be issued.
[spacer] MAIN: Undervolt . blo ck. V< 018 200
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold of undervoltage blocking. If the voltage falls below this
threshold, the over-/underfrequency protection function and underfrequency
load shedding function will be blocked.
Parameter Address
current protection
0: No Fig. 3-123, (p. 3-168)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling the definite-time overcurrent protection function.
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: No Fig. 3-140, (p. 3-189)
0: No
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the inverse-time overcurrent protection function.
Parameter Address
direction
determination
0: No Fig. 3-158, (p. 3-210)
[spacer]
Enable/disable the short-circuit direction determination.
Parameter Address
protection
0: No Fig. 3-169, (p. 3-224)
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the switch on to fault (short circuit) protection.
[spacer] SOT F : Operating mode 011 061
[spacer]
The setting of the operating mode defines whether, while the timer is running, a
general starting will lead to a trip command (Trip by gen. start.) or exceeding
the thresholds of the first, second, third or fourth overcurrent stages (Trip by I>,
Trip by I>>, Trip by I>>>, Trip by I>>>>).
[spacer] SOT F : Manual close timer 011 060
[spacer]
Setting for the timer stage that will be started by a manual close.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling protective signaling.
Parameter Address
control
0: No Fig. 3-176, (p. 3-234)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling auto-reclosing control.
[spacer] ARC: S ig.as g.tri p t.GF DSS 015 105
[spacer]
Selection of the GFDSS starting to trigger the auto-reclosing control function.
[spacer] ARC: Fct.as sig.s t ar t ARC 015 203
[spacer]
Function assignment to start auto-reclosing control function.
[spacer] ARC: Fct.as sgn. tLOG IC 015 033
[spacer]
Function assignment to tLOGIC.
Parameter Address
synchronism check
0: No Fig. 3-195, (p. 3-259)
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the automatic synchronism check.
[spacer] ASC: Transm .cycle ,me as .v. 101 212
[spacer]
Cycle period for transmission of ASC measured values.
Parameter Address
direction
determination using
steady-state values
0: No Fig. 3-210, (p. 3-277)
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling ground fault direction determination by steady-state
values.
[spacer] GFDSS : O pe rating mode 016 090
[spacer]
This setting specifies which of the following evaluation mode will be performed.
● Steady-state power evaluation.
● Steady-state current evaluation.
● Steady-state admittance evaluation.
● Steady-state power and admittance evaluation.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the transient ground fault direction determination.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling motor protection
[spacer] MP: Hours_Run > 025 156
10000 1 65000 h
[spacer]
Setting the maximum hours for running time.
Parameter Address
protection
0: No Fig. 3-242, (p. 3-315)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling thermal overload protection.
[spacer] THER M : R e lat ive re pl ic a 022 064
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling the Relative replica mode of operation.
Note that it is not permitted to enable both Absolute replica and Relative replica
modes.
[spacer] THER M : Absolut e r eplica 022 065
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the Absolute replica mode of operation.
Note that it is not permitted to enable both Absolute replica and Relative replica
modes.
Parameter Address
tion
0: No Fig. 3-247, (p. 3-325)
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling unbalance protection.
Parameter Address
tion
0: No Fig. 3-249, (p. 3-327)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling time-voltage protection.
Parameter Address
underfrequency pro‐
tection
0: No Fig. 3-263, (p. 3-341)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling over-/underfrequency protection.
Parameter Address
shedding
0: No Fig. 3-266, (p. 3-346)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling underfrequency load shedding protection.
Parameter Address
protection
0: No Fig. 3-270, (p. 3-350)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling the power directional protection function.
Parameter Address
directional reactive
power protection
0: No Fig. 3-284, (p. 3-363)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling QV protection.
Parameter Address
failure protection
0: No Fig. 3-288, (p. 3-366)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling circuit breaker failure protection.
[spacer] CBF: S tart with man. tr ip 022 154
[spacer]
Setting that permit a manual trip signal to also be used as a start criterion.
[spacer] CBF: Fct.as signm. CBAux. 022 159
[spacer]
Selection of trip signals – assigned to Gen. trip command 1 – for which, in
addition to current flow monitoring, status signals from CB auxiliary contacts are
evaluated.
[spacer] CBF: I < 022 160
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold to detect a break in current flow.
[spacer] CBF: Evaluation IN 022 184
[spacer]
Select whether the measured or the calculated residual current shall be used for
residual current monitoring function. This choice is only possible when a
measuring input for the residual current is available, otherwise the internally
derived value of the residual current is always used, regardless of the setting.
[spacer] CBF: I N< 022 180
[spacer]
Setting of the comparator threshold for residual current monitoring function.
[spacer] CBF: t 1 3p 022 165
[spacer]
Setting the 1st CBF timer stage to 3-pole operating mode.
[spacer] CBF: t 2 022 166
[spacer]
Setting for the 2nd CBF timer stage.
[spacer] CBF: M in.dur. tr ip cmd. t1 022 167
[spacer]
Setting the 1st timer stage for minimum duration of trip command.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting the 2nd timer stage for minimum duration of trip command.
[spacer] CBF: Latching trip cmd.t 1 022 169
[spacer]
The 1st timer stage trip command, set to latch mode, will remain active until
reset by operating parameters or through an appropriately configured binary
signal input.
[spacer] CBF: Latching trip cmd.t 2 022 170
[spacer]
The 2nd timer stage trip command, set to latch mode, will remain active until
reset by operating parameters or through an appropriately configured binary
signal input.
[spacer] CBF: De lay/s tarting t rig. 022 155
[spacer]
The signal CB F: Trip si gnal is issued when this timer stage's time duration
has elapsed.
[spacer] CBF: De lay/f ault beh. C B 022 171
[spacer]
If during this delay time period the circuit breaker does not provide a signal from
its auxiliary contacts that it is closed, then faults behind the CB are recognized
through the current criterion (see section “Fault behind CB protection”).
[spacer] CBF: De lay/C B s ync.supe rv 022 172
[spacer]
Setting for the time delay to bridge circuit breaker operate times during CB
synchronization supervision.
Parameter Address
condition monitoring
0: No Fig. 3-298, (p. 3-374)
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling circuit breaker monitoring.
[spacer] CBM: Blocking USER 022 150
[spacer]
Setting for temporary blocking of circuit breaker monitoring during protection
injection testing.
[spacer] CBM: S ig. as g. trip cmd. 022 152
[spacer]
Using the setting for external devices the trip command issued by the control
function may be linked to the trip command 1 issued by the protection by
assigning the trip command issued by the control function by this parameter.
[spacer] CBM: Op er ating mode 022 007
[spacer]
This setting defines starting criteria for circuit breaker monitoring. To evaluate
all trip commands issued by the protection device With trip cmd. only must be
selected. For further evaluation of operational trip commands the additional CB
auxiliary contact CB sig. EXT or trip is used.
[spacer] CBM: I nom,CB 022 012
[spacer]
Setting for the CB nominal current.
[spacer] CBM: Per m . CB op. Inom,CB 022 013
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum number of CB operations at nominal current.
[spacer] CBM: M e d. curr. I t ri p,CB 022 014
[spacer]
Setting for the average CB disconnection current.
Note: In general valid only for pneumatically operated CBs.
[spacer] CBM: Per m . CB op. Imed, CB 022 015
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum number of CB operations at average disconnection
(ruptured) current.
Note: In general valid only for pneumatically operated CBs.
[spacer] CBM: M ax . curr. It r ip,CB 022 016
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum CB disconnection (ruptured) current.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum number of CB operations permitted at maximum CB
disconnection (ruptured) current.
[spacer] CBM: No. CB ope rations > 022 019
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum number of mechanical CB switching operations.
[spacer] CBM: R e main No. CB op. < 022 020
[spacer]
Setting for the warning stage with the number of remaining CB operations at CB
nominal current.
[spacer] CBM: ΣItr ip > 022 022
[spacer]
Setting for the warning stage with the accumulated CB disconnection (ruptured)
current values.
[spacer] CBM: ΣItr ip **2> 022 081
[spacer]
Setting for the warning stage with the accumulated CB disconnection (ruptured)
current values to the second power.
[spacer] CBM: ΣI* t> 022 096
[spacer]
Setting for the warning stage with the sum of the current-time integrals of the
CB disconnection (ruptured) current values
[spacer] CBM: C orr. acqu.t ime trip 007 249
[spacer]
Correction of the time tolerances permissible for leading or lagging CB auxiliary
contacts in case of a triggering by the open command.
[spacer] CBM: C orr.acqu.t . C B sig. 022 018
[spacer]
Correction of the time tolerances permissible for leading or lagging CB auxiliary
contacts in case of a triggering by the position signal issued by the CB auxiliary
contacts.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: No Fig. 3-308, (p. 3-384)
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the measuring-circuit monitoring function.
[spacer] MCM ON: Op . m ode Idiff> 017 028
[spacer]
Adaptation of measuring-circuit monitoring to the system current transformers.
[spacer] MCM ON: I dif f> 017 024
[spacer]
Setting the operate value of measuring-circuit monitoring.
[spacer] MCM ON: Op . m ode Vmin< monit 018 079
[spacer]
Selection of the monitoring mode in the voltage-measuring circuit.
[spacer] MCM ON: Vm in< 017 022
[spacer]
Setting the operate value for the voltage trigger Vmin< of measuring circuit
monitoring.
[spacer] MCM ON: Op erate delay 017 023
[spacer]
Setting of the time delay for current and voltage monitoring.
[spacer] MCM ON: Phas e s e qu. monitor. 018 019
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling phase sequence monitoring.
[spacer] MCM ON: FF,Vre f enable d US ER 014 013
[spacer]
Enabling or disabling the “Fuse Failure” monitoring function of the reference
voltage Vref.
[spacer] MCM ON: Op er. de lay F F , Vre f 014 012
[spacer]
Setting for the time delay for “Fuse Failure” monitoring of the reference voltage
Vref.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: No Fig. 3-315, (p. 3-393)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling limit value monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : I> 014 004
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the first overcurrent stage for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : I> > 014 020
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second overcurrent stage for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tI> 014 031
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the first overcurrent stage of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tI>> 014 032
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the second overcurrent stage of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : I< 014 021
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the first undercurrent stage of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : I< < 014 022
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second undercurrent stage of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tI< 014 033
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the first undercurrent stage of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tI<< 014 034
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the second undercurrent stage of limit value
monitoring.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage VPG> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VPG>> 014 024
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage VPG>> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPG> 014 035
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VPG> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPG>> 014 036
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VPG>> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VPG< 014 025
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of undervoltage stage VPG< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VPG<< 014 026
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of undervoltage stage VPG<< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPG< 014 037
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage VPG< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPG<< 014 038
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage VPG<< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VPP> 014 027
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage VPP> of limit value
monitoring.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage VPP>> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPP> 014 039
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VPP> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPP>> 014 040
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VPP>> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VPP< 014 029
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of undervoltage stage VPP< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VPP<< 014 030
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of undervoltage stage VPP<< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPP< 014 041
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage VPP< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVPP<< 014 042
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage VPP<< of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VNG> 014 043
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage VNG> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : VNG>> 014 044
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage VNG>> of limit value
monitoring.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VNG> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVNG>> 014 046
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VNG>> of limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : Vref > 042 144
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage Vref> for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : Vref >> 042 145
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of overvoltage stage Vref>> for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVref> 042 148
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vref> for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVref>> 042 149
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vref>> for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : Vref < 042 146
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of undervoltage stage Vref< for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : Vref << 042 147
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of undervoltage stage Vref<< for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : tVref< 042 150
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage Vref< for limit value
monitoring.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage Vref<< for limit value
monitoring.
[spacer] LIMIT : IDC,lin> 014 110
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value IDC,lin> for monitoring the linearized direct
current.
[spacer] LIMIT : IDC,lin>> 014 111
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value IDC,lin>> for monitoring the linearized direct
current.
[spacer] LIMIT : tIDC,lin> 014 112
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overcurrent stage IDC,lin>.
[spacer] LIMIT : tIDC,lin>> 014 113
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overcurrent stage IDC,lin>>.
[spacer] LIMIT : IDC,lin< 014 114
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value IDC,lin< for monitoring the linearized direct
current.
[spacer] LIMIT : IDC,lin<< 014 115
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value IDC,lin<< for monitoring the linearized direct
current.
[spacer] LIMIT : tIDC,lin< 014 116
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undercurrent stage IDC,lin<.
[spacer] LIMIT : tIDC,lin<< 014 117
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undercurrent stage IDC,lin<<.
[spacer] LIMIT : T> 014 100
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of temperature monitoring T>.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of temperature monitoring T>>.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT > 014 103
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of temperature monitoring T>.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT >> 014 104
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of temperature monitoring T>>.
[spacer] LIMIT : T< 014 105
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of temperature monitoring T<.
[spacer] LIMIT : T<< 014 106
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of temperature monitoring T<<.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT < 014 107
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of temperature monitoring T<.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT << 014 108
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of temperature monitoring T<<.
[spacer] LIMIT : T1> 014 120
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting the operate value of temperature monitoring Tn> for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : T1>> 014 121
[spacer]
Setting the operate value of temperature monitoring Tn>> for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT 1> 014 122
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Parameter Address
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
[spacer]
Setting the operate delay of temperature monitoring Tn> for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT 1>> 014 123
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
[spacer]
Setting the operate delay of temperature monitoring Tn>> for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : T1< 014 124
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting the operate value of temperature monitoring Tn< for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : T1<< 014 125
[spacer]
Setting the operate value of temperature monitoring Tn<< for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT 1< 014 126
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Parameter Address
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
[spacer]
Setting the operate delay of temperature monitoring Tn< for temperature
sensor Tn.
[spacer] LIMIT : tT 1<< 014 127
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
Blocked 0 1000 s
[spacer]
Setting the operate delay of temperature monitoring Tn<< for temperature
sensor Tn.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: No Fig. 3-321, (p. 3-400)
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling the transformer monitoring.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Enable/disable the logic function.
[spacer] LOGIC: Se t 1 US ER 034 030
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
These settings define the static input conditions for the logic function.
[spacer] LOGIC: Fct.as s ignm. outp. 1 030 000
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
These settings assign functions to the outputs.
[spacer] LOGIC: Op. m ode t output 1 030 001
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
These settings define the operating modes for the output timer stages.
[spacer] LOGIC: Tim e t1 output 1 030 002
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Settings of timer stage t1 for the respective outputs.
[spacer] LOGIC: Tim e t2 output 1 030 003
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Settings for timer stage t2 for the respective outputs.
Note: This setting has no effect in the “minimum time” operating mode.
[spacer] LOGIC: Sig .as sig. out p. 1 044 000
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
These settings assign the function of a binary input signal to the output of the
logic equation.
[spacer] LOGIC: Sig .as sig.out p. 1 (t ) 044 001
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
These settings assign the function of a binary input signal to the output of the
logic equation.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
These settings assign the function of a binary input signal to the output of the
logic equation.
[spacer] LOG_2: S ig.as sig.out p. 1 (t ) 064 001
[spacer]
These settings assign the function of a binary input signal to the output of the
logic equation.
[spacer] LOG_2: General e nabl e USE R 011 137
[spacer]
Enable/disable the function group LOG_2 (Programmable Logic 2).
[spacer] LOG_2: Fct.assignm. outp. 1 050 000
[spacer]
These settings assign functions to the outputs.
[spacer] LOG_2: Op . m ode t output 1 050 001
Parameter Address
[spacer]
These settings define the operating modes for the output timer stages.
[spacer] LOG_2: T im e t 1 output 1 050 002
0 0 60000 s
0 0 60000 s
0 0 60000 s
[spacer]
Settings of timer stage t1 for the respective outputs.
[spacer] LOG_2: T im e t 2 output 1 050 003
0 0 60000 s
0 0 60000 s
0 0 60000 s
[spacer]
Settings for timer stage t2 for the respective outputs.
Note: This setting has no effect in the “minimum time” operating mode.
Parameter Address
1: S001
2: S002
3: S003
4: S004
5: S005
6: S006
7: S007
8: S008
9: S009
10: S010
11: S011
12: S012
13: S013
14: S014
15: S015
16: S016
17: S017
18: S018
19: S019
Parameter Address
20: S020
21: S021
22: S022
23: S023
24: S024
25: S025
26: S026
27: S027
28: S028
29: S029
30: S030
31: S031
32: S032
33: S033
34: S034
35: S035
36: S036
37: S037
38: S038
Parameter Address
39: S039
40: S040
41: S041
42: S042
43: S043
44: S044
45: S045
46: S046
47: S047
48: S048
49: S049
50: S050
51: S051
52: S052
53: S053
54: S054
55: S055
56: S056
57: S057
Parameter Address
58: S058
59: S059
60: S060
61: S061
62: S062
63: S063
64: S064
[spacer]
Selection of the signal designation.
[spacer] SIG_1: Op er. mod e s ig. S 001 226 001
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
Parameter Address
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
Parameter Address
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
Parameter Address
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
1: Start/end signal
[spacer]
Selection of the signal operating mode.
[spacer] SIG_1: Gr.as g. de bounc.S0 01 226 003
1: Group 1
Parameter Address
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
Parameter Address
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
Parameter Address
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
Parameter Address
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
[spacer]
Group assignment for the debouncing time and the chatter suppression.
[spacer] SIG_1: M in. sig. dur. S0 01 226 002
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
Parameter Address
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
Parameter Address
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
Parameter Address
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
0 0 254 s
[spacer]
The logic “1” signal must be available for this minimum time setting so that a
telegram can be sent in the Start/end signal mode.
Parameter Address
commands
1: C001
2: C002
3: C003
4: C004
5: C005
6: C006
7: C007
8: C008
9: C009
10: C010
11: C011
12: C012
13: C013
14: C014
15: C015
16: C016
17: C017
18: C018
Parameter Address
19: C019
20: C020
21: C021
22: C022
23: C023
24: C024
25: C025
26: C026
232: CMD_DC1
233: CMD_DC2
234: CMD_DC3
[spacer]
Selection of the command designation.
[spacer] CMD_1: Oper. m ode cmd. C 001 200 002
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
Parameter Address
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
3: Persistent command
Parameter Address
3: Persistent command
[spacer]
Selection of the command operating mode.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling binary counts.
[spacer] COUNT : Deb ounce t. c ount. 1 217 160
3 0 1000 ms
3 0 1000 ms
3 0 1000 ms
[spacer]
Setting for the debounce time of the binary signal to be counted.
[spacer] COUNT : Limit count e r 1 217 221
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
[spacer]
Setting a limit for the counter value. A warning signal is issued if the counter
value exceeds the set limit. Setting this parameter to Blocked disables the limit
check.
[spacer] COUNT : Cycle t.count t r ans m 217 007
[spacer]
Setting the cycle time for the periodic transmission of the counts.
[spacer] COUNT : IEC61850 pulsQty 221 096
1 0 1000
[spacer]
Setting the scaling factor to transmit the counter value via IEC 61850. According
to the standard the resulting value is calculated as:
Value transmitted = actual value · pulsQty
(see IEC 61850: Value = actVal · pulsQty).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Disabling or enabling TIMER protection.
[spacer] TIM ER : S tart hour 1 014 089
0 0 23 h
0 0 23 h
0 0 23 h
[spacer]
The parameter defines the start hour of the TIMER.
[spacer] TIM ER : S tart m inute 1 014 102
0 0 59 min
0 0 59 min
0 0 59 min
[spacer]
The parameter defines the start minute of the TIMER.
[spacer] TIM ER : E nd hour 1 014 109
0 0 23 h
0 0 23 h
0 0 23 h
[spacer]
The parameter defines the end hour of the TIMER.
[spacer] TIM ER : E nd m inute 1 014 118
0 0 59 mi
0 0 59 min
Parameter Address
0 0 59 min
[spacer]
The parameter defines the end minute of the TIMER.
[spacer] TIM ER : Calendar 1 014 178
[spacer]
The setting defines the calender day of week for the TIMER. One or more of the
seven weekdays can be selected.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selection of backup temperature sensor groups for parameter subset PSx.
Parameter Address
Main function MAIN: Neut r.p t. treat . PSx 010 048 001 076 001 077 001 078
1: Low-imped. grounding
[spacer]
The neutral-point treatment of the system must be set here.
[spacer] MAIN: Gen. s tart. mode P S x 017 027 001 219 001 220 001 221
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the triggering of the residual current stages IN>,
Iref,N>, IN>> or IN>>> as well as the negative-sequence current stage Iref,neg>
should result in the formation of the general starting signal. If the setting is W/o
start. IN, Ineg then the associated time delays tIN>, tIref,N>, tIN>>, tIN>>>,
tIref,neg>are automatically excluded from the formation of the trip command.
[spacer] MAIN: Bl.tim .s t.IN ,neg P Sx 017 015 001 214 001 215 001 216
[spacer]
This setting defines whether a blocking of the residual and negative-sequence
current stages should take place for single-pole startings or multi-pole phase
current startings.
[spacer] MAIN: Sup pr.start.sig. P Sx 017 054 001 222 001 223 001 224
[spacer]
Setting of the timer stage for the suppression of the phase-selective startings
and of the residual and negative-sequence system starting.
[spacer] MAIN: tGS PSx 017 005 001 225 001 226 001 227
[spacer]
Setting for the time delay of the general starting signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Op. rush r e st r. PS x 017 097 001 088 001 089 001 090
[spacer]
Setting for the operating mode of the inrush stabilization function.
[spacer] MAIN: Funct.R us h r est r. PS x 017 093 017 064 017 082 017 083
[spacer]
Select the protection elements that shall be blocked when the inrush
stabilization is triggered.
[spacer] MAIN: Rush I(2fn)/I( fn) PS x 017 098 001 091 001 092 001 093
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of inrush stabilization.
[spacer] MAIN: I>lif t rush re st rP Sx 017 095 001 085 001 086 001 087
[spacer]
Setting for the current threshold for disabling the inrush stabilization.
Parameter Address
[spacer] MAIN: t lift rus h r st r. PSx 019 001 019 002 019 003 019 004
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum duration of inrush stabilization.
[spacer] MAIN: Hld time dyn.par .P Sx 018 009 001 211 001 212 001 213
[spacer]
Setting the hold time of the “dynamic parameters”. After switching to the
“dynamic” thresholds, the latter will remain active in place of the “normal”
thresholds during this period.
[spacer] MAIN: Phase re v ersal I PSx 010 200 010 201 010 202 010 203
0: No swap
[spacer]
The phase sequence for the current, given by the active parameter subset with
the setting at M AI N: Phase re ver s al I P S x may be reversed by triggering
a binary signal input configured at MAIN: P hase reversal I EXT.
To enable the function a phase sequence for normal operation must be set in
the parameter. (Setting selection: A-B swapped, B-C swapped, C-A swapped).
The default setting is No swap, which disables the function.
Note: Designed for motor protection applications with 'left/right' motor rotation
control by phase reversal with parallel circuit breakers (one CB with phase
reversal). Here the voltage is measured on the busbar side and the current
down-stream between CB and motor. Dependent on the operating mode the
current can therefore be measured in phase reversal to the voltage.
Parameter Address
Fault data FT_DA: Line le ng th PS x 010 005 010 006 010 007 010 008
acquisition
10.00 0.01 500.00 km Fig. 3-119, (p. 3-162)
[spacer]
This setting defines the distance in km that the fault locator interprets as 100 %
when calculating the fault distance.
[spacer] FT_DA: Line reactance P S x 010 012 010 013 010 014 010 015
[spacer]
This setting defines the reactance X that the fault locator interprets as 100 %
when calculating the fault distance.
[spacer] FT_DA: S tart data acqu. PS x 010 011 010 042 010 043 010 044
[spacer]
This setting determines at what point during a fault the acquisition of fault data
should take place.
[spacer] FT_DA: Outp . f lt.locat . P Sx 010 032 010 033 010 034 010 035
[spacer]
Setting for the conditions under which a fault location is output.
[spacer] FT_DA: Abs . value kG PS x 012 037 012 087 013 037 013 087
[spacer] FT_DA: Angle k G PSx 012 036 012 086 013 036 013 086
[spacer]
Setting for the absolute value and angle of the complex ground factor k̲G.
Z̲0 - Z̲pos
k̲G =
3 ⋅ Z̲pos
Parameter Address
Definite-time over‐ DTOC: Enable PSx 072 098 073 098 074 098 075 098
current protection
0: No Fig. 3-123, (p. 3-168)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which definite-time overcurrent
protection is enabled.
[spacer] DTOC: St art w. D ire ct . PS x 016 105 016 106 016 107 016 108
0: No
[spacer]
If this parameter is set to Yes, then starting of P139 will issue only if measured
direction is equal to set direction. Otherwise the P139 will not perform a
"starting" when a fault occurs.
[spacer] DTOC: Mod e t ime r st art P Sx 002 138 002 139 002 142 002 143
1: With starting
[spacer]
This parameter permits the selection whether the timer stages for phase or
residual current stages are triggered with the start (With starting) or are
direction-dependent (With direction).
[spacer] DTOC: Me as .value I/ IN> PS x 060 002 060 003 060 004 060 005
[spacer] DTOC: Me as .val. I/ IN>> P Sx 060 006 060 007 060 008 060 009
[spacer] DTOC: Me as .val.I/ IN>>> P Sx 060 010 060 011 060 012 060 013
[spacer] DTOC: Me as .v.I/ IN>>>> P Sx 060 014 060 015 060 016 060 017
[spacer]
These settings allow to select for the respective overcurrent stage whether the
starting decision shall be based on the fundamental or on the r.m.s. value.
Remark: For the negative-sequence stages, the starting decision is always based
on the fundamental.
[spacer] DTOC: I0 Elimin . I> PS x 013 150 013 151 013 152 013 153
[spacer] DTOC: I0 Elimin . I>> PS x 013 154 013 155 013 156 013 157
[spacer] DTOC: I0 Elimin . I>>> PS x 013 158 013 159 013 160 013 161
Parameter Address
[spacer] DTOC: I0 Elimin. I>>>> PS x 013 162 013 163 013 164 013 165
[spacer]
Depending on this setting the respective phase overcurrent stage uses either
the measured phase current or a value where the residual current has been
eliminated.
● Setting without: The respective phase current is used.
● Setting with I0 calculated: The respective phase current Ix is shifted by one
third of the calculated residual current (derived from the sum of the phase
currents), i. e. instead of I̲x the value (I̲x - ⅓⋅∑ I̲ P) is used.
● Setting with I0 measured: The respective phase current Ix is shifted by one
third of the residual current measured at the fourth transformer, i. e.
instead of I̲x the value (I̲x - ⅓⋅I̲ N) is used.
[spacer] DTOC: I> PS x 017 000 073 007 074 007 075 007
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the first overcurrent stage (phase current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: I> d ynam ic P S x 017 080 073 032 074 032 075 032
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the first overcurrent stage in dynamic mode
(phase current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: I>> PS x 017 001 073 008 074 008 075 008
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second overcurrent stage (phase current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: I>> d ynamic P Sx 017 084 073 033 074 033 075 033
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second overcurrent stage in dynamic mode
(phase current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
Parameter Address
[spacer] DTOC: I>>> PS x 017 002 073 009 074 009 075 009
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the third overcurrent stage (phase current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: I>>> d ynamic P Sx 017 085 073 034 074 034 075 034
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the third overcurrent stage in dynamic mode
(phase current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: I>>>> PSx 016 149 016 150 016 151 016 152
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the fourth overcurrent stage (phase current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: I>>>> d ynami c P Sx 016 153 016 154 016 155 016 156
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the fourth overcurrent stage in dynamic mode
(phase current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: tI> PSx 017 004 073 019 074 019 075 019
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the first overcurrent stage.
[spacer] DTOC: tI>> PSx 017 006 073 020 074 020 075 020
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the second overcurrent stage.
[spacer] DTOC: tI>>> PSx 017 007 073 021 074 021 075 021
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the third overcurrent stage.
[spacer] DTOC: tI>>>> PSx 016 157 016 158 016 159 016 160
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the fourth overcurrent stage.
Parameter Address
[spacer] DTOC: V< (I>) PS x 011 244 011 245 011 246 011 247
[spacer] DTOC: V< (I>>) PS x 011 248 011 249 011 250 011 251
[spacer] DTOC: V< (I>>>) PS x 011 252 011 253 011 254 011 255
[spacer] DTOC: tS D PSx 012 206 012 207 012 208 012 209
[spacer]
Setting a voltage threshold for the respective phase current stage. This criterion
means that in addition to a phase current exceeding its threshold also the
voltage in an appropriate measuring loop must fall below the threshold that is
set here. For the phase-ground measuring loops, an overcurrent starting is only
enabled when the voltage falls below this threshold for at least the time duration
that set at DTOC: t SD PSx.
Setting the threshold to Blocked deactivates this type of voltage check (for the
respective overcurrent stage).
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg> PS x 072 011 073 011 074 011 075 011
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg>> PS x 072 012 073 012 074 012 075 012
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg>>> PSx 072 013 073 013 074 013 075 013
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg>>>> PSx 016 161 016 162 016 163 016 164
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the overcurrent stage of the negative-sequence
system.
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg> dynamic PS x 076 200 077 200 078 200 079 200
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Ineg> dynamic. (Ineg = negative-sequence current)
This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld time
dyn.par.PSx is elapsing.
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg>> dynamic PS x 076 201 077 201 078 201 079 201
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Ineg>> dynamic. (Ineg = negative-sequence current)
This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld time
dyn.par.PSx is elapsing.
Parameter Address
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg>>> dy namic P Sx 076 202 077 202 078 202 079 202
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Ineg>>> dynamic. (Ineg = negative-sequence current)
This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld time
dyn.par.PSx is elapsing.
[spacer] DTOC: Ineg>>>> dy namic PS x 016 165 016 166 016 167 016 168
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Ineg>>>> dynamic. (Ineg = negative-sequence
current)
This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld time
dyn.par.PSx is elapsing.
[spacer] DTOC: tIneg > PSx 072 023 073 023 074 023 075 023
[spacer] DTOC: tIneg >> P Sx 072 024 073 024 074 024 075 024
[spacer] DTOC: tIneg >>> P Sx 072 025 073 025 074 025 075 025
[spacer] DTOC: tIneg >>>> P Sx 016 169 016 170 016 171 016 172
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the overcurrent stage of the negative-sequence
system.
[spacer] DTOC: Eval. IN> P Sx 072 128 073 128 074 128 075 128
[spacer] DTOC: Eval. IN>> P Sx 007 239 007 240 007 241 007 242
[spacer] DTOC: Eval. IN>>> P Sx 007 243 007 244 007 245 007 246
[spacer]
This setting determines which current will be monitored:
● Setting Calculated: The current calculated by the P139 is used.
● Setting Measured: The residual current measured at the T 4 current
transformer is used.
● Setting Calc with I0 elim.: The calculated current shifted by one third of the
residual current (∑ I̲ P - ⅓⋅I̲ N) is used.
Note: Stage IN>>>> always uses the calculated current.
Parameter Address
[spacer] DTOC: IN> PS x 017 003 073 015 074 015 075 015
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the first overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: IN> d ynamic P Sx 017 081 073 035 074 035 075 035
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the dynamic first overcurrent stage (residual
current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see Chapter “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: IN>> PS x 017 009 073 016 074 016 075 016
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: IN>> d ynamic P Sx 017 086 073 036 074 036 075 036
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second overcurrent stage in dynamic mode
(residual current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see Chapter “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: IN>>> PS x 017 018 073 017 074 017 075 017
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the third overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: IN>>> d ynami c P Sx 017 087 073 037 074 037 075 037
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the dynamic third overcurrent stage (residual
current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer
stage MAIN: Hld t ime dyn. par.P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see “Technical Data”).
Parameter Address
[spacer] DTOC: IN>>>> PS x 072 018 073 018 074 018 075 018
[spacer]
Setting the operate value of the fourth overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see Chapter “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: IN>>>> dyn. PS x 072 036 072 105 072 202 072 219
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the dynamic fourth overcurrent stage (residual
current stage). This operate value is effective only while the timer stage
MAIN: Hld time dyn.par .P Sx is elapsing.
Caution! The range of setting values includes operate values that are not
permitted as continuous current values (see Chapter “Technical Data”).
[spacer] DTOC: tIN> PSx 017 008 073 027 074 027 075 027
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the first overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
[spacer] DTOC: tIN>> PSx 017 010 073 028 074 028 075 028
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the second overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
[spacer] DTOC: tIN>>> PSx 017 019 073 029 074 029 075 029
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the third overcurrent stage (residual current
stage).
[spacer] DTOC: tIN>>>> PSx 072 030 073 030 074 030 075 030
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overcurrent stage IN>>>>.
[spacer] DTOC: Puls.prol.IN>,int PSx 017 055 073 042 074 042 075 042
[spacer]
Setting for the pulse prolongation time of the hold-time logic for intermittent
ground faults.
[spacer] DTOC: tIN>,inte rm. P Sx 017 056 073 038 074 038 075 038
[spacer]
Setting for the tripping time of the hold-time logic for intermittent ground faults.
[spacer] DTOC: Hold- t. tIN>,int mPSx 017 057 073 039 074 039 075 039
[spacer]
Setting for the hold-time for intermittent ground faults.
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: No Fig. 3-140, (p. 3-189)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which IDMT protection is enabled.
[spacer] IDMT1: Mode tim e r st art P Sx 007 226 007 227 007 228 007 229
1: With starting
[spacer]
This parameter permits the selection whether the timer stages for phase or
residual current stages are triggered with the start (With starting) or are
direction-dependent (With direction).
[spacer] IDMT1: Me as .value I/ IN PS x 060 018 060 019 060 020 060 021
[spacer] IDMT2: Me as .value I/ IN PS x 060 022 060 023 060 024 060 025
[spacer]
These settings allow to select for the respective overcurrent stage whether the
starting decision shall be based on the fundamental or on the r.m.s. value.
Remark: For the negative-sequence stage of each IDMTx, the starting decision is
always based on the fundamental.
[spacer] IDMT1: I0 Elimin. I> P Sx 013 166 013 167 013 168 013 169
[spacer] IDMT2: I0 Elimin. I> P Sx 013 170 013 171 013 172 013 173
[spacer]
Depending on this setting the respective phase overcurrent stage uses either
the measured phase current or a value where the residual current has been
eliminated.
● Setting without: The respective phase current is used.
● Setting with I0 calculated: The respective phase current Ix is shifted by one
third of the calculated residual current (derived from the sum of the phase
currents), i. e. instead of I̲x the value (I̲x - ⅓⋅∑ I̲ P) is used.
● Setting with I0 measured: The respective phase current Ix is shifted by one
third of the residual current measured at the fourth transformer, i. e.
instead of I̲x the value (I̲x - ⅓⋅I̲ N) is used.
[spacer] IDMT1: Time Cor re ct ion PSx 013 143 013 144 013 145 013 146
[spacer]
Parameter to compensate the IDMT starting time. Negative values reduce the
IDMT starting time by the set value. Positive values extend the IDMT starting
time by the set value.
Parameter Address
[spacer] IDMT1: Ire f,P PS x 072 050 073 050 074 050 075 050
[spacer] IDMT2: Ire f,P PS x 076 236 076 237 076 238 076 239
[spacer]
Setting for the reference current (phase current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Ire f,P dynamic PSx 072 003 073 003 074 003 075 003
[spacer] IDMT2: Ire f,P dynamic PSx 076 030 076 031 076 032 076 033
[spacer]
Setting for the reference current in dynamic mode (phase current system).
This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld time
dyn.par.PSx is elapsing.
[spacer] IDMT1: Factor KI,P PSx 007 250 007 251 007 252 007 253
[spacer]
Enable threshold for the IDMT1 protection starting for all IP types of
characteristics. This factor KI will result in a linear shifting of the enable
threshold along the X axis of the respective characteristic. The factor will not
result in a shifting of the characteristic itself.
[spacer] IDMT1: Characte risti c P PS x 072 056 073 056 074 056 075 056
[spacer] IDMT2: Characte risti c P PS x 071 004 071 005 071 006 071 007
[spacer]
Setting for the tripping characteristic (phase current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Factor k t,P PS x 072 053 073 053 074 053 075 053
[spacer] IDMT2: Factor k t,P PS x 078 250 078 251 078 252 078 253
[spacer]
Setting for the factor kt,P of the starting characteristic (phase current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Min. trip t ime P PSx 072 077 073 077 074 077 075 077
[spacer] IDMT2: Min. trip t ime P PSx 071 044 071 045 071 046 071 047
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum trip time (phase current system). As a rule, this value
should be set as for the first DTOC stage (I>).
[spacer] IDMT1: Hold time P PS x 072 071 073 071 074 071 075 071
Parameter Address
[spacer] IDMT2: Hold tim e P PS x 071 028 071 029 071 030 071 031
[spacer]
Setting for the holding time for intermittent short circuits (phase current
system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Releas e P PSx 072 059 073 059 074 059 075 059
[spacer] IDMT2: Releas e P PSx 071 016 071 017 071 018 071 019
[spacer]
Setting for the release or reset characteristic (phase current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Ire f,neg PSx 072 051 073 051 074 051 075 051
[spacer] IDMT2: Ire f,neg PSx 076 250 076 251 076 252 076 253
[spacer]
Setting for the reference current (negative-sequence current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Ire f,neg dynamic PS x 072 004 073 004 074 004 075 004
[spacer] IDMT2: Ire f,neg dynamic PS x 076 034 076 035 076 036 076 037
[spacer]
Setting for the reference current in dynamic mode (negative-sequence current
system). This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld
time d yn.par.PSx is elapsing.
[spacer] IDMT1: Factor KI ,ne g PS x 007 254 007 255 008 002 008 005
[spacer]
Enable threshold for the IDMT1 protection starting for all Ineg types of
characteristics. This factor KI will result in a linear shifting of the enable
threshold along the X axis of the respective characteristic. The factor will not
result in a shifting of the characteristic itself.
[spacer] IDMT1: Character. ne g. P Sx 072 057 073 057 074 057 075 057
[spacer] IDMT2: Character. ne g. P Sx 071 008 071 009 071 010 071 011
0: Definite Time
[spacer]
Setting for the tripping characteristic (negative-sequence current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Factor k t,neg P Sx 072 054 073 054 074 054 075 054
[spacer] IDMT2: Factor k t,neg P Sx 079 250 079 251 079 252 079 253
[spacer]
Setting for the factor kt,neg of the starting characteristic (negative-sequence
current system).
Parameter Address
[spacer] IDMT1: Min.trip t ime ne gPSx 072 078 073 078 074 078 075 078
[spacer] IDMT2: Min.trip t ime ne gPSx 071 048 071 049 071 050 071 051
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum trip time (negative-sequence current system).
As a rule, this value should be set as for the first DTOC stage (I>).
[spacer] IDMT1: Hold time neg P Sx 072 072 073 072 074 072 075 072
[spacer] IDMT2: Hold time neg P Sx 071 032 071 033 071 034 071 035
[spacer]
Setting the holding time for intermittent short circuits (negative-sequence
current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Releas e neg. PSx 072 060 073 060 074 060 075 060
[spacer] IDMT2: Releas e neg. PSx 071 020 071 021 071 022 071 023
1: Without delay
[spacer]
Setting for the release or reset characteristic (negative-sequence current
system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Evaluat ion IN PS x 072 075 073 075 074 075 075 075
2: Measured
[spacer] IDMT2: Evaluat ion IN PS x 071 040 071 041 071 042 071 043
2: Measured
[spacer]
This setting determines which current will be monitored:
● Setting Calculated: The current calculated by the P139 is used.
● Setting Measured: The residual current measured at the T 4 current
transformer is used.
● Setting Calc with I0 elim.: The calculated current shifted by one third of the
residual current (∑I̲P - ⅓I̲N) is used.
[spacer] IDMT1: Ire f,N PSx 072 052 073 052 074 052 075 052
[spacer] IDMT2: Ire f,N PSx 077 250 077 251 077 252 077 253
[spacer]
Setting for the reference current (residual current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Ire f,N dynamic P Sx 072 005 073 005 074 005 075 005
Parameter Address
[spacer] IDMT2: Ire f,N dynamic P Sx 076 038 076 039 076 040 076 041
[spacer]
Setting the reference current in dynamic mode (residual current system).
This operate value is effective only while the timer stage MAIN: Hld time
dyn.par.PSx is elapsing.
[spacer] IDMT1: Factor KI ,N P Sx 001 173 001 174 001 175 001 176
[spacer]
The enable threshold for the IDMT1 protection starting for all IN types of
characteristics. This factor KI will result in a linear shifting of the enable
threshold along the X axis of the respective characteristic. The factor will not
result in a shifting of the characteristic itself.
[spacer] IDMT1: Characteristi c N PSx 072 058 073 058 074 058 075 058
[spacer] IDMT2: Characteristi c N PSx 071 012 071 013 071 014 071 015
[spacer]
Setting for the tripping characteristic (residual current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Factor k t,N P Sx 072 055 073 055 074 055 075 055
[spacer] IDMT2: Factor k t,N P Sx 071 000 071 001 071 002 071 003
[spacer]
Setting for the factor kt,N of the starting characteristic (residual current system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Min. trip t ime N P Sx 072 079 073 079 074 079 075 079
[spacer] IDMT2: Min. trip t ime N P Sx 071 052 071 053 071 054 071 055
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum trip time (residual current system). As a rule, this value
should be set as for the first DTOC stage (IN>).
[spacer] IDMT1: Hold tim e N P Sx 072 073 073 073 074 073 075 073
[spacer] IDMT2: Hold tim e N P Sx 071 036 071 037 071 038 071 039
[spacer]
Setting for the holding time for intermittent short circuits (residual current
system).
[spacer] IDMT1: Releas e N PSx 072 061 073 061 074 061 075 061
[spacer] IDMT2: Releas e N PSx 071 024 071 025 071 026 071 027
[spacer]
Setting for for the reset characteristic (residual current system).
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: No
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which IDMTx protection is enabled.
Parameter Address
Short-circuit SCDD: Enable PSx 076 235 077 235 078 235 079 235
direction
determination
0: No Fig. 3-158, (p. 3-210)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which short-circuit direction
determination is enabled.
[spacer] SCDD: Tr ip b ias PSx 017 074 077 236 078 236 079 236
[spacer]
This setting determines whether an overcurrent direction determination in
forward direction shall be formed when the direction determination of the phase
current and residual current stage is blocked.
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tI> PSx 017 071 077 237 078 237 079 237
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tI>> PSx 017 072 077 238 078 238 079 238
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tI>>> PSx 007 230 007 231 007 232 007 233
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tI>>>> PSx 016 177 016 178 016 179 016 180
[spacer]
This setting for the measuring direction determines whether a trip signal in the
DTOC phase current stage will be issued for forward, backward or non-
directional fault decisions. If the ARC is enabled and has been set accordingly
then a starting will trigger the associated ARC tripping time.
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ct. tI r ef,P> P Sx 017 066 077 239 078 239 079 239
[spacer]
This setting for the measuring direction determines whether a tIref,P> trip signal
in the IDMT1 phase current stage will be issued for forward, backward or non-
directional fault decisions. If the ARC is enabled and has been set accordingly
then a starting will trigger the associated ARC tripping time.
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tIN> PSx 017 073 077 240 078 240 079 240
[spacer]
This setting for the measuring direction determines whether a tIN> trip signal in
the DTOC residual current stage will be issued for forward, backward or non-
directional fault decisions. If the ARC is enabled and has been set accordingly
then a starting will trigger the associated ARC tripping time.
Parameter Address
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tIN>> PSx 017 075 077 241 078 241 079 241
[spacer]
This setting for the measuring direction determines whether a tIN>> trip signal
in the DTOC residual current stage will be issued for forward, backward or non-
directional fault decisions. If the ARC is enabled and has been set accordingly
then a starting will trigger the associated ARC tripping time.
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ction tIN>>> PSx 007 235 007 236 007 237 007 238
[spacer]
This setting for the measuring direction determines whether a tIN>>> trip
signal in the DTOC residual current stage will be issued for forward, backward
(reverse) or non-directional fault decisions. If the ARC is enabled and has been
set accordingly then a starting will trigger the associated ARC tripping time.
[spacer] SCDD: Dire ct. tIr ef,N> PS x 017 067 077 242 078 242 079 242
[spacer]
This setting for the measuring direction determines whether a tIref,N> trip
signal in the IDMT1 residual current stage will be issued for forward, backward or
non-directional fault decisions. If the ARC is enabled and has been set
accordingly then a starting will trigger the associated ARC tripping time.
[spacer] SCDD: Charact. angle G P Sx 017 076 077 243 078 243 079 243
[spacer]
Setting for the characteristic angle of the residual current stage in
correspondence to the measuring relation. Using this setting, a wide range of
conditions can be accommodated, depending on the system's neutral grounding
impedance.
Examples:
● System neutral with relatively high resistance αG = 0°
● System neutral with relatively low resistance αG = −45°
● System neutral effectively grounded αG = −75°
● System neutral reactance-grounded αG = −90°
● System with isolated neutral αG = +90°
[spacer] SCDD: Evaluation I N PS x 008 105 008 106 008 107 008 108
1: Calculated
[spacer]
This parameter is used to select whether the measured or the calculated
residual current value is to be used for the SCDD residual current stages.
[spacer] SCDD: VNG> PSx 017 077 077 244 078 244 079 244
[spacer]
Setting the operate value VNG>. This setting value is an enabling criterion of the
base point release of short-circuit direction determination.
In choosing this setting, the set nominal voltage M AI N: VNG,nom V.T.
sec. should be taken into account.
Parameter Address
[spacer] SCDD: Evaluation VNG PS x 071 056 071 057 071 058 071 059
[spacer]
User may select between Measured and Calculated (standard default).
[spacer] SCDD: Oper .val.Vmemory P Sx 010 109 010 116 010 117 010 118
[spacer]
In the event of a three-phase fault in the phase current stage, the measured
voltage VABmeas is compared with the selected operate value, Vop.Val., of the
voltage memory. If VABmeas < Vop.Val. then the SCDD function will not use
VABmeas but will revert to the voltage memory, if it has been enabled.
[spacer] SCDD: B lock. bias G PS x 017 078 077 245 078 245 079 245
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the trip bias of the residual current stage should be
blocked in the event of a phase current starting.
Parameter Address
Protective signaling PSIG: Enab le PS x 015 014 015 015 015 016 015 017
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which protective signaling is
enabled.
[spacer] PSIG: Tripping t ime PS x 015 011 024 003 024 063 025 023
[spacer]
Setting for the time delay of protective signaling.
With blocking schemes this time must be set to the channel transmission delay
+30 ms.
[spacer] PSIG: Re lease t. se nd PSx 015 002 024 001 024 061 025 021
[spacer]
This setting determines the duration of the send signal.
[spacer] PSIG: DC loop op. mode PSx 015 012 024 051 025 011 025 071
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the transmitting relay will be operated in energize-
on-signal mode (“open-circuit principle”) or normally-energized mode (“closed-
circuit principle”), i.e., Transm.rel.make con. or Transm.rel.break
con,respectively.
[spacer] PSIG: Direc.de pe nde nce P Sx 015 001 015 115 015 116 015 117
[spacer]
Setting for the directional dependence evaluation of protective signaling. The
following settings are possible:
● Without
● Phase curr. system
● Residual curr.system
● Phase/resid.c.system
Parameter Address
Auto-reclosing ARC: Enable PS x 015 046 015 047 015 048 015 049
control
0: No Fig. 3-176, (p. 3-234)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which ARC is enabled.
[spacer] ARC: C B clos.pos .s ig. PS x 015 050 024 024 024 084 025 044
[spacer]
This setting defines whether the CB closed position will be taken into account or
not. If the setting is With, a binary signal input must be configured accordingly.
Then the ARC function is ready only if the CB is closed.
[spacer] ARC: Op erating mode P Sx 015 051 024 025 024 085 025 045
[spacer]
The operating mode setting defines which of the following reclosure types is
permitted.
● TDR only.
● HSR or TDR.
● Test HSR only.
[spacer] ARC: Op erative time PS x 015 066 024 035 024 095 025 055
[spacer]
Setting for operative time 1.
If the fault is cleared within this time, the fixed dead time 1p or 3p (depending
on the trip condition and HSR operating mode) is started.
[spacer] ARC: HSR t rip.time GS PS x 015 038 024 100 024 150 025 100
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a general starting condition.
[spacer] ARC: HSR t rip.time I> P Sx 015 072 024 040 025 000 025 060
[spacer]
The HSR tripping time replaces timer stage t1,ze of distance protection or the
operate delay of backup overcurrent-time protection – provided that the BUOC
operating mode is set accordingly – if a HSR is permitted and protective
signaling is not ready.
[spacer] ARC: HSR t rip.time I>>P Sx 015 074 024 101 024 151 025 101
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a phase current starting in the
second DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: HSR trip.t ime I>>>PSx 014 096 024 102 024 152 025 102
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a phase current starting in the
third DTOC overcurrent stage.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ARC: HSR tr.tim e I>>>> PSx 016 181 016 182 016 183 016 184
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a phase current starting in the
fourth DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: HSR t rip.time IN>P Sx 015 076 024 103 024 153 025 103
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a residual current starting in the
first DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: HSR trip.t ime IN>>PSx 015 031 024 104 024 154 025 104
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a residual current starting in the
second DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: HSR trip.t . IN>>> PS x 014 098 024 105 024 155 025 105
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a residual current starting in the
third DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: HSR trip.t .Ire f,P PS x 015 094 024 106 024 156 025 106
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a starting in the IDMT1 phase
current system.
[spacer] ARC: HSR trip.t .Ire f,N PSx 015 096 024 107 024 157 025 107
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a starting in the IDMT1 residual
current system.
[spacer] ARC: HSR tr.t.Iref ,ne g PS x 015 034 024 108 024 158 025 108
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via a starting in the IDMT1 negative-
sequence current system.
[spacer] ARC: HSR t rip t.GF DS S PS x 015 078 024 109 024 159 025 109
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via ‘ground fault direction
determination using steady-state values'.
[spacer] ARC: HSR t rip t. adm. P Sx 021 059 021 066 021 067 021 068
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via ‘ground fault direction
determination using steady-state values' of steady-state admittance evaluation.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ARC: HSR trip.t . LOG IC P Sx 015 098 024 110 024 160 025 110
[spacer]
Setting for the HSR tripping time and start via programmable logic.
[spacer] ARC: HSR b lock.f . I>>>P Sx 015 080 024 111 024 161 025 111
[spacer]
The selection of the HSR blocking by I>>> defines whether an HSR is blocked
during an I>>> starting.
[spacer] ARC: HSR d ead time P Sx 015 056 024 030 024 090 025 050
[spacer]
Dead time setting for a three-pole HSR.
[spacer] ARC: No. permit . T DR PS x 015 068 024 037 024 097 025 057
[spacer]
Setting for the number of time-delayed reclosures permitted. With the 0 setting,
only one HSR is carried out.
[spacer] ARC: T DR t rip.time G S P Sx 015 039 024 112 024 162 025 112
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a general starting condition.
[spacer] ARC: T DR t rip.time I> PS x 015 073 024 041 025 001 025 061
[spacer]
The TDR tripping time replaces timer stage t1,ze of distance protection or the
operate delay of backup overcurrent-time protection – provided that the BUOC
operating mode is set accordingly – if a TDR is permitted and protective
signaling is not ready.
[spacer] ARC: T DR t rip.time I>>PSx 015 075 024 113 024 163 025 113
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a phase current starting in the
second DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: T DR trip.t ime I>>>P Sx 014 097 024 114 024 164 025 114
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a phase current starting in the
third DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: T DR tr.tim e I>>>> P Sx 016 189 016 186 016 187 016 188
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a phase current starting in the
fourth DTOC overcurrent stage.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ARC: T DR t rip.time IN>PSx 015 077 024 115 024 165 025 115
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a residual current starting in the
first DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: T DR trip.t ime IN>>P Sx 015 032 024 116 024 166 025 116
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a residual current starting in the
second DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: T DR trip.t . IN>>> P Sx 014 099 024 117 024 167 025 117
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a residual current starting in the
third DTOC overcurrent stage.
[spacer] ARC: T DR trip.t .Iref,P P Sx 015 095 024 118 024 168 025 118
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a starting in the IDMT1 phase
current system.
[spacer] ARC: T DR trip.t .Iref,N P Sx 015 097 024 119 024 169 025 119
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a starting in the IDMT1 residual
current system.
[spacer] ARC: T DR tr.t.Ire f,ne g PS x 015 035 024 120 024 170 025 120
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via a starting in the IDMT1 negative-
sequence current system.
[spacer] ARC: T DR t rip t.G FDSS PS x 015 079 024 121 024 171 025 121
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via ‘ground fault direction
determination using steady-state values'.
[spacer] ARC: T DR t rip t. adm. PSx 021 069 021 070 021 071 021 072
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via ‘ground fault direction
determination using steady-state values' of steady-state admittance evaluation.
[spacer] ARC: T DR trip.t . LOGIC PS x 015 099 024 122 024 172 025 122
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR tripping time and start via programmable logic.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ARC: T DR b lock.f. I> >>PSx 015 081 024 124 024 174 025 124
[spacer]
The selection of the TDR blocking by I>>> defines whether an TDR is blocked
during an I>>> starting.
[spacer] ARC: T DR d ead time PSx 015 057 024 031 024 091 025 051
[spacer]
Setting for the TDR dead time.
[spacer] ARC: R eclaim time PS x 015 054 024 028 024 088 025 048
[spacer]
Setting for the reclaim time.
[spacer] ARC: Blocking t ime P S x 015 058 024 032 024 092 025 052
[spacer]
Setting for the time that will elapse before the ARC will be ready again after
blocking by a binary signal input.
Parameter Address
Automatic ASC: Enab le PS x 018 020 018 021 018 022 018 023
synchronism check
0: No Fig. 3-195, (p. 3-259)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which automatic synchronism check
(ASC) is enabled.
[spacer] ASC: CB ass ignment PS x 037 131 037 132 037 133 037 134
[spacer]
This setting defines the function group DEVxx that will control the circuit
breaker.
[spacer] ASC: Sys te m int e grat . PS x 037 135 037 136 037 137 037 138
[spacer]
This setting defines whether ASC will operate in “Autom. synchron. check” or
“Autom. synchr. control” mode.
[spacer] ASC: Active for HSR PS x 018 001 077 030 078 030 079 030
[spacer]
This setting defines whether reclosing after a three-pole HSR will occur only
after being enabled by ASC.
[spacer] ASC: Active for TDR PS x 018 002 077 031 078 031 079 031
[spacer]
This setting defines whether reclosing after a three-pole TDR will occur only
after being enabled by ASC.
[spacer] ASC: Clos .rej.w.block PS x 018 003 077 032 078 032 079 032
[spacer]
This setting defines whether reclosing is rejected after being blocked by ASC.
[spacer] ASC: Me as.V(T90 ) USE R PS x 016 222 016 223 016 224 016 225
0: No
[spacer]
This setting decides which voltage(s) the ASC function shall use for the
operating modes “voltage-checked close enable” and “voltage/synchronism-
checked close enable”:
● If set to No then the three phase-to-ground voltages are checked.
● If set to Yes then the (single-phase) voltage measured at transformer T90
is checked. (Note that it is left to system engineering that the proper
voltage – matching the setting ASC: Me asure ment loop PSx – is
connected to the T90 input.)
[spacer] ASC: Op erative t ime PS x 018 010 077 034 078 034 079 034
[spacer]
Setting for the operative time for ASC.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ASC: Me asur e ment loop P Sx 031 060 077 044 078 044 079 044
[spacer]
The voltage measurement loop, corresponding to the reference voltage, must be
selected so that determination of differential values is correct.
Example: Connect transformer T 15 to measure the reference voltage to
phases A & B. The measurement loop should be set to Loop A-B.
[spacer] ASC: Phi off set PS x 018 034 077 042 078 042 079 042
[spacer]
Setting for a Phi offset that may be necessary so that determination of the
differential angle is correct.
[spacer] ASC: AR op. m ode P Sx 018 025 018 026 018 027 018 028
1: Voltage-checked
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Criteria for a close enable are defined by setting for the
operating mode.
[spacer] ASC: AR with tCB PSx 000 038 000 039 000 050 000 051
0: No
[spacer]
Function ASC provides a choice as to whether the CB operating time (tCB), as
configured at M AI N: tCB ,clos e is to be taken into account for the precisely
synchronized reclosure (AR) or not.
[spacer] ASC: AR Op.m ode v- chk .P Sx 018 029 018 030 018 031 018 032
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: This setting defines the logic linking of trigger decisions
for a voltage controlled close enable.
[spacer] ASC: AR V> volt.che ck PS x 026 017 077 043 078 043 079 043
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting the voltage threshold that the phase-to-ground
voltages and the reference voltage must exceed so that they are recognized as
“Voltage present”.
Note: The logic linking of trigger decisions is defined by setting ASC: AR
Op.mode v-chk.PS x.
[spacer] ASC: AR V< volt.che ck PS x 018 017 077 040 078 040 079 040
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting the voltage threshold that the phase-to-ground
voltages and the reference voltage must fall below so that they are recognized
as “No voltage”.
Note: The logic linking of trigger decisions is defined by setting ASC: AR
Op.mode v-chk.PS x.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ASC: AR tmin v- check PS x 018 018 077 041 078 041 079 041
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting for the operate delay value to define the
minimum time period during which voltage conditions must be met so that the
close enable of the ASC is effected.
[spacer] ASC: AR V> s ync.che ck PS x 018 011 077 035 078 035 079 035
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting for the threshold of the minimum voltage to
obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: AR Delt a Vmax PSx 018 012 077 036 078 036 079 036
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting the maximum differential voltage between
measured and reference voltages to obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: AR Delt a f max PS x 018 014 077 038 078 038 079 038
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting the maximum differential frequency between
measured and reference voltages to obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: AR Delt a phi max PS x 018 013 077 037 078 037 079 037
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting the maximum differential angle between
measured and reference voltages to obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: AR tmin sy nc.chk PS x 018 015 077 039 078 039 079 039
[spacer]
Auto-reclosing control: Setting for the operate delay value to define the
minimum time period during which synchronism conditions must be met so that
the close enable of the ASC is effected.
[spacer] ASC: MC op. mode P Sx 000 056 000 057 000 058 000 059
1: Voltage-checked
[spacer]
Manual close command: Criteria for a close enable are defined by setting for the
operating mode.
[spacer] ASC: MC wit h tCB P Sx 000 102 000 103 000 104 000 105
0: No
[spacer]
Manual close command: In slightly asynchronous power systems, setting this
parameter to Yes ensures that the circuit breaker closing time is taken into
account by the automatic synchronism check (ASC) to issue of a close
command.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ASC: MC op.mode v- chk. PSx 000 060 000 061 000 062 000 063
[spacer]
Manual close command: This setting defines the logic linking of trigger decisions
for a voltage controlled close enable.
[spacer] ASC: MC V> volt .che ck PSx 000 064 000 065 000 066 000 067
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting the voltage threshold that the phase-to-ground
voltages and the reference voltage must exceed so that they are recognized as
“Voltage present”.
Note: The logic linking of trigger decisions is defined by setting ASC: MC
op.mode v-chk .PS x.
[spacer] ASC: MC V< volt .che ck PSx 000 068 000 069 000 070 000 071
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting the voltage threshold that the phase-to-ground
voltages and the reference voltage must fall below so that they are recognized
as “No voltage”.
Note: The logic linking of trigger decisions is defined by setting ASC: MC
op.mode v-chk .PS x.
[spacer] ASC: MC tm in v-che ck P Sx 000 072 000 073 000 074 000 075
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting for the operate delay value to define the
minimum time period during which voltage conditions must be met so that the
close enable of the ASC is effected.
[spacer] ASC: MC V> sync.che ck P Sx 000 052 000 053 000 054 000 055
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting for the threshold of the minimum voltage to
obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: MC De lta Vmax PS x 000 080 000 081 000 082 000 083
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting the maximum differential voltage between
measured and reference voltages to obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: MC De lta f max P S x 000 084 000 086 000 087 000 088
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting the maximum differential frequency between
measured and reference voltages to obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
[spacer] ASC: MC De lta phi max P Sx 000 089 000 091 000 092 000 093
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting the maximum differential angle between
measured and reference voltages to obtain a synchronism checked close enable.
Parameter Address
[spacer] ASC: MC tm in s ync.chk PS x 000 098 000 099 000 100 000 101
[spacer]
Manual close command: Setting for the operate delay value to define the
minimum time period during which synchronism conditions must be met so that
the close enable of the ASC is effected.
Parameter Address
Ground fault GFDSS : E nable PSx 001 050 001 051 001 052 001 053
direction
determination using
steady-state values
0: No Fig. 3-210, (p. 3-277)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which the GFDSS function is
enabled.
[spacer] GFDSS : E valuation VNG PS x 016 083 001 011 001 012 001 013
[spacer]
This setting specifies which neutral-point displacement voltage will be used for
direction determination: The displacement voltage calculated from the phase-
to-ground voltages or the displacement voltage measured at the T 90
transformer of the P139.
[spacer] GFDSS : VNG> PS x 016 062 000 233 000 234 000 235
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the neutral-point displacement voltage.
[spacer] GFDSS : tVNG> PSx 016 061 000 230 000 231 000 232
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the VNG> trigger.
[spacer] GFDSS : f /fnom (powe r) P Sx 016 091 001 044 001 045 001 046
[spacer]
Setting for the frequency of the measured variables evaluated in steady-state
power evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : O p.mode power P Sx 016 063 000 236 000 237 000 238
[spacer]
Setting for the operating mode of the ground fault direction determination by
steady-state values. The following settings are possible:
● “cos φ circuit” for resonant-grounded systems,
● “sin φ circuit” for isolated neutral-point systems.
[spacer] GFDSS : M eas . dir . powe r P Sx 016 070 001 002 001 003 001 004
[spacer]
This setting defines the measuring direction for the “forward” or “backward”
decision.
Parameter Address
[spacer] GFDSS : I N,act>/r eac> LS PS x 016 064 000 239 000 240 000 241
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold of the active or reactive power component of residual
current that must be exceeded so that the “LS” (line side) directional decision is
enabled.
[spacer] GFDSS : S ector angle LS P Sx 016 065 000 242 000 243 000 244
[spacer]
Setting for the sector angle for measurement in the line side direction.
Note: This setting is only effective in the “cos φ circuit” operating mode.
[spacer] GFDSS : O p. delay LS pow P S x 016 066 000 245 000 246 000 247
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the direction decision in the forward direction.
[spacer] GFDSS : R e l de lay LS pow PSx 016 072 001 005 001 006 001 007
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of the direction decision in the forward
direction.
[spacer] GFDSS : I N,act>/r eac> BS PS x 016 067 000 251 000 252 000 253
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold of the active or reactive power component of residual
current that must be exceeded so that the “BS” (busbar side) directional
decision is enabled.
[spacer] GFDSS : S ector angle BS P Sx 016 068 000 248 000 249 000 250
[spacer]
Setting for the sector angle for measurement in the direction of the busbar side.
Note: This setting is only effective in the “cos φ circuit” operating mode.
[spacer] GFDSS : O p. delay BS pow P S x 016 069 000 254 000 255 001 001
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the direction decision in the backward (reverse)
direction.
[spacer] GFDSS : R e l de lay BS pow PSx 016 073 001 008 001 009 001 010
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of the direction decision in the
backward direction.
[spacer] GFDSS : Hold time pow. PS x 020 172 020 173 020 174 020 175
[spacer]
Setting for the hold time of steady-state power operating evaluation.
Parameter Address
[spacer] GFDSS : O pe r. m ode admit PS x 020 176 020 177 020 178 020 179
[spacer]
Setting for the operating mode of the steady-state admittance evaluation. The
following settings are possible:
● “cos φ circuit” for resonant-grounded systems,
● “sin φ circuit” for isolated neutral-point systems.
[spacer] GFDSS : M eas . dir . admit PS x 020 180 020 181 020 182 020 183
[spacer]
This setting defines the measuring direction for the “forward” or “backward”
decision of steady-state admittance evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : G(N)> / B( N)> LS P S x 016 111 001 029 001 030 001 031
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold of the active or reactive susceptance component of
residual current that must be exceeded so that the “LS” (line side) directional
decision is enabled.
[spacer] GFDSS : O p. delay LS adm P Sx 020 184 020 185 020 186 020 187
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the direction decision in the forward direction of
steady-state admittance evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : R e l de lay LS adm PS x 020 188 020 189 020 190 020 191
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of the direction decision in the forward
direction of steady-state admittance evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : G(N)> / B( N)> BS P S x 016 112 001 032 001 033 001 034
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold of the active or reactive susceptance component of
residual current that must be exceeded so that the “BS” (busbar side)
directional decision is enabled.
[spacer] GFDSS : O p. delay BS adm P Sx 020 192 020 193 020 194 020 195
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the direction decision in the backward (reverse)
direction of steady-state admittance evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : R e l de lay BS adm PS x 020 200 020 201 020 202 020 221
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of the direction decision in the
backward direction of steady-state admittance evaluation.
Parameter Address
[spacer] GFDSS : Y (N)> P Sx 016 113 001 035 001 036 001 037
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the admittance for non-directional ground fault
determination (in operating mode “admittance evaluation”).
[spacer] GFDSS : Cor rection angle P Sx 016 110 001 026 001 027 001 028
0 -30 30 °
[spacer]
This setting is provided to compensate for phase-angle errors of the system
transformers (in operating mode “admittance evaluation”).
[spacer] GFDSS : O pe r.de lay Y(N)> P S x 016 114 001 038 001 039 001 040
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay value of the admittance for non-directional ground
fault determination (in operating mode “admittance evaluation”).
[spacer] GFDSS : R e l. de lay Y(N) > PS x 016 115 001 041 001 042 001 043
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of the admittance for non-directional
ground fault determination (in operating mode “admittance evaluation”).
[spacer] GFDSS : Hold time adm. PSx 020 222 020 223 020 224 020 225
[spacer]
Setting for the hold time of steady-state admittance evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : f /fnom (I meas .) PS x 016 092 001 047 001 048 001 049
[spacer]
Setting for the frequency of the measured variables evaluated in steady-state
current evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : I N> PS x 016 093 001 017 001 018 001 019
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of steady-state current evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : O pe rate delay IN P Sx 016 094 001 020 001 021 001 022
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of steady-state current evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : R e le ase del ay IN P Sx 016 095 001 023 001 024 001 025
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of steady-state current evaluation.
Parameter Address
Transient ground TGFD: Enable PS x 001 054 001 055 001 056 001 057
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which the TGFD function is enabled.
[spacer] TGFD: Evaluation VNG PSx 016 048 001 058 001 059 001 060
[spacer]
This setting specifies which neutral-point displacement voltage will be used for
evaluation: The displacement voltage from the open delta winding of a voltage
transformer assembly or the displacement voltage calculated from the three
phase-to-ground voltages.
[spacer] TGFD: M e as ur e m. dir ec. PSx 016 045 001 073 001 074 001 075
[spacer]
The direction measurement of the transient ground fault direction determination
function depends on the connection of the measuring circuits. If the connection
is as shown in Chapter “Installation and Connection”, then the setting must be
Standard, if the P139's “forward” decision is to be in the direction of the
outgoing feeder. If the connection direction is reversed or – given a connection
scheme according to Chapter “Installation and Connection” – if the “forward”
decision is to be in the busbar direction, then the setting must be Opposite.
Note: The global setting M AIN: C onn. me as. circ. IN does not affect the
direction determination feature of the transient ground fault direction
determination function.
[spacer] TGFD: VNG> PS x 016 041 001 061 001 062 001 063
[spacer]
Setting for the neutral-point displacement voltage threshold.
[spacer] TGFD: I N,p> PSx 016 042 001 064 001 065 001 066
[spacer]
Setting for the residual current threshold. A peak value is evaluated.
[spacer] TGFD: Op erate de lay P Sx 016 044 001 067 001 068 001 069
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay.
[spacer] TGFD: Buffe r t ime PSx 016 043 001 070 001 071 001 072
[spacer]
Setting for the signal buffer time for transient ground fault direction
determination.
Buffer time = 0 keeps the directional decision stored as long as VNG(50Hz)
exceeds the threshold VNG>.
Buffer time = blocked keeps the directional decision stored until (manual) reset
through TGFD: R es et s ignal USE R or TGF D: Reset signal EXT.
Parameter Address
Motor protection MP: Enable PS x 024 148 024 147 024 197 025 147
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which motor protection is enabled.
[spacer] MP: I re f PSx 017 012 024 131 024 181 025 131
[spacer]
For the determination of the reference current, the nominal motor current needs
to be calculated first from the motor data.
Pnom
I nom,motor =
3 ⋅ V nom ⋅ η ⋅ cosφ
The reference current is the nominal motor current as projected onto the
transformer secondary side and is thus calculated as follows:
I ref I nom,motor / T nom
=
I nom,(relay) I nom,(relay)
Example:
Motor and System Data
Nominal motor voltage Vnom: 10 kV
Nominal motor power Pnom: 1500 kW
Efficiency η: 96.6%
Active power factor cos φ: 0.86
Nominal transformation ratio Tnom of the main current transformer: 1 A
Determination of the Nominal Motor Current
1500kW
I nom,motor = = 104A
3 ⋅ 10kV ⋅ 0.966 ⋅ 0.86
Determination of the reference current
I ref 104A / 100
= = 1.04
I nom,(relay) 1A
Parameter Address
[spacer] MP: Factor k P PSx 017 040 024 132 024 182 025 132
[spacer]
The starting factor k should be set according to the maximum permissible
thermal continuous current:
I therm,motor
k=
I nom,motor
Example:
Motor Data:
Maximum permissible continuous thermal motor current Itherm,motor=
1.1 Inom,motor
Determination of the Starting Factor:
1.1 ⋅ I nom,motor
k= = 1.1
I nom,motor
[spacer] MP: I StUp> PSx 017 053 024 133 024 183 025 133
[spacer]
Setting for the current threshold for the operational status determination
“machine starting up”.
[spacer] MP: tISt Up> PS x 017 042 024 134 024 184 025 134
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay for the operational status determination “machine
starting up”. Usually, the default setting can be retained.
[spacer] MP: Charact e r.t ype P PSx 017 029 024 135 024 185 025 135
[spacer]
The selection of the tripping characteristic defines the restrictiveness of the
motor protection function. For low overcurrents, the logarithmic characteristic
provides significantly higher tripping times than the reciprocally squared
characteristic, since the latter neglects any heat transfer to the cooling medium
in the overload range.
Parameter Address
[spacer] MP: t6Iref PS x 017 041 024 136 024 186 025 136
[spacer]
This setting for the overload tripping time t6Iref is determined from the cold
machine data, using Iref = Inom,motor.
For the reciprocally squared characteristic we set:
( I startup
)
2
I nom,motor
t6I = tblock,cold ⋅
ref 36
For the logarithmic characteristic we set:
1
t6I = tblock,cold ⋅
( I startup
)
ref 2
I nom,motor
36 ⋅ ln
( I startup
)
2
-1
I nom,motor
Based on the setting value thus determined, the tripping time for a warm
machine is now defined as follows.
For the reciprocally squared characteristic we have:
36
t = (1 - 0.2) ⋅ t6I ⋅
( I startup
)
ref 2
I nom,motor
( I startup
)
2
I nom,motor
t = (1 - 0.2) ⋅ t6I ⋅ 36 ⋅ ln
( I startup
)
ref 2
-1
I nom,motor
Example:
Motor Data
Motor startup current: Istartup = 5.7 Inom,motor
Max. permissible locked-rotor time with cold machine: tblock,cold = 18 s
Max. permissible locked-rotor time with warm machine: tblock,warm = 16 s
Determination of the Setting Value for the Reciprocally Squared
Characteristic:
t6Iref = 18s∙5.72/36 = 16.2s
Control of Tripping Time with Warm Machine:
t = 0.8∙16.2s∙36/5.72 = 14.4s ≤ 16s (o.k.)
Parameter Address
[spacer] MP: Tau aft er s t .-up PS x 018 042 024 137 024 187 025 137
[spacer]
Setting for the heat dispersion time constant after startup. Usually, the default
setting can be retained.
Pre-decreasing of the stored value thermal replica is carried out linearly up to
the minimum value stored after initial startup and depending on the count of the
startup frequency monitor. The rate for this pre-decreasing of the stored value is
constant and ranges at about 40% of the discharge (τ after startup = 20) within
a time duration of 60 s, for example. The relation between “MP: Tau after
st.-up PS x = 20 s” and 60 s is based on the approximation that this heat
transfer is practically finished after three times its time constant. The linear
decrease of the replica at this stage is done for simplification of data processing,
which looks appropriate with regard to its relatively short time constant
“(018 042) M P: Tau afte r st .-up P Sx” compared to “(017 088) MP: Tau
ma ch.r unning PS x”.
Under the assumption that the first machine start yields to a thermal replica
value of 60% (ideal value, for “(017 047) MP : Pe rm. No.st.-ups PSx = 3/2
cold/warm”), this linear heat transfer takes place until replica goes down to 20%,
hence the thermal replica change is 60% − 20% = 40%.
The same calculation applies to the 2nd start from warm machine: 80% − 40%
= 40% (where 80% are reached because of 20% heat from running machine
before start plus 60% from the start); or for 3rd consecutive start: 100% − 60%
=40%.
[spacer] MP: Tau mach.r unning P Sx 017 088 024 138 024 188 025 138
[spacer] MP: Tau mach.s toppe d PS x 017 089 024 139 024 189 025 139
[spacer]
Setting for the cooling time constant with a running or stopped machine,
respectively.
If the thermal time constants of the motor are unknown, the cooling time
constant with machine running is best set to 50 minutes and the cooling time
with machine stopped to the five-fold value of that with machine running.
[spacer] MP: Perm. No.st .-ups P S x 017 047 024 140 024 190 025 140
[spacer]
Setting for the startup sequence of the motor as permitted by thermal
considerations.
Note: The heavy starting logic (M P: S t .- up t ime tStUpPSx,
MP: Blocking time t E P Sx) can only be activated if the permissible
startup sequence is set to two startups from cold and one startup from warm.
[spacer] MP: R C permit te d, Θ< PS x 018 043 024 141 024 191 025 141
[spacer]
Setting for the threshold value of the overload memory for reclosure permission.
Usually, the default setting can be retained.
Parameter Address
[spacer] MP: Op erating mode P Sx 018 041 024 142 024 192 025 142
[spacer]
This setting defines whether motor protection will be operated together with
thermal overload protection (THERM).
[spacer] MP: S t.-up t ime tS tUpPS x 017 043 024 143 024 193 025 143
[spacer] MP: Blocking time t E P Sx 017 044 024 144 024 194 025 144
[spacer]
Using an overspeed monitor, the heavy starting logic can be activated if
necessary. For this purpose, the load-torque-dependent operational startup time
needs to be set for tStUp and the maximum permissible locked-rotor time (the
“tE time”) with a machine at operating temperature needs to be set for tE.
If the heavy starting logic is not used then the set startup time tStUp and the tE-
time should be set to the same value; the default values can be retained.
Note: The heavy starting logic (M P: P e rm. No.st.-ups PSx) can only be
activated if the permissible startup sequence is set to two startups from cold
and one startup from warm.
[spacer] MP: R etain replica P S x 009 046 009 250 009 251 009 252
0: No
[spacer]
With this parameter it can be configured whether the thermal replica is retained
in the non-volatile section of the device's memory so that it will still be available
after an interruption of the supply voltage.
[spacer] MP: I < PSx 017 048 024 145 024 195 025 145
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the minimum current stage of the underload
protection function of motor protection.
[spacer] MP: tI< PS x 017 050 024 146 024 196 025 146
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the minimum current stage of the underload
protection function of motor protection.
Parameter Address
Thermal overload THER M : Enable PSx 072 175 073 175 074 175 075 175
protection
0: No Fig. 3-242, (p. 3-315)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which thermal overload protection
is enabled.
[spacer] THER M : S ele ct cur rent P Sx 013 139 013 140 013 141 013 142
[spacer]
Depending on this setting the thermal replica is calculated based on either the
maximum phase current, or based on the calculated residual current derived
from the sum of the phase currents (setting IN calculated), or based on the
residual current measured at the fourth transformer (setting IN measured).
[spacer] THER M : S el. backup t h. PSx 072 080 073 080 074 080 075 080
[spacer]
Selecting the backup temperature sensor for the parameter subset PSx.
[spacer] THER M : Ir ef PSx 072 179 073 179 074 179 075 179
[spacer]
Setting for the reference current.
[spacer] THER M : S tar t .f act.OL_RC PS x 072 180 073 180 074 180 075 180
[spacer]
Setting for the starting factor to trigger overload recording.
[spacer] THER M : Tim.const .1 ,>Ibl PSx 072 187 073 187 074 187 075 187
[spacer]
Setting for the thermal time constants of the protected object with current flow
(Ibl: base line current).
[spacer] THER M : Tim.const .2 ,<Ibl PSx 072 188 073 188 074 188 075 188
[spacer]
Setting for the thermal time constants of the protected object without current
flow (cooling time constant).
Note: This setting option is only relevant when machines are running. In all
other cases, time constant 2 must be set equal to time constant 1.
[spacer] THER M : M ax.pe rm.obj .t mp.PS x 072 182 073 182 074 182 075 182
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum permissible temperature of the protected object.
[spacer] THER M : O/ T f .Iref pe r s. PS x 072 167 073 167 074 167 075 167
[spacer]
Setting for overtemperature resulting from a persistent limit current (Θmax -
Θa,max).
Parameter Address
[spacer] THER M : M ax.pe rm.cool.t mpPS x 072 185 073 185 074 185 075 185
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum permissible coolant temperature.
Note: This setting is active only if the coolant temperature is measured via the
PT 100 or the 20 mA input.
[spacer] THER M : De fault CTA PS x 072 186 073 186 074 186 075 186
[spacer]
Setting for the coolant temperature to be used for calculation of the trip time if
coolant temperature is not measured.
[spacer] THER M : Warning t emp. PS x 072 153 073 153 074 153 075 153
[spacer]
Setting for the temperature (in °C) to trigger a warning alarm.
Note: This setting is only enabled in the Absolute replica mode of operation.
[spacer] THER M : R e l. O/ T warning P Sx 072 184 073 184 074 184 075 184
[spacer]
Setting for the operate threshold of the warning stage.
Note: This setting is enabled only in the Relative replica operating mode.
[spacer] THER M : R e l. O/ T t rip P Sx 072 181 073 181 074 181 075 181
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the trip stage.
Note: If the operating mode has been set to Absolute replica, the setting here
will be automatically set to 100% and this parameter will be hidden as far as the
local control panel is concerned.
[spacer] THER M : Hyste re sis t ri p PSx 072 183 073 183 074 183 075 183
[spacer]
Setting for the hysteresis of the trip stage.
[spacer] THER M : Warning pre-t rip PS x 072 191 073 191 074 191 075 191
[spacer]
A warning will be given in advance of the trip. The time difference between the
warning time and the trip time is set here.
[spacer] THER M : R e tain r e pl ic a PS x 009 019 009 030 009 032 009 039
0: No
[spacer]
With this parameter it can be configured whether the thermal replica is retained
in the non-volatile section of the device's memory so that it will still be available
after an interruption of the supply voltage.
Parameter Address
[spacer] THER M : S ele ct meas.input PS x 072 177 073 177 074 177 075 177
[spacer]
Selecting if and how the coolant temperature is measured: Via the PT100, the
20mA input or Tx (x = 1 to 9).
[spacer] THER M : Funct.f.CT A fai l. PSx 076 177 077 177 078 177 079 177
[spacer]
The setting defines how the thermal overload protection function will continue to
operate in the event of faulty coolant temperature acquisition. User can select
between Default temp. value, Last meas.temperat. and Blocking.
Parameter Address
Unbalance protec‐ I2>: Enable PSx 018 220 018 221 018 222 018 223
tion
0: No Fig. 3-247, (p. 3-325)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which unbalance protection is
enabled.
[spacer] I2>: Ineg> PSx 018 091 018 224 018 225 018 226
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the first overcurrent stage.
[spacer] I2>: Ineg>> PSx 018 092 018 227 018 228 018 229
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value of the second overcurrent stage.
[spacer] I2>: tIneg> PS x 018 093 018 230 018 231 018 232
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the first overcurrent stage.
[spacer] I2>: tIneg>> PS x 018 094 018 233 018 234 018 235
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the second overcurrent stage.
Parameter Address
tion
0: No Fig. 3-249, (p. 3-327)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which time-voltage protection is
enabled.
[spacer] V<>: Ope rating mode PSx 076 001 077 001 078 001 079 001
[spacer]
This setting specifies whether the phase-to-ground voltages ('Star' operating
mode) or the phase-to-phase voltages ('Delta' operating mode) will be
monitored.
Note: In the settings for the operate values of the time-voltage protection
function, the reference quantity is Vnom in the Delta operating mode, but Vnom/
√3 in the Star operating mode.
To work out the settings for the over/undervoltage stages, consider the following
example for Vnom = 100 V:
Setting in the Delta operating mode for an operate value of 80 V (phase-to-
phase):
operate value 80V
Setting value = = = 0.80
V nom 100V
Setting in the Star operating mode for an operate value of 46.2 V (phase-to-
phase):
operate value 46.2V 46.2V ⋅ 3
Setting value = = = = 0.80
V nom 100V 100V
3 3
[spacer] V<>: V> PSx 076 003 077 003 078 003 079 003
[spacer]
Setting for operate value V>.
[spacer] V<>: V> > PSx 076 004 077 004 078 004 079 004
[spacer]
Setting for operate value V>>.
[spacer] V<>: V> >> PS x 011 075 011 076 011 077 011 078
[spacer]
Setting for operate value V>>>.
[spacer] V<>: tV> PS x 076 005 077 005 078 005 079 005
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage V>.
Parameter Address
[spacer] V<>: tV>> PS x 076 006 077 006 078 006 079 006
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage V>>.
[spacer] V<>: tV>>> PS x 011 079 011 080 011 081 011 082
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage V>>>.
[spacer] V<>: tV> 3-pole PS x 076 027 077 027 078 027 079 027
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage V> when all three trigger
stages are activated.
[spacer] V<>: tV>> 3- pole P S x 011 092 011 094 011 095 011 096
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage V>> when all three trigger
stages are activated.
[spacer] V<>: tV>>> 3- pole P Sx 011 099 011 105 011 117 011 118
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage V>>> when all three trigger
stages are activated.
[spacer] V<>: V< PSx 076 007 077 007 078 007 079 007
[spacer]
Setting for operate value V<.
[spacer] V<>: V< < PSx 076 008 077 008 078 008 079 008
[spacer]
Setting for operate value V<<.
[spacer] V<>: V< << PS x 011 083 011 084 011 085 011 086
[spacer]
Setting for operate value V<<<.
[spacer] V<>: tV< PS x 076 009 077 009 078 009 079 009
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage V<.
[spacer] V<>: tV<< PS x 076 010 077 010 078 010 079 010
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage V<<.
Parameter Address
[spacer] V<>: tV<<< PS x 011 088 011 089 011 090 011 091
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage V<<<.
[spacer] V<>: tV< 3-pole PS x 076 028 077 028 078 028 079 028
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage V< when all three trigger
stages are activated.
[spacer] V<>: tV<< 3- pole P S x 011 119 011 124 011 125 011 126
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage V<< when all three trigger
stages are activated.
[spacer] V<>: tV<<< 3- pole P Sx 011 127 011 128 011 129 011 130
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage V<<< when all three trigger
stages are activated.
[spacer] V<>: Vpo s> PS x 076 015 077 015 078 015 079 015
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vpos>.
[spacer] V<>: Vpo s>> PSx 076 016 077 016 078 016 079 016
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vpos>>.
[spacer] V<>: tVp os> PSx 076 017 077 017 078 017 079 017
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vpos>.
[spacer] V<>: tVp os>> PSx 076 018 077 018 078 018 079 018
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vpos>>.
[spacer] V<>: Vpo s< PS x 076 019 077 019 078 019 079 019
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vpos<.
[spacer] V<>: Vpo s<< PSx 076 020 077 020 078 020 079 020
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vpos<<.
Parameter Address
[spacer] V<>: tVp os< PSx 076 021 077 021 078 021 079 021
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage Vpos<.
[spacer] V<>: tVp os<< PSx 076 022 077 022 078 022 079 022
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage Vpos<<.
[spacer] V<>: Vneg> PS x 076 023 077 023 078 023 079 023
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vneg>.
[spacer] V<>: Vneg>> PS x 076 024 077 024 078 024 079 024
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vneg>>.
[spacer] V<>: tVneg> PSx 076 025 077 025 078 025 079 025
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vneg>.
[spacer] V<>: tVneg>> PSx 076 026 077 026 078 026 079 026
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vneg>>.
[spacer] V<>: Meas . Value VNG> P Sx 018 219 018 250 018 251 018 252
[spacer] V<>: Meas . Value VNG>>P Sx 018 253 018 254 018 255 019 005
[spacer]
These settings allow to select for the respective overcurrent stage whether the
starting decision shall be based on the fundamental or on the r.m.s. value.
[spacer] V<>: Evaluation VNG PS x 076 002 077 002 078 002 079 002
[spacer]
This setting determines which neutral-point displacement voltage will be
monitored: The displacement voltage calculated by the P139 or the
displacement voltage measured at the T 90 voltage transformer.
[spacer] V<>: VNG> PS x 076 011 077 011 078 011 079 011
[spacer]
Setting for operate value VNG>.
[spacer] V<>: VNG>> PSx 076 012 077 012 078 012 079 012
[spacer]
Setting for operate value VNG>>.
Parameter Address
[spacer] V<>: tVNG> PS x 076 013 077 013 078 013 079 013
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VNG>.
[spacer] V<>: tVNG>> PSx 076 014 077 014 078 014 079 014
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage VNG>>.
[spacer] V<>: Vref> PS x 007 064 007 071 007 075 007 079
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vref>.
[spacer] V<>: Vref>> PSx 007 065 007 068 007 072 007 076
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vref>>.
[spacer] V<>: Vref>>> PS x 010 250 010 251 010 252 010 253
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vref>>>.
[spacer] V<>: tVref> PSx 007 066 007 069 007 073 007 077
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vref>.
[spacer] V<>: tVref>> PSx 007 067 007 070 007 074 007 078
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vref>>.
[spacer] V<>: tVref>>> PSx 010 254 010 255 011 020 011 035
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vref>>>.
[spacer] V<>: Vref< PS x 007 086 007 097 007 101 007 105
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vref<.
[spacer] V<>: Vref<< PSx 007 087 007 098 007 102 007 106
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vref<<.
[spacer] V<>: Vref<<< PS x 011 059 011 062 011 069 011 070
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Vref<<<.
Parameter Address
[spacer] V<>: tVref< PSx 007 088 007 099 007 103 007 107
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage Vref<.
[spacer] V<>: tVref<< PSx 007 096 007 100 007 104 007 108
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of undervoltage stage Vref<<.
[spacer] V<>: tVref<<< PSx 011 071 011 072 011 073 011 074
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of overvoltage stage Vref<<<.
[spacer] V<>: Op. mode V< mon. P Sx 001 162 001 163 001 164 001 165
[spacer]
Activation of the minimum current monitoring mode for undervoltage stage V<.
[spacer] V<>: I enable V< PSx 001 155 001 159 001 160 001 161
[spacer]
This setting defines the threshold value of the minimum current monitoring for
undervoltage stage V<.
[spacer] V<>: tT rans ient pulse P Sx 076 029 077 029 078 029 079 029
[spacer]
Setting for the time limit of the signals generated by the undervoltage stages.
[spacer] V<>: Hyst . V<> meas. PSx 076 048 077 048 078 048 079 048
[spacer]
Setting for the hysteresis of the trigger stages for monitoring measured
voltages.
[spacer] V<>: Hyst . V<> de duc . P Sx 076 049 077 049 078 049 079 049
[spacer]
Setting for the hysteresis of the trigger stages for monitoring deduced voltages
such as Vneg and VNG.
Parameter Address
Over-/ f<> : Enable PSx 018 196 018 197 018 198 018 199
underfrequency pro‐
tection
0: No Fig. 3-263, (p. 3-341)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which over-/underfrequency
protection is enabled.
[spacer] f<> : Oper. m ode f1 PS x 018 120 018 121 018 122 018 123
[spacer] f<> : Oper. m ode f2 PS x 018 144 018 145 018 146 018 147
1: f
[spacer] f<> : Oper. m ode f3 PS x 018 168 018 169 018 170 018 171
1: f
[spacer] f<> : Oper. m ode f4 PS x 018 192 018 193 018 194 018 195
1: f
[spacer] f<> : Oper. m ode f5 PS x 019 171 019 172 019 173 019 174
1: f
[spacer]
Setting for the operating mode of the timer stages of over-/underfrequency
protection.
[spacer] f<> : f1 PS x 018 100 018 101 018 102 018 103
[spacer] f<> : f2 PS x 018 124 018 125 018 126 018 127
[spacer] f<> : f3 PS x 018 148 018 149 018 150 018 151
[spacer] f<> : f4 PS x 018 172 018 173 018 174 018 175
[spacer] f<> : f5 PS x 019 151 019 152 019 153 019 154
[spacer]
Setting for the frequency threshold. The over-/underfrequency protection
function will operate if one of the following two conditions applies: The
threshold is higher than the set nominal frequency and the frequency exceeds
this threshold. The threshold is lower than the set nominal frequency and the
frequency falls below this threshold. Depending on the chosen operating mode,
either a signal is issued without further monitoring, or further monitoring
mechanisms are started.
[spacer] f<> : tf1 PSx 018 104 018 105 018 106 018 107
[spacer] f<> : tf2 PSx 018 128 018 129 018 130 018 131
Parameter Address
[spacer] f<> : tf3 PSx 018 152 018 153 018 154 018 155
[spacer] f<> : tf4 PSx 018 176 018 177 018 178 018 179
[spacer] f<> : tf5 PSx 019 155 019 156 019 157 019 158
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of over-/underfrequency protection.
[spacer] f<> : df1/dt PS x 018 108 018 109 018 110 018 111
[spacer] f<> : df2/dt PS x 018 132 018 133 018 134 018 135
[spacer] f<> : df3/dt PS x 018 156 018 157 018 158 018 159
[spacer] f<> : df4/dt PS x 018 180 018 181 018 182 018 183
[spacer] f<> : df5/dt PS x 019 159 013 092 013 093 013 094
[spacer]
Setting for the frequency gradient to be monitored.
Note: This setting is ineffective unless operating mode f with df/dt has been
selected.
[spacer] f<> : De lta f1 PS x 018 112 018 113 018 114 018 115
[spacer] f<> : De lta f2 PS x 018 136 018 137 018 138 018 139
[spacer] f<> : De lta f3 PS x 018 160 018 161 018 162 018 163
[spacer] f<> : De lta f4 PS x 018 184 018 185 018 186 018 187
[spacer] f<> : De lta f5 PS x 019 163 019 164 019 165 019 166
[spacer]
Setting for Delta f.
Note: This setting is ineffective unless operating mode f w. Delta f/Delta t has
been selected.
[spacer] f<> : De lta t1 PS x 018 116 018 117 018 118 018 119
[spacer] f<> : De lta t2 PS x 018 140 018 141 018 142 018 143
Parameter Address
[spacer] f<> : De lta t3 PSx 018 164 018 165 018 166 018 167
[spacer] f<> : De lta t4 PSx 018 188 018 189 018 190 018 191
[spacer] f<> : De lta t5 PSx 019 167 019 168 019 169 019 170
[spacer]
Setting for Delta t.
Note: This setting is ineffective unless operating mode f w. Delta f/Delta t has
been selected.
Parameter Address
shedding
0: No Fig. 3-266, (p. 3-346)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which underfrequency load
shedding protection is enabled.
[spacer] Pf<: f1 PS x 015 211 015 212 015 221 015 222
[spacer] Pf<: f2 PS x 015 223 015 224 015 225 015 226
[spacer] Pf<: f3 PS x 015 227 015 228 015 229 015 230
[spacer] Pf<: f4 PS x 015 231 015 232 015 233 015 234
[spacer] Pf<: f5 PS x 015 235 015 236 015 237 015 238
[spacer] Pf<: f6 PS x 015 239 015 240 015 241 015 242
[spacer] Pf<: f7 PS x 015 243 015 244 015 245 015 246
[spacer] Pf<: f8 PS x 015 247 015 248 015 249 015 250
[spacer] Pf<: f9 PS x 015 251 015 252 015 253 015 254
[spacer] Pf<: f10 PSx 015 255 016 001 016 002 016 003
[spacer]
Setting for the frequency threshold.
[spacer] Pf<: tPF< PSx 016 004 016 005 016 006 016 007
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of underfrequency load shedding protection.
[spacer] Pf<: Dire ction Pmin PS x 016 008 016 009 016 010 016 011
0: Forward directional
[spacer]
This setting defines the active power direction.
[spacer] Pf<: Pmin PS x 016 012 016 016 016 020 016 021
[spacer]
The setting defines the threshold of maximum active power for allowing tripping
in case of underfrequency threshold is reached.
Parameter Address
[spacer] Pf<: hystere sis Pmin PSx 016 217 016 218 016 219 016 220
[spacer]
Setting for the hysteresis of the active power threshold.
[spacer] Pf<: Im in PS x 016 022 016 023 016 024 016 025
[spacer]
The setting defines the minimum current to release active power measurement.
[spacer] Pf<: S ector angle PSx 016 026 016 027 016 028 016 029
[spacer]
The setting defines the angle to provide stability under high active power
condition.
Parameter Address
Power directional P<>: Enabled PSx 014 252 014 253 014 254 014 255
protection
0: No Fig. 3-270, (p. 3-350)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which power directional protection
is enabled.
[spacer] P<>: S tart w. Direc t. P Sx 021 074 021 075 021 076 021 077
[spacer]
Setting for determination of the starting condition for all power stages:
● With setting Yes, starting takes place only, if the power start threshold
operates AND the measured direction is equal to the set direction of the
stage.
● With setting No, starting takes place, if the power start threshold operates.
[spacer] P<>: P> PS x 017 120 017 200 017 201 017 202
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value P> for the active power.
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay P > PSx 017 128 017 129 017 130 017 131
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage P>.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay P > PSx 017 132 017 133 017 134 017 135
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay of stage P>.
[spacer] P<>: Direction P> PS x 017 136 017 137 017 138 017 139
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a P>> trip signal will
be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng. ratio P> PSx 017 124 017 125 017 126 017 127
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value P> of active power.
[spacer] P<>: P>> PS x 017 140 017 141 017 142 017 143
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value P>> for the active power.
Parameter Address
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay P >>PS x 017 148 017 149 017 150 017 151
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage P>>.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay P >>P Sx 017 152 017 153 017 154 017 155
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay of stage P>>.
[spacer] P<>: Direction P>> PS x 017 156 017 157 017 158 017 159
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a P>> trip signal will
be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng. ratio P>>P S x 017 144 017 145 017 146 017 147
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value P>> of active power.
[spacer] P<>: Q> PS x 017 160 017 161 017 162 017 163
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value Q> of the reactive power.
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay Q> P Sx 017 168 017 169 017 170 017 171
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage Q>.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay Q> P Sx 017 172 017 173 017 174 017 175
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay of stage Q>.
[spacer] P<>: Direction Q> PS x 017 176 017 177 017 178 017 179
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a Q> trip signal will
be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng. ratio Q> P Sx 017 164 017 165 017 166 017 167
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value Q> of reactive power.
[spacer] P<>: Q>> PS x 017 180 017 181 017 182 017 183
[spacer]
Setting for the operate value Q>> of the reactive power.
Parameter Address
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay Q>>P Sx 017 188 017 189 017 190 017 191
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage Q>>.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay Q>>P Sx 017 192 017 193 017 194 017 195
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay of stage Q>>.
[spacer] P<>: Direction Q>> PS x 017 196 017 197 017 198 017 199
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a Q>> trip signal
will be issued for forward, backward or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng. ratio Q>>PS x 017 184 017 185 017 186 017 187
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value Q>> of reactive power.
[spacer] P<>: P< PS x 017 030 017 031 017 032 017 033
[spacer]
Setting the operate value P< for the active power.
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay P < PSx 017 060 017 061 017 062 017 063
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage P<.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay P < PSx 017 226 017 227 017 228 017 229
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of stage P<.
[spacer] P<>: Direction P< PS x 017 230 017 231 017 232 017 233
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a P< trip signal will
be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng. ratio P< PSx 017 034 017 035 017 036 017 037
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value P< of active power.
[spacer] P<>: P<< PS x 017 234 017 235 017 236 017 237
[spacer]
Setting for operate value P<< of active power.
Parameter Address
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay P <<PS x 017 242 017 243 017 244 017 245
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage P<<.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay P <<P Sx 017 246 017 247 017 248 017 249
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of stage P<<.
[spacer] P<>: Direction P<< PS x 017 250 017 251 017 252 017 253
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a P<< trip signal will
be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng.ratio P<< PS x 017 238 017 239 017 240 017 241
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value P<< of active power.
[spacer] P<>: Q< PS x 018 035 018 036 018 037 018 038
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Q< of reactive power.
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay Q< P Sx 018 052 018 053 018 054 018 055
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage Q<.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay Q< P Sx 018 056 018 057 018 058 018 059
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of stage Q<.
[spacer] P<>: Direction Q< PS x 018 081 018 082 018 083 018 084
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a Q< trip signal will
be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng. ratio Q< P Sx 018 044 018 045 018 046 018 047
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value Q< of reactive power.
[spacer] P<>: Q<< PS x 018 085 018 086 018 087 018 088
[spacer]
Setting for operate value Q<< of reactive power.
Parameter Address
[spacer] P<>: Op erate de lay Q<<P Sx 018 213 018 214 018 215 018 216
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of stage Q<<.
[spacer] P<>: R eleas e de lay Q<<P Sx 018 236 018 237 018 238 018 239
[spacer]
Setting for the release delay (reset time) of stage Q<<.
[spacer] P<>: Direction Q<< PS x 018 242 018 243 018 244 018 245
[spacer]
This setting of the measuring direction determines whether a Q<< trip signal
will be issued for forward, backward (reverse) or non-directional fault decisions.
[spacer] P<>: Diseng.ratio Q<< P Sx 018 095 018 096 018 097 018 098
[spacer]
Setting for the disengaging ratio of operate value Q<< of reactive power.
[spacer] P<>: t Transient pulse P Sx 018 246 018 247 018 248 018 249
[spacer]
Setting for the time limit of the signals generated by stages P<, P<<, Q< and
Q<< after the respective operate delays have elapsed.
Parameter Address
Voltage controlled QV: Enable d PSx 013 223 013 224 013 225 013 226
directional reactive
power protection
0: No Fig. 3-284, (p. 3-363)
Fig. 3-285, (p. 3-363)
[spacer]
This setting defines the parameter subset in which QV protection is enabled.
[spacer] QV: V< PS x 013 231 013 232 013 233 013 234
[spacer]
The setting defines the phase-phase undervoltage threshold. The funcation
operates when all three phase-phase voltages drop below the set threshold
(AND combination).
[spacer] QV: hystere sis V< PSx 014 079 014 080 014 081 014 082
2 1 10 %
[spacer]
Setting for the hysteresis of the undervoltage threshold of QV function.
[spacer] QV: Direction Q PSx 013 227 013 228 013 229 013 230
0: Forward directional
[spacer]
This setting defines the reactive power direction.
[spacer] QV: Qmin PSx 014 084 014 085 014 086 014 087
[spacer]
The setting defines the threshold of maximum reactive power for allowing
tripping in case of undevoltage threshold is reached.
[spacer] QV: hystere sis Qmin PS x 016 213 016 214 016 215 016 216
[spacer]
Setting for the hysteresis of the reactive power threshold.
[spacer] QV: S e ctor ang le PSx 013 235 013 236 013 237 013 238
[spacer]
The setting defines the angle to provide stability under high active power
condition.
[spacer] QV: Im in PS x 013 243 013 244 013 245 013 246
[spacer]
The setting defines the minimum current to release reactive power
measurement.
[spacer] QV: t1 PS x 013 247 013 248 013 249 013 250
[spacer] QV: t2 PS x 013 251 013 252 013 253 013 254
[spacer]
Setting for the first or second operate time, respectively.
Parameter Address
[spacer] QV: M in.d ur .tr.cmd.1 PSx 014 065 014 066 014 067 014 068
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum pulse time of the first trip command.
[spacer] QV: M in.d ur .tr.cmd.2 PSx 014 069 014 070 014 071 014 072
[spacer]
Setting for the minimum pulse time of the second trip command.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Enabling the bay interlocking function from the local control panel.
[spacer] MAIN: SI active USER 221 002
[spacer]
Enabling the station interlocking function from the local control panel.
[spacer] MAIN: Inp.asg. fct .block. 1 221 014
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signals assigned to function block 1 and 2.
[spacer] MAIN: Op. delay fct . block 221 029
[spacer]
Setting for the operate delay of the function blocks.
[spacer] MAIN: Pe rm.No.mot .dr iv e op 221 027
[spacer]
Setting for the permissible motor drive operations within the time interval
defined at M AIN: Mon.ti me mot .dr iv e s.
[spacer] MAIN: Mon.time mot. drive s 221 026
[spacer]
Setting for the monitoring time to monitor the number of motor drives.
[spacer] MAIN: Cool.t ime mot.drive s 221 028
[spacer]
Setting for the cooling time for motors in motor-operated switchgear.
[spacer] MAIN: Mon.time Dir.Cont r. 221 060
[spacer]
Setting for the monitoring time for the motor relay.
[spacer] MAIN: CB1 max . ope r. c ap. 221 084
1 1 99
1 1 99
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum number of CB operations for an ARC cycle (or for a
limited time period).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Selecting the event which, when present, will initialize the counter at
MAIN: CB1 act. oper . cap. with the value at MAIN: CB1 max. ope r.
cap..
[spacer] MAIN: CB2 re ady fct. ass ign 221 089
[spacer]
Selecting the event which, when present, will initialize the counter at
MAIN: CB1 act. oper . cap. (or MAIN: CB2 act. oper. cap.) with the
value at MAI N: CB1 max. oper . cap. (or M AI N: CB 2 max. oper .
cap., respectively).
[spacer] MAIN: DC op. delay t1 221 240
[spacer]
Setting the delay of the commands CMD_DC1, CMD_DC2 and CMD_DC3.
[spacer] MAIN: DC1 im pulse t 2 221 241
[spacer]
Setting the maximum duration of the command CMD_DC1.
[spacer] MAIN: DC2/3 release de lay 221 242
[spacer]
Setting the delay of the termination of the commands CMD_DC2 and CMD_DC3.
[spacer] MAIN: W. ex t. cmd. t ermin. 221 063
0: No
[spacer]
This setting determines if bay types, defined for direct motor control, can be
used together with external termination contacts to directly influence the control
process of motor driven switchgear.
[spacer] MAIN: Cmd .end f . DC fai l. 221 111
[spacer]
In the case of direct motor control by motor relay K200, this parameter can be
set to Yes or No. If the K200 contacts should not have opened until the end of
the command to the motor when the set monitoring time-delay had expired
(monitoring via binary signal input –U 706, signal S IG_1: S ignal S012 EXT
as the standard setting) then the direction control contacts are opened if this
parameter is set to Yes.
If this parameter is set to No then respective fault signals (MAIN: DC fai l.
cmd. End, MAIN: DC fail . cmd.s tar t, M AIN: DE V op.time
exceede d) are issued when the monitoring time-delay has expired and the
direction control contacts will remain closed. (Note: This behavior still bears the
danger of an undefined switch position!)
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Select whether the command CMD_DC3 shall be terminated only by the signal
SIG_DC3, or with positive indication of the final switchgear position as well.
(Note that in either case, the termination of CMD_DC3 is delayed by the setting
MAIN: DC2/3 rele ase de lay.)
Parameter Address
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
0: Not assigned
[spacer]
Setting for the designation of the respective external device. Either one of the
pre-defined designations or the term Device Name User may be selected. In the
latter case any text (max 4 characters) may be entered at DEV01: DEV-
Name Use r that will be used as the devices' designation. (The same holds for
DEV02 etc.)
[spacer] DEV01: DEV- Name Us er 218 101
0:
0:
0:
0:
0:
0:
Parameter Address
0:
0:
0:
0:
[spacer]
Any text (max. 4 characters) may be entered as the devices’ name which will
then be used as the designation, if the associated parameter
DEV01: De signat. e xt. dev. has been set to Device Name User. When
instead one of the pre-defined designations is selected at DE V01: Des ig nat.
ext. de v. it will be used and DE V01: D EV- Name User is ignored. A
designation with more than 4 characters is internally truncated. (The same holds
for DEV02 etc.)
[spacer] DEV01: Oper. mode cmd. 210 024
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
3: Time control
[spacer]
Selecting the operating mode of the command from long command, short
command or time control.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Setting for the time that a control command is sustained after a switchgear
position signal – “Open” or “Closed” – has been received.
[spacer] DEV01: Op.tim e swit ch. dev. 210 004
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
Parameter Address
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
20 0 254 s
[spacer]
Setting the operating time for switchgear (switching device).
[spacer] DEV01: Gr. as s ign. de bounc . 210 011
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
1: Group 1
[spacer]
Assigning the external device to one of eight groups for debouncing and chatter
suppression.
[spacer] DEV01: S tartCmdTi me superv . 210 007
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This parameter allows for defining a monitoring timer for the begin of a switch
command.
After sending an Open / Close command, the corresponding timer starts. If the
switchgear unit has not reached its intermediate position after this time has
elapsed then the command is deactivated and MAIN: S tar tcmdtime
exceed. is signaled.
In the default setting blocked this monitoring is switched off. This is
recommended for switchgear units for which it is impossible to detect the
intermediate position.
[spacer] DEV01: Interm . p os. s uppr . 210 012
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
This setting determines whether the “intermediate position” signal will be
suppressed or not, while the switchgear is operating.
[spacer] DEV01: S tat .ind.i nter m.pos. 210 027
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
This setting determines whether the actual status will be signaled with a 5 s
delay after the “Faulty position” signal is issued.
[spacer] DEV01: Inp.asg . s w.tr . pl ug 210 014
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Definition of the binary signal that is used to signal the position (“plugged-in” /
“unplugged”) of the switch truck plug.
[spacer] DEV01: With ge n. trip cmd.1 210 021
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
This setting specifies whether the circuit breaker will be opened by “general trip
command 1” of the protection function.
Note: This setting is only visible (active) for external devices that are defined as
“circuit breakers”. This definition is included in the bay type definitions.
[spacer] DEV01: With ge n. trip cmd.2 210 022
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
This setting specifies whether the circuit breaker will be opened by “general trip
command 2” of the protection function.
Note: This setting is only visible (active) for external devices that are defined as
“circuit breakers”. This definition is included in the bay type definitions.
[spacer] DEV01: With close c md. /pr ot 210 023
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
This setting specifies whether the circuit breaker will be closed by the “close
command” of the protection function.
Note: This setting is only visible (active) for external devices that are defined as
“circuit breakers”. This definition is included in the bay type definitions.
[spacer] DEV01: Inp.asg .el.ctrl.open 210 019
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This setting defines the binary signal that will be used as the control signal to
move the switchgear unit to the open position.
Note: Only signals that are defined in the DEVxx function groups can be
selected.
[spacer] DEV01: Inp.asg .e l.ctr.clos e 210 020
[spacer]
This setting defines the binary signal that will be used as the control signal to
move the switchgear unit to the “Closed” position.
Note: Only signals that are defined in the DEVxx function groups can be
selected.
[spacer] DEV01: Block cmd ope n 218 120
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Select whether open commands for the switchgear unit shall be blocked.
[spacer] DEV01: Block cmd clos e 218 160
[spacer]
Select whether close commands for the switchgear unit shall be blocked.
[spacer] DEV01: Oper.count .l imit 218 211
Parameter Address
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
[spacer]
Setting a limit value for the number of switching commands for the respective
switchgear unit.
[spacer] DEV01: Inp. as g. e nd Ope n 210 015
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This setting defines the binary signal that will be used to terminate the “Open”
command.
[spacer] DEV01: Inp. as g. e nd Close 210 016
[spacer]
This setting defines the binary signal that will be used to terminate the “Close”
command.
[spacer] DEV01: Open w/o s tat. int e rl 210 025
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
This setting specifies whether switching to “Open” position is permitted without
a check by the station interlock function.
[spacer] DEV01: Clos e w/ o stat . int . 210 026
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
This setting specifies whether switching to “Closed” position is permitted
without a check by the station interlock function.
[spacer] DEV01: Fct.as sig.BI wS I open 210 039
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This setting defines which output will issue the “Open” enable to the interlocking
logic when there is “bay interlock with substation interlock”.
Note: The interlock conditions for bay interlock with station interlock are
included in the bay type definitions (see “List of Bay Types” in the Appendix).
If the interlock condition is to be modified, this is possible by modifying the
corresponding Boolean equation in the interlocking logic or by defining a new
interlocking logic equation. Only in the latter case is it necessary to change the
function assignment.
[spacer] DEV01: Fct.as sig.BI wS I clos 210 040
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This setting defines which output will issue the “Close” enable to the interlocking
logic when there is “bay interlock with substation interlock”.
Note: The interlock conditions for bay interlock with station interlock are
included in the bay type definitions (see “List of Bay Types” in the Appendix).
If the interlock condition is to be modified, this is possible by modifying the
corresponding Boolean equation in the interlocking logic or by defining a new
interlocking logic equation. Only in the latter case is it necessary to change the
function assignment.
[spacer] DEV01: Fct.as g.BI w/ o S I op 210 041
[spacer]
This setting defines which output will issue the “Open” enable to the interlocking
logic when there is “bay interlock without substation interlock”.
Note: The interlock conditions for bay interlock without station interlock are
included in the bay type definitions (see “List of Bay Types” in the Appendix).
If the interlock condition is to be modified, this is possible by modifying the
corresponding Boolean equation in the interlocking logic or by defining a new
interlocking logic equation. Only in the latter case is it necessary to change the
function assignment.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
This setting defines which output will issue the “Close” enable to the interlocking
logic when there is “bay interlock without substation interlock”.
Note: The interlock conditions for bay interlock without station interlock are
included in the bay type definitions (see “List of Bay Types” in the Appendix).
If the interlock condition is to be modified, this is possible by modifying the
corresponding Boolean equation in the interlocking logic or by defining a new
interlocking logic equation. Only in the latter case is it necessary to change the
function assignment.
Parameter Address
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
Blocked 1 65000
[spacer]
Setting a limit value for the number of switching commands to the Three
Position Drive.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The interlock conditions are also transmitted together with reporting in the
“phase 2” of the IEC 61850 communication protocol. Therefore it is a
requirement that these interlock conditions are cyclically checked and not, as
with software versions that still implement “phase 1”, only with the request for a
switching operation.
This parameter sets the cycle time, after which a check of the interlock
conditions is carried out.
As additional processor capacity must be provided for each of these checks it
must be ensured that a favorable compromise is found for the cycle time setting
value. On the one hand it is desirable to select a cycle time value which is as
short as possible so that changes in the interlock conditions are updated without
any notable delays, but on the other hand this cycle time value should not be so
short that the P139 will be under too much strain. As the CPU load of the P139 is
dependent on the total number of function groups having been configured it is
not possible to suggest a generally acceptable cycle time value.
[spacer] ILOCK: R se t ILOCK violati on 221 123
[spacer]
The interlock violation signal (221 018) M AIN: Interlock equ. viol. will be
automatically reset after the time period set here. (The default value Blocked
disables the automatic reset.)
[spacer] ILOCK: Fct.assig nm. outp. 1 250 000
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Definition of the interlock conditions.
8.1 Operation
The P139 generates a large number of signals, processes binary input signals,
and acquires measured data during fault-free operation of the protected object
as well as fault-related data. A number of counters are available for statistical
purposes. This information can be read out from the integrated local control
panel or via the operating program.
All this information can be found in the “Operation” and “Events” folders in the
menu tree.
Note
Detailed information about all parameters, including complete selection tables and
IEC 60870‑5‑103 protocol properties, are separately available as a set of interlinked
PDF files for user-friendly navigation, packed in one ZIP archive named
DataModelExplorer_P139_en_P01.zip.
A list of the Logical Nodes that have been implemented for the IEC 61850 protocol
can be found in a separate document.
Parameter Address
interface
0.0 0.0 100.0 %
[spacer]
Display of the updated measured operating value for the number of corrupted
messages within the last 1000 received messages.
[spacer] COMM 3: No.t.err.,max,st ore d 120 041
[spacer]
Display of the updated measured operating value for the proportion of corrupted
messages within the last 1000 received messages.
[spacer] COMM 3: Loop back res ult 120 057
[spacer]
While the hold time is running, the loop back test results can be checked by
reading out these values.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the input current.
[spacer] MEASI: Curr e nt IDC p.u. 004 135
[spacer]
Display of the input current referred to IDC,nom.
[spacer]
Display of the linearized input current referred to IDC,nom.
[spacer]
Display of the scaled linearized value.
[spacer] MEASI: T emp eratur e T 004 133
[spacer]
Display of the temperature measured at the “PT 100” temperature input on the
analog p/c board.
[spacer] MEASI: T emp eratur e T1 004 224
[spacer]
Display of temperatures measured at inputs on the temperature p/c board.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the maximum temperature measured at the “PT 100” temperature
input on the analog p/c board.
[spacer] MEASI: T emp eratur e T1 max. 004 234
[spacer]
Display of maximum temperatures measured at inputs on the temperature p/c
board.
[spacer] MEASI: T emp eratur e p.u. T 004 221
[spacer]
Display of the temperature measured at the “PT 100” temperature input on the
analog p/c board referred to 100°C.
[spacer] MEASI: T emp eratur e p.u. T1 004 081
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of temperatures measured at inputs on the temperature p/c board
referred to 100°C.
Parameter Address
output
0.00 0.00 20.00 mA Fig. 3-51, (p. 3-85)
[spacer]
Display of the current on the analog measured data output (A1: channel 1; A2:
channel 2).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Date display. The date can also be set here. The centuries are not displayed.
The supported dates range from January 1st, 1997, until November 7th, 2098.
[spacer] MAIN: Tim e of day 003 091
[spacer]
Display of the time of day. The time can also be set here.
[spacer] MAIN: Tim e s witc hing 003 095
[spacer]
Setting for standard time or daylight saving time.
This setting is necessary in order to avoid misinterpretation of the times
assigned to signals and event data that can be read out through the PC or
communication interfaces.
[spacer] MAIN: Fre que nc y f 004 040
[spacer]
Display of system frequency.
[spacer] MAIN: IA prim,de mand 006 226
[spacer]
Display the three delayed phase currents (demand values) as primary
quantities.
[spacer] MAIN: IA prim,de mand st or. 006 223
[spacer]
Display the three stored phase currents (demand values) as primary quantities.
[spacer] MAIN: Curr. IP,max prim. 005 050
[spacer]
Display of the maximum phase current as a primary quantity.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the delayed maximum phase current as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: IP,max prim,de mand. st 005 034
[spacer]
Display of the delayed stored maximum phase current as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Curr. IP,m in prim. 005 055
[spacer]
Display of the minimum phase current as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Current A pr im. 005 040
[spacer]
Display of phase current A as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Current B prim. 006 040
[spacer]
Display of phase current B as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Current C pr im. 007 040
[spacer]
Display of phase current C as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Current Σ(IP) pri m. 005 010
[spacer]
Display of the calculated resultant current as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Current IN pr im. 004 043
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for the residual current as a primary quantity. The
measured residual current is displayed.
[spacer] MAIN: Volt. VPG,max prim. 008 042
[spacer]
Display of the maximum phase-to-ground voltage as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Volt. VPG,min prim. 009 042
[spacer]
Display of the minimum phase-to-ground voltage as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage A-G prim. 005 042
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-ground voltage A-G as a primary
quantity.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-ground voltage B-G as a primary
quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage C- G pr im. 007 042
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-ground voltage C-G as a primary
quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Volt. Σ(VPG )/ 3 pr im. 005 012
[spacer]
Display of the calculated neutral-displacement voltage as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage VNG pr im. 004 041
[spacer]
Display of the neutral-point displacement voltage measured at transformer T 90
as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage Vr ef pri m. 005 046
[spacer]
Display of the reference voltage measured at transformer T 15 as a primary
quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Volt. VPP,max prim. 008 044
[spacer]
Display of the maximum phase-to-phase voltage as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage VP P,min prim 009 044
[spacer]
Display of the minimum phase-to-phase voltage as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage A- B pri m. 005 044
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-phase voltage A-B as a primary
quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage B-C prim. 006 044
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-phase voltage B-C as a primary
quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage C- A prim. 007 044
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-phase voltage C-A as a primary
quantity.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the updated apparent power value as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Active powe r P pr im. 004 050
[spacer]
Display of the updated active power value as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Re ac. powe r Q prim. 004 052
[spacer]
Display of the updated reactive power value as a primary quantity.
[spacer] MAIN: Active powe r fac tor 004 054
[spacer]
Display of the updated active power factor.
[spacer] MAIN: Act.energy outp. prim 008 065
2: MWh
2: MWh
2: Mvarh
2: Mvarh
[spacer]
Display of the updated active energy output (or active energy input, reactive
energy output, reactive energy input, respectively) as a primary quantity.
At run-time, the value is displayed with 32 bit precision. (But note that for
technical reasons, this value is internally stored as a text value.)
Value ranges:
● MAIN: Act .e ne rgy outp.pr im – 0 … 6,553,500.00 MWh
● MAIN: Act.ene rgy inp. pri m – 0 … 6,553,500.00 MWh
● MAIN: Re act.e n. out p. pr im – 0 … 6,553,500.00 Mvar h
● MAIN: Re act. e n. inp. prim – 0 … 6,553,500.00 Mvar h
Note: As an alternative, the same values also exist as numbers with 16 bit
precision:
● (005 061) M AIN: Act .e ne rgy out p.prim
● (005 062) M AI N: Act .e ne r gy inp. pri m
● (005 063) M AIN: Re act .e n. out p. prim
● (005 064) M AIN: Reac t. e n. inp. prim
[spacer] MAIN: Act.energy outp. prim 005 061
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the updated active energy output (or active energy input, reactive
energy output, reactive energy input, respectively) as a primary quantity.
The value is displayed as a number with 16 bit precision.
The setting at M AIN: Op. mode e nergy cnt . decides which procedure
shall be used to determine the active and reactive energy:
● If procedure 1 is selected, active and reactive energy are determined
every 2 s (approximately).
● If procedure 2 is selected, active and reactive energy are determined
every 100 ms (approximately).
Procedure 2 obviously gives more precise results but puts more strain on the
system.
Whenever the maximum value of 655.35 MWh or 655.35 MVAr h is exceeded,
the determination of the energy output is restarted, and the value that
exceeded the range is transferred to the new cycle. Moreover, a counter is
incremented:
● (009 090) M AIN: No.ove rfl.act .e n.out: Counter for value overflow
of MAI N: Act .e nergy out p.pr im
● (009 091) M AI N: No.ov e r fl.act .e n.inp: Counter for value overflow
of M AIN: Act .e ner gy inp. pr im
● (009 092) M AIN: No. ov/ fl.r e ac. en.out: Counter for value overflow
of MAI N: R eact .en. out p. prim
● (009 093) MAIN: No.ov/ fl. r e ac.e n.i np: Counter for value overflow
of M AIN: Re act . en. i np. pr im
Note that the maximum value of these counters is 10000.
As an alternative to these 16 bit numbers, there are also 32 bit precision values
available:
● (008 065) M AIN: Act .e ne rgy o ut p.pri m
● (008 066) M AIN: Act .ene rgy i np. prim
● (008 067) M AIN: R eact .e n. outp. pri m
● (008 068) M AIN: R eact . en. inp. pri m
[spacer] MAIN: Load angle phi A 004 055
[spacer]
Display of the updated load angle value in phase A.
[spacer] MAIN: Load angle phi B 004 056
[spacer]
Display of the updated load angle value in phase B.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the updated load angle value in phase C.
[spacer] MAIN: Angle phi N 004 072
[spacer]
Display of the angle between the measured residual current system quantities IN
and VNG.
[spacer]
Display of the angle between the calculated neutral-point displacement voltage
and the measured residual current system quantities IN.
[spacer]
Display of the phase relation of measured and calculated residual current. (The
phase relation is displayed as either “Equal phase” or “Reverse phase”.)
[spacer] MAIN: Fre que ncy f p.u. 004 070
[spacer]
Display of system frequency referred to fn.
[spacer] MAIN: IA p.u.,de mand 006 235
[spacer]
Display of the delayed phase currents referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the delayed stored phase currents referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the maximum phase current referred to Inom.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the delayed maximum phase current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the delayed stored maximum phase current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the minimum phase current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of phase current A referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of phase current B referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of phase current C referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the positive sequence current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the negative-sequence current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the calculated residual current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated residual current value referred to Inom. The measured
residual current is displayed.
[spacer] MAIN: Voltage VP G,max p.u. 008 043
[spacer]
Display of the maximum phase-to-ground voltage referred to Vnom.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the minimum phase-to-ground voltage referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-ground voltage A-G referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-ground voltage B-G referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-ground voltage C-G referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the positive-sequence voltage referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the negative-sequence voltage referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the calculated neutral-point displacement voltage referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the neutral-point displacement voltage measured at transformer T 90
referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the reference voltage measured at transformer T 15 referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the maximum phase-to-phase voltage referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the minimum phase-to-phase voltage referred to Vnom.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-phase voltage A-B referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-phase voltage B-C referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for phase-to-phase voltage C-A referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated apparent power value referred to nominal apparent
power Snom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated active power value referred to nominal apparent power
Snom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for reactive power referred to nominal apparent
power Snom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated load angle value in phase A referred to 100°C.
[spacer] MAIN: Load angle phi B p.u 005 074
[spacer]
Display of the updated load angle value in phase B referred to 100°C.
[spacer] MAIN: Load angle phi C p.u 005 075
[spacer]
Display of the updated load angle value in phase C referred to 100°C.
[spacer] MAIN: Angle phi N p.u. 005 076
[spacer]
Display of the angle between the measured residual current system quantities IN
and VNG referred to 100°.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the angle between the calculated neutral-point displacement voltage
and the measured residual current system quantities IN referred to 100°.
[spacer]
Display of the local phase-to-phase angles phi.
[spacer] MAIN: Current ΣI unfilt . 004 074
[spacer]
Display of calculated unfiltered resultant current.
Parameter Address
direction
determination using
steady-state values
Not measured 0.000 30.000 IN,nom Fig. 3-215, (p. 3-282)
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for the active component of residual current
referred to IN,nom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for the reactive component of residual current
referred to IN,nom.
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for the harmonic content of residual current
referred to IN,nom. This display is only active when the steady-state current
evaluation mode of the ground fault direction determination function (GFDSS) is
enabled.
[spacer] GFDSS : Adm itt . Y(N) p.u. 004 191
[spacer]
Display of the updated admittance value referred to YN,nom.
Note: With setting: GF DS S : E valuat ion VNG PS x set to Measured:
YN,nom = IN,nom / VNG,nom
With setting: GFDSS: E val uation VNG PSx = Calculated:
YN,nom = IN,nom / Vnom
[spacer]
Display of the updated conductance value referred to YN,nom.
Note: With setting: G FDSS : Ev aluation VNG PSx set to Measured:
YN,nom = IN,nom / VNG,nom
With setting: GFDSS: E valuat ion VNG P Sx = Calculated:
YN,nom = IN,nom / Vnom
[spacer]
Display of the updated susceptance value referred to YN,nom.
Note: With setting: G FDSS : Ev aluat ion VNG PS x set to Measured:
YN,nom = IN,nom / VNG,nom
With setting: GFDSS: E valuat ion VNG P Sx = Calculated:
YN,nom = IN,nom / Vnom
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the buffer content of the motor protection function.
[spacer] MP: S t-up s s t ill p ermit t 004 012
[spacer]
Display of the current number of motor startups still permitted before RC
blocking.
[spacer] MP: Ther m. repl. MP p.u. 005 071
[spacer]
Display of the buffer content of the motor protection (referred to 100%).
[spacer] MP: Pre-close time le ft 012 018
[spacer]
Display of the remaining waiting time until the next start-up operation will be
enabled.
[spacer] MP: S t-up s s t . p erm.p.u. 005 086
[spacer]
Display of the current number of motor startups still permitted before RC
blocking (referred to the factor 10).
Parameter Address
protection
Not measured -25000 25000 % Fig. 3-245, (p. 3-322)
[spacer]
Display of the buffer content of the thermal overload protection function.
[spacer] THER M : Curre nt I,t he rm pr im 007 220
[spacer]
Display of the “thermal current” (as a primary quantity, or as a per unit quantity,
respectively).
These measured operating values are calculated as follows:
Statustherm. repl.
I therm,prim = I ref I nom,CT,prim
100
I therm,prim
I therm,p.u. =
I ref I nom,CT,prim
With:
● Itherm,prim = THER M: C urr e nt I,t he rm prim
● Itherm,p.u. = THE RM: C ur r ent I,t he rm p.u
● Statustherm. repl. = THE RM : Stat us THE RM r eplica
● Iref = THER M: Ire f P Sx
● Inom,CT,prim = MAIN: Inom C.T. prim.
In a measured values message the thermal current is processed as a per-unit
variable referred to Iref.
[spacer]
Display of the temperature of the protected object.
[spacer] THER M : Coolant t empe ratur e 004 149
[spacer]
Display of coolant temperature, dependent on the setting for THE RM: Sel ect
meas .inputPS x.
When set to None the set temperature value will be displayed. When set to
PT100 the temperature measured by the resistance thermometer will be
displayed. When set to 20mA input the temperature measured via an external
20 mA transducer will be displayed.
[spacer] THER M : Pre - trip t ime left 004 139
[spacer]
Display of the time remaining before the thermal overload protection function
will reach the tripping threshold (“time-to-trip”).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the buffer content of the thermal overload protection function
referred to a buffer content of 100%.
[spacer] THER M : Object te mp. p.u. 004 179
[spacer]
Display of the temperature of the protected object referred to 100°C.
[spacer] THER M : Coolant t emp. p.u. 004 178
[spacer]
Display of the coolant temperature referred to 100°C.
[spacer] THER M : Te m p. offse t re pli ca 004 109
[spacer]
Display of the additional reserve if coolant temperature is taken into account
and if the measured coolant temperature is lower than the set maximum
permissible coolant temperature. (In this case, the thermal model has been
shifted downwards.)
If there is no coolant temperature acquisition and if the coolant temperature and
the maximum permissible coolant temperature have been set to the same
value, then the coolant temperature is not taken into account and the
characteristic is a function of the current only. The additional reserve amounts
to 0 in this case.
Parameter Address
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
[spacer]
Display of the updated count.
Note: The count value can be set here (Preload-Function).
Parameter Address
interface
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
[spacer]
Display of the relevant receive signal.
[spacer] COMM 3: State send 1 121 000
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
[spacer]
Display of the updated value for the relevant send signal.
Parameter Address
Orientated
Substation Events
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
[spacer]
Display of the virtual binary GOOSE input state.
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
0: 0
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
Parameter Address
0: "Low"
0: "Low"
[spacer]
The state of the binary signal inputs is displayed as follows:
● Without function: No functions are assigned to the binary signal input.
● "Low": Not energized.
● "High": Energized.
This display appears regardless of the setting for the binary signal input mode.
Parameter Address
output
0: Inactive Fig. 3-43, (p. 3-72)
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
Parameter Address
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
Parameter Address
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
Parameter Address
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
Parameter Address
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
[spacer]
The state of the output relays is displayed as follows:
● Without function: No functions are assigned to the output relay.
● Inactive: The output relay is not energized.
● Active: The output relay is energized.
This display appears regardless of the operating mode set for the output relay.
Parameter Address
1: Active
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
Parameter Address
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
0: Inactive
[spacer]
The state of the LED indicators is displayed as follows:
● Inactive: The LED indicator is not energized.
● Active: The LED indicator is energized.
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the PIN code of HMI is changed.
[spacer] CS: COMM pas s w. change 180 101
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the password of communication interface is changed.
[spacer] CS: HM I pincode invalid 180 102
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the PIN code via HMI is invalid.
[spacer] CS: COMM pas s w. inv alid 180 103
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the password via communication interface is invalid.
[spacer] CS: re set tok en ge ne rat e 180 104
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the reset token is generated.
[spacer] CS: RBAC re s et s uc ce ss 180 105
0: No
[spacer]
Display when the RBAC reset is successful.
[spacer] CS: RBAC re s et failed 180 106
0: No
[spacer]
Display when the RBAC reset is failed.
[spacer] CS: Us e r01 block e d 180 107
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the user is blocked.
[spacer] CS: HM I logged in 180 122
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the user is logged in via HMI.
[spacer] CS: COMMS logge d in 180 123
0: No
[spacer]
The signal shows the user is logged in via communication interface.
[spacer] CS: IEC C S br ick faul ty 180 124
1: Yes
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
Signal that the protection unit is in edit mode. As a standard this signal is linked
to LED: Fct.as sig. H1 7 r ed.
[spacer] LOC: Tr ig. m enu jmp 1 E XT 030 230
0: No
[spacer]
Signal that menu jump list 1 is being triggered. (See the corresponding setting
at LOC: Fct. menu jmp lis t 1.)
[spacer] LOC: Tr ig. m enu jmp 2 E XT 030 231
0: No
[spacer]
Signal that menu jump list 2 is being triggered. (See the corresponding setting
at LOC: Fct. menu jmp lis t 2.)
[spacer] LOC: Illum ination on EX T 037 101
0: No
[spacer]
This signal shows that the backlighting for the front panel LCD is switched on.
[spacer] LOC: Loc.acc.bl ock .act iv e 221 005
Parameter Address
communication
interface 1
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
interface
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
Communication
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Display when control from multiple levels is allowed, i.e. (225 208) L OC: Fc t.
ass ig n. L/R k e y is set to R & L <-> L, and relay is in 'R&L' mode.
[spacer] IEC: Com m and blocki ng 104 087
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Display when Port A for SEB or Port A&B for REB is blocked.
[spacer] IEC: Port C block ed 104 076
0: No
[spacer]
Display when Port C is blocked.
[spacer] IEC: Port A fault y 104 197
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Display when an Ethernet module is not operational, i.e. if the MAC address is
missing or there is a non-plausible parameter setting.
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
Display when a client has made a reservation to control an external device
(“select” for control by control mode “select before operate”).
[spacer] IEC: Control b lock e d 221 126
[spacer]
Display when control via communication is blocked, i.e. (221 125) IEC: Ctrl
blocke d us er is set to Yes.
Parameter Address
Generic Object GOOSE: Ext .De v01 posit ion 109 000
Orientated
Substation Events
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
Parameter Address
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
Parameter Address
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
Parameter Address
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
Parameter Address
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
Parameter Address
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
Parameter Address
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
0: Interm. pos.
[spacer]
State of the virtual two-pole GOOSE input, representing the state of an external
device.
[spacer] GOOSE: Ext .De v01 ope n 109 001
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Binary open state of the virtual two-pole GOOSE input, representing the state of
an external device.
[spacer] GOOSE: Ext .De v01 close d 109 002
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Binary closed state of the virtual two-pole GOOSE input, representing the state
of an external device.
[spacer] GOOSE: Ext .De v01 int erm.pos 109 003
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Binary intermediate position state of the virtual two-pole GOOSE input,
representing the state of an external device.
[spacer] GOOSE: IE D link f ault y 107 250
0: No
[spacer]
Display which appears as soon as receipt of at least one of the configured
GOOSEs is faulty or not available. To each GOOSE the GOOSE sending device
will attach a validity stamp, up to which a repetition of GOOSE will be carried out
independent of a change of state. Thus the unit monitors the time period at
which the next state signal must be received.
[spacer] GOOSE: IE D01-16 link ed 107 251
2:
2:
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
2:
2:
2:
2:
2:
2:
2:
2:
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
Binary and analog OUTP: Block outp.r el. EXT 040 014
output
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
output
1: Yes
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
1: Yes
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: Standard time
0: No
1: Yes
[spacer]
Signal that the protection unit is operational. By default this signal is linked to
LED: F ct.ass ig. H 1 gre e n.
[spacer] MAIN: Tim e s yn chr oniz ed 009 109
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
In the case of direct motor control by motor relay K200 this fault signal is issued
(as a group signal) when no positive position signal (status signal) has been
received from the external device after it has been issued a close command and
the set running time-delay has elapsed.
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
Signal that the chatter suppression has started.
[spacer] MAIN: DC fail. cmd. End 221 108
0: No
[spacer]
In the case of direct motor control by motor relay K200 this signal is issued if the
K200 contacts have not reopened after the set monitoring time-delay has
elapsed.
[spacer] MAIN: DC fail. cmd.st art 221 109
0: No
[spacer]
In the case of direct motor control by motor relay K200 this signal is issued if the
K200 contacts have not closed after the set monitoring time-delay has elapsed.
[spacer] MAIN: St artcm dt ime e xce e d. 221 112
[spacer]
If the monitoring, set by D EV01 : St artC mdTime superv. (or
DEV02: S tartCm dTi me superv . etc.), is active then an exceeded timer is
flagged by this logic state signal.
[spacer] MAIN: Shunt t rip ove rr un 221 114
[spacer]
Signal that any of the operated switchgear units happens to end up in a faulty
position after termination of the switching command.
[spacer] MAIN: Mult. sig . 1 act iv e 221 017
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
1: Yes
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
selection
0: No
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
recording
0: No Fig. 3-93, (p. 3-134)
Parameter Address
recording
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
recording
0: No
Parameter Address
acquisition
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
current protection
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
rent protection
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
1: Yes
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
direction
determination
0: No Fig. 3-158, (p. 3-210)
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
protection
0: No
Parameter Address
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
control
0: No
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
synchronism check
0: No
[spacer]
This parameter allows to select the ASC input source via binary input,
communication protocol signal or programmable logic. (See setting (016 222)
ASC: Me as.V(T90 ) USE R PS x for details.)
[spacer] ASC: Me as.V(T90 ) act ive 016 240
[spacer]
Signal that reports which voltage(s) the ASC function is currently using for the
operating modes “voltage-checked close enable” and “voltage/synchronism-
checked close enable”.
● The value No means that the three phase-to-ground voltages are checked.
● The value Yes means that the (single-phase) voltage measured at
transformer T90 is checked.
(See also parameters (016 222) ASC: M e as. V(T 90) U SER PSx, (016 221)
ASC: Me as .V(T 90) EX T.)
[spacer] ASC: R es et coun ter s E XT 006 074
0: No
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Close request via external signal for a test triggering of the ASC in operating
mode automatic reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: Te s t M C clos e r. EXT 037 064
0: No
[spacer]
Close request via external signal for a test triggering of the ASC in operating
mode manual reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: Enab l.close re qu.E X T 037 063
1: Yes
0: No
[spacer]
Close request via external signal for a triggering of the ASC in operating mode
manual reclosure.
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
Close request via external signal for a triggering of the ASC in operating mode
automatic reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: Ext./us e r enabled 037 092
[spacer]
Signaling of a close request for a test triggering of the ASC in operating mode
automatic reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: Te s t M C close re qu. 034 019
[spacer]
Signaling of a close request for a test triggering of the ASC in operating mode
manual reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: AR Clos e r e ques t 008 239
[spacer]
Signaling of a close request for a triggering of the ASC in operating mode
automatic reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: MC Close r eques t 034 018
[spacer]
Signaling of a close request for a triggering of the ASC in operating mode
manual reclosure.
[spacer] ASC: Cycle running 038 019
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
direction
determination using
steady-state values
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
protection
0: No
0: No
0: No
1: Yes
0: No
Parameter Address
tion
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
tion
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
underfrequency pro‐
tection
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
shedding
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
protection
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
directional reactive
power protection
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
failure protection
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
0: No
1: Yes
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Signal that the residual current is greater than the set value CBF: IN<.
[spacer] CBF: S tartup 3p 038 211
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
condition monitoring
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: No Fig. 3-308, (p. 3-384)
[spacer]
This parameter allows to block the “Fuse Failure” monitoring of the reference
voltage via binary input (e. g. from circuit breaker auxiliary contacts) or
programmable logic.
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: No Fig. 3-311, (p. 3-389)
Fig. 3-315, (p. 3-393)
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: Not triggered
0: Not triggered
0: Not triggered
Parameter Address
0: Not triggered
0: Not triggered
Parameter Address
monitoring
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
2: Not configured
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Warning that the number of switching commands has exceeded the set limit
value.
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: Intermediate pos.
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Signaling of the rotating direction of the motor.
[spacer] TPD1: W arning op.count. 219 007
[spacer]
Warning that the number of switching commands has exceeded the set limit
value.
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
commands
0: No Fig. 3-355, (p. 3-442)
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Output of the respective equation of the interlocking logic.
These logic state signals are transmitted with the request for a switching
operation, and cyclically (according to the setting ILO CK: Cycle t
inte rl.che ck).
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
[spacer]
Warning that the counter value has exceeded the set limit value.
Parameter Address
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
Parameter Address
0: No
[spacer]
Setting the enable for changing values from the local control panel.
Parameter Address
communication
interface 1
060 000: MAIN: Without function Fig. 3-19, (p. 3-27)
[spacer]
Signal selection for testing purposes.
[spacer] COMM 1: Tes t s pont .s ig.s t ar t 003 184
[spacer]
Triggering of transmission of a selected signal as “starting”.
[spacer] COMM 1: Tes t s pont .s ig. end 003 186
[spacer]
Triggering of transmission of a selected signal as “ending”.
[spacer] COMM 1: Se l. po s. dev. tes t 221 105
0: Not assigned
[spacer]
Select a device DEVxx for testing the transmission of switchgear device position
in monitoring direction.
[spacer] COMM 1: Tes t p osition de v. 221 106
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Carry out a test to check the transmission of switchgear device position in
monitoring direction for the device selected at C OMM1: S el. pos .
dev.test.
Parameter Address
communication
interface 2
060 000: MAIN: Without function Fig. 3-21, (p. 3-30)
[spacer]
Signal selection for testing purposes.
[spacer] COMM 2: Tes t s pont .s ig.s t ar t 103 184
[spacer]
Triggering of transmission of a selected signal as "starting".
[spacer] COMM 2: Tes t s pont .s ig. end 103 186
[spacer]
Triggering of transmission of a selected signal as "ending".
Parameter Address
interface
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Resetting counter for number of telegram errors.
[spacer] COMM 3: Se nd s ignal for t es t 120 050
0: None
1: 1
0: don't execute
170 0 255
[spacer]
Setting a bit pattern consisting of 3 bits.
[spacer] COMM 3: Loop back t est 120 054
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Carrying out a loop back test with the PCOMM interface.
[spacer] COMM 3: Hold time for te s t 120 052
10 1 600 s
[spacer]
Selecting the hold time (in seconds) for the functional testing.
Parameter Address
Communication
060 000: MAIN: Without function Fig. 3-30, (p. 3-56)
0: Not assigned
0: don't execute
Parameter Address
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Resetting measured maximum temperatures Tmax and Tmax Tx (x=1...9) to
updated measured values.
Parameter Address
output
0: don't execute Fig. 3-43, (p. 3-72)
[spacer]
Reset of latched output relays from the user interface.
[spacer] OUTP: Re lay assign. f.t e st 003 042
[spacer]
Selection of the relay to be tested.
[spacer] OUTP: Re lay te st 003 043
[spacer]
The relay selected for testing is triggered for the duration set at OUTP: H ol d -
time f or tes t.
[spacer] OUTP: Hold- tim e for t e st 003 044
[spacer]
Setting for the time period for which the selected output relay is triggered for
functional testing.
Parameter Address
output
0: don't execute Fig. 3-47, (p. 3-75)
[spacer]
Resetting the measured data output function.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Reset of the following memories:
● All counters
● LED indicators
● Operating data memory
● All event memories
● Event counters
● Fault data
● Measured overload data
● Recorded fault values
[spacer] MAIN: Enable sys t. IN US ER 003 142
[spacer]
Enabling the residual current stages of the DTOC/IDMT protection.
[spacer] MAIN: Dis able s yst .IN US E R 003 141
[spacer]
Disabling the residual current stages of the DTOC/IDMT protection.
[spacer] MAIN: Re s e t indicat. USE R 021 010
[spacer]
Reset of the following displays:
● LED indicators
● Fault data
[spacer] MAIN: Rs e t .lat ch.t rip US ER 021 005
[spacer]
Reset of latched trip commands from the local control panel.
[spacer] MAIN: Re s e t c. cl/ t r. cUS ER 003 007
[spacer]
The counters for counting the close and trip commands are reset.
[spacer] MAIN: Re s e t IP,max,s t .USER 003 033
[spacer]
The display of the stored maximum phase current is reset.
[spacer] MAIN: Re s e t m eas .v. en.USE R 003 032
[spacer]
The display of active and reactive energy output and input is reset.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Group of resetting commands.
[spacer] MAIN: Man. trip cmd. US ER 003 040
[spacer]
A 100 ms trip command is issued from the local control panel.
Note: The command is only executed if the manual trip command has been
configured as trip command 1 or 2.
[spacer] MAIN: Man.cl.cmd.e nablUS E R 003 105
[spacer]
Setting the enable for the issue of a close command from the local control panel
(enables manual breaker close operations).
[spacer] MAIN: Man. clos e cmd. US ER 018 033
[spacer]
A close command is issued from the local control panel for the set reclose
command time.
[spacer] MAIN: Sof t War m re st art 003 039
0: don't execute
[spacer]
A warm restart of the software is carried out. The device functions as it does
when the power supply is turned on, except that no hardware tests are carried
out.
[spacer] MAIN: Warm re star t 010 166
0: don't execute
[spacer]
A warm restart is carried out. The device functions as it does when the power
supply is turned on.
[spacer] MAIN: Sof t Cold re star t 000 085
0: don't execute
[spacer]
A cold restart of the software is carried out. This means that all settings and
recordings are cleared, but no tests of the hardware are carried out during the
restart. Parameter values used by the P139 after a cold restart have been
selected in such a manner that the P139 is blocked after a cold restart.
[spacer] MAIN: Cold rest art 009 254
0: don't execute
[spacer]
A cold restart is carried out. A cold restart means that all settings and recordings
are cleared. Parameter values used by the P139 after a cold restart have been
selected in such a manner that the P139 is blocked after a cold restart.
Parameter Address
recording
0: don't execute Fig. 3-98, (p. 3-142)
[spacer]
The operating data memory and the counter for operation signals are reset.
Parameter Address
recording
0: don't execute Fig. 3-99, (p. 3-143)
[spacer]
Reset of the monitoring signal memory.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Reset of the overload memory.
Parameter Address
recording
0: don't execute Fig. 3-113, (p. 3-155)
[spacer]
Reset of the ground fault memory.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Fault recording is enabled from the local control panel for 500 ms.
[spacer] FT_RC: Res et record. USE R 003 006
[spacer]
Reset of the following memories:
● LED indicators
● Fault memory
● Fault counter
● Fault data
● Recorded fault values
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Protective signaling is enabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] PSIG: Dis able US ER 003 131
[spacer]
Protective signaling is disabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] PSIG: Tes t telecom. USE R 015 009
[spacer]
A send signal is issued for 500 ms.
Parameter Address
control
0: don't execute Fig. 3-176, (p. 3-234)
[spacer]
The auto-reclosing control function is enabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] ARC: Disable USER 003 133
[spacer]
The auto-reclosing control function is disabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] ARC: T est HS R A-B- C US ER 011 066
[spacer]
A three-pole test HSR is triggered.
[spacer] ARC: R ese t counte rs US ER 003 005
[spacer]
The ARC counters are reset.
Parameter Address
synchronism check
0: don't execute Fig. 3-195, (p. 3-259)
[spacer]
Automatic synchronism check is enabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] ASC: Disable USER 003 135
[spacer]
Automatic synchronism check is disabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] ASC: AR close re qu. US E R 008 238
[spacer]
A close request is issued with Automatic Reclose parameters. This will trigger
the ASC functional operation. A close command is transmitted to the CB if the
check of the ASC is positive.
[spacer] ASC: MC clos e r e qu. USE R 018 004
[spacer]
A close request is issued from the integrated local control panel. This will trigger
the ASC functional operation. A close command is transmitted to the CB if the
check of the ASC is positive.
[spacer] ASC: Te s t AR clos e r .US ER 008 237
[spacer]
A close request is issued with Automatic Reclose parameters. This will trigger
the ASC functional operation. No close command is transmitted to the CB if the
check of the ASC is positive. Only a signal is issued.
[spacer] ASC: Te s t M C clos e r.USER 018 005
[spacer]
A close request is issued from the integrated local control panel. This will trigger
the ASC functional operation. No close command is transmitted to the CB if the
check of the ASC is positive. Only a signal is issued.
[spacer] ASC: R es et coun ter s US ER 003 089
[spacer]
The ASC counters are reset.
Parameter Address
direction
determination using
steady-state values
0: don't execute Fig. 3-218, (p. 3-284)
Fig. 3-224, (p. 3-290)
[spacer]
The counters for the ground fault direction determination function using steady-
state values are reset.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The direction decisions can be reset while the buffer time is elapsing.
[spacer] TGFD: R es et counte rs US ER 003 022
[spacer]
The counters for the transient ground fault direction determination function are
reset.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Resetting the thermal replica of the motor protection function.
[spacer] MP: I nitialize Hours _Run 025 151
0: don't execute
[spacer]
In order to set the default value for the operating hours, this parameter should
be set to “execute”.
[spacer] MP: I nit. val. Hours _R un 025 154
Blocked 0 65000 h
[spacer]
Setting for the default value of the operating hours counter.
Parameter Address
protection
0: don't execute Fig. 3-246, (p. 3-324)
[spacer]
Resetting the thermal replica of the thermal overload protection function.
Parameter Address
underfrequency pro‐
tection
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Resetting the measured event values f<>: M ax. frequ. for
f> and f<>: Min. fre qu. for f<.
Parameter Address
shedding
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
Parameter Address
failure protection
0: don't execute Fig. 3-288, (p. 3-366)
[spacer]
Circuit breaker failure protection is enabled from the local control panel.
[spacer] CBF: Disable USER 003 015
[spacer]
Circuit breaker failure protection is disabled from the local control panel.
Parameter Address
condition monitoring
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Values are initialized to trigger circuit breaker condition monitoring.
[spacer] CBM: R e se t m eas .val . USER 003 013
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Resetting circuit breaker condition monitoring
[spacer] CBM: S e t No. CB oper. A 022 131
Blocked 0 65000
Blocked 0 65000
[spacer]
Set the number of CB operations.
[spacer] CBM: S e t remain. CB op. A 022 134
Blocked 0 65000
Blocked 0 65000
[spacer]
Set the remaining CB operations.
[spacer] CBM: S e t Σ Itrip A 022 137
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Set the limit values for the ruptured currents and their squares. (An alarm is
displayed if these limit values are exceeded.)
Parameter Address
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
0: don't execute
[spacer]
Intervention in the logic at the appropriate point by a 100 ms pulse.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Count transmission.
[spacer] COUNT : Re s e t USE R 217 003
[spacer]
Count reset.
Parameter Address
recording
0 0 1000 Fig. 3-98, (p. 3-142)
[spacer]
Point of entry into the operating data log.
Parameter Address
recording
0 0 30 Fig. 3-99, (p. 3-143)
[spacer]
Point of entry into the monitoring signal log.
8.2 Events
Parameter Address
interface
0 0 65535
[spacer]
Number of corrupted telegrams.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Number of general starting signals.
[spacer] MAIN: CB1 act. oper . cap. 221 087
1 1 99
1 1 99
[spacer]
Setting for the maximum number of CB operations for an ARC cycle (or for a
limited time period).
[spacer] MAIN: No. g en.t ri p cmds . 1 004 006
[spacer]
Number of general trip commands 1.
[spacer] MAIN: No. g en.t ri p cmds . 2 009 050
[spacer]
Number of general trip commands 2.
[spacer] MAIN: No. g en.t ri p cmds . 3 009 056
[spacer]
Number of general trip commands 3.
[spacer] MAIN: No. g en.t ri p cmds . 4 009 057
[spacer]
Number of general trip commands 4.
[spacer] MAIN: No. close c ommands 009 055
[spacer]
Number of close commands.
[spacer] MAIN: No. m otor dri ve op. 221 025
[spacer]
Number of times external devices with direct motor control are activated during
the monitoring time.
[spacer] MAIN: No.overfl .act.e n. out 009 090
[spacer]
Counter for the number of times the measuring range of the active energy
output was exceeded.
Note: The maximum value of this counter is 10000.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Counter for the number of times the measuring range of the active energy input
was exceeded.
Note: The maximum value of this counter is 10000.
[spacer] MAIN: No.ov/f l.reac.e n.out 009 092
[spacer]
Counter for the number of times the measuring range of the reactive energy
output was exceeded.
Note: The maximum value of this counter is 10000.
[spacer] MAIN: No.ov/f l.reac.e n.inp 009 093
[spacer]
Counter for the number of times the measuring range of the reactive energy
input was exceeded.
Note: The maximum value of this counter is 10000.
Parameter Address
recording
0 0 1000 Fig. 3-98, (p. 3-142)
[spacer]
Number of signals stored in the operating data memory.
Parameter Address
recording
0 0 30 Fig. 3-99, (p. 3-143)
[spacer]
Number of signals stored in the monitoring signal memory.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Number of overload events.
Parameter Address
recording
0 0 9999 Fig. 3-112, (p. 3-154)
[spacer]
Number of ground faults.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Number of faults.
[spacer] FT_RC: No. sys te m dis t urb. 004 010
[spacer]
Number of system disturbances.
Parameter Address
control
0: don't execute Fig. 3-192, (p. 3-254)
[spacer]
Number of high-speed reclosures.
[spacer] ARC: Num be r T DR 004 008
[spacer]
Number of time-delay reclosures.
[spacer] ARC: No. HS R succe ss f ul 016 198
[spacer]
Number of OC reclosures.
[spacer] ARC: No. HS R unsucce ss ful 016 199
[spacer]
Number of OCO reclosures.
[spacer] ARC: No. TDR s ucc ess ful 016 211
[spacer]
Number of OCOC reclosures.
[spacer] ARC: No. TDR uns ucc essful 016 212
[spacer]
Number of OCOCO reclosures.
Parameter Address
synchronism check
0: don't execute Fig. 3-209, (p. 3-274)
[spacer]
Number of reclosures after a manual close request.
[spacer] ASC: No. clos e re que st s 009 033
[spacer]
Number of close requests.
[spacer] ASC: No. clos e re je ct ions 009 034
[spacer]
Number of close rejections.
Parameter Address
direction
determination using
steady-state values
0: don't execute Fig. 3-224, (p. 3-290)
[spacer]
Number of ground faults detected by steady-state power evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : No. GF (curr . meas ) 009 003
[spacer]
Number of ground faults detected by steady-state current evaluation.
[spacer] GFDSS : No. GF admit t. Y( N) 009 060
[spacer]
Number of ground faults (non-directional) detected by the admittance
evaluation method.
[spacer] GFDSS : No. GF f orward/ LS 009 000
[spacer]
Number of ground faults in the forward direction.
[spacer] GFDSS : No. GF back ward/ BS 009 001
[spacer]
Number of ground faults in the backward direction.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Number of transient ground faults.
[spacer] TGFD: No. GF fo rward/LS 004 013
[spacer]
Number of transient ground faults in the forward direction.
[spacer] TGFD: No. GF bac kward/B S 004 014
[spacer]
Number of ground faults in the backward direction.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Number of motor startups since the last reset.
[spacer] MP: No. of hours run 025 150
0 0 65000 h
[spacer]
Number of operating hours since the last reset.
Parameter Address
condition monitoring
0 0 65000 Fig. 3-303, (p. 3-379)
0 0 65000
0 0 65000
[spacer]
Number of mechanical switching operations made.
[spacer] CBM: R e main. No. CB op. A 008 014
30000 0 65000
30000 0 65000
[spacer]
Number of remaining switching operations (as shown by evaluating wear with
reference to the CB wear characteristic).
Parameter Address
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
[spacer]
Number of switching operations made. It is also possible to manually set this
counter to any value from 0 to 65535.
[spacer] DEV01: De v. op. c apabi li ty 210 003
1 1 99
1 1 99
1 1 99
1 1 99
1 1 99
1 1 99
1 1 99
1 1 99
Parameter Address
1 1 99
1 1 99
[spacer]
Number of remaining switching operations. It is also possible to manually set
this counter to any value from 1 to 99.
Parameter Address
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
0 0 65535
[spacer]
Number of switching operations made. It is also possible to manually set this
counter to any value from 0 to 65535.
Parameter Address
acquisition
Not measured 0.0 6500.0 s Fig. 3-100, (p. 3-144)
[spacer]
Duration of the overload event.
[spacer] OL_DA: T .taken f.s tar tup, MP 005 096
[spacer]
Display of the motor startup time.
[spacer] OL_DA: S tar t- up curr ent, MP 005 098
[spacer]
Display of the motor startup current.
[spacer] OL_DA: Heat.dur.star t-up,MP 005 097
[spacer]
Display of startup heating in motor protection.
[spacer] OL_DA: S tatus THERM r e pl ic a 004 147
[spacer]
Display of the buffer content of the thermal overload protection function.
[spacer] OL_DA: L oad curre nt T HERM 004 058
[spacer]
Display of the load current used by the thermal overload protection function to
calculate the tripping time.
[spacer] OL_DA: Ob ject t emp. THE RM 004 035
[spacer]
Display of the temperature of the protected object.
[spacer] OL_DA: C oolant te mp. T HERM 004 036
[spacer]
Display of coolant temperature, dependent on the setting for THE RM: Sel ect
meas .inputPS x.
When set to None the set temperature value will be displayed. When set to
PT100 the temperature measured by the resistance thermometer will be
displayed. When set to 20mA input the temperature measured via an external
20 mA transducer will be displayed.
[spacer] OL_DA: Pre - trip t .le ft THE RM 004 148
[spacer]
Display of the time remaining before the thermal overload protection function
will reach the tripping threshold (“time-to-trip”).
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the additional reserve if coolant temperature is taken into account
and if the measured coolant temperature is lower than the set maximum
permissible coolant temperature. (In this case, the thermal model has been
shifted downwards.)
If there is no coolant temperature acquisition and if the coolant temperature and
the maximum permissible coolant temperature have been set to the same
value, then the coolant temperature is not taken into account and the
characteristic is a function of the current only. The additional reserve amounts
to 0 in this case.
Parameter Address
Ground fault data GF_DA: Ground flt . dur ation 009 100
acquisition
Not measured 0.0 6500.0 min Fig. 3-105, (p. 3-148)
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault duration of the most recent ground fault.
[spacer] GF_DA: GF durati on pow.me as 009 024
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault duration of the most recent ground fault as
determined by the steady-state power evaluation feature of the ground fault
direction determination function.
[spacer] GF_DA: Voltage VNG p.u. 009 020
[spacer]
Display of the neutral-displacement voltage of the most recent ground fault
referred to Vnom.
Note: This display is only active if the steady-state power evaluation mode of
the ground fault direction determination function is enabled.
[spacer] GF_DA: Current IN p. u. 009 021
[spacer]
Display of the residual current of the most recent ground fault referred to Inom.
Note: This display is only active when the ground fault direction determination
function using steady state values (GFDSS) is enabled.
[spacer] GF_DA: Curr. IN ,act p.u. 009 022
[spacer]
Display of the active component of the residual current of the most recent
ground fault referred to Inom.
Note: This display is only active if the steady-state power evaluation mode of
the ground fault direction determination function is enabled.
[spacer] GF_DA: Curr. IN ,re ac p. u. 009 023
[spacer]
Display of the reactive component of the residual current of the most recent
ground fault referred to Inom.
Note: This display is only active if the steady-state power evaluation mode of
the ground fault direction determination function is enabled.
[spacer] GF_DA: GF durat. cur r.meas. 009 026
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault duration of the most recent ground fault as
determined by the steady-state current evaluation feature of the ground fault
direction determination function.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the residual current component having the set filter frequency for the
most recent ground fault (referred to Inom).
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault duration of the most recent ground fault as
determined by the admittance evaluation mode of the ground fault direction
determination function.
[spacer] GF_DA: Admitt ance Y (N) p.u. 009 065
[spacer]
Display of the admittance value referred to YN,nom.
Note:
If GFDS S: Evaluation VNG P Sx is set to Measured:
YN,nom = IN,nom / VNG,nom
If GF DS S: Evaluati on VNG P Sx is set to Calculated:
YN,nom = IN,nom / Vnom
[spacer]
Display of the conductance value referred to YN,nom.
Note:
If GFDS S : Evaluation VNG P Sx is set to Measured:
YN,nom = IN,nom / VNG,nom
If GFDSS : Evaluation VNG P Sx is set to Calculated:
YN,nom = IN,nom / Vnom
[spacer]
Display of the susceptance value referred to YN,nom.
Note:
If GFDS S: Evaluat ion VNG PS x is set to Measured:
YN,nom = IN,nom / VNG,nom
If GF DSS : Evaluation VNG PSx is set to Calculated:
YN,nom = IN,nom / Vnom
Parameter Address
acquisition
Not measured 0.0 60.0 s Fig. 3-114, (p. 3-156)
[spacer]
Display of the fault duration.
[spacer] FT_DA: Running t ime 004 021
[spacer]
Display of the running time.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault t ype 010 198
[spacer]
Display of the fault type. This value is determined from the starting signals of
the function group MAIN.
[spacer] FT_DA: Me as . loop s ele ct e d 004 079
[spacer]
Display of the measuring loop selected for determination of fault data.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault curre nt P p.u. 004 025
[spacer]
Display of the fault current referred to Inom.
[spacer]
Display of the fault voltage as a primary quantity.
[spacer] FT_DA: Flt.volt . PG/ P P p.u. 004 026
[spacer]
Display of the fault voltage referred to Vnom.
[spacer]
Display of the fault angle.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault curr. N pri m. 010 216
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault current as a primary quantity.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault curr. N p.u. 004 049
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault current referred to IN,nom.
[spacer]
Display of the ground fault angle.
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Display of the fault reactance as a primary quantity.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault react ance, se c. 004 028
[spacer]
Display of the fault reactance as a secondary quantity.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault im pedance , s e c 004 023
[spacer]
Display of the fault impedance as a secondary quantity.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault locat. pe rce nt 004 027
[spacer]
Display of the fault location of the last fault (in %) referred to the setting at
FT_DA: Line reactance P S x.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault curre nt P prim 010 199
[spacer]
Display of the fault current as a primary quantity.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault location 004 022
[spacer]
Display of the fault location of the last fault in km.
[spacer] FT_DA: Fault im pedance ,pr im 024 004
Parameter Address
synchronism check
Not measured 0.000 3.000 Vnom Fig. 3-208, (p. 3-274)
[spacer]
Display of the difference between amplitudes of the measurement loop voltage
and the reference voltage during a close request, referred to Vnom. The display
only appears if ASC is operating.
[spacer] ASC: Angle dif fe re nce 004 089
[spacer]
Display of the angle difference between measured voltage and reference
voltage at the time of the close request (in degrees).
This display only appears when the automatic synchronism check function is
active.
[spacer] ASC: Fre qu. dif fe re nce 004 090
[spacer]
Display of the frequency difference between measured voltage and reference
voltage at the time of the close request (in Hz). This display only appears when
the automatic synchronism check function is active.
Parameter Address
underfrequency pro‐
tection
Not measured 12.00 70.00 Hz
[spacer]
Maximum frequency during an overfrequency condition.
[spacer] f<> : M in. frequ. for f< 005 001
[spacer]
Minimum frequency during an underfrequency condition.
Parameter Address
condition monitoring
Not measured 0 65000 A Fig. 3-303, (p. 3-379)
[spacer]
Ruptured currents and their squared values.
[spacer] CBM: ΣItr ip A 009 071
0 0 65000 Inom,CB
0 0 65000 Inom,CB
[spacer]
Sum of the per-unit ruptured currents for each circuit breaker contact.
[spacer] CBM: ΣItr ip **2 A 009 077
0 0 65000 Inom,CB**
2
Parameter Address
0 0 65000 Inom,CB**
2
[spacer]
Sum of the squared per-unit ruptured currents for each circuit breaker contact.
[spacer] CBM: I *t A 009 061
[spacer]
Current-time integral of the per-unit ruptured current for each circuit breaker
contact.
[spacer] CBM: ΣI* t A 009 087
[spacer]
Sum of the current-time integrals of the per-unit ruptured currents for each
circuit breaker contact.
Parameter Address
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
[spacer]
Point of entry into the overload log.
Parameter Address
recording
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
[spacer]
Point of entry into the ground fault log.
Parameter Address
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
0 0 9999
[spacer]
Point of entry into the fault log.
Parameter
Name of the configuration bank currently valid. Setting is carried out with the
IED Configurator, after a connection with the device has been established (via
menu item “Manage IED”).
Version number of the configuration bank currently valid. Setting is carried out
with the IED Configurator, after a connection with the device has been
established (via menu item “Manage IED”).
Parameter
Name of the inactive configuration bank. Setting is carried out with the IED
Configurator, after a connection with the device has been established (via menu
item “Manage IED”).
Version number of the inactive configuration bank. Setting is carried out with
the IED Configurator, after a connection with the device has been established
(via menu item “Manage IED”).
Identification of the .MCL configuration file. If required, this preset value may be
modified by, for example, entering a bay name.
Specific value to identify the IEC 61850 data model and configuration.
If required, this preset value may be modified by, for example, identifying the
revision states during engineering.
Parameter Address
Explicitly assigned device name for the function in the system (IED); is part of
the Logical Device Name.
Important note: According to the IEC standard the name must consist of only
letters (A..Z, a..z), digits (0..9) and underscore characters (_), and the name
must start with a letter. Note that a non-standard name causes problems with
the IEC 61850 communication.
Parameter
Description
Type
Configuration Revision
Supported Models
The values listed in the column “Template Details” only provide information.
They are preset and cannot be modified.
9.3 Communications
The category “Communications” contains the general network-related settings.
Assigned IP address of the Interface1 of P139 for the server function in the
system.
The subnet mask defines which part of the IP address is addressed by the sub-
network and which part by the device that is logged-on to the network.
This parameter shows the IPv4 address of the network gateway for
communication links to clients outside of the local network.
Assigned IP address of the Interface2 of P139 for the server function in the
system.
The subnet mask defines which part of the IP address is addressed by the sub-
network and which part by the device that is logged-on to the network.
This parameter shows the IPv4 address of the network gateway for
communication links to clients outside of the local network.
2 104 096
The subnet mask of VLAN defines which part of the IP address is addressed by
the sub-network and which part by the device that is logged-on to the network.
This parameter shows the IPv4 address of the network gateway of the VLAN for
communication links to clients outside of the local network.
Checkbox to enable/disable web services for the SAT tool to configure security
and the RBAC.
Return time period for setting procedures that have commenced. (The default
value above is in seconds. The IED Configurator, however, displays converts this
to minutes.)
9.4 SNTP
The category “SNTP” contains the clock synchronization settings.
Parameter
Location
Contents
9.6.1 System/LLN0
Virtual MAC address that the sending device provides as the destination; preset.
ID-number of the virtual LAN with which the GOOSE is sent; preset.
VLAN Priority 4
Priority with which the GOOSE is sent in the virtual LAN; preset.
First send repetition of the GOOSE occurring after the set time period; preset.
Continuous send repetition of the GOOSE occurring after the set time period;
preset.
Increment 900
Specification factor for the transition of time intervals for GOOSE send
repetitions from the first to the continuous repetition.
GOOSE ID consisting of the Device Name and the GOOSE Control Block.
Dataset Reference
Configuration Revision 1
Application ID (hex) 0
GOOSE Identifier
Dataset Reference
Configuration Revision 0
Distance of the quality descriptor to the data object if not preset. The quality of
the received information is to be tested if such has been configured.
Default value for the information in case GOOSE receipt has failed.
● False – not set
● True – set
● Last Known Value – retain last value received
● Double Point: intermediate (00) – switching device in intermediate position
● Double Point: Off (01) – switching device open
● Double Point: On (10) – switching device closed
● Double Point: Bad state (11) – switching device in intermediate position
9.8.1 System/LLN0
Report type:
● Unbuffered (updating)
● Buffered (saving)
Report ID TEMPLATESystem/
LLN0$RP
$urcbA, ...,
TEMPLATESystem/
LLN0$RP
$urcbP, ...,
TEMPLATESystem/
LLN0$BR
$brcbA, ...,
TEMPLATESystem/
LLN0$BR$brcbH
Report ID consisting of the Device Name and the Report Control Block.
Dataset Reference
Configuration Revision 1
9.9 Controls
Parameter
sboTimeout
Application ID (hex) 0
GOOSE Identifier
Dataset Reference
Configuration Revision 0
Default value for the information in case GOOSE receipt has failed:
● False – not set
● True – set
● Last Known Value – retain last value received
● Double Point: intermediate (00) – switching device in intermediate position
● Double Point: Off (01) – switching device open
● Double Point: On (10) – switching device closed
● Double Point: Bad state (11) – switching device in intermediate position
9.10 Measurements
Parameter
Parameter
Multiplier for the smallest display value of the measured value. In order to have
the current measured value sent when it has changed from the value last sent
the result of the set dead band value multiplied by the smallest display value
must exceed the smallest display value.
9.11.1 System/LLN0
Parameter
Mod.measCyc Value
Parameter
Mod.enCyc Value
Cyclic transmission of measured values without dead band check: Time interval
in seconds between transmissions of two energy count values.
Parameter
Mod.comtrade Value
Parameter
Mod.distExtr Value
10 Commissioning
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Only qualified personnel, trained, authorized and familiar with the device
and all the safety instructions in the general Safety Guide (SFTY/5LM/L11
or later version) and appropriate Chapter 5, Chapter 10, Chapter 11,
Chapter 12 and Chapter 13 of this manual, shall work on installation,
connection, commissioning, maintenance or servicing of this device.
⚫ When installing and connecting the device the warning notices at the
beginning of Chapter “Installation and Connection” (Chapter 5) must be
observed.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Switch off the auxiliary power supply before any work in the terminal strip
area.
⚫ Switch off all the power supplies in connection to the equipment before
any work in the terminal strip area to isolate the device.
⚫ Do not touch the terminal strip area when equipment is in operation.
⚫ Do not remove or add wires in the terminal strip area when equipment is
in operation.
⚫ Short-circuit the system current transformers before disconnecting wires
to the transformer board (valid only for pin terminals, not required for ring
terminals which have a shortening block).
⚫ A protective conductor (ground/earth) of at least 1.5 mm2 must be
connected to the protective conductor terminal on the power supply board
and on the main relay case.
⚫ Do never remove the protective conductor connection to the device casing
as long as other wires are connected to it.
⚫ Where stranded conductors are used, insulated crimped wire end ferrules
must be employed.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Note: Regarding the appropriate wiring connections of the equipment refer to the
document Px3x_Grounding_Application_Guide_EN_h.pdf.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The device must be reliably grounded to meet protective equipment
grounding requirements.
⚫ The surface-mounted case is grounded using the bolt and nut,
appropriately marked, as the ground connection. The flush-mounted case
must be grounded in the area of the rear sidepieces at the location
provided. The bracket is marked with the protective ground symbol: .
The cross-section of the ground conductor must conform to applicable
national standards. A minimum cross section of 2.5 mm² (≤ AWG12) is
required.
⚫ In addition, a protective ground connection at the terminal contact on the
power supply module (identified by the letters “PE” on the terminal
connection diagram) is also required for proper operation of the device.
The cross-section of this ground conductor must also conform to applicable
national standards. A minimum cross section of 1.5 mm² (US: AWG14 or
thicker) is required.
⚫ If a detachable HMI is installed, a further protective conductor (ground/
earth) of at least 1.5 mm² (US: AWG14 or thicker) must be connected to
the DHMI protective conductor terminal to link the DHMI and the main
relay case; these must be located within the same substation.
⚫ All grounding connections must be low-inductance, i.e. it must be kept as
short as possible.
⚫ The protective conductor (earth) must always be connected to the
protective grounding conductor terminal in order to guarantee the safety
given by this setup.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog signals to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
⚫ Do not open the secondary circuit of live system current transformers! If
the secondary circuit of a live CT is opened, there is the danger that the
resulting voltages will endanger personnel and damage the insulation.
⚫ For pin-terminal connection devices, the terminal block for system current
transformer connection is not a shorting block! Therefore always short-
circuit the system current transformers before loosening the threaded
terminals.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The power supply must be turned off for at least 5 s before power supply
module V is removed. Otherwise there is the danger of an electric shock.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ When increased-safety machinery is located in a hazardous area the
device must always be installed outside of this hazardous area to protect
this equipment.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The PC interface is not designed as a permanent connection.
Consequently, the female connector does not have the extra insulation
from circuits connected to the system that is required per IEC/EN
60255-27. Therefore DO NOT leave any permanent cable connection on
the PC interface connector at the HMI front panel.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Do not connect or disconnect the RS 485 or fiber-optic interface when the
supply voltage for the device is under power and in operation.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
HAZARD OF UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION
⚫ When using the programmable logic (function group LOGIC), the user must
carry out a functional type test to conform to the requirements of the
relevant protection/control application.
⚫ In particular, it is necessary to verify that the requirements for the
implementation of logic linking (by setting) as well as the time
performance during device startup, during operation and when there is a
fault (device blocking) are fulfilled.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unintended
equipment operation.
10.2.1 Preparation
After the P139 has been installed and connected as described in Chapter 5, (p. 5-
1), the commissioning procedure can begin.
Before turning on the power supply voltage, the following items must be checked
again:
● Is the device connected to the protective ground at the specified location?
● Does the nominal voltage of the battery agree with the nominal auxiliary
voltage of the device?
● Are the current and voltage transformer connections, grounding, and phase
sequences correct?
After the wiring work is completed, check the system to make sure it is properly
isolated. The conditions given in IEC/EN 60255-27 must be satisfied.
Once all checks have been made, the power supply voltage may be turned on.
After voltage has been applied, the device starts up. During startup, various
startup tests are carried out (see Section 3.14, (p. 3-139)). The LED indicators for
HEALTHY (H1) and OUT OF SERVICE (H2) will light up. After approximately 15 s,
the P139 is ready for operation. By default (factory setting) or after a cold restart,
the device type “P139” and the time are displayed on the first line of the LCD
after the device has started up. If a bay type has already been selected this bay
will then be shown as a single-pole display.
Once the change enabling command has been issued (see Section 6.12.3, (p. 6-
33)), all settings can be entered. The procedure for entering settings from the
integrated local control panel is described in Section 6.12.4, (p. 6-36).
If either the PC interface or the communication interface will be used for setting
the P139 and reading out event records, then the following settings must first be
made from the integrated local control panel.
The settings given above apply to the IEC 60870-5-103 communication protocol. If
another protocol is being used for the communication interface, additional settings
may be necessary. See Chapter “Settings” for further details.
After the settings have been made, the following checks should be carried out
again before the blocking is cancelled:
You can edit rights (associated Element To Secure (ETS)) for each role:
You can edit Elements To Secure (ETS) by editing permissions, objects and
rights:
Please, refer to the “Security Administration Tool ” for complete information about
security administration tool.
10.2.3 Testing
When testing trip or close commands configured to standard outputs, the CB must
not be mechanically locked, so that its auxiliary 52a/b contact could operate and
break the DC current. If the CB has to stay locked, tripping or closing circuit has to
be opened by terminal disconnection or test switch. Otherwise there is a high risk
of damaging the P139 output contact.
The manual trip command is not executed unless the manual trip is included in the
selection of possible functions to effect a trip (in the configuration of trip
commands).
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Before starting the test, open any triggering circuits for external devices so
that no inadvertent switching operations will take place.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog test values to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see Chapter “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Bus Bus
1,3,5
2,4,6
Px3x Px3x
Direction check: with active power flow ±180° ±0° ±180° ±0°
from Feeder to Bus: Load angle phi¹) =
from Bus to Feeder: Load angle phi¹) = ±0° ±180° ±0° ±180°
Im
I Re
19Z8833A
Devices from the “Easergy MiCOM 30” family use the current phasor as reference
for angle measurement. With positive reactive power the load angle is positive,
too.
Display Energy flow towards the line Energy flow towards the busbar
A
B BS
C
IA
IB
IC
IN
N
LS
P139
V̲A-G
- V̲N-G
I̲N I̲A
- I̲N
V̲C-G V̲N-G
V̲B-G
19Z5093A
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog test values to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see Chapter “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog test values to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see Chapter “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
stages” (Section 10.2.10.3, (p. 10-15)). Trip signals issued by the residual current
stages are now directional.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog test values to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see Chapter “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Before the motor protection can be tested the thermal replica must always be
cleared. Clearing the thermal replica is done by short term disabling of the
protection by setting MAIN: Devi ce on-l i ne to No (= off) (Par/Func/Glob menu
branch). The actual status of the thermal replica may be read out from the
operating data display at MP: The rm .r epl. buf f er MP (Oper/Cycl/Data menu
branch). Because the characteristic curve is settable, there can be different
tripping times:
With the thermal replica cleared an applied test current is abruptly changed from
0 (= machine stopped) to a value ≥ to the setting of MP: tIStUp> PS x, in the
Par/Func/PSx menu branch (= machine starting up):
36
t = t6I ·
ref (I / I ref)2
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog test values to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see Chapter “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
Before the thermal overload protection can be tested the thermal replica must
always be cleared. Clearing the thermal replica is done by short term disabling of
the protection by setting M AIN: D evi ce on-li ne to No (= off) (Par/Func/Glob
menu branch). The actual status of the thermal replica may be read out from the
V nom
|V | = 3 · V NG · 3
‾ test
In this formula VNG is the setting V<>: V NG> PSx or V <>: V NG>> PSx.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Application of analog test values to the measuring inputs must be in
compliance with the maximum permissible rating of the measuring inputs
(see Chapter “Technical Data”, Chapter 2).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
A
B BS
C
IN
k IN
A
T4
l
e N(e)
E(n) T90
V VNG
n
P139
U V W N
LS
V̲A-G
I̲B
I̲N
V̲C-G
I̲C V̲B-G
V̲N-G
V̲B-G
45Z5063B
Fig. 10-2: Ancillary circuit for systems with ground fault compensation and Holmgreen group, ground fault
towards BS.
First the fuse in the phase A line to the voltage transformer is removed and the
associated secondary VT line is short circuited (see Fig. 10-2, (p. 10-20) and
Fig. 10-3, (p. 10-21)). This will produce a neutral-point displacement voltage
V̲N‑G with an amplitude which is smaller by the factor 3 than with a saturated
ground fault.
If current is measured at a Holmgreen group the secondary side of the phase A
line current transformer must be disconnected and shorted (see Fig. 10-2, (p. 10-
20)).
A test-wire is inserted through the core balance current transformer to obtain a
current flow from the phase B line (see Fig. 10-3, (p. 10-21)). The ancillary
circuit figures include vector diagrams displaying the position of current and
voltage vectors.
A simulated ground fault on the busbar is displayed in the example. The current
connections or the voltage connections must be exchanged to test a ground fault
on the line side.
A
B BS
C
K k I̲N
T4
L l
e N(e)
E(n) T90
V VNG
n
U V W N
V̲A-G
LS
I̲N
V̲C-G V̲B-G
V̲N-G
V̲B-G 19Z5291C
Fig. 10-3: Ancillary circuit for systems with ground fault compensation and core balance current transformer,
ground fault towards BS.
A
B BS
C
IN
k IN
A
T4
l
e N(e)
E(n) T90
V VNG
n
P139
U V W N
LS
V̲A-G
I̲N
V̲C-G
V̲B-G
V̲B-G 45Z5065B
Fig. 10-4: Ancillary circuit for isolated neutral-point systems and Holmgreen group, ground fault towards LS.
First the fuse in the phase A line to the voltage transformer’s primary side is
removed and the associated secondary VT line is short circuited (see Fig. 10-4,
(p. 10-22) and Fig. 10-5, (p. 10-23)). This will produce a neutral-point
displacement voltage V̲N‑G with an amplitude which is smaller by the factor 3
than with a saturated ground fault.
If current is measured at a Holmgreen group the secondary side of the phase A
and B line current transformers must be disconnected and shorted (see Fig. 10-4,
(p. 10-22)).
A test-wire is inserted through the core balance current transformer to obtain
current flow from the phase B and C lines (see Fig. 10-5, (p. 10-23)). The
ancillary circuit figures include vector diagrams displaying the position of current
and voltage vectors.
A simulated ground fault on the line side is displayed in the example. The current
connections or the voltage connections must be exchanged to test a ground fault
on the busbar side.
A
B BS
C
K k I̲N
T4
L l
e N(e)
E(n) T90
V VNG
n
P139
A
U V W N
V̲A-G
LS
I̲B-C ≙ I̲N
V̲C-G V̲B-G
V̲N-G
V̲B-G
19Z5292C
Fig. 10-5: Ancillary circuit for isolated neutral-point systems and core balance current transformers, ground fault
towards LS.
A substation interlock is only effective when a communication link exists from the
communication interface to the substation control level. If the communication link
is disrupted then the device switches automatically to bay interlock (BI) without
substation interlock (SI). Whether or not a communication error is present can be
checked at M A I N : C o m m u n i c a t i o n e r r o r (Oper/Cycl/Log menu branch).
The substation interlock (SI) can be deactivated selectively for any switchgear unit
and in any control direction – “Open” or “Close”. (Check – e.g. for DEV01 – at
D E V 0 1 : O p e n w / o s t a t . i n t e r l or D E V 0 1 : C l o s e w / o s t a t . i n t . (Par/Func/
Cont menu branch).
11 Troubleshooting
This chapter describes problems that might be encountered, their causes, and
possible methods for eliminating them. It is intended as a general orientation
only, and in cases of doubt it is better to return the P139 to the manufacturer.
Please follow the packaging instructions in Section 5.1, (p. 5-4) when returning
equipment to the manufacturer.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Only qualified personnel, trained, authorized and familiar with the device
and all the safety instructions in the general Safety Guide (SFTY/5LM/L11
or later version) and appropriate Chapter 5, Chapter 10, Chapter 11,
Chapter 12 and Chapter 13 of this manual, shall work on installation,
connection, commissioning, maintenance or servicing of this device.
⚫ Before checking further, disconnect the P139 from the power supply.
⚫ Switch off all the power supplies in connection to the equipment to isolate
the device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ The local control panel (or front element) is connected to processor
module P by a plug-in connecting cable. Make sure the connector position
is correct. Do not bend the connecting cable!
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage
or unintended equipment operation.
Problem
● Lines of text are not displayed on the local control panel.
o Check to see whether there is supply voltage at the device connection
points.
o Check to see whether the magnitude of the auxiliary voltage is correct.
The P139 is protected against damage resulting from polarity reversal.
● The P139 issues an “Alarm” signal on LED H 3.
o Identify the specific problem by reading out the monitoring signal
memory (see Section 6.12.6.2, (p. 6-43)). The table below lists possible
monitoring or warning indication (provided that a configuration setting
has been entered at SFMON: Fct. ass ign. warning), the faulty area,
the P139's response, and the mode of the output relay configured for
“Warning” and “Blocked/faulty”.
Key
● –: No reaction and/or no output relay triggered.
● Yes: The corresponding output relay is triggered.
● Updating: The output relay configured for 'Warning' starts only if the
monitoring signal is still present.
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The external input CBF : CB fault y EX T has become active.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: W arning (LE D) 036 070
[spacer]
Warning configured for LED H3.
[spacer] SFMO N: W arning (re lay ) 036 100
[spacer]
Warning configured for an output relay.
[spacer] SFMO N: W arm re start e x ec. 041 202
[spacer]
A warm restart has been carried out.
[spacer] SFMO N: C old re star t exe c. 041 201
[spacer]
A cold restart has been carried out.
[spacer] SFMO N: C old re star t 093 024
[spacer]
A cold restart has been carried out on account of a checksum error in the
memory (NOVRAM).
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: C old re st./ SW update 093 025
[spacer]
A cold restart has been carried out following a software update.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: B lockin g/ HW fail ure 090 019
[spacer]
Supplementary warning that this device is blocked.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: R elay Kxx faulty 041 200
[spacer]
Multiple signal: output relay defective.
Device reaction: –
'Warning' output relay: Updating
'Blocked/faulty' output relay: Yes
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The hardware clock has failed.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: B at te ry failure 090 010
[spacer]
Battery voltage too low. Replace battery.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid SW d.loade d 096 121
[spacer]
Wrong or invalid software has been downloaded.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid type of bay 096 122
[spacer]
If the user has selected a bay type that requires a P139 hardware configuration
that is not actually fitted, then this signal is generated.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: +15V s upply faulty 093 081
[spacer]
The +15 V internal supply voltage has dropped below a minimum value.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: +24V s upply faulty 093 082
[spacer]
The +24 V internal supply voltage has dropped below a minimum value.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The −15 V internal supply voltage has dropped below a minimum value.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: W rong module s lot 1 096 100
[spacer]
Module in wrong slot.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The device has been fitted with a wrong digital bus. Since this is checked using
the module variant number this signal can also occur after a firmware upgrade
to a version that is not compatible with the hardware.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: W rong m odule HM I 096 124
[spacer]
The device has been fitted with a wrong HMI. Since this is checked using the
module variant number this signal can also occur after a firmware upgrade to a
version that is not compatible with the hardware.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: W rong m odule C omm 096 125
[spacer]
The device has been fitted with a wrong communication module. Since this is
checked using the module variant number this signal can also occur after a
firmware upgrade to a version that is not compatible with the hardware.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: W rong m odule Ana. Bus 096 126
[spacer]
The device has been fitted with a wrong analog bus. Since this is checked using
the module variant number this signal can also occur after a firmware upgrade
to a version that is not compatible with the hardware.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: D e fe ct.module slot 1 097 000
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Defective module in slot x.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: +15V fault y mod. N 093 096
[spacer]
The +15 V internal supply voltage of the transient ground fault evaluation
module has dropped below a minimum value.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: - 15V fault y mod. N 093 097
[spacer]
The −15 V internal supply voltage of the transient ground fault evaluation
module has dropped below a minimum value.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: D AC f au lt y module N 093 095
[spacer]
The digital-to-analog converter of the transient ground fault evaluation module
is defective.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The checksum feature of the transient ground fault evaluation module has
detected a fault in the data transmission of the Dual-Port-RAM.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M odule N RAM faulty 093 091
[spacer]
Fault in the program or data memory of the transient ground fault evaluation
module.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M odule Y DP R fault y 093 110
[spacer]
The checksum feature of analog I/O module Y has detected a fault in the data
transmission of the Dual-Port-RAM.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M odule Y RAM fault y 093 111
[spacer]
Fault in the program or data memory of the analog I/O module.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M od.Y R TD DP R fault y 093 108
[spacer]
The checksum feature of analog module (RTD) has detected a fault in the data
transmission of the Dual-Port-RAM.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M od.Y R TD RAM faul ty 093 109
[spacer]
Fault in the program or data memory of the analog module (RTD).
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: E rror K 7 07 097 084
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Output relay K xxx defective.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: U nd ef . ope r at. code 093 010
[spacer]
Undefined operation code.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: Abnormal t erminat ion 093 030
[spacer]
The application has been terminated in an unexpected way. If this error occurs
during a (re-)start of the device then this message is displayed and the device is
blocked.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: B ad arg. s ys t em call 093 031
[spacer]
Invalid parameter when calling a function of the operating system. If this error
occurs during a (re-)start of the device then this message is displayed and the
device is blocked.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: M ute x de adloc k 093 032
[spacer]
Software threads are locked from each other by mutex. If this error occurs
during a (re-)start of the device then this message is displayed and the device is
blocked.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Attempt to access an invalid memory segment. If this error occurs during a
(re-)start of the device then this message is displayed and the device is blocked.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: U ne xpe ct e d e xc ept ion 093 034
[spacer]
Miscellaneous error message from the processor or operating system. If this
error occurs during a (re-)start of the device then this message is displayed and
the device is blocked.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid ar ithm. op. 093 011
[spacer]
Invalid arithmetic operation.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: U nd ef ined i nter rupt 093 012
[spacer]
Undefined interrupt.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: E x ce pt ion oper .s ys t . 093 013
[spacer]
Interrupt of the operating system.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: Pr ote ction f ailure 090 021
[spacer]
Watchdog is monitoring the periodic start of protection routines. It has detected
an error.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
Parameter Address
[spacer]
A checksum error involving the parameters in the memory (NOVRAM) has been
detected.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: C lock sync. e rror 093 041
[spacer]
In 10 consecutive clock synchronization telegrams, the difference between the
time of day given in the telegram and that of the hardware clock is greater than
10 ms.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nt e rm.volt. fail.RAM 093 026
[spacer]
Faulty test pattern in the RAM. This can occur, for example, if the processor
module or the power supply module is removed from the bus module (digital).
This fault is only detected during device startup. After the fault is detected, the
software initializes the RAM. This means that all records are deleted.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: O ve rflow MT_RC 090 012
[spacer]
Last entry in the monitoring signal memory in the event of overflow.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C he ck s um DM OD 093 023
[spacer]
A checksum that was calculated from the data model in the memory of the
device yielded a wrong result. If this error occurs during a (re-)start of the device
then this message is displayed and the device is blocked.
1st device reaction: Warm restart
2nd device reaction: Device blocking
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: Yes
[spacer] SFMO N: S em aph. M T_RC block . 093 015
[spacer]
Software overloaded.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Incorrect or invalid communication software has been downloaded.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nval. C onfig. I EC 093 079
[spacer]
Invalid parameters in the IEC configuration.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid SW ver s. N 093 093
[spacer]
Incorrect or invalid software for transient ground fault evaluation module has
been downloaded.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: T im e -out module N 093 092
[spacer]
Watchdog is monitoring the periodic status signal of the transient ground fault
evaluation module. It has detected an error.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid SW ver s. Y 093 113
[spacer]
Incorrect or invalid software for analog I/O module Y has been downloaded.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid SW ver s YRTD 093 123
[spacer]
Incorrect or invalid software for analog module (RTD) has been downloaded.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: T im e -out module Y 093 112
[spacer]
Watchdog is monitoring the periodic status signal of the analog I/O module Y. It
has detected an error.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Watchdog is monitoring the periodic status signal of the analog module (RTD). It
has detected an error.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I RIGB faulty 093 117
[spacer]
The IRIGB interface is enabled but there is no plausible input signal.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M .c.b. trip V 098 000
[spacer]
The line-side voltage transformer m.c.b. has tripped.
Device reaction: Blocking of the short-circuit direction determination.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M .c.b. trip Vref 098 011
[spacer]
The m.c.b. monitoring the reference voltage transformer has tripped.
Device reaction: Blocking of automatic synchronism check (ASC).
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I ns ul. Alarm 1 098 091
[spacer]
The transformer monitoring has received/detected a Buchholz/insulation fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: D C Fault y 1 098 097
[spacer]
The transformer monitoring has received/detected a DC fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Measuring-circuit monitoring has detected a fault in the phase sequence of the
phase-to-ground voltages.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: U nd er volt age 098 009
[spacer]
The measuring-circuit monitoring function has detected an undervoltage.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: F F, Vref trigge re d 098 022
[spacer]
The fuse failure monitoring function has detected a fault in the reference
voltage-measuring circuit.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M .circ. V,Vref fl ty. 098 023
[spacer]
Multiple signal: Voltage-measuring circuits for phase-to-ground voltages or the
reference voltage faulty.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M eas . cir c. V f aul ty 098 017
[spacer]
Multiple signal: Voltage-measuring circuits faulty.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M eas . cir c. I fault y 098 005
[spacer]
The measuring-circuit monitoring function has detected a fault in the current-
measuring circuits.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: M eas .circ .V,I fault y 098 016
[spacer]
Multiple signal: Multiple signaling: Current- or voltage-measuring circuits faulty.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The set time C OMM3: T ime -out comm.faul t has elapsed since the most
recent 100% valid telegram was received. The receive signals are set to their
user-defined default values.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: Hardware e r ror COM M3 093 143
[spacer]
The device has detected a hardware error in the effective connection
InterMiCOM (communication interface 3).
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid SW ver s DHMI 093 145
[spacer]
Incorrect or invalid software was loaded to operate the detachable display
(DHMI).
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid confi g.TP Dx 093 160
[spacer]
An invalid assignment of switchgear units has been made for TPD1: TPD1
Dis connector and TP D1 : TP D1 gr ound. s wit ch.
Device reaction: Blocking of the Three Position Drive.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C omm.link fail.C OMM3 093 142
[spacer]
Timer stage COM M3: T ime -out link fail . has elapsed indicating a
persistent failure of the transmission channel. The receive signals are set to
their user-defined default values.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: L im .e x ce ed.,t e l.e r r. 093 141
[spacer]
The threshold set for timer stage COMM3: Limit telegr. e rrors was
exceeded and the receive signals are set to their user-defined default values.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: T elecom. faulty 098 006
[spacer]
The transmission channel of protective signaling is faulty.
Device reaction: Blocking of protective signaling.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
Invalid parameters in the setting for the thermal replica.
Device reaction: Blocking of thermal overload protection.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: S etting e rror CB M 098 020
[spacer]
An invalid characteristic has been set for circuit breaker monitoring.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C T A error 098 034
[spacer]
Measurement of the coolant temperature via the analog module is faulty.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: T GF D mon . tr igge re d 093 094
[spacer]
The monitoring function for transient ground fault direction determination has
operated.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C B No. C B op. > 098 066
[spacer]
The maximum number of CB operations performed has been exceeded.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: F ct s .not pe rm.f.60 Hz 093 098
[spacer]
A protective function has been activated that is not permitted for operation at a
system frequency of 60 Hz.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C B rem . No. C B op. < 098 067
[spacer]
The minimum number of CB operations performed at nominal current has fallen
below the threshold.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The maximum sum of disconnection current values has been exceeded.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C B ΣI trip**2 > 098 069
[spacer]
The maximum sum of the disconnection current values to the second power has
been exceeded.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid scali ng BCD 093 124
[spacer]
An invalid characteristic has been set for the BCD output channel of analog I/O
module Y.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C B tm ax> A 098 070
[spacer]
The maximum duration for the opening of a CB pole has been exceeded.
Disconnection is not determined for this CB pole.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid scali ng A-1 093 114
[spacer]
An invalid characteristic has been set for one of the analog output channels of
analog I/O module Y.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nvalid scali ng IDC 093 116
[spacer]
An invalid characteristic has been set for the analog input channel of analog I/O
module Y.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The P139 has detected an open circuit in the connection of the resistance
thermometer “PT100” to the analog I/O module Y.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: T 1 ope n circ. 098 029
[spacer]
The P139 has detected an open circuit in the connection of a resistance
thermometer Tx (x = 1 ... 9) to the analog module (RTD).
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: O ve rload 20 mA input 098 025
[spacer]
The 20 mA input of analog I/O module Y is overloaded.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: O pe n circ. 20 mA inp. 098 026
[spacer]
The P139 has detected an open circuit in the connection of the 20 mA input.
Device reaction: Depends on type of fault detected.
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: S etting e rror f<> 098 028
[spacer]
The over-/underfrequency protection function has been set for “overfrequency”
monitoring (based on the settings for operate value and nominal frequency).
This setting is not valid in the f w. Delta f/Delta t operating mode.
Device reaction: Blocking of the over-/under frequency protection function
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
Parameter Address
[spacer]
The underfrequency load shedding protection function Pf< has been set for
“overfrequency” monitoring (based on Pf< underfrequency threshold settings
and nominal frequency).
If fnom = 50 Hz and any Pf< threshold setting is greater or equal to 50 Hz, the
alarm is raised and the Pf< function is blocked. Ditto fnom = 60 Hz and any Pf<
threshold setting is equal to 60 Hz.
Whether the threshold with false setting is activated or not does not matter.
Device reaction: Blocking of the underfrequency load shedding protection
function Pf<
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: I nv.inp.f.cloc k sy nc 093 120
[spacer]
The function was configured to a binary signal input on the analog I/O module Y.
Such a configuration is not permitted for this function.
Device reaction: –
“Warning” output relay: Updating
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: O utput 30 098 053
[spacer]
These LOGIC outputs can be included in the list of warning signals by selection
at S FMON: Fct. ass ign. warning. The warning signals are also recorded
in the monitoring signal memory.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
[spacer] SFMO N: C B pos .s ig. implaus. 098 124
[spacer]
The plausibility logic was triggered during the acquisition of the circuit breaker's
(CB) status signals.
“Warning” output relay: Yes
“Blocked/faulty” output relay: –
12 Maintenance
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Only qualified personnel, trained, authorized and familiar with the device
and all the safety instructions in the general Safety Guide (SFTY/5LM/L11
or later version) and appropriate Chapter5, Chapter 10, Chapter 11,
Chapter 12 and Chapter 13 of this manual, shall work on installation,
connection, commissioning, maintenance or servicing of this device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
The P139 is a low-maintenance device. The components used in the units are
selected to meet exacting requirements. Recalibration is not necessary.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Always disconnect the device from the auxiliary power supply, before
removing any hardware module.
⚫ Switch off all the power supplies in connection to the equipment to isolate
the device, before removing any hardware module.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ The power supply must be turned off for at least 5 s before power supply
module V is removed. Otherwise there is the danger of an electric shock.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
⚫ The local control panel (or front element) is connected to processor
module P by a plug-in connecting cable. Make sure the connector position
is correct. Do not bend the connecting cable!
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage
or unintended equipment operation.
In general, the electronic components used for the device family Easergy MiCOM
30 are designed for a long service life.
For the power supply, however, dimensioning requirements dictate the use of
electrolytic capacitors that are subject to increased wear and tear. The useful life
of these capacitors depends on their temperature and thus on the components
fitted in the device, the load conditions, device location and environmental
conditions.
The internal voltage levels are cyclically checked by the P30 self-monitoring
functions. In case the voltage levels deviate from their specified values a warning
message will be issued or, for persistent problems, the device will be set to a
safe condition (blocking).
Moreover, the power supply module of the P139 is equipped with a lithium
battery for non-volatile storage of fault data and for keeping the internal clock
running in the event of failure of the auxiliary power supply. The useful life of the
lithium battery depends on the auxiliary power supply of the device.
● If the P139 is continuously connected to the auxiliary power supply, then
there is no discharging of the battery, and the battery will thus not be
depleted during its service life.
● Should the P139 be disconnected from the auxiliary power supply for
several years, then the battery capacity would decrease.
During normal operation, the battery voltage is monitored. If the voltage falls
below a pre-defined threshold, a warning message will be issued and the battery
has to be replaced.
After the maintenance procedures described above have been completed, new
commissioning tests as described in Section 10.2, (p. 10-5) must be carried out.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
⚫ Before starting the test, open any triggering circuits for external devices so
that no inadvertent switching operations will take place.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious
injury.
13 Storage
Devices must be stored in a dry and clean environment. A temperature range of
-25°C to +70°C (-13°F to +158°F) must be maintained during storage (see
chapter entitled “Technical Data”). The relative humidity must be controlled so
that neither condensation nor ice formation will result.
If the units are stored without being connected to auxiliary voltage, then the
electrolytic capacitors in the power supply area need to be recharged every
4 years. Recharge the capacitors by connecting auxiliary voltage to the P139 for
approximately 10 minutes.
If the units are stored during a longer time, the battery of the power supply
module is used for the continuous buffering of the event data in the working
memory of the processor module. Therefore the battery is permanently required
and discharges over time. In order to avoid this continuous discharge, it is
recommended to remove the power supply module from the mounting rack
during long storage periods. The contents of the event memory should be
previously read out and stored separately!
WARNING
HAZARD OF EQUIPMENT DAMAGE OR LIFETIME REDUCTION
⚫ Do not sustain exposure to high humidity during storage, the value shall
not exceed 75% relative humidity.
⚫ Once the device has been unpacked, it is recommended to energize it
within the three following months.
⚫ The device has to be energized at least once in 4 years, if it is not in
permanent operation.
⚫ Where electrical equipment is being installed, sufficient time should be
allowed for acclimatization to the ambient temperature of the environment
before energization.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage,
unintended equipment operation or reduction of equipment lifetime.
84 TE frame 88512‑4‑9650723‑301
15 Order Information
Basic Configuration Variants
Feeder Management and Bay Control P139- 9 0 -316 -4xx -661 -7xx -47x -46x -9x x -9x x -8xx
Basic device:
Basic device 40TE, pin-terminal connection, 3 -426
Basic device 40TE, CT/VT ring-, I/O pin-terminal connection, 5 -427
20)
Basic device 84TE, ring-terminal connection, 8 -428
basic complement with 4 binary inputs, 8 output relays
and 6 binary inputs and 6 output relays (2-pole) for the
control of 3 switchgear units
Current transformer:
2)
Inom = 1 A / 5 A (T1...T4) 9
Voltage transformer:
Without 0
Vnom = 50 ... 130 V (4-pole) 4
Vnom = 50 ... 130 V (5-pole) for automatic synchronism control 5
Additional binary I/O options:
Without 0
With 1 binary module (add. 6 binary inputs and 6 output relays (2-pole)) 5
for the control of up to 3 additional switchgear units
Further Options
Feeder Management and Bay Control P139- 9 0 -316 -4xx -661 -7xx -47x -46x -9x x -9x x -8xx
19)
Binary modules with single pole high break contacts for control :
Without high break contact characteristic Without order extension No.
With 1 module with high break contacts (1-pole) -471
With 2 modules with high break contacts (1-pole) -472
Communication Options
Feeder Management and Bay Control P139- 9 0 -316 -4xx -661 -7xx -47x -46x -9x x -9x x -8xx
26)
Ethernet Board 2, 100 Mbit/s, Protocol IEC 61850 Ed. 1/ Ed. 2/ IEC 60870-5-104 (switchable)
without Cyber Security compatibility -97
27)
with advanced Cyber Security compatibility -99
Language:
4)
English (German) Without order extension No.
4)
Px40 English (English) Not yet available - on request -800
4)
German (English) -801
4)
French (English) Not yet available - on request -802
4)
Spanish (English) Not yet available - on request -803
4)
Polish (English) -804
4) 7)
Russian (English) Not yet available - on request -805
4) 20)
Chinese (English) Not yet available - on request -806
Key
2) Switching via parameter, default setting is underlined!
3) This option is excluded if the InterMiCOM interface (‑95x) is ordered.
4) Second included language in brackets.
7) Hardware option, supports Cyrillic letters instead of special West. European
characters.
8) Standard variant recommended if higher pickup threshold not explicitly required
by the application.
10) Transient ground fault option for variants with current and voltage
transformers only.
19) Depending on the selected numbers of binary modules (6 binary inputs and
6 output relays). Use of High-break contacts: 1-pole only.
20) The Chinese HMI is available only for 40T variants.
26) Option IEC 60870-5-104 only for German market and on request.
27) According to BDEW / NERC / IEEE 1686.
Schneider Electric
35 rue Joseph Monier
92506 Rueil-Malmaison
FRANCE
Phone: +33 (0) 1 41 29 70 00
Fax: +33 (0) 1 41 29 71 00
www.schneider-electric.com
Publishing: Schneider Electric
Publication: P139/EN M/R-b5-B Volume 1 05/2019